Dictionary New One
Dictionary New One
Dictionary New One
subsets of 𝑋.
α-CUT OF A FUZZY SET: An α-cut of a fuzzy set 𝐴 is a crisp set 𝐴, that contains all the
elements in 𝑈 that have membership values in 𝐴 greater than or equal to a, that is,
𝐴𝛼 = {𝒂 ∇ 𝑈; 𝝁𝑨 (𝑥) ≥ 𝛼}
ς-ALGEBRA: Let X be a set. A ς-algebra on 𝑋 is a collection of subsets of 𝑋, say 𝑅 ⊆ 2𝑋 ,
such that
1. 𝑋 ∇ 𝑅;
2. if 𝐴, 𝐵 ∇ 𝑅, then 𝐴 ∖ 𝐵 ∇ 𝑅;
If we drop the first condition from the definition we got a ς-ring. Note, that in the third
condition we admit any countable unions. The empty set belongs to any ς-algebra. For
a 𝜍-algebra 𝑅 and 𝐴, 𝐵 ∇ 𝑅, we have 𝐴 ∩ 𝐵 = 𝑋\ 𝑋\(𝐴 ∩ 𝐵) = X ((X\A)⋃(X\B) ) ∇ R .
Note that
ς-LOCALLY FINITE BASE: A ς-locally finite base is a base which is a union of countably
many locally finite collections of open sets.
Ɛ-Net: A sub set S of a metric space X is called ɛ-net if for any point in X there is a point
in S on the distance ≤ ɛ. This is different from topological nets which oversimplify
limits.
A
A-SET: It is the continuous image of a Borel set. Since any Borel set is a continuous
image of the set of irrational numbers, an A-set can be defined as a continuous image of
the set of irrational numbers.
A countable intersection and a countable union of A-sets is an A-set.
Any A-set is Lebesgue-measurable.
The property of being an A-set is invariant relative to Borel-measurable
mappings, and to A-operations. Moreover, for a set to be an A-set it is necessary
and sufficient that it can be represented as the result of an A-operation applied to
a family of closed sets.
Any uncountable A-set topologically contains a perfect Cantor set.
ABACUS: Abacus is a counting device consisting of rods on which beads can be moved
so as to represent numbers.
abc CONJECTURE: (1) The abc conjecture of Masser and Oesterlé efforts to state as much
as possible about repeated prime factors in an equation a + b = c. For example 3 + 125
= 128 but the prime powers here are special.
(2) 𝑎𝑚 + 𝑏 𝑛 = 𝑐 𝑝 has no solution in integers if a, b, c >2
ABEL DIFFERENTIAL EQUATION: The ordinary differential equation
If 𝑓1 ∇ 𝐶(𝑎, 𝑏) and 𝑓2 , 𝑓3 ∇ 𝐶1 (𝑎, 𝑏) and 𝑓3 (𝑥) ≠ 0 for 𝑥 ∇ [𝑎, 𝑏], then Abel's differential
equation of the first kind can be reduced to the normal form 𝑑𝑧/𝑑𝑡 = 𝑧 3 + 𝛷(𝑡) by
substitution of variables. In the general case, Abel's differential equation of the first kind
cannot be integrated in closed form, though this is possible in special cases.
If 𝑔0 , 𝑔1 ∇ 𝐶1 (𝑎, 𝑏) and 𝑔1 (𝑥) ≠ 0, 𝑔0 (𝑥) + 𝑔1 (𝑥)𝑦 ≠ 0, Abel's differential equation of
the second kind can be reduced to Abel's differential equation of the first kind by
substituting
𝑔0 (𝑥) + 𝑔1 (𝑥)𝑦 = 1/𝑧.
ABELIAN CATEGORY: An Abelian category is an abstract mathematical category which
displays some of the characteristic properties of the category of all abelian groups.
ABELIAN DIFFERENTIALS: An Abelian differential on a closed Riemann surface ℛ is, by
definition, a complex differential form 𝑤 = 𝑎(𝑧)𝑑𝑧, where 𝑎(𝑧) is a meromorphic
function of a local parameter 𝑧. Such a differential is said to be of the first kind if 𝑎(𝑧) is
holomorphic, of the second kind if the residue vanishes everywhere, and of the third
kind otherwise.
ABELIAN FUNCTION: An inverse function of an abelian integral. Abelian functions have
two variables and four periods. They are a generalization of elliptic functions, and, are
also called hyper elliptic functions.
A complete classification is known for finitely generated Abelian groups. This is given by
the fundamental theorem of finitely generated Abelian groups:
Every finitely generated Abelian group is a direct sum of finitely many non-split cyclic
subgroups some of which are finite and primary, while the others are infinite. In
particular, finite Abelian groups split into a direct sum of primary cyclic groups. Such
splittings are, in general, not unique, but any two splitting of a finitely generated Abelian
group into direct sums of non-split cyclic groups are isomorphic, so that the number of
infinite cyclic summands and the collection of the orders of the primary cyclic
summands do not depend on the splitting chosen. These numbers are called invariants
of the finitely generated Abelian group.
Two finitely generated Abelian groups are isomorphic if and only if they have the
same invariants.
Not every Abelian group is a direct sum of (even infinitely many) cyclic groups.
Any subgroup of an Abelian group that is a direct sum of cyclic groups itself is
such a direct sum.
A finite set of elements 𝑔1 , … , 𝑔𝑘 in an Abelian group is called linearly dependent if there
𝑘
exist integers 𝑛1 , … , 𝑛𝑘 , not all equal to zero, such that 𝑖=1 𝑛𝑖 𝑔𝑖 = 0. If such numbers do
not exist, the set is said to be linearly independent. An arbitrary collection of elements
of A is said to be linearly dependent if there exists a finite linearly dependent sub
collection. An Abelian group that is not a torsion group has maximal linearly
independent sets. The cardinality of all maximal linearly independent collections of
elements is the same and is called the rank of the given Abelian group. The rank of a
torsion group is considered to be zero. The rank of a free Abelian group coincides with
the cardinality of a set of free generators of it.
ABEL’S IMPOSSIBILITY THEOREM: In general, polynomial equations higher than
fourth degree are incapable of algebraic solution in terms of a finite number of
additions, multiplications, and root extractions.
ABEL’S INEQUALITY: If ⌌𝑎𝑛 ⌍ and ⌌𝑏𝑛 ⌍ are sequences such that for some 𝑚 ∇ 𝑁, and
𝑛
𝛼 ∇ 𝑅 +, 𝑏1 ≥ 𝑏2 ≥ 𝑏3 ≥ . . . ≥ 𝑏𝑚 −1 ≥ 𝑏𝑚 ≥ 0 and |𝑠𝑛 | ≅ 𝑖=1 𝑎𝑖 ≤𝛼 for
𝑛
𝑛 = 1, 2, . . . , 𝑚, then 𝑖=1 𝑎𝑖 𝑏𝑖 ≤ 𝛼𝑏1 .
ABEL’S IRREDUCIBILITY THEOREM: If one root of the equation 𝑓(𝑥) = 0, which is
irreducible over a field K, is also a root of the equation 𝐹(𝑥) = 0 in K, then all the roots
of the irreducible equation 𝑓(𝑥) = 0 are roots of 𝐹(𝑥) = 0. Equivalently, 𝐹(𝑥) can be
divided by 𝑓(𝑥) without a remainder, 𝐹(𝑥) = 𝑓(𝑥)𝑔(𝑥), where 𝑔(𝑥) is also a polynomial
over K.
ABEL, NIELS HENRIK (1802–29): Norwegian mathematician who, at the age of 19,
proved that the general equation of degree greater than 4 cannot be solved
algebraically. He was also responsible for fundamental developments in the theory of
algebraic functions. He died in some poverty at the age of 26, just a few days before he
would have received a letter announcing his appointment to a professorship in Berlin.
lim 𝑠 𝑧 = 𝑠(𝑧0 )
𝑧→𝑧0
This limit always exists along the radius: The series
∞
𝑘
𝑆 𝑧 = 𝑎𝑘 𝑧 − 𝑏
𝑘=0
converges uniformly along any radius of the disc of convergence joining the
points 𝑏 and 𝑧0 . This theorem is used, in particular, to calculate the sum of a power
series which converges at the boundary points of the disc of convergence.
n+k n+k
For any n ≥ 0 and any k ≥ 1; this formula also holds for n = −1 if we put 𝐴−1 = 0.
ABEL’S TEST: Abel’s test is a test for the convergence of an infinite series which states
that if 𝛴𝑎𝑛 is a convergent series, and {𝑏𝑛 } is monotonically decreasing, then 𝛴𝑎𝑛 𝑏𝑛 is
also convergent.
ABEL’S THEOREM (ALGEBRAIC EQUATIONS): Formulas expressing the solution of an
arbitrary equation of degree in terms of its coefficients using radicals do not exist for
any 𝑛 ≥ 5 . The theorem was proved by N.H. Abel in 1824. Abel's theorem may also be
obtained as a corollary of Galois Theory, from which a more general theorem follows:
For any 𝑛 ≥ 5 there exist algebraic equations with integer coefficients whose roots
cannot be expressed in terms of radicals of rational numbers.
ABOVE (GREATER THAN): The limit of a function at 𝑎 from above is the limit of 𝑓(𝑥) as
𝑥 → 𝑎 for values of 𝑥 > 𝑎. It is of particular importance when 𝑓(𝑥) has a discontinuity
at 𝑎, i.e. where the limits from above and from below do not coincide. It can be written
as 𝑓(𝑎+) or lim𝑥→𝑎+ 𝑓(𝑥).
ABRIDGED MULTIPLICATION: A method of multiplication where digits may be dropped
in each step of the calculation, in order to simplify the calculations, while maintaining
the desired level of accuracy, usually expressed in terms of decimal places.
ABSCISSA: Abscissa in two dimensional plane means x-coordinate. The abscissa of the
point (a, b) in Cartesian coordinates is a.
ABSOLUTE CONTINUITY OF LEBESGUE INTEGRAL: Let 𝑓 ∇ 𝐿1 (𝑋). Then for any 𝜀 > 0
there is a 𝛿 > 0 such that
∫ 𝑓 𝑑µ < 𝜀 𝑖𝑓 µ 𝐴 < 𝛿.
𝐴
Let 𝑋 and 𝑌 be spaces, and let 𝑆 and 𝑇 be semirings on 𝑋 and 𝑌 respectively and µ and 𝜈
be measures on 𝑆 and 𝑇 respectively. If µ and 𝜈 are 𝜍 −additive, then the product
measure 𝜈 × µ is 𝜍 −additive as well.
Let 𝐶 ∇ 𝐿(𝑋 × 𝑌). For almost every 𝑥 ∇ 𝑋 the set 𝐶𝑥 = {𝑦 ∇ 𝑌: (𝑥, 𝑦) ∇ 𝐶} is
𝜈 −measurable and 𝜈(𝐶𝑥 ) = 𝑓𝐶 (𝑥).
Any measurable set is up to a set of zero measure can be received from elementary sets
by two monotonic limits.
ABSOLUTE ERROR: The difference between the measured value or the approximation of
a quantity and the true value. When 0.7 is used as an approximation for 0.709, the error
equals (0.7-0.709), which is -0.009. In this case, the absolute error is |0.7-0.709|, which
is 0.009.
ABSOLUTE EXTREMUM: It is also known as an absolute maximum or an absolute
minimum.
ABSOLUTE FREQUENCY: Absolute frequency is the number of occurrences of an event.
For example, if a die is rolled 50 times and 8 sixes are observed, the absolute frequency
of sixes is 8 and the relative frequency is 8/50.
ABSOLUTE GEOMETRY: The term Absolute Geometry had been introduced by J. Bolyai
in 1832. Absolute Geometry is derived from the first four of Euclid's postulates. The first
28 Propositions from Elements, I belong to Absolute Geometry. Euclid apparently made
a conscientious effort to see how far he can reach without invoking his Fifth postulate.
All theorems of Absolute Geometry are automatically true in the geometries of Euclid,
Lobachevsky and Riemann since those three only differ in their treatment of the Fifth
postulate.
ABSOLUTE INEQUALITY: It is an inequality that contains absolute value(s). Example: |7x
- 6| < 1.
ABSOLUTELY CONTINUOUS CHARGE: Let 𝑋 be a set with 𝜍 −algebra 𝑅 and 𝜍 −finite
measure µ and finite charge 𝜈 on 𝑅. The charge 𝜈 is absolutely continuous with respect
to µ if µ(𝐴) = 0 for 𝐴 ∇ 𝑅 implies 𝜈(𝐴) = 0. Two charges 𝜈1 and 𝜈2 are equivalent if two
conditions | 𝜈1 |(𝐴) = 0 and | 𝜈2 |(𝐴) = 0 are equivalent.
ABSOLUTE NUMBER: A real value with its sign ignored - the result of applying
the modulus function to a value.
𝑧 = 𝑎2 + 𝑏 2 .
It is to be noted that absolute value of a complex number 𝑧 is again the distance from
origin (zero) to that number 𝑧.
In a similar fashion, we can define the absolute value of a number 𝑎 ∇ 𝑅 𝑛 as
𝑎 = 𝑎1 2 + 𝑎2 2 + − − − − +𝑎𝑛 2 , where 𝑎 = 𝑎1 , 𝑎2 , − − −𝑎𝑛 .
It is to be noted that absolute value of a number 𝑎 ∇ 𝑅 𝑛 is again the distance from origin
(zero) to that number 𝑎 in n dimensional space.
ABSORPTION LAWS: For all sets A and B, we have
𝐴 ∩ (𝐴 ∪ 𝐵) = 𝐴 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝐴 ∪ (𝐴 ∩ 𝐵) = 𝐴.
These are said to be the absorption laws.
ABSTRACT ALGEBRA: It is the area of mathematics concerned with algebraic structures
involving sets of elements with particular operations satisfying certain axioms such as
groups, rings and fields.
ABSTRACTION: Abstraction is the process of making a general statement which
summarizes what can be observed in particular instances. For example, we can say that
𝑥 3 < 𝑥 for 0 < 𝑥 < 1 and 𝑥 3 > 𝑥 for 𝑥 < 0 𝑜𝑟 𝑥 > 1. Mathematical theorems are
essentially abstraction of concepts to a higher level.
ABSTRACT MANIFOLD: An abstract manifold (or just a manifold) of dimension m, is a
Hausdorff topological space 𝑀, equipped with an m-dimensional smooth atlas.
Compatible atlases are regarded as belonging to the same manifold (the precise
definition is thus that a manifold is a Hausdorff topological space equipped with a
smooth structure). A chart on 𝑀 is a chart from any atlas compatible with the structure.
It is often required of an abstract manifold that it should have a countable atlas.
ABSTRACT SUBMANIFOLD: Let 𝑀 be an abstract manifold. An abstract submanifold of 𝑀
is a subset 𝑁 ⊂ 𝑀 which is an abstract manifold on its own such that:
(i) the topology of 𝑁 is induced from 𝑀,
(ii) the inclusion map 𝑖: 𝑁 → 𝑀 is smooth, and
(iii) the differential 𝑑𝑖𝑝 : 𝑇𝑝 𝑁 → 𝑇𝑝 𝑀 is injective for each 𝑝 ∇ 𝑁.
In this case, the manifold 𝑀 is said to be ambient to 𝑁. In particular, since 𝑑𝑖𝑝 is injective,
the dimension of 𝑁 must be smaller than or equal to that of 𝑀.
ABUNDANCE: The abundance of a number 𝑛 is the quantity
𝐴 𝑛 = 𝜍(𝑛) 2𝑛,
where 𝑜(𝑛) is the divisor function. Kravitz has conjectured that no numbers exist whose
abundance is an odd square.
The following table lists special classifications given to a number n based on the value of
A(n).
A(n) Number
<0 deficient number
-1 almost perfect number
0 perfect number
1 Quasi-perfect number
>1 abundant number
ABUNDANT NUMBER: Abundant number is a positive integer that is smaller than the
sum of its positive divisors, not including itself, For example, 12 is divisible by 1, 2, 3, 4
and 6, and 1 + 2 + 3 + 4 + 6 = 16 > 12.
AC: It is the abbreviation for Axiom of Choice.
ACCELERATION: The acceleration of a moving object measures the rate of change in its
velocity with respect to time. For example, if a car increases its velocity from 20 to 45
45−20
meters/ second in 8 seconds, its acceleration would be = 3.125 meters/ second2
8
Newton obtained that, if F represents the force acting on a moving object and m
represents its mass, the acceleration 𝑎 of the moving object is determined by the
formula 𝐹 = 𝑚𝑎.
ACCEPTANCE REGION: The set of values for a random variable in hypothesis
testing such that the null hypothesis is not rejected.
∅B = − rdr
OAB
For all paths from O to B. Thus the motion in which the velocity potential is single
valued is called acyclic. In simply connected region the only possible irrotational motion
is acylic. When the velocity potential is not single- valued, the motion is said to be cyclic
i.e., it is not possible to assign to every point of the original region a unique and definite
value of ∅.
Note that A + B is also a matrix of the type 𝑚 × 𝑛. More clearly we can say that:
Then
a11 + b11 a12 + b12 … a1n + b1n
a + b21 a22 + b22 … a2n + b2n
A + B = 21
……… ……… … ……
am1 + bm1 am2 + bm2 … amn + bmn m×n.
For example, if
3 2 −1 1 −2 7
A= and B = ; then
4 −3 1 2×3 3 2 −1 2×3
3+1 2 − 2 −1 + 7 4 0 6
A+B= =
4+3 −3 + 2 1 − 1 7 −1 0 2×3.
It should be noted that addition is defined only for matrices which are of the same size.
If two matrices A and B are of the same size, they are said to be conformable for
addition. If the matrices A and BA are not of the same size, we cannot find their sum.
ADDITION (OF VECTORS): Given vectors 𝒂 and 𝒃, let 𝑂𝐴 and 𝑂𝐵 be directed line-
segments that represent 𝒂 and 𝒃, with the same initial point O. The sum of 𝑂𝐴 and 𝑂𝐵 is
the directed line-segment 𝑂𝐶 , where OACB is a parallelogram, and the sum 𝒂 + 𝒃 is
defined to be the vector c represented by 𝑂𝐶 .
This is called the parallelogram law. Alternatively, the sum of vectors 𝒂 and 𝒃 can be
defined by representing a by a directed line-segment 𝑂𝑃 and 𝒃 by 𝑃𝑄 where the final
point of the first directed line-segment is the initial point of the second. Then 𝒂 + 𝒃 is
the vector represented by 𝑂𝑄. This is called the triangle law. Addition of vectors has the
following properties, which hold for all a, b and c:
(i) 𝒂 + 𝒃 = 𝒃 + 𝒂, the commutative law.
(ii) 𝒂 + (𝒃 + 𝒄) = (𝒂 + 𝒃) + 𝒄, the associative law.
(iii) 𝒂 + 𝟎 = 𝟎 + 𝒂 = 𝒂, where 0 is the zero vector.
(iv) 𝒂 + (−𝒂) = (−𝒂) + 𝒂 = 𝟎, where −𝒂 is the negative of 𝒂.
ADDITION LAW: In the theory of probability, If A and B are two events then the addition
law states that the
𝑃(𝐴 ∪ 𝐵) = 𝑃(𝐴) + 𝑃(𝐵) − 𝑃(𝐴 ∩ 𝐵).
In the special case, where A and B are mutually exclusive events this reduces to
𝑃(𝐴 ∪ 𝐵) = 𝑃(𝐴) + 𝑃(𝐵).
ADDITIVE FUNCTION: A function 𝑓(𝑥) over a domain 𝐷 is said to be an additive
functiuon if
𝑓 𝑥 + 𝑦 = 𝑓 𝑥 + 𝑓 𝑦 ∀𝑥, 𝑦 ∇ 𝐷.
For example, 𝑓(𝑥) = 𝑛𝑥 is an additive function since
𝑓 𝑥 + 𝑦 = 𝑛 𝑥 + 𝑦 = 𝑛𝑥 + 𝑛𝑦 = 𝑓(𝑥) + 𝑓(𝑦)
ADDITIVE GROUP: A group G with the operation + (addition) may be called an additive
group.
ADDITIVE IDENTITY: The number zero is known as the additive identity element,
because it satisfies the property that the addition of zero does not change a number:
𝑎 + 0 = 𝑎 = 0 + 𝑎 ∀ 𝑎 ∇ 𝑅..
ADDITIVE INVERSE: The sum of a number and its additive inverse is zero. The additive
inverse of 𝑎 (written as −𝑎) is also called the negative or the opposite of 𝑎: 𝑎 + −𝑎 =
0 = −𝑎 + 𝑎 ∀ 𝑎 ∇ 𝑅. For example, -6 is the additive inverse of 6 and -7 is the additive
inverse of 7.
ADHERENT POINT: Adherent point of a set A is a point of the set A in a topological space
that belongs to the closure of a set A. In other words, a point 𝑝 ∇ 𝑆 is said to be an
adherent point of 𝑆 if every nbd of 𝑝 contains a point of 𝑆. The set of all adherent points
of the set 𝑆 is called adherence of 𝑆 and is denoted by 𝐴𝑑 𝐴.
ADHERENT POINT OF A FILTER: Let (𝐸, 𝑇) be a topological space and 𝐹 a filter on 𝐸. A
point 𝑥 ∇ 𝐸 is said to be adherent point of 𝐹 if it is adherent to every 𝐴 ∇ 𝐹, i.e. if every
𝑋 ∇ 𝐵(𝑥) meets every 𝐴 ∇ 𝐹. Consider in 𝑅 the set of points 1/𝑛, 1 − 1/𝑛 (where
𝑛 ∇ 𝑁) and the point 2. Let 𝐹 be the filter consisting of the complements of finite
subsets of this set. 𝐹 has the points 0 and 1 as adherent points.
AD INFINITUM: Literally meaning "to infinity" in Latin. It is a phrase used in
mathematics (and other fields) as a more elegant way of what is more commonly
expressed as "... and so on and so forth".
ADJACENCY RELATION: The set E of edges of a graph (V, E), being a set of unordered
pairs of elements of V, constitutes a relation on V. Formally, an adjacency relation is any
relation which is irreflexive and symmetric.
ADJACENT ANGLES: Two angles that share a ray, thereby being directly next to each
other
ADJACENT EDGES: Adjacent edges are a pair of edges in a graph joined by a common
vertex.
ADJACENT FRACTION: Two fractions are said to be adjacent if their difference has a
unit numerator. For example, I/3 and 1/4 are adjacent since l/3 - l/4 = l/12, but l/2 and
l/5 are not since l/2 - l/5 = 3/10. Adjacent fractions can be adjacent in a Farey sequence.
of the matrix B = Aij , where Aij denotes the cofactor of the element aij in the
n×n
determinant A , is called the adjoint of the matrix A and is denoted by ht symbol Adj. A.
If A be any n-rowed square matrix, then Adj A A = A Adj A = A In , where 𝐼𝑛 is the n-
rowed unit matrix.
ADJOINT OPERATOR: Let 𝐻 and 𝐾 be Hilbert Spaces and 𝑇 ∇ 𝐵(𝐻, 𝐾). Then there exists
operator 𝑇 ∗∇ 𝐵(𝐾, 𝐻) such that ⟨ 𝑇, 𝑘 ⟩𝐾 = ⟨ , 𝑇 ∗ 𝑘 ⟩𝐻 for all ∇ 𝐻, 𝑘 ∇ 𝐾. Such
𝑇 ∗ is called the adjoint operator of 𝑇. Also 𝑇 ∗∗ = 𝑇 𝑎𝑛𝑑 ||𝑇 ∗ || = ||𝑇||.
For operators 𝑇1 and 𝑇2 , (𝑇1 𝑇2 )*= 𝑇2 *𝑇1 *, (𝑇1 +𝑇2 )*= 𝑇1 *+𝑇2 * and λ T)*=λT*.
If A is an operator on a Hilbert space H then (𝑘𝑒𝑟𝐴)⊥ = 𝐼𝑚 𝐴∗ .
ADJUNCTION: If 𝑎 is an element of a field 𝑓 over the prime field 𝑃, then the set of all
rational functions of a with coefficients in 𝑃 is a field derived from 𝑃 by adjunction of 𝑎.
ADMISSIBLE HYPOTHESIS: Any hypothesis that has not been ruled out, that is, a
hypothesis that may possibly be true.
a.e.: It is the abbreviation for almost everywhere
AEROFOIL: The aerofoil has a profile if fish type. It is used in modern airplanes. Such an
aerofoil has a blunt leading edge and a sharp trailing edge. The projection of the profile
on the double tangent is the chord. The ratio of the span to the chord is the aspect ratio.
The locus of the point midway between the points in which an ordinate perpendicular
to the chord meets the profile is known as the camber line of a profile. The camber is the
ratio of the maximum ordinate of the camber line to the chord.
The theory of the flow round such an aerofoil is made on the following assumptions:
AGREE: If 𝑓(𝑥) and 𝑔(𝑥) are two functions defined on a set S, and 𝑓(𝑥) = 𝑔(𝑥) for all
𝑥 ∇ 𝑆, then we say that 𝑓 and 𝑔 agree on the set 𝑆.
Ai: It is the abbreviation for Airy function.
AHLFORS-BERS THEOREM: The Riemann’s moduli space gives the solution to
Riemann’s moduli problem, which requires an analytic parameterization of the compact
Riemann surfaces in a fixed homeomorphism.
ALGEBRA OF SETS: The set of all subsets of a universal set E is closed under the binary
operations ∪ union and ∩ intersection and the unary operation complementation .
The following are some of the properties, or laws, that hold for subsets A, B and C of E:
(i) 𝐴 ∪ (𝐵 ∪ 𝐶) = (𝐴 ∪ 𝐵) ∪ 𝐶 and 𝐴 ∩ (𝐵 ∩ 𝐶) = (𝐴 ∩ 𝐵) ∩ 𝐶 (Associative
property)
(ii) 𝐴 ∪ 𝐵 = 𝐵 ∪ 𝐴 and 𝐴 ∩ 𝐵 = 𝐵 ∩ 𝐴 (commutative property)
(iii) 𝐴 ∪ Ø = 𝐴 and 𝐴 ∩ Ø = Ø, where Ø is the empty set.
(iv) 𝐴 ∪ 𝐸 = 𝐸 and 𝐴 ∩ 𝐸 = 𝐴.
(v) 𝐴 ∪ 𝐴 = 𝐴 and 𝐴 ∩ 𝐴 = 𝐴.
(vi) 𝐴 ∩ (𝐵 ∪ 𝐶) = (𝐴 ∩ 𝐵) ∪ (𝐴 ∩ 𝐶)
and 𝐴 ∪ (𝐵 ∩ 𝐶) = (𝐴 ∪ 𝐵) ∩ (𝐴 ∪ 𝐶) (distributive property)
(vii) 𝐴 ∪ 𝐴′ = 𝐸 and 𝐴 ∩ 𝐴′ = Ø.
(viii) 𝐸′ = Ø and Ø′ = 𝐸.
(ix) (𝐴′)′ = 𝐴.
(x) (𝐴 ∪ 𝐵)′ = 𝐴′ ∩ 𝐵′ and (𝐴 ∩ 𝐵)′ = 𝐴′ ∪ 𝐵′ De Morgan’s laws
The application of these laws to subsets of E is known as the algebra of sets.
ALGEBRA WITH IDENTITY: An algebra A is called an algebra with identity if there exists
a non-zero element in A, denoted by 𝑒 and called the identity element or the identity
such that
𝑒𝑓 = 𝑓𝑒 = 𝑓 𝑓𝑜𝑟 𝑎𝑙𝑙 𝑓𝜖 𝐴
Obviously the identify in an algebra is unique.
ALGORITHM: An algorithm is a chain of instructions that tell how to carry out a task. An
algorithm must be specified exactly, so that there can be no doubt about what to do
next, and it must have a finite number of steps.
ALIQUOT PART : Aliquot part is another name for a proper divisor, i.e. any divisor of a
given number other than the number itself. A prime number has only one aliquot part -
the number 1. 1, 2, 3, 4, 6 are all aliquot parts of 12. The number 1 does not have aliquot
parts.
AL-KHWARIZMI: Muhammad Ibn Musa Al-Khwarizmi (780 AD to 850 AD) was a
Muslim mathematician who introduced modern numerals (the Hindu-arabic numerals)
to Europe in his book titled Kitab -al-jabr-walli-muqabalah that provided the source for
the term algebra. His name is the source for the term algorithm.
ALMOST CONTINUOUS FUNCTION: A function 𝑓 ∶ 𝑋 → 𝑌 is almost continuous,
𝑓 ∇ 𝐴𝐶(𝑋, 𝑌 ), provided each open subset of 𝑋 × 𝑌 containing the graph of 𝑓 also
contains the graph of a continuous function from 𝑋 to 𝑌 . This property was defined as a
generalization of functions having the fixed-point property. It is easy to see that if every
function in 𝐶(𝑋, 𝑋) has the fixed-point property, then so does every 𝑓 ∇ 𝐴𝐶(𝑋, 𝑋).
ALMOST EVERYWHERE: If we have a property 𝑃(𝑥) which is true except possibly for
𝑥 ∇ 𝐴 and µ(𝐴) = 0, we say 𝑃(𝑥) is almost everywhere or a.e. t is Therefore, it is a
property holding for all values except on a set of zero measure. The most remarkable
example of a set of zero measure is the set of rational numbers, so if
1, when 𝑥 is rational
𝑓 𝑥 = ,
0, when 𝑥 is irrational
then we can say that 𝑓(𝑥) = 0 almost everywhere.
ALMOST PERIODIC FUNCTIONS: The theory of almost periodic functions was originated
by H. Bohr in 1924 as a result of his study of Dirichlet series. The theory provides a
method of studying a wide class of trigonometric series of general type.
Let 𝑓(𝑥) be a complex-valued continuous function defined for all real values of 𝑥. A
number 𝑻 is called a translation number of 𝑓(𝑥) belonging to 𝜖 > 0 if
𝑠𝑢𝑝
𝑓(𝑥 + 𝑇) − 𝑓(𝑥) <∇
−∞ < 𝑥 < ∞
If for any ∇ > 0 there exists a number 𝑙(∇) > 0 such that any interval of length 𝑙(∇)
contains a translation number belonging to ∇, then 𝒇(𝒙) is called almost periodic in the
sense of Bohr. We denote by 𝑩 the set of all almost periodic functions in the sense of
Bohr.
ALPHABETS AND WORDS: Let 𝐴 be a finite set. We refer to this set 𝐴 as an alphabet and
we refer to the elements of 𝐴 as letters. (For example, the set 𝐴 might be the set of
letters in the English language, or in any other world language, or the set {0, 1} of binary
digits, or the set {0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9} of decimal digits.) For any natural number 𝑛, we
define a word of length 𝑛 over the alphabet 𝐴 to be a string of the form 𝑎1 𝑎2 . . . 𝑎𝑛 in
which 𝑎𝑖 ∇ 𝐴 for 𝑖 = 1, 2, . . . , 𝑛. We shall denote by 𝐴𝑛 the set of all words of length 𝑛
over the alphabet 𝐴. In particular, 𝐴1 = 𝐴.
Alt: alternating group (Alt(n) is also written as An)
ALTERNATING GROUP, An: It is the subgroup of the symmetric group 𝑆𝑛 and it contains
all the even permutations of 𝑛 objects. It has order 𝑛!/2. For 𝑛 > 4, it is the only proper
normal subgroup of 𝑆𝑛 apart from the empty set. The alternating group is a simple
group.
ALTERNATING MAP: A multilinear map 𝜙: 𝑉 𝑘 = 𝑉 × · · · × 𝑉 → 𝑈 where 𝑘 > 1, is
said to be alternating if for all 𝑣1 , . . . , 𝑣𝑘 ∇ 𝑉 the value 𝜙(𝑣1 , . . . , 𝑣𝑘 ) changes sign
whenever two of the vectors 𝑣1 , . . . , 𝑣𝑘 are interchanged, that is
𝜙(𝑣1 , . . . , 𝑣𝑖 , . . . , 𝑣𝑗 , . . . , 𝑣𝑘 ) = −𝜙(𝑣1 , . . . , 𝑣𝑗 , . . . , 𝑣𝑖 , . . . , 𝑣𝑘 ).
ALTERNATING SERIES: An alternating series is a series in which every term has the
opposite sign from the preceding term. For example, 1 − 𝑥 + 𝑥 2 − 𝑥 3 + − − − is an
alternating series.
ALTERNATIVE HYPOTHESIS: The model considered to be the case if the null
hypothesis in considered to be rejected (not hold). There is some debate as to whether
an alternative hypothesis increases the subjectiveness of hypothesis testing, since the
alternative hypothesis does not necessarily have to be the negation of the null
hypothesis. The issue is whether it is appropriate to make presumptions of what
the model in consideration cannot be (models not covered by the null or alternative
hypothesis but not considered) in hypothesis testing. Setting the alternative hypothesis
to be the negation of the null hypothesis amounts to not using alternative hypothesis as
some statistician would advocate. The alternative hypothesis is the hypothesis that
states, “The null hypothesis is false.”
AMBIGUOUS: Having more than one possible way, meaning , value, or solution.
AMICABLE NUMBERS: A pair of numbers with the property that each is equal to the sum
of the positive proper divisors of the other. Here proper divisor means that the number
is not included as one of its own divisors. For example, 220 and 284 are amicable
numbers because the positive divisors of 220 are 1,
2, 4, 5, 10, 11, 20, 22, 44, 55 and 110, whose sum is 284, and the positive divisors of 284
are 1, 2, 4, 71 and 142, whose sum is 220. More than 600 pairs are now known.
AMOUNT: The total value of an investment, including the principal and the interest
AMPLITUDE: Half the difference between the maximum and the minimum values of a
periodic function. The amplitude of a periodic function is half of the difference between
the largest possible value of the function and the smallest possible value. For example,
for the function 𝑦 = 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝑥, the largest possible value of 𝑦 is 1 and the smallest possible
1−(−1)
value of 𝑦 is −1, so the amplitude is = 1.
2
An : The alternating group of degree 𝑛 and order 𝑛!/2. That is, a group having 𝑛!/
2 members which act on 𝑛 elements of a set. It is a group that consists of members
which are even permutations (compositions of even number of permutations) only.
AND: The word “AND” is a connective word used in logic. The sentence “ p AND q” is true
only if both sentence p as well as sentence q are true. The operation of AND is illustrated
by the truth table:
p Q p AND q
T T T
T F F
F T F
F F F
Let the given plane be 𝑟 ∙ 𝑛 = 𝑞 and the given line ne parallel to the vector b. Then if ∅
be the angle between the normal to the plane i.e. n and the given line (parallel to b), we
have
𝑛 ∙𝑏
∴ ∅ = 𝑐𝑜𝑠 −1 .
𝑛𝑏
ANGLE BETWEEN TWO LINES: If a line has slope m, then the angle it makes with the
positive direction of x-axis is tan−1 𝑚.
The angle between a line with slope 𝑚1 and another line with slope 𝑚2 is given by
𝑚1 − 𝑚2
tan−1 .
1 + 𝑚1 𝑚2
If 𝒗𝟏 is a vector pointing in the direction of a line, and 𝒗𝟐 is a vector pointing in the
direction of another line, then the angle between them is:
𝒗𝟏 . 𝒗𝟐
cos−1
𝒗𝟏 × 𝒗𝟐
ANGLE BETWEEN TWO PLANES: The angle between the normals to two planes is called
the angle between the planes.
𝑛1∙ 𝑛2 𝑛1∙ 𝑛2
or cos 𝜃 = where 𝑛1 = 𝑛1 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑛2 𝑛2 or 𝜃 = 𝑐𝑜𝑠 −1 .
𝑛1𝑛2 𝑛1𝑛2
ANGLE BETWEEN LINES IN SPACE: If ⌌𝑙1 , 𝑚1 , 𝑛1 ⌍ and ⌌𝑙2 , 𝑚2 , 𝑛2 ⌍ are direction ratios for
directions along the lines, the angle θ between the lines is given by
𝑙1 𝑙2 + 𝑚1 𝑚2 + 𝑛1 𝑛2
𝜃 = cos −1
𝑙1 2 + 𝑚1 2 + 𝑛1 2 𝑙2 2 + 𝑚2 2 + 𝑛2 2
ANGLE BISECTOR THEOREM: A theorem which states that, given any triangle and any
one of its angle, the angle bisector divides its opposite side into
2 segments whose length are of the same ratio as the lengths of the
corresponding adjacent sides.
ANGULAR ACCELERATION: The time derivative of angular velocity, that is, the rate
(with respect of time) of increase of angular velocity.
ANGULAR FREQUENCY: Also known as angular speed. (So called because the measure is
essentially the same as how often - frequency - a certain unit of angle is achieved.). It is the
𝑑2𝑥
constant ω in the equation = −𝜔2 𝑥 for simple harmonic motion. The angular
𝑑𝑡 2
ANGULAR MEASURE: The angle between the line from the observer to object 1 and the
line from the observer to object 2. For example: Shortly after sunrise, you see that the
sun is only a few degrees above the horizon, while at noon it is elevated to nearly 90
degrees (or directly overhead). You are the observer, the sun is Object 1, and the
horizon is Object 2.
ANGULAR MOMENTUM: A measure of the state of a physical system that is related to its
spin or abiliy to spin. Analogous to linear momentum, angular momentum of a system is
conserved unless an external force is applied in a particular way. Suppose that the
particle P of mass m has position vector 𝒓 and is moving with velocity 𝒗 at any time t.
Then the angular momentum 𝑳 of P about the point A with position vector 𝒓’ is the
vector defined by 𝑳 = (𝒓 – 𝒓’) × 𝑚𝒗. It is the moment of the linear momentum about
the point A
area of a rectangle of width 𝑤 and length equal to the circumference of the circle
midway in size between the two original circles.
ANTIPODAL POINTS: Antipodal points are two points on a sphere that are at opposite
ends of a diameter.
ANTISYMMETRIC MATRIX: A matrix such that it's sum with its transpose matrix is
the zero matrix.
APOTHEM: The apothem of a regular polygon is the distance from the center of the
polygon to one of the sides of the polygon, in the direction that is perpendicular to that
side.
In many cases, the ordinary equality symbol (=) is used in situations where, to be
rigorous, the approximate equality sign ought to be used. This is done for two reasons:
first, most fonts do not include an approximate equality symbol; and secondly, many
people do not know what the approximate equality symbol means.
APPROXIMATION: When two quantities 𝑋 and 𝑥 are approximately equal, written
𝑋 ≈ 𝑥, one of them may be used in suitable circumstances in place of, or as an
22
approximation for, the other. For example, 𝜋 = and 3 = 1.73.
7
2
𝑑𝑦
𝑑𝑠 = 1+ 𝑑𝑥
𝑑𝑥
Now, suppose we need to know the length of the arc between the lines 𝑥 = 𝑎 and 𝑥 =
𝑏. Set up this integral:
𝑏
2
𝑑𝑦
𝑑𝑠 = 1+ 𝑑𝑥
𝑑𝑥
𝑎
For the curve 𝑥 = 𝑥(𝑡), 𝑦 = 𝑦(𝑡)(𝑡 ∇ [𝑎, 𝑏]), the arc length equals
𝑡=𝑏
2 2
𝑑𝑥 𝑑𝑦
𝑑𝑠 = + 𝑑𝑡
𝑑𝑡 𝑑𝑡
𝑡=𝑎
ARCHIMEDES: Archimedes (290 BC to 211 BC) studied at Alexandria and then lived in
Syracuse. He wrote extensively on mathematics and developed formulas for the volume
and surface area of a sphere, and a way to calculate the circumference of a circle. He also
developed the principle of floating bodies and invented military devices that delayed
the capture of the city by the Romans.
ARCHIMEDES’ SPIRAL INVERSE: Taking the origin as the inversion center, archimedes'
spiral 𝑇 = 𝑎𝜃 inverts to the hyperbolic spiral = 𝑎/𝜃 .
For the curve 𝑥 = 𝑥(𝑡), 𝑦 = 𝑦(𝑡)(𝑡 ∇ [𝑎, 𝑏]), the surface area equals
𝑡=𝑏
2 2
𝑑𝑥 𝑑𝑦
2𝜋 𝑦 + 𝑑𝑡
𝑑𝑡 𝑑𝑡
𝑡=𝑎
AREA OF A TRAPEZOID: The area of a trapezoid is equal to half the product of its height
and the sum of its bases.
AREA OF A TRIANGLE: The area of a triangle is equal to half the product of a base (a
side) and the height to that base.
AREA-PRESERVING MAP: A map 𝐹 from 𝐼𝑘 n to 𝑅 n is area-preserving if 𝑚(𝐴) =
𝑚(𝐹 𝐴 ) for every subregion 𝐴 of 𝐼𝑘 n , where 𝑚(𝐴) is the measure of 𝐴. A linear
transformation is area preserving if its corresponding determinant is equal to 1.
AREA UNDER A CURVE: Suppose that the curve 𝑦 = 𝑓(𝑥) lies above the 𝑥 −axis, so that
𝑓(𝑥) ≥ 0 for all 𝑥 in [𝑎, 𝑏]. The area under the curve, that is, the area of the region
bounded by the curve, the 𝑥-axis and the lines 𝑥 = 𝑎 and 𝑥 = 𝑏, equals
𝑏
𝑓 𝑥 𝑑𝑥
𝑎
If 𝑓(𝑥) ≤ 0 for all 𝑥 in [𝑎, 𝑏], the integral above is negative. However, it is still the case
that its absolute value is equal to the area of the region bounded by the curve, the
𝑥 −axis and the lines 𝑥 = 𝑎 and 𝑥 = 𝑏. If 𝑦 = 𝑓(𝑥) crosses the 𝑥-axis, appropriate
results hold. For example, if the regions A and B are as shown in the figure below,
𝑓 𝑥 𝑑𝑥
𝑎
− 𝑓 𝑥 𝑑𝑥
𝑏
It follows that
𝑐 𝑏 𝑐
𝑓 𝑥 𝑑𝑥 = 𝑓 𝑥 𝑑𝑥 + 𝑓 𝑥 𝑑𝑥
𝑎 𝑎 𝑏
Similarly, to find the area of the region bounded by a suitable curve, the 𝑦-axis, and lines
𝑦 = 𝑐 and 𝑦 = 𝑑, an equation 𝑥 = 𝑔(𝑦) for the curve must be found. Then the
required area equals
𝑑
𝑔 𝑦 𝑑𝑦
𝑐
If a curve has an equation 𝑟 = 𝑟(𝜃) in polar coordinates, there is an integral that gives
the area of the region bounded by an arc AB of the curve and the two radial lines OA and
OB. Suppose that ∠xOA = α and ∠xOB = β. The area of the region described equals
𝛽
1
𝑟 2 𝑑𝜃
2
𝛼
ARTIN L-FUNCTIONS: Artin L-functions are defined for quite general Galois
representations. The introduction of étale cohomology in the 1960s meant that Hasse–
Weil L-functions (q.v) could be regarded as Artin L-functions for the Galois
representations on l-adic cohomology groups.
ARTIN’S CONJECTURE: There are at least two statements which go by the name of
Artin’s conjecture. The first is the Riemann hypothesis. The second states that every
integer not equal to −1 or a square number is a primitive root modulo 𝑝 for infinitely
many p and proposes a density for the set of such 𝑝 which are always rational multiples
of a constant known as Artin's constant. There is an analogous theorem for functions
instead of numbers which has been proved by Billharz.
for every function 𝑓𝑛 belonging to the sequence, and every 𝑥 ∇ [𝑎, 𝑏]. The sequence
is equicontinuous if, for every 𝜀 > 0, there exists 𝛿 > 0 such that
whenever |𝑥 − 𝑦| < 𝛿 for all functions 𝑓𝑛 in the sequence. Succinctly, a sequence is
equicontinuous if and only if all of its elements admit the same modulus of continuity. In
simplest terms, the theorem can be stated as follows:
d2 y dy
𝑥 + 𝛼 + 1 − 𝑥 + ny = 0,
dx 2 dx
(1 + 2) + 3 = 1 + (2 + 3)
(4 × 5) × 6 = 4 × (5 × 6)
The following examples demonstrate that subtraction and division are not associative:
(3 − 2) − 1 3 − (2 − 1)
(12 / 4) / 3 12 / (4 / 3)
ASSOCIATIVE ALGEBRAS: Let 𝐾 be a commutative ring with unity element 1, and let 𝐴
be a ring which is a unitary 𝐾-module. Such a ring 𝐴 is called an associative algebra over
𝐾 (or simply algebra over 𝐾 ) if it satisfies the condition 𝛼(𝑎𝑏) = (𝛼𝑎)𝑏 = 𝑎(𝛼𝑏) (𝛼 ∇
𝐾; 𝑎, 𝑏 ∇ 𝐴). An (associative) algebra 𝐴 over 𝐾 is often written 𝐴/𝐾, and 𝐾 is called the
coefficient ring (or ground ring) of the algebra 𝐴 = 𝐴/𝐾 . In particular, if 𝐾 is a field,
then it is called the coefficient field (or ground field) of 𝐴. Notions such as zero algebra,
unitary algebra, commutative algebra, (semi) simple algebra, and division algebra are
replicas of the respective ones for rings. Considering both structures as rings and as 𝐾 -
modules, homomorphisms and isomorphisms are defined in a natural manner, and are
called algebra homomorphism and algebra isomorphism, respectively. In this
connection, subalgebra, quotient algebra (or residue class algebra), and direct product
of algebras are also defined as in the case of rings.
ASSOCIATIVE BINARY OPERATIONS: Let ∗ be a binary operation on a set 𝐴. Given any
three elements 𝑥, 𝑦 and 𝑧 of a set 𝐴, the binary operation, applied to the elements 𝑥 ∗ 𝑦
and 𝑧 of 𝐴, yields an element (𝑥 ∗ 𝑦) ∗ 𝑧 of 𝐴, and, applied to the elements 𝑥 and 𝑦 ∗ 𝑧
of 𝐴, yields an element 𝑥 ∗ (𝑦 ∗ 𝑧) of 𝐴. A binary operation ∗ on a set 𝐴 is said to be
associative if (𝑥 ∗ 𝑦) ∗ 𝑧 = 𝑥 ∗ (𝑦 ∗ 𝑧) for all elements 𝑥, 𝑦 and 𝑧 of 𝐴. The
operations of addition and multiplication on the set 𝑅 of real numbers are associative,
since (𝑥 + 𝑦) + 𝑧 = 𝑥 + (𝑦 + 𝑧) and (𝑥 × 𝑦) × 𝑧 = 𝑥 × (𝑦 × 𝑧) for all real numbers
𝑥, 𝑦 and 𝑧. However the operation of subtraction is not associative. For example
(1 − 2) − 3 = −4, but 1 − (2 − 3) = 2.
ASSOCIATIVE PROPERTY: An operation obeys the associative property if the grouping of
the numbers involved does not matter. Formally, the associative property of addition
says that
𝑎+ 𝑏 + 𝑐= 𝑎+ 𝑏+ 𝑐 .
The associative property for multiplication says that
(𝑎 × 𝑏) × 𝑐 = 𝑎 × 𝑏 × 𝑐 .
ASSUMPTION OF SEQUENCING: Some principal assumptions are as follows:
(i) The processing times 𝐴′𝑖 𝑠 etc. are exactly known and are independent of the
order of the jobs in which they are to be processed. Such problems where times are
exactly known are called deterministic problems.
(ii) The time taken by the jobs in going from one machine to another is negligible.
(iii) Each job, once started on a machine, is to be performed up to completion on that
machine.
(iv) A job starts on the machine as soon as the job and the machine both are idle and
job is next to the machine and the machine is also next to the job.
(v) There is only one machine of each type.
(vi) No machine may process more than one job at a time.
(vii) The cost of keeping the jobs in inventory (if needed) during the in process is
same for all jobs. Also it is too small that it can be neglected.
(viii) The order of completion of jobs has no significance i.e., no job is to be given
priority. Times of jobs are independent of sequence of jobs.
ASTROID: It is a hypocycloid in which the radius of the rolling circle is a quarter of the
radius of the fixed circle. It has parametric equations 𝑥 = 𝑎 𝑐𝑜𝑠 3 𝑡, 𝑦 = 𝑎 𝑠𝑖𝑛3 𝑡, where
𝑎 is the radius of the fixed circle.
2. The relation between two functions that tends to the same value (possibly infinite)
and such that the difference between the values of the 2 functions, considered as a
proportion of the values of either function, becomes arbitrarily small.
ATKINSON'S THEOREM: Let 𝐻 be a Hilbert space and 𝐿(𝐻) the set of bounded operators
on 𝐻. An operator 𝑇 ∇ 𝐿(𝐻) is said to be a Fredholm operator if the kernel 𝐾𝑒𝑟(𝑇) is
finite-dimensional, 𝐾𝑒𝑟(𝑇 ∗ ) is finite-dimensional (where 𝑇 ∗ denotes the adjoint of 𝑇),
and the range 𝑅𝑎𝑛(𝑇) is closed. Atkinson's theorem states:
A 𝑇 ∇ 𝐿(𝐻) is a Fredholm operator if and only if 𝑇 is invertible modulo compact
perturbation, i.e. 𝑇𝑆 = 𝐼 + 𝐶1 and 𝑆𝑇 = 𝐼 + 𝐶2 for some bounded
operator 𝑆 and compact operators 𝐶1 and 𝐶2 .
ATLASES: The description of most manifolds requires more than one chart (a single
chart is adequate for only the simplest manifolds). A specific collection of charts which
covers a manifold is called an atlas. An atlas is not unique as all manifolds can be
covered multiple ways using different combinations of charts. Two atlases are said to
be Ck equivalent if their union is also a Ck atlas.
AUGEND: An argument in the binary operation of addition. Technically the second
argument, it is commonly applied to both arguments due to addition
being commutative.
the augmented matrix is the matrix obtained by adjoining to the matrix of coefficients
an extra column of entries taken from the right-hand sides of the equations.
We would like to make the process of solving a system of linear equations more
mechanical by forgetting about the variable names 𝑤, 𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧 etc and doing the whole
operation as a matrix calculation. For this, we use the augmented matrix of the system
of equations, which we have constructed by “glueing” an extra column on the right-hand
side of the matrix representing the linear transformation, as above.
The vertical line in the matrix is put there to remind that the rightmost column is
different from the others, and arises from the constants on the right hand side of the
equations.
Let us look at the following system of linear equations over ℝ: Suppose that we want to
find all 𝑤, 𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧 𝜖 ℝ satisfying the equations.
2𝑤 − 𝑥 + 4𝑦 − 𝑧 = 1
𝑤 + 2𝑥 + 𝑦 + 𝑧 = 2
𝑤 − 3𝑥 + 3𝑦 − 2𝑧 = −1
−3𝑤 − 𝑥 − 5𝑦 + 0𝑧 = −3
Matrix Operation(s)
2 −1 4 −1 : 1
1 2 1 1 : 2 𝑅1 →
𝑅1
1 −3 3 −2 : −1 2
−3 −1 −5 0 : −3
1 −1 2 2 −1 2 : 1 2 𝑅2 → 𝑅2 − 𝑅1
1 2 1 1 : 2 𝑅3 → 𝑅3 − 𝑅1
1 −3 3 −2 : −1
𝑅4 → 𝑅4 + 3𝑅1
−3 −1 −5 0 : −3
1 −1 2 2 −1 2 : 1 2
0 5 2 −1 3 2 : 3 2 𝑅3 → 𝑅3 + 𝑅2
0 −5 2 1 −3 2 : −3 2 𝑅4 → 𝑅4 + 𝑅2
0 −5 2 1 −3 2 : −3 2
1 −1 2 2 −1 2 : 1 2
0 5 2 −1 3 2 : 3 2 𝑅2 →
2𝑅2
0 0 0 0 : 0 5
0 0 0 0 : 0
1 −1 2 2 −1 2 : 1 2
0 1 −2 5 3 5 : 3 5 𝑅1 → 𝑅1 +
𝑅2
0 0 0 0 : 0 2
0 0 0 0 : 0
1 0 9 5 −1 5 : 4 5
0 1 −2 5 3 5 : 3 5
0 0 0 0 : 0
0 0 0 0 : 0
The original system has been transformed to the following equivalent system, i.e, Both
systems have the same solutions.
𝑤 + 9𝑦 5 − 𝑧 5 = 4 5 , 𝑥 − 2𝑦 5 + 3 𝑧 5 = 3 5
𝑤, 𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧 = −9𝛼 5 + 𝛽 5 + 4 5 , 2𝛼 5 − 3 𝛽 5 + 3 5 , 𝛼, 𝛽
AXIAL PLANE: A fixed reference plane containing two of the three coordinate axes in a
three-dimensional coordinate system. For example, the plane that contains 𝑥-axis and 𝑦-
axis is the axial plane called the 𝑥𝑦-plane, or (𝑥, 𝑦)-plane. Similarly, the plane containing
𝑦-axis and 𝑧-axis is the 𝑦𝑧-plane.
AXIOM: An axiom is a statement that is assumed to be true without proof. Axiom is a
synonym for postulate.
AXIOMATIC SET THEORY: Axiomatic set theory pursues the goal of reestablishing the
essentials of G. Cantor’s rather intuitive set theory by axiomatic constructions
consistent with modern theories of the foundations of mathematics. A system of axioms
for set theory was first given by E. Zermelo, and was completed by A. Fraenkel. J. von
Neumann expressed it in symbolic logic, gave a formal generalization, and eliminated
ambiguous concepts. P. Bernays and K. Godel further refined and simplified von
Neumann’s formulation. The theories based on the systems before and after the formal
generalization are called Zermelo-Fraenkel set theory (ZF) and Bernays-Gode1 set
theory (BG), respectively.
AXIOM OF CHOICE: It states that for any collection of mutually exclusive sets there is at
least one set that contains exactly one element in common with each of the non-empty
sets.
This asserts that if for any element 𝑥 of a there is a set 𝑦 such that 𝐴(𝑥, 𝑦), then there is a
choice function 𝑦 for the formula, i.e., 𝐴 𝑥, 𝑦 𝑥 for all 𝑥 in a. Usually a function is
represented by its graph. A set 𝑓 is called a function defined on a if
∀𝑥 ∇ 𝑎∀𝑦𝐴𝑧 𝑥, 𝑦 ∇ 𝑓⋀ 𝑥, 𝑧 ∇ 𝑓 → 𝑦 = 𝑧).
This formula is denoted by Fnc(𝑓); then the formula 𝐴 𝑥, 𝑓 𝑥 is an abbreviation of
Fun 𝑓 ⋀ 3𝑦(𝑥, 𝑦) ∇ 𝑓 ⋀ 𝐴 (𝑥, 𝑦)).
This asserts the existence of the empty set. The empty set is denoted by ⊘ or 0.
AXIOM OF EXTENSIONALITY: ∀𝑥 𝑥 𝜖 𝑎 ≡ 𝑥 𝜖 𝑏 → 𝑎 = 𝑏.
This asserts that sets formed by the same elements are equal. The formula 𝑥 𝜖 𝑎 (𝑥 𝜖 𝑏)
is denoted by 𝑎 ⊂ 𝑏. This means “𝑎 is a subset of 𝑏.” Then Axiom 1 can be expressed by
𝑎 ⊂ 𝑏 ∧ 𝑏 ⊂ 𝑎 → 𝑎 = 𝑏.
This asserts the existence of the set consisting all the natural numbers, whereas
0,1 = 0′ = 0 , 2 = 1′ = 0,1 , 3 = 2′ = 0,1,2 . This definition of natural number is due
to von Neumann.
This asserts the existence, for any sets a of the power set 𝑥 consisting of all the subsets
of a. This 𝑥 is denoted by 𝑃𝑎. We have 𝑆(𝑃 𝑎 = 𝑎, 𝑠𝑜 𝑆 is a left inverse of 𝑃 and the
products 𝑆𝑃 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑃𝑆 are idempotent.
ℸ(𝑥𝜖𝑦 𝐴 𝑦𝜖 𝑥), etc. If we assume the axiom of choice stated below, then this is equivalent
to the nonexistence of an infinite descending sequence
𝑥𝑛 ∇ ⋯ ∇ 𝑥2 ∇ 𝑥1 .
If a model e1 of a set theory satisfies the axiom of regularity and has an infinite
descending sequence that is not in the model, then such a model is called a nonstandard
model.
This asserts that the existence for any set a and a formula 𝐴(𝑦) of a set 𝑥 consisting of all
element of a satisfying 𝐴(𝑦). This 𝑥 is denoted by {𝑦𝜖𝑎 𝐴 𝑦 }. This is rather a schema for
an infinite number of axioms, for there are an infinite number of 𝐴(𝑦). This axiom, also
called the axiom of comprehension or axiom of subsets, was introduced by Zermelo.
This asserts the existence, for any sets a of the sum (or union) 𝑥 of all the sets that are
elements of a. This 𝑥 is denoted by the 𝑈𝑎 or 𝑆(𝑎). We write a 𝑈𝑏 for 𝑈 𝑎, 𝑏 and
𝑎′ for 𝑎𝑈{𝑎. 𝑎}.
This asserts the existence, for any sets a and b, of a set 𝑥 having a and b as its only
elements. This 𝑥 is called the unordered pair of a and b and is denoted by 𝑎, 𝑏 . The
notion of ordered pair is characterized by
𝑎, 𝑏 = 𝑐. 𝑑 ≡ 𝑎 = 𝑐 ∨ 𝑏 = 𝑑.
An example of such is 𝑎, 𝑏 = 𝑎, 𝑎 , 𝑎, 𝑏 .
(Identity)
𝛼 + −𝛼 = 0 = −𝛼 + 𝛼 (Inverse)
These axioms may or may not be satisfied by a given number system S.For example,
in ℕ, A1 and A2 hold but A3 and A4 do not hold. A1-A4 all hold in ℞, ℚ, ℝ 𝑎𝑛𝑑 ℂ.
M4. For each number 𝛼 𝜖 𝑆 𝑤𝑖𝑡 𝛼 ≠ 0,there exist a number 𝛼 −1 𝜖 𝑆 𝑠𝑢𝑐 𝑡𝑎𝑡
𝛼. 𝛼 −1 = 1 = 𝛼 −1 . 𝛼 (Inverse)
In ℕ 𝑎𝑛𝑑 ℞, M1-M3 hold but M4 does not hold. M1-M4 all hold in ℚ, ℝ 𝑎𝑛𝑑 ℂ.
AXIS OF SYMMETRY: It is a line in which the two halves of a curve reflect into each
other.
AXIS-SYMMETRIC FLOW FIELD: A flow field is said to be axis-symmetric when the
velocity components (𝑢, 𝑣, 𝑤) with regard to cylindrical coordinates x, r, ∅ are all
independent of the azimuthal angle ∅. The velocity component q ∅ in the direction of
increasing ∅ is called swirl component of velocity.
AZIMUTH: The angle between the projection of the radius vector onto the plane
perpendicular to the polar axis, and the initial line.
B
BABBAGE, CHARLES (1792–1871): Charles Babbage was a British mathematician and
inventor of mechanical calculators.
BACK-SUBSTITUTION: A method of solving a system of linear equations (or
the equivalent matrix equation) that involves finding the components in the reverse
order to the way it is indexed, due to its being manipulated to a row-echelon form. (The
Upper-triangular form of a square matrix is a special case of this.)
BAIRE CATEGORY THEOREM: A Baire space is a topological space with the following
property: for each countable collection of open dense sets 𝑈𝑛 , their intersection ⋂ 𝑈𝑛 is
dense.
(BCT1) Every complete metric space is a Baire space. More generally, every topological
space which is homeomorphic to an open subset of a complete pseudometric space is a
Baire space. Thus every completely metrizable topological space is a Baire space.
(BCT2) Every locally compact Hausdorff space is a Baire space. The proof is similar to
the preceding statement; the finite intersection property takes the role played by
completeness.
Note that neither of these statements implies the other, since there are complete metric
spaces which are not locally compact (the irrational numbers with the metric defined
below; also, any Banach space of infinite dimension), and there are locally compact
Hausdorff spaces which are not metrizable (for instance, any uncountable product of
non-trivial compact Hausdorff spaces is such; also, several function spaces used in
Functional Analysis; the uncountable Fort space).
(BCT3) A non-empty complete metric space is not the countable union of nowhere-
dense closed sets.
BALL: A ball in a metric space is a set containing all the points which are not more than a
given distance (radius of the ball) from a fixed point (center of the ball). An open ball
does not include the boundary where the distance is equal to the given constant and a
closed ball does include the boundary.
BANACH–ALAOGLU THEOREM : Banach–Alaoglu theorem also known as Alaoglu's
theorem states that the closed unit ball of the dual space of a normed vector
space is compact in the weak topology.
BANACH FIXED POINT THEOREM: Let (𝑋, 𝑑) be a non-empty complete metric
space with a contraction mapping 𝑇 : 𝑋 → 𝑋. Then 𝑇 admits a unique fixed-
point 𝑥 ∗ in 𝑋 (i.e. 𝑇(𝑥 ∗ ) = 𝑥 ∗ ). Furthermore, 𝑥 ∗ can be found as follows:
Start with an arbitrary element 𝑥0 in X and define a sequence {𝑥𝑛 } by 𝑥𝑛 = 𝑇(𝑥𝑛−1 ),
then 𝑥𝑛 → 𝑥 ∗ .
BANACH–MAZUR THEOREM: Most well-behaved normed spaces are subspaces of the
space of continuous paths. It is named after Stefan Banach and Stanisław Mazur.
BANACH SPACE: A complete normed vector space on the real or complex numbers.
A. For 1 ≤ 𝑝 < ∞, the space 𝑙𝑝 is a Banach space.
B. The spaces 𝑐0 and 𝑙∞ are Banach spaces.
C. Let 𝐸 be a normed space, and let 𝐹 be a Banach space. Then 𝐵(𝐸, 𝐹) is a Banach
space.
D. Let 1 < 𝑝 < ∞, and again let 𝑞 be such that 1/𝑝 + 1/𝑞 = 1. Then the map
𝑙𝑞 → (𝑙_𝑝)∗ : 𝑢 ↦ 𝜑𝑢 , is an isometric isomorphism, where 𝜑𝑢 is defined, for
∞
𝑢 = (𝑢𝑗 ) ∇ 𝑙𝑞 , by 𝜑𝑢 𝑥 = 𝑖=1 𝑢𝑖 𝑥𝑖 𝑥 = 𝑥𝑖 ∇ 𝑙𝑝
In a specialized type of vertical bar graph called a Pareto chart , values of the dependent
variable are plotted in decreasing order of relative frequency from left to right. Another
type of bar graph called a histogram uses rectangles to show the frequency of data items
in successive numerical intervals of equal size. Other types of bar graphs allow plotting
multiple ranges of the dependent variable, multiple independent variables,
positive/negative variables and multi-category variables.
The scalars 𝛼1 , 𝛼2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝛼𝑛 in the note above are called the coordinates of 𝑣 with respect
to the basis 𝑣1 , 𝑣2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝑣𝑛 . with respect to the different basis, 𝑣 will have different
coordinates.
1: (1,0) and (0,1) form a basis of ℝ2 .This follows because each element (𝑥, 𝑦) 𝜖ℝ2 can be
written as 𝑥(1,0) + 𝑦(0,1) and this expression is clearly unique.
2: More generally (1,0,0), (0,1,0), (0,0,1) form a basis of ℝ3 .
(1,0,0,0, ), (0,1,0,0), (0,0,1,0) , (0,0,0,1) form a basis of ℝ4 and so on. This is called the
standard basis of ℝ𝑛 for n 𝜖𝑁.
3: There are many other basis of ℝ𝑛 .For example (1,0), (1,1) form a basis of ℝ2 because
(𝛼1 , , 𝛼2 ) = 𝛼1 −𝛼2 1,0 + 𝛼2 (0,1) and this expression is unique. In fact, any two non-
zero vectors such that one is not a scalar multiple of the other form a basis of ℝ2 .
4: As we have defined a basis, it has to consist of a finite number of vectors. Not every
vector space has a finite basis. For example, let 𝐾 𝑥 be the space of polynomials in an
indeterminate x with coefficients in the field K.Let 𝑝1 𝑥 , 𝑝2 𝑥 , … … . , 𝑝𝑛 𝑥 be any finite
collection of polynomials in 𝐾 𝑥 .Then if 𝑑 is the maximum degree of
𝑝1 𝑥 , 𝑝2 𝑥 , … … . , 𝑝𝑛 𝑥 ,any linear combination of 𝑝1 𝑥 , 𝑝2 𝑥 , … … . , 𝑝𝑛 𝑥 has degree
atmost d,and so 𝑝1 𝑥 , 𝑝2 𝑥 , … … . , 𝑝𝑛 𝑥 cannot span 𝐾[𝑥].On the other hand, it is
possible to define what it means for an infinite set of vectors 1, 𝑥, 𝑥 2 , … … … , … . . 𝑥 𝑛 … … ..
is a basis of 𝐾 𝑥 . A vector space with a finite basis is called finite-dimensional. The
spaces of functions mentioned in example above have uncountably infinite dimension.
BASE (TOPOLOGY): Let X be a topological space with Γ as topology defined on it. Then a
collection 𝐵𝑛 of subsets of X is said to be a base for the topology Γ if for every open set
𝐺 ∇ Γ and for every element 𝑥 ∇ 𝐺, there exists a member 𝐵𝑛 of this collection such that
𝑥 ∇ 𝐵𝑛 ⊆ 𝐺. If there exists a countable base for a topological space, then the topological
space is called a second countable space.
BASIC FEASIBLE SOLUTION: A basic feasible solution for a linear programming problem
is a solution that satisfies the constraints of the problem where the number of nonzero
variables equals the number of constraints.
Consider a linear programming problem with 𝑚 constraints and 𝑛 total variables
(including slack variables). Then a basic feasible solution is a solution that satisfies the
constraints of the problem and has exactly 𝑚 nonzero variables and 𝑛 − 𝑚 variables
equal to zero. The basic feasible solutions will be at the corners of the feasible region,
and an important theorem of linear programming states that, if there is an optimal
solution, it will be a basic feasible solution.
BASIC FEASIBLE SOLUTIONS OF TRANSPORTATION PROBLEMS: A feasible solution
(𝑥𝑖,𝑗 ) of a Transportation Problem is said to be basic if there exists a basis 𝐵 for that
Transportation Problem such that 𝑥𝑖,𝑗 = 0 whenever (𝑖, 𝑗) ∈ 𝐵.
BASIC MODULE DECOMPOSITION THEOREM: If 𝑀 is a finitely generated module over a
Euclidean domain 𝐷 then 𝑀 may be written as an internal direct sum 𝑀 = 𝑀1 ⊕
𝑀2 ⊕ · · · ⊕ 𝑀𝑠 where 𝑀𝑖 is a non-trivial cyclic submodule of order 𝑑𝑖 [1 ≤ 𝑖 ≤ 𝑠]
and 𝑑𝑖 |𝑑𝑖+1 [1 ≤ 𝑖 ≤ 𝑠 − 1].
BASIS: A set of vectors in a vector space form a basis if other vectors can be written as a
linear combination of the basis vectors. The vectors in the basis need to be necessarily
linearly independent.
BASIS AND DIMENSION OF A SUBSPACE: A set of vectors 𝑎1 , 𝑎2 , 𝑎3 , … , 𝑎𝑘 belonging to
the subspace 𝑆 is said to be a basic of 𝑆, if
It can be easily shown that every subspace, 𝑆,or 𝑉𝑛 possesses a basic. It can be easily
shown that the vectors e1 = 1,0,0, … 0 , e2 = 0,1,0, … 0 , e3 = 0,0,1, … 0 , … en =
0,0,0, … 1 constitute a basis of 𝑉𝑛 .
We have already shown that these vectors are linearly independent. Moreover any
vector 𝑎 = (𝑎1 , 𝑎2 , … , 𝑎𝑛 ) of 𝑉𝑛 is expressible as 𝑎 = 𝑎1 𝑒1 + 𝑎2 𝑒2 + 𝑎3 𝑒3 + ⋯ + 𝑎𝑛 𝑒𝑛 .
Hence the vectors 𝑒1 , 𝑒2 , 𝑒3 , … , 𝑒𝑛 constitute a basis of 𝑉𝑛 .
A basis of a subspace, 𝑆, can always be selected out of a set of vectors which span
𝑆.
A vector subspace may (and in fact does) possess several bases.
The number of members in any one basis of a subspace is the same as in any
other basis. This number is called the dimension of the subspace.
BASIS THEOREM: Any linearly independent set of n vectors is a basis of a vector space of
finite dimension n.
BAYES FACTOR: The Bayesian equivalent (in its application) to the classical frequentist
concept of hypothesis testing.
BAYESIAN CONFIDENCE INTERVAL: An interval of a posterior distribution which is
such that the density at any point inside the interval is greater than the density at any
point outside and that the area under the curve for that interval is equal to a
prespecified probability level. For any probability level there is generally only one such
interval, which is also often known as the highest posterior density region. Unlike the
usual confidence interval associated with frequentist inference, here the intervals
specify the range within which parameters lie with a certain probability.
(1) Obtain the likelihood, 𝑓 (𝑥 𝜃 ) describing the process giving rise to the data 𝑥 in
terms of the unknown parameters 𝜃.
(2) Obtain the prior distribution, 𝑓 (𝜃) expressing what is known about 𝜃, prior to
observing the data.
(4) Derive appropriate inference statements from the posterior distribution. These may
include specific inferences such as point estimates, interval estimates or probabilities of
hypotheses. If interest centres on particular components of q their posterior
distribution is formed by integrating out the other parameters.
This form of inference differs from the classical form of frequentist inference in several
respects, particularly the use of the prior distribution which is absent from classical
inference. It represents the investigator’s knowledge about the parameters before
seeing the data. Classical statistics uses only the likelihood. Consequently to a Bayesian
every problem is unique and is characterized by the investigator’s beliefs about the
parameters expressed in the prior distribution for the specific investigation.
find the probability that the sum of the two numbers will be greater than or equal to 11,
given that doubles were obtained as
1 3
3 12 1
𝑃 𝐵 𝐴 = =
1 3 2 9 7
+
3 12 3 12
BAYES, THOMAS (1702 to 1761): Thomas Bayes was an English mathematician who
studied probability and statistical inference.
BEARING: The angle that the direction makes with north, measured in degrees in a
clockwise direction from north. Bearings of less than 100° are generally written with an
initial 0. For example, north-east has a bearing of 045°, and south-west has a bearing of
225°. Bearing is an important concept in radar, sonar, navigation, and surveying.
BECKMAN–QUARLES THEOREM: If a transformation of the Euclidean plane or a higher-
dimensional Euclidean space preserves unit distances, then it preserves all distances.
Equivalently, every automorphism of the unit distance graph of the plane must be
an isometry of the plane.
BECQUEREL: An SI derived unit of radio acitivity denoted by the symbol Bq.
BEES ALGORITHM: The bees algorithm is a method of problem solving that mimics the
behavior of honeybees to find the optimum solution. Based on the behaviors bees
employ to search and prioritize, the algorithm is a classical example of swarm
intelligence, in which many individuals work together to solve problems or optimize
scenarios. Bees search for food by using scouts to explore areas deemed most likely to
produce favorable results. At first, the scouts conduct random searches to locate the
areas where food exists in the greatest abundance. Then they conduct more orderly,
localized searches until they arrive at the most efficient possible food-recovery process.
The bees algorithm makes it possible for research scientists and engineers to solve
complex problems involving vast amounts of data, categorizing the results according to
specific criteria (such as geographic region or age group), and then giving priority to the
results most likely to yield workable solutions. Computers and swarms of insect
robots can use the bees algorithm as well.
Machine vision
Pattern recognition
Image analysis
Job scheduling
Finding multiple solutions to problem
Data aggregation
Mechanical component design
Robot control
BELL CURVE: It is the shape of the normal curve i.e. the shape of the graph that indicates
a normal distribution in probability and statistics.
BELL-SHAPED DISTRIBUTION: A probability distribution having the overall shape of a
vertical cross-section of a bell. The normal distribution is the most well known example,
but Student’s t-distribution is also this shape.
BELONGS TO: If x is an element of a set S, then we say that x belongs to S and this is
written as x ∇ S. Naturally, x ∈ S means that x does not belong to S.
BELOW (LESS THAN): The limit of a function at 𝑎 from below is the limit of 𝑓(𝑥) as
𝑥 → 𝑎 for values of 𝑥 < 𝑎. It is of particular importance when 𝑓(𝑥) has a discontinuity
at 𝑎, i.e. where the limits from above and from below do not coincide. It can be written
as 𝑓(𝑎−) or lim𝑥→𝑎− 𝑓(𝑥).
BELTRAMI AND ENNPER THEOREM (DIFFERENTIAL GEOMETRY): Statement: At a point
on a surface where the Gaussian curvature is negative and equal to 𝜅, the torsion of the
asymptotic line is ± −𝜅.
∂q
∂∅ ∂t = 0 ⇒ curl q = 0. Since 𝑞×curl 𝑞= 0.
It follows that 𝑞 and curl 𝑞 are parallel i.e., streamlines and vortex lines coincide. For
such a motion, 𝑞 is known as a Beltrami vector and the flow is known as a Beltrami flow.
𝜍 1+ 𝜍
ℯ𝑖𝑗 = − 𝛿𝑖𝑗 𝜃 + 𝜏𝑖𝑗
𝐸 𝐸
1 𝜍 1+ 𝜍
Then ∆2 𝜏𝑖𝑗 + 𝜃, 𝑖𝑗 − 1+ 𝜍 𝛿𝑖𝑗 − 𝑑𝑖𝑣 𝐹 = 𝐹𝑖,𝑗 + 𝐹𝑗 ,𝑖
1+ 𝜍 1− 𝜍
1 𝜍
Or ∆2 𝜏𝑖𝑗 + 𝜃, 𝑖𝑗 + 1− 𝜍 𝛿𝑖𝑗 𝑑𝑖𝑣 𝐹 = − 𝐹𝑖,𝑗 + 𝐹𝑗 ,𝑖
1+ 𝜍
1 𝜍
Or ∆2 𝜏𝑖𝑗 + 𝜃, 𝑖𝑗 = − 1− 𝜍 𝛿𝑖𝑗 𝑑𝑖𝑣 𝐹 = − 𝐹𝑖,𝑗 + 𝐹𝑗 ,𝑖
1+ 𝜍
These are called Beltrami- Michell compatibility equations. The Cartesian form of this
equation is
1 𝜕2𝜃 𝜍 2𝜕𝐹𝑥
∆2 𝜏𝑥𝑥 + 2
=− 𝑑𝑖𝑣 𝐹 − ,
1 + 𝜍 𝜕𝑥 1− 𝜍 𝜕𝑥
2
1 𝜕2𝜃 𝜍 2𝜕𝐹𝑦
∆ 𝜏𝑦𝑦 + = − 𝑑𝑖𝑣 𝐹 − ,
1 + 𝜍 𝜕𝑦 2 1− 𝜍 𝜕𝑦
1 𝜕2𝜃 𝜍 2𝜕𝐹𝑧
∆2 𝜏𝑧𝑧 + 2
=− 𝑑𝑖𝑣 𝐹 − ,
1 + 𝜍 𝜕𝑧 1− 𝜍 𝜕𝑧
2
1 𝜕2𝜃 𝜕𝐹𝑦 𝜕𝐹𝑧
∆ 𝜏𝑦𝑧 + =− + ,
1 + 𝜍 𝜕𝑦 𝜕𝑧 𝜕𝑧 𝜕𝑦
2
1 𝜕2𝜃 𝜕𝐹𝑧 𝜕𝐹𝑥
∆ 𝜏𝑧𝑥 + =− + ,
1 + 𝜍 𝜕𝑧 𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑧
with equality if and only if (𝑀, 𝑔) is isometric to the 𝑚-sphere 𝑺𝒎 with its usual metric.
for every integer 𝑟 ≥ 0 and every real number 𝑥 ≥ − 1. If the exponent 𝑟 is even, then
the inequality is valid for all real numbers 𝑥. The strict version of the inequality reads
BERNOULLI, JAKOB (1655 to 1705): Jakob Bernoulli was a Swiss mathematician who
studied concepts in what is now the calculus of variations, particularly the catenary
curve.
BERNOULLI, JOHANN (1667 to 1748): Johann Bernoulli, brother of Jakob Bernoulli, was
also a mathematician investigating these issues.
BERNOULLI NUMBER: Bernoulli number can be defined through the power series
expansion of
𝑥 𝑥 2 ∕ 2! 𝑥 4 ∕ 4! 𝑥 6 ∕ 6!
𝑥 1 − 𝑒 −𝑥 = 1 + + + + +−−−
2 6 30 42
𝑥𝑛
The Bernoulli numbers are the coefficients of in this expansion.
𝑛!
BERTRAND’S POSTULATE: For any integer greater than 3, there is always at least one
prime between n and 2n – 2. For example, for n = 6 the number 7 is prime and lies
between 6 and 10. This statement was first conjectured in 1845 by Joseph Bertrand.
Bertrand himself verified his statement for all numbers in the interval [2, 3 × 106 ]. His
conjecture was completely proved by Chebyshev in 1852 and so the postulate is also
called the Bertrand–Chebyshev theorem or Chebyshev's theorem. Chebyshev's theorem
can also be stated as a relationship with 𝜋(𝑥), where 𝜋(𝑥) is the prime counting
𝜋
function (number of primes less than or equal to 𝑥): 𝜋 𝑥 − 𝜋 ≥ 1 ∀ 𝑥 ≥ 2.
2
d2R 1 dR 1 d2θ′ d 2 z′
θ′ z′ dr 2 + r θ′ z′ dr + r 2 Rz′ + Rθ′ dz 2 = 0.
dθ 2
1 d2R 1 dR 1 1 d 2 θ′ 1 d2z′
or +r + r 2 θ′ + z′ + = 0. …………….. ii
R dr 2 dr dθ 2 dz 2
Since the first three terms are independent of z therefore the fourth terms also be
independent of z. Thus the fourth term must be equal to constant
1 d2z′ d2z′
i.e. z′ = C (constant) or = Cz′. ………….. iii
dz 2 dz 2
Similarly third term must be free form θ and therefore must be equal to a constant
1 d2θ′ d2θ′
i.e., = D or = Dθ′ . ………….. iv
θ′ dθ 2 dθ 2
d2R dR
r2 + dr + D + Cr 2 R = 0 …………….. v
dr 2
dR dR dv dR d2R d 2 R dv d2R
Putting kr = v so that dr = . dr = k dv and = k dv 2 . dr = k 2 dv 2
dv dr 2
in (v), we have
d2R dR v2
k 2 r 2 dv 2 + kr dv + D + C k 2 R = 0.
d2R dR
Putting 𝐶 = k 2 𝐷 = −n2 , we get v 2 dv 2 + v dv + v 2 − n2 R = 0.
d2y dy
Putting 𝑅 = 𝑦 and 𝑣 = 𝑥, we have x 2 dx 2 + x dx + x 2 − n2 y = 0
The solution of this equation is called the cylindrical function or Bessel’s function of
order n.
2 𝑛
BESSEL’S INEQUALITY: If ⌌𝑒𝑖 ⌍ is orthonormal set, then 𝑥 ≥ 𝑖=1 ⌌𝑥, 𝑒𝑖 ⌍ 2 . For an
arbitrary vector of 𝑆, we have
𝑛
2 2
≥ , 𝑒𝑖
𝑖=1
where 𝛤(𝑝) is the gamma function, is called a beta function. For integers 𝑚, 𝑛, we have
𝑚 − 1 ! (𝑛 − 1)!
𝛽 𝑚, 𝑛 =
(𝑚 + 𝑛 − 1)!
BÉZOUT'S IDENTITY: Let 𝑎 and 𝑏 be nonzero integers and let 𝑑 be their greatest
common divisor. Then there exist integers 𝑥 and 𝑦 such that
In addition,
𝑥 and 𝑦 are called Bézout coefficients for (𝑎, 𝑏) and are not unique. A pair of Bézout
coefficients can be computed by the extended Euclidean algorithm.
BHĀSKARA (1114–85): Bhaskara was an eminent Indian mathematician who continued
in the tradition of Brahmagupta, making corrections and filling in many gaps in the
earlier work. He solved examples of Pell’s equation and grappled with the problem of
division by zero.
Suppose a distribution has minimum 𝑚, maximum 𝑀, and expected value 𝜇. Then the
inequality says:
𝑎𝑧 + 𝑏
𝑤=
𝑐𝑧 + 𝑑
𝑐𝑤𝑧 + 𝑤𝑑 − 𝑎𝑧 − 𝑏 = 0
That is why, it is called bilinear. Here we assume that 𝑎𝑑 − 𝑏𝑐 ≠ 0 which is called the
determinant of the transformation. The transformation (1) is said to be normalized if
𝑎𝑑 − 𝑏𝑐 = 1. If the determinant vanishes, then 𝑤 is merely a constant.
BILLION: The name variously given to a thousand million and a million million in the
past. Traditionally, the US used a billion as the former and the UK as the latter, also
referred to as short billion and long billion respectively. With the rapid globalization in
the past few decades, the US definition has become more prevalent although it is better
to clarify as its use is dominant.
BIMODAL: A frequency distribution of numerical data that shows two distinct peaks
(modes).
BINARY AND TERNARY CODE: A code over 𝐴 = {0, 1} is called a binary code and a code
over 𝐴 = {0, 1, 2} is called a ternary code.
BINARY HAMMING CODE: Let 𝑟 ≥ 2 and let C be a binary linear code with 𝑛 = 2𝑟 −
1 whose parity-check matrix 𝐻 is such that the columns are all of the non-zero vectors
in 𝐹2𝑟 . This code 𝐶 is called a binary Hamming code of length 2𝑟 − 1, denoted
𝐻𝑎𝑚(𝑟, 2).
BINARY NUMBERS: Binary (base-2) numbers are written in a positional system that
uses only two digits: 0 and 1. Each digit of a binary number represents a power of 2. The
rightmost digit is the 1’s digit, the next digit to the left is the 2’s digit, and so on. For
example, the binary number 11101 represents
1 × 24 + 1 × 23 + 1 × 22 + 0 × 21 + 1 × 20 = 16 + 8 + 4 + 0 + 1 = 29
BINARY OPERATIONS ON SETS: A binary operation ∗ on a set 𝐴 is an operation which,
when applied to any elements 𝑥 and 𝑦 of the set 𝐴, yields an element x ∗ 𝑦 of 𝐴. Example
The arithmetic operations of addition, subtraction and multiplication are binary
operations on the set 𝑅 of real numbers which, when applied to real numbers 𝑥 and 𝑦,
yield the real numbers 𝑥 + 𝑦, 𝑥 − 𝑦 and 𝑥𝑦 respectively. However division is not a
binary operation on the set of real numbers, since the quotient 𝑥/𝑦 is not defined when
𝑦 = 0. (Under a binary operation ∗ on a set must determine an element 𝑥 ∗ 𝑦 of the set
for every pair of elements 𝑥 and 𝑦 of that set.)
BINARY RELATIONS: A binary relation on a set specifies relations between pairs of
elements from the set. Example The relations = ‘equals’ , ≠ ‘not equal to’ , < ‘less
than’ , > ‘greater than’ , ≤ ‘less than or equal to’ and ≥ ‘greater than or equal to’
are all binary relations on the set 𝑅 of real numbers. Let 𝐴 be a set, and let 𝑃(𝐴) be the
power set of 𝐴 (i.e., the set whose elements are the subsets of 𝐴). Then ⊂ is a binary
relation on 𝑃(𝐴), where two subsets 𝐵 and 𝐶 of A satisfy 𝐵 ⊂ 𝐶 if and only if 𝐵 is a
subset of 𝐶. If one has a relation 𝑅 on a set 𝐴, then, given two elements 𝑥 and 𝑦 of 𝐴,
either 𝑥 is related to 𝑦, in which case we may write 𝑥𝑅𝑦, or else the element 𝑥 is not
related to 𝑦.
BINARY SYMMETRIC CHANNEL: A binary symmetric channel has two probabilities:
𝑃[1 𝑟𝑒𝑐𝑒𝑖𝑣𝑒𝑑 | 0 𝑤𝑎𝑠 𝑠𝑒𝑛𝑡] = 𝑃[0 𝑟𝑒𝑐𝑒𝑖𝑣𝑒𝑑 | 1 𝑤𝑎𝑠 𝑠𝑒𝑛𝑡] = 𝑝
𝑃[1 𝑟𝑒𝑐𝑒𝑖𝑣𝑒𝑑 | 1 𝑤𝑎𝑠 𝑠𝑒𝑛𝑡] = 𝑃[0 𝑟𝑒𝑐𝑒𝑖𝑣𝑒𝑑 | 0 𝑤𝑎𝑠 𝑠𝑒𝑛𝑡] = 1 − 𝑝
The probability 𝑝 is called the crossover probability.
BINOMIAL: A binomial is the sum of two terms. For example, (𝑝𝑥 + 𝑞) is a binomial.
BINOMIAL THEOREM: The binomial theorem tells how to expand the expression
(𝑎 + 𝑏)𝑛 . The general formula is
𝑛 0 𝑛 1 𝑛 𝑛
(𝑎 + 𝑏)𝑛 = 𝑝 (1 − 𝑝)𝑛 + 𝑝 (1 − 𝑝)𝑛−1 + − − − + 𝑝 (1 − 𝑝)0
0 1 𝑛
Some examples of the powers of binomials are as follows:
(𝑎 + 𝑏)0 = 1
(𝑎 + 𝑏)1 = 𝑎 + 𝑏
(𝑎 + 𝑏)2 = 𝑎2 + 2𝑎𝑏 + 𝑏 2
(𝑎 + 𝑏)3 = 𝑎3 + 3𝑎2 𝑏 + 3𝑎𝑏 2 + 𝑏 3
(𝑎 + 𝑏)4 = 𝑎4 + 4𝑎3 𝑏 + 6𝑎2 𝑏 2 + 4𝑎𝑏 3 + 𝑏 4
(𝑎 + 𝑏)5 = 𝑎5 + 5𝑎4 𝑏 + 10𝑎3 𝑏 2 + 10𝑎2 𝑏 3 + 5𝑎𝑏 4 + 𝑏 5
The coefficients form an interesting pattern of numbers known as Pascal’s triangle. This
triangle is an array of numbers such that any entry is equal to the sum of the two entries
above it.
BINORMAL: The normal perpendicular to the principal to the principal normal at point
𝑃 is called binormal at point 𝑃.
BIPARTITE GRAPHS: A graph (𝑉, 𝐸) is said to be bipartite if there exist subsets 𝑉1 and 𝑉2 ,
such that
(i) 𝑉1 ∪ 𝑉2 = 𝑉 ;
(ii) 𝑉1 ∩ 𝑉2 = ∅;
(iii) each edge in E is of the form {𝑣, 𝑤} with 𝑣 ∇ 𝑉1 and 𝑤 ∇ 𝑉2 .
1 2 3 r−1
𝒫 = 1− 1− 1− −−− 1−
365 365 365 365
For example, when 𝑟 = 23, 𝑝 < 0.5, so that for 23 people the probability that no two
people have the same birthday is less than a half, so the probability that at least two of
the twenty three people share a birthday is greater than a half; most people when asked
to make a guess of how many people are needed to achieve a greater than 50% chance
of at least two of them sharing a birthday, put the figure higher than 23. Matching
triplets of birthdays are much harder to observe and it can be shown that in a group of
23 people the probability of at least one triplet of matching birthdays is only 0.013; now
there has to be a group of 88 people before the probability becomes larger than 0.5.
BISECTOR: A line or plane which divides a geometrical object (e.g. a figure or an angle)
into two congruent parts.
BIT: The simplest unit of information consisting of one binary digit, conventionally
labelled 0 and 1.
BLASIUS’S THEOREM: Let a fixed cylinder be placed in a liquid which is moving steadily
and irrotationally given by the relation 𝑤 = 𝑓(𝑧), if the hydro-dynamical pressure on
the contour of a fixed cylinder are represented by a force (𝑋, 𝑌) and a couple 𝑀 about
the origin of coordinates then
1 𝑑𝑤 2
𝑋 − 𝑖𝑌 = 2 𝑖𝜌 ∫𝐶 𝑑𝑧 (neglecting extraneous forces)
𝑑𝑧
1 𝑑𝑤 2
and 𝑀 = 𝑅𝑒𝑎𝑙 𝑝𝑎𝑟𝑡 𝑜𝑓 − 2 𝜌 ∫𝐶 𝑑𝑧 ,
𝑑𝑧
where the integrations are round any contour which surrounds the cylinder.
BLOCH'S THEOREM: Bloch's theorem gives a lower bound on the size of a disc in which
an inverse to a holomorphic function exists. Let 𝑓 be a holomorphic function in the unit
disk |𝑧| ≤ 1. Take |𝑓′(0)| = 1. Then there exists a disc of radius 𝑏 and an analytic
function 𝜑 in this disc, such that 𝑓(𝜑(𝑧)) = 𝑧 for all 𝑧 in this disc. Here 𝑏 > 1/72 is an
absolute constant.
BLOCK CODE: Let 𝐴 = {𝑎1 , . . . , 𝑎𝑞 } be an alphabet; we call the 𝑎𝑖 values symbols. A block
code 𝐶 of length 𝑛 over 𝐴 is a subset of 𝐴𝑛 . A vector 𝑐 ∇ 𝐶 is called a codeword. The
number of elements in 𝐶, denoted |𝐶|, is called the size of the code. A code of length 𝑛
and size 𝑀 is called an (𝑛, 𝑀)-code.
BOCHNER’S THEOREM: A continuous function 𝑓 ∶ 𝐺 → 𝐶 is positive definite if and only
if 𝑓 = µ for some µ ∇ 𝑀 +(𝐺 ).
BODY FORCES: The forces which are proportional to the mass contained in the volume
element are called body forces.
BOLYAI, JANOS (1802 to 1860): Janos Bolyai was a Hungarian mathematician who
developed a version of non-Euclidian geometry.
BOLZANO WEIRSTRASS THEOREM: Every infinite bounded set of real numbers has a
limit point.
Every bounded sequence has at least one limit point.
BONNET’S THEOREM ON PARALLEL SURFACE DIFFERENTIAL GEOMETRY): In general
for every surface (S) of constant positive Gaussian curvature. 𝐴−2 there are associated
two surface of constant mean curvature ±(2𝐴)−1 which are parallel to the former (S)
and distant ± 𝐴 form it.
BOOLEAN PRIME IDEAL THEOREM: The Boolean prime ideal theorem is the strong
prime ideal theorem for Boolean algebras. Its formal statement is:
Let 𝐵 be a Boolean algebra, let 𝐼 be an ideal and let 𝐹 be a filter of 𝐵, such
that 𝐼 and 𝐹 are disjoint. Then 𝐼 is contained in some prime ideal of 𝐵 that is disjoint
from 𝐹.
The weak prime ideal theorem for Boolean algebras simply states that every Boolean
algebra contains a prime ideal.
BOOLE'S INEQUALITY: For any finite or countable set of events, the probability that at
least one of the events happens is no greater than the sum of the probabilities of the
individual events. Formally, for a countable set of events 𝐴1 , 𝐴2 , 𝐴3 , . . ., we have
2𝑟 𝑅+𝑟
𝑀 𝑟 ≤ 𝐴 𝑅 + 𝑓(0)
𝑅−𝑟 𝑅−𝑟
BOREL, FÉLIX EDOUARD JUSTIN EMILE: Félix Edouard Justin Emile Borel (1871–1956)
was a French mathematician who was one of the first to study real-valued functions,
with important results in set theory and measure theory.
BOREL MEASURE: It is a measure defined on the sigma algebra of a topological space
onto the set of real numbers. If the mapping is onto the interval [0, 1] it is a Borel
probability measure.
BOREL SET: It is a set obtained from repeated applications of unions and intersections
of countable collections of closed or open intervals on the real line.
BOREL’S METHOD OF SUMMATION: If for a given series 𝑢𝑛 ,
∞
𝑠𝑛 𝑥 𝑛
𝑢 𝑥 =
𝑛!
𝑛=0
is convergent for all 𝑥, and 𝑢(𝑥) 𝑒 𝑥 → 𝑠 𝑎𝑠 𝑥 → ∞, then 𝑢𝑛 is said to be summable by
Borel’s expontial method to the sum 𝑠, and we write 𝑢𝑛 = 𝑠(𝐵). The transformation
thus determined is denoted by 𝐵 and is called Borel’s method of summation.
BOREL 𝝈 −ALGEBRA: Let 𝐾 be a compact topological space. The Borel 𝜍 −algebra, 𝐵(𝐾),
on 𝐾, is the 𝜍 −algebra generated by the open sets in 𝐾. A member of 𝐵(𝐾) is a Borel
set. Notice that if 𝑓: 𝐾 → 𝐾 is a continuous function, then clearly f is 𝐵(𝐾) −measurable
(the inverse image of an open set will be open, and hence certainly Borel). So if
µ: 𝐵(𝐾) → 𝐾 is a finite charge or complex measure (for 𝐾 = ℝ or 𝐾 = ℂ respectively),
then 𝑓 will be µ-integrable (as 𝑓 is bounded) and so we can define 𝜑𝜇 : 𝐶𝐾 𝐾 → 𝐾 by
𝜑𝜇 𝑓 = ∫𝑋 𝑓𝑑𝜇. Clearly 𝜑𝜇 is linear. Suppose for now that µ is positive, so that
𝜑𝜇 (𝑡) ≤ ∫𝑋 𝑓 𝑑𝜇 ≤ 𝑓 ∞ 𝜇(𝐾)
Note that
1. Many common measures on the real line, e.g. the Lebesgue measure, point
measures, etc., are regular.
1
𝜇 ∅ = 0, 𝜇 = 0, 𝜇 𝐴 = +∞
2
0, 𝑖𝑓 𝐴 𝑖𝑠 𝑎𝑡 𝑚𝑜𝑠𝑡 𝑐𝑜𝑢𝑛𝑡𝑎𝑏𝑙𝑒
𝜇 𝐴 =
+∞, 𝑖𝑓 𝐴 𝑖𝑠 𝑜𝑡𝑒𝑟𝑤𝑖𝑠𝑒
We let 𝑀𝑅 (𝐾) and 𝑀𝐶 (𝐾) be the collection of all finite, regular, signed or complex
measures on 𝐵(𝐾). The variation || · || is a norm on 𝑀𝐾 (𝐾).
BORSUK-ULAM THEOREM: For any continuous real function on the sphere 𝑆 𝑛 there
must be antipodal (i.e. opposite) points where the values of the function are same.
BOUNDED LINEAR FUNCTIONAL: The linear functional Φ on the normed linear space 𝑁
is said to be bounded if there exists a real constant 𝑘, such that Φ (𝑓) ≤ 𝑘 𝑓 .
Equivalently, we can say that Φ is bounded if Φ (𝑓) is bounded on the closed unit
sphere of 𝑁 i.e, Φ(𝑓) / 𝑓 is bounded for every 𝑓 ≠ 0 in 𝑁.
BOUNDED LINEAR OPERATOR: Let 𝑁 and 𝑁′ be two normed linear spaces with the
same scalars. Then a linear operator 𝑇 of 𝑁 into 𝑁′ is said to be bounded if there exists
a non-negative real number 𝑘 such that
𝑇 𝑓 ≤ 𝑘 𝑓 , for all 𝑓 ∇ 𝑁.
BOUNDED SEQUENCE: The real sequence ⌌𝑎𝑛 ⌍ is said to be bounded if there is a real
number 𝑀 such that, for all 𝑛, |𝑎𝑛 | < 𝑀.
BOUNDED SET: A set 𝐴 is said to be a bounded set if closure of 𝐴 does not consist of any
infinite values.
BOX PLOT: Box plot is another name of the box-and-whisker diagram, also known as a
box-and-whisker plot.
BRACES: Symbols { and } commonly used to represent the order of operations along
with parentheses and brackets. (And other less common types.) They're also used to
represent sets.
BRACHISTOCHRONE: The trajectory of fastest travel between 2 points if a bead is
considered to be guided by a smooth wire, under gravity only, between the 2 points
starting from rest. Note that the starting point must not be the lower of the 2 points or
the bead would never reach the other point. (At the starting point, the bead
has zero Kinectic energy. It will never reach the point with higher gravitational potential
energy. However, due tot he smoothness of the wire, points of equal heights are
possible.)
BRACKETS: Symbols [ and ] commonly used to represent the order of operations, along
with parentheses and braces. (And other less common types.) Informally, all 3 pairs of
symbols are referred to as brackets. Brackets are also used to
represent matrices amongst other mathematical objects.
2
𝑢 + 𝑣 2 , 𝑖𝑓 𝑢 ≠ 𝑣,
𝑑(𝑢, 𝑣) =
0 𝑖𝑓 𝑢 = 𝑣,
BUTLER’S SPHERE THEOREM: Let a rigid sphere r = a be introduced into flow field of an
axis-symmetric irrotational flow in an incompressible inviscid fluid with no rigid
boundaries, characterized by the stream function Ψ0 = Ψ0 (r, θ)all of whose singularties
are at a distance greater than a from the origin, where Ψ0 = 0(r 2 ) at an origin, then the
stream function becomes
r a2
Ψ = Ψ0 − Ψ1 = Ψ0 r, θ − Ψ0 ,θ
a r
𝑎 = 𝑡0 ≤ 𝑡1 ≤ 𝑡2 ≤ ⋯ ≤ 𝑡𝑛 = 𝑏,
𝑉𝑛 = 𝑓 𝑡𝑘 − 𝑓 𝑡𝑘−1 .
𝑘=1
We denote the space of all functions of bounded variation in the interval [𝑎, 𝑏] by
𝐵𝑉 𝑎, 𝑏 . That this is a linear space follows from the property that a function is of
bounded variation if and only if it can be expressed as the difference of two non-
decreasing functions.
C
𝑪𝟎 SPACE: This is the space of all sequences of complex numbers which converges to
zero, with the norm defined as in 𝑐. Since, if two sequences converge to zero, then their
linear combination also converges to zero, 𝑪𝟎 is a subspace of 𝑐. Thus 𝑐0 is a normed
linear space.
∞
For completeness, let 𝑓𝑛 be a fundamental sequence in 𝑐0 . Since 𝑐0 ⊂ 𝑐, 𝑓𝑛 𝑛=1 is also
a fundamental sequence is 𝑐, and has a limit 𝑐. By the theorem of double limits
𝑙𝑖𝑚𝑛→∞𝑓(𝑛) exists and is equal to 0. Hence
𝑓 = 𝑓(𝑛)∞
𝑛=1 lies in 𝑐.
1
𝑓 = 𝑓 𝑡 𝑑𝑡,
0
𝐂[𝐚, 𝐛] SPACE: The space 𝐶 [𝑎, 𝑏] is the space of all bounded continuous functions
defined on the closed interval 𝑎, 𝑏 . We know that 𝐶 [𝑎, 𝑏] is a linear space with respect
to pointwise linear operations defined by
𝑓+𝑔 𝑥 = 𝑓 𝑥 + 𝑔 𝑥 and 𝛼𝑓 𝑥 = 𝛼𝑓 𝑥 ,
CALCULUS: Calculus is divided into two general areas: differential calculus and integral
calculus. The basic problem in differential calculus is to find the rate of change of a
function. Geometrically, this means finding the slope of the tangent line to a function at a
particular point; physically, this means finding the speed of an object if you are given its
position as a function of time. The slope of the tangent line to the curve 𝑦 = 𝑓 (𝑥) at a
𝑑𝑦
point (𝑥, 𝑓 (𝑥)) is called the derivative, written as 𝑦 ′ or . The reverse process of
𝑑𝑥
𝐽= 𝑓 𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑦 ′ 𝑑𝑥
𝑎
𝐽(𝑒) = 𝑓 𝑥, 𝑌, 𝑌 ′ 𝑑𝑥
𝑎
CANCELLATION: Any method of calculation the result of which, when compared to the
original form, attributes a number of components of the original form to mitigate the
effects of the rest (of those components), so that the result remains the same through
their omission. A common example invloves the numerator and denominator of
a fraction, and another invloves the omission of one logarithm symbol from each side of
the equation (when the each side consists of the logarithm only), even though the
former is a result of the equivalence of fractions and the latter the injective nature of
the logarithmic function. Failure of understanding these can result in the misuse of such
methods, and is commonplace amongst students.
CANCELLATION LAWS: Let ⟪ be a binary operation on a set 𝑆. The cancellation laws are
said to hold if, for all 𝑎, 𝑏 and 𝑐 in 𝑆,
(i) if 𝑎⟪𝑏 = 𝑎⟪𝑐, then b = c,
(ii) if 𝑏⟪𝑎 = 𝑐⟪𝑎, then b = c.
In a group G, the cancellation laws hold.
CANONICAL: Describes a representation of an object (e.g. an expression,
a transformation) in a way that is preferred, perhaps unique or considered natural due
to certain properties that it exhibits, even though there may be
other equivalent representations.
CANONICAL HEIGHT: The canonical height on an abelian variety is a height function that
is a distinguished quadratic form.
CANONICAL OR NORMAL FORM OF A REAL QUADRATIC FORMS: If X ′ AX is a real
quadratic form in 𝑛 variables, then there exists real non-singular linear transformation
𝑋 = PV which transforms X ′ AX to the form
𝜌1 , 𝜌1 ≠ 𝑖𝑛𝑡𝑒𝑔𝑒𝑟
∞
𝜌= 𝜌1 − 1, 𝜌1 𝑖𝑠 𝑖𝑛𝑡𝑒𝑔𝑒𝑟 𝑠. 𝑡. 𝑟𝑛 − 𝜌1 𝑖𝑠 𝑐𝑜𝑛𝑣𝑒𝑟𝑔𝑒𝑛𝑡
𝑛=1
𝜌1 , 𝑜𝑡𝑒𝑟𝑤𝑖𝑠𝑒
∞
𝑧
𝐺 𝑧 = ,𝑝
𝑧𝑛
𝑛 =1
Converges uniformly and absolutely in any bounded closed domain of 𝑧 − 𝑝𝑙𝑎𝑛𝑒 which
does not contain any 𝑧𝑛 𝑛 = 1,2,3, … . Also 𝐺(𝑧) is an integral function and vanishes if
and only if 𝑧 is a zero of 𝑓 𝑧 . We call this product by the name Canocial product formed
with zero of 𝑓 𝑧 , the integer 𝜌 is called genus of it.
CANTILEVER: A beam or such similar structures which is anchored at only one end such
that it resists rotation under load.
intervals, again remove the open interval that forms the middle third. The Cantor set is
the set that remains when this process is continued indefinitely. It consists of those real
numbers whose ternary representation 0. 𝑐1 𝑐2 𝑐3 … has each ternary digit 𝑐𝑖 equal to
either the digit 0 or 2.
it follows that
CANTOR LEMMA: No interval [a, b] is countable.
CANTOR’S PARADOX: Suppose there exists an infinite set A containing the largest
possible number of elements. Cantor’s Diagonal Theorem shows that its power set has
more elements than A had. This proves there is no largest cardinal number.
CANTOR'S THEOREM: It states that, for any set A, the set of all subsets of 𝐴 (the power
set of 𝐴) has a strictly greater cardinality than 𝐴 itself.
CARMICHAEL'S THEOREM: It states that for 𝑛 greater than 12, the 𝑛th Fibonacci
number 𝐹(𝑛) has at least one prime divisor that does not divide any earlier Fibonacci
number.
CARTESIAN COORDINATE SYSTEM: The rectilinear coordinate system used for any
(finite and natural) number of dimensions. The number of axes used is commonly seen
as a basic way of "defining" the number of dimensions.
These axes must all be mutually perpendicular and the components (the coordinates) of
a point are the shortest distances of a point to the hyperplane consisting the axes
(except the axis related to the component in question). Thus, the x-coordinate of a point
is the shortest distance from the point to any point on the line (plane) consisting of
the y-axis (both y and z-axes) in 2D (3D).
While rectilinear coordinate system is a more descriptive name of its function, it is more
commonly called Cartesian, named after Cartesius, the Latin name of René Descartes.
CARTESIAN PRODUCT: The Cartesian product 𝐴 × 𝐵, of sets 𝐴 and 𝐵, is the set of all
ordered pairs (𝑎, 𝑏), where 𝑎 ∇ 𝐴 and 𝑏 ∇ 𝐵. Similarly, the Cartesian product
𝐴 × 𝐵 × 𝐶 of sets 𝐴, 𝐵 and 𝐶 can be defined as the set of all ordered triples (𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐),
where 𝑎 ∇ 𝐴, 𝑏 ∇ 𝐵 and 𝑐 ∇ 𝐶.
2. For series - a necessary and sufficient condition for the convergence of a series: An
infinite series 𝛴𝑎𝑛 is convergent, if and only if, for any positive number 𝜀 , there is an
integer 𝑁(𝜀) (𝑁 is a function of 𝜀 ), such that
CAUCHY HADAMARD THEOREM: Consider the formal power series in one complex
variable z of the form
1 𝑓 𝑧 𝑑𝑧
𝑓′ 𝑎 = ∫𝐶
2𝜋𝑖 (𝑧 − 𝑎)²
𝑡
CAUCHY MACLAURIN’S INTEGRAL TEST: Let 𝐹 𝑡 = ∫𝑎 𝑓 𝑥 𝑑𝑥 for 𝑎 ≤ 𝑡 < ∞. If
∞
lim𝑡→∞ 𝐹(𝑡) exists and is equal to 𝑙 ∇ 𝑅, the improper integral ∫𝑎 𝑓 𝑥 𝑑𝑥 is convergent
to 𝑙 otherwise, it is divergent.
CAUCHY MEAN VALUE THEOREM: If real valued functions 𝑓(𝑥) and 𝑔(𝑥) are such that
𝑓 𝑥 , 𝑔(𝑥) are continuous in the closed interval [𝑎, 𝑏]
𝑓 𝑥 , 𝑔(𝑥) are differentiable in the open interval (𝑎, 𝑏)
𝑓 ′ (𝑐) 𝑓 𝑏 −𝑓(𝑎)
then there exist at least one value of 𝑥 = 𝑐 ∇ (𝑎, 𝑏) such that 𝑔 ′ (𝑐) = 𝑔 .
𝑏 −𝑔(𝑎)
CAUCHY RATIO TEST: Also known simply as the ratio test. It is a method of deciding
the convergence of a series through the general ratio of one term of the series to the
next.
CAUCHY SCHWARZ INEQUALITY FOR INTEGRALS: If 𝑓(𝑥), 𝑔(𝑥) are real functions then
{∫ [𝑓(𝑥)𝑔(𝑥)]𝑑𝑥}2 ≤ {∫ [𝑓(𝑥)]2 𝑑𝑥}{∫ [𝑔(𝑥)]2 𝑑𝑥}
if all these integrals exist.
CAUCHY SCHWARZ INEQUALITY FOR SUMS: If 𝑎𝑖 and 𝑏𝑖 are real numbers, 𝑖 = 1, 2, … , 𝑛
then
𝑛 𝑛 𝑛
𝑎𝑖 𝑏𝑖 ≤ 𝑎𝑖2 𝑏𝑖2
𝑖=1 𝑖=1 𝑖=1
CAUCHY SEQUENCE: A sequence ⌌𝑎𝑛 ⌍ for which the metric 𝑑(𝑎𝑛 , 𝑎𝑚 ), where 𝑚 > 𝑛,
satisfies lim𝑛 →∞ 𝑑 𝑎𝑛 , 𝑎𝑚 = 0.
Cauchy sequences converge when they are defined on the set of real numbers, but do
not necessarily converge on the set of rational numbers.
CAUCHY’S CONDENSATION TEST: If the function 𝑓(𝑥) is positive for all positive integral
values of 𝑛 and continually decreases as 𝑛 increases, then the two infinite series 𝑓(𝑛)
and 𝑎𝑛 𝑓(𝑎𝑛 ) are either both convergent or both divergent, 𝑎 being a positive integer
greater than 1.
CAUCHY’S FIRST THEOREM ON LIMITS: If ⌌𝑥𝑛 ⌍ is a sequence of positive reals such that
lim𝑛→∞ 𝑥𝑛 = 𝑙, then
𝑥1 + 𝑥2 + 𝑥3 + − − − + 𝑥𝑛
lim =𝑙
𝑛 →∞ 𝑛
CAUCHY’S GENERAL PRINCIPLE OF CONVERGENCE: A sequence ⌌𝑥𝑛 ⌍ of real numbers
converges if and only if it is a Cauchy sequence.
CAUCHY’S INEQUALITY COMPLEX ANALYSIS): If 𝑓(𝑧) is analytic within and on a circle
𝑛 𝑀𝑛 !
𝐶, given by 𝑧 − 𝑎 = 𝑅 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑖𝑓 𝑓(𝑧) ≤ 𝑀 for every 𝑧 𝑜𝑛 𝐶, then 𝑓 (𝑎) ≤ 𝑅𝑛
CAUCHY’S INTEGRAL THEOREM: For a closed curve C and an analytic function 𝑓(𝑧),
𝑓 𝑧 𝑑𝑧 = 0
CAUCHY’S LEMMA: If 𝐺 is a finite group and 𝑝 is a prime number that divides the order
of 𝐺, then 𝐺 must contain an element of order 𝑝.
1
CAUCHY’S ROOT TEST: Let 𝑢𝑛 be a series of positive terms such that lim𝑛→∞ 𝑢𝑛 𝑛 = 𝑙.
Then
1. 𝑢𝑛 converges if 𝑙 < 1.
2. 𝑢𝑛 diverges if 𝑙 > 1.
3. The test fails if 𝑙 = 1.
CAUCHY’S SECOND THEOREM ON LIMITS: If ⌌𝑥𝑛 ⌍ is a sequence of positive reals such that
lim𝑛→∞ 𝑥𝑛 = 𝑙, then
𝑛
lim 𝑥1 𝑥2 𝑥3 − − − 𝑥𝑛 = 𝑙
𝑛→∞
CAVALIERI’S PRINCIPLE: Two geometrical figures whose cross sections are the same as
each other, at the same distance away from some reference line/lines (plane/planes)
have the same area (volume). As an example, this explains why triangles whose bases
have the same length, and have the same height, have also the same area, regardless of
its shape.
CEILING FUNCTION: It is the function on real numbers whose value is always rounded
up, if the argument is not already an integer. The function leaves integers unchanged.
CELESTIAL MECHANICS: The study of motions of celestial bodies such as stars, planets
and comets etc.
CELL: Categories of data divided into rectangular arrays through more than
one variable. It is essentially a conventional use for the analogue of groups in 1
dimension.
CELSUIS: Represented by the symbol °C. It is based on dividing the difference between
the freezing point and boiling point of water into 100 equal "degrees.
CENSORED OBSERVATIONS: In statistics, these are the observations that are made
incomplete systematically due to the nature of the procedure (possible) for observation
or the objects under study.
CENTESIMAL MEASURE: A metric angular measure dividing a right angle into 100
centesimal degrees.
CENTRAL CONIC: A central conic is a conic with a centre of symmetry, and thus an
ellipse or a hyperbola. The conic with equation
𝑎𝑥 2 + 2𝑥𝑦 + 𝑏𝑦 2 + 2𝑔𝑥 + 2𝑓𝑦 + 𝑐 = 0
is central if and only if
𝑎𝑏 ≠ 2 .
CENTRAL DIFFERENCE: If {(𝑥𝑖 , 𝑓𝑖 )}, 𝑖 = 0, 1, 2, … is a given set of function values with
𝑥𝑖+1 = 𝑥𝑖 + , 𝑓𝑖 = 𝑓(𝑥𝑖 ) then the central difference at 𝑓𝑖 is defined by
𝑓𝑖+1 – 𝑓𝑖−1 𝑓 𝑥𝑖+1 − 𝑓(𝑥𝑖−1 )
=
2 2
CENTRAL DIFFERENCE APPROXIMATION: The most common numerical approximation
to the derivative of a function 𝑓(𝑥) is to take the gradient of the chord joining the point
and another point where 𝑥 has been increased by a small amount . The central
difference approximation uses the chord joining the two points whose 𝑥 values are a
small amount from the value 𝑥0 , giving
𝑓 𝑥0 + − 𝑓 𝑥0 −
𝑓 ′ (𝑥0 ) ≈
2
CENTRAL FIELD: The family of curves 𝑦 = 𝑦 𝑥, 𝑐 is said to form a central field over a
domain D if together they cover the whole D without intersecting each other.
CENTRALIZER: Let 𝐺 be a group. The centralizer 𝐶() of an element of 𝐺 is the
subgroup of 𝐺 defined by 𝐶() = {𝑔 ∇ 𝐺 ∶ 𝑔 = 𝑔}.
CENTRAL LIMIT THEOREM: If independent samples of size n are taken from a
population the distribution of the sample means (known as the sampling distribution of
the mean) will be approximately normal for large n. The mean of the sampling
distribution is the population mean and its variance is the population variance divided
by n. Note that there is no need for the distribution in the population sampled to be
normal. The theorem is important because it allows statements to be made about
population parameters by comparing the results of a single experiment with those that
would be expected according to some null hypothesis.
CENTRAL TENDENCY: A common measure in summary statistics bsed around the loose
idea that we can assign one location to represent the locations of a number of objects
considered as one. Thus, there is not just one but rather a number of slightly different
concepts which fits the description of central tendency. It is what is commonly referred
to by the similarly loose idea of an average.
CENTRE OF A FUZZY SET: if the mean value of all points at which the membership
function of the fuzzy set achieves its maximum value is finite, then define this mean
value as the center of the fuzzy set; if the mean value equals positive (negative) infinite,
then the center is defined as the smallest (largest) among all points that achieve the
maximum membership value.
CENTRE OF A GROUP: The set of elements which are commutative with every elements
of the group. Note that there must be at least one element in the centre, the identity.
Whereas the centre can be as large as the group, such a group is called an Abelian group.
CENTRE OF BUOYANCY: The centre of gravity of the body of water that an object
displaces.
CENTRE OF CURVATURE: Given a curve, the centre of curvature of a point on this curve
is the centre of a circle which "locally" (for a neighborhood of that point) describes the
curvature of the curve.
CENTRE OF MASS: The point (not necessarily within the object) which is the
weighted average of the point masses of a body (or the set of infinitely many point
masses through integration), which can be used to calculate linear motion of a rigid
body as if all of the object's mass are at that point (the centre of mass) only.
(Considering the object as a particle.) It is also known as the barycentre. A point q ∇ M is
called the center of mass of the points if it is a point of global minimum
of the function
Such a point is unique if all distances are less than radius of convexity.
For uniform bodies:
2
TRIANGULAR LAMINA: along median from vertex
3
𝑟 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝛼
CIRCULAR ARC, RADIUS r, ANGLE AT CENTRE 2α: from centre
α
2𝑟 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝛼
SECTOR OF CIRCLE, RADIUS r, ANGLE AT CENTRE 2𝛼: from centre
3α
CEVIAN: Any line segment joining a vertex of a triangle to a point on the infinite line
containing the opposite side.
c.g.s. UNITS: A system of units based on centimeters, grams and seconds. (Instead
of meters, kilograms and hours for the SI units). It has been largely superseded by the
use of SI units nowadays.
A − λI = 0 ………. 1
A − λI X = 0 𝑜𝑟 𝐴𝑋 = λX.
The characteristic roots of a skew-Hermitian matrix are either pure imaginary or zero.
The characteristic roots of a real symmetric matrix are either pure imaginary or zero,
for every such matrix is skew- Hermitian.
𝑓 𝑧 − 𝜋𝑛 𝑧 ≤ 𝑀 𝑅𝑛 .
d2 y dy
1 − 𝑥2 − x + n2 y = 0
dx 2 dx
more than 𝑘 standard deviations from its mean is not more than 1/𝑘 2 . If X is a random
𝐸{𝑔 𝑋 }
variable and 𝑔(𝑋) is always ≥ 0 then 𝑃 𝑔(𝑋) ≥ 𝑘 ≤ says that for a non-negative
𝑘
function of a random variable, the probability the function takes a value at least 𝑘 can be
no more than the mean of the function divided by 𝑘.
While these inequalities are very weak statements in that most distributions do not
come close to the limit specified, it is very useful sometimes to be able to identify an
upper limit that it is impossible for a probability to exceed.
CHEBYSHEV’S INEQUALITY (MEASURE THEORY): If 𝑓 is non-negative & summable, then
1
𝜇 𝑥 ∇ 𝑋: 𝑓 𝑥 > 𝑐 < 𝑐 ∫ 𝑓𝑑𝜇. Let (𝑓𝑛 ) be monotonically ↑ sequence of µ −summable
Tn x = cos(ncos −1 x)
and Un x = sin(ncos −1 x)
1
Un x = sin (n + 1)cos−1 x) / [ 1 − x 2 ] Un+1 (x)
[ 1 − x2
and
then
Similarly, if
and
then
CHEBYSHEV’S THEOREM (NUMBER THEORY): For any positive integer greater than 𝑛
there is always a prime between 𝑛 and 2𝑛.
CHEBYSHEV’S THEOREM (STATISTICS): For a random variable, whatever the
distribution, with 𝐸(𝑋) = 𝜇, 𝑉𝑎𝑟(𝑋) = 𝜍 2 the proportion of values which lie within 𝑘
1
standard deviations of the mean will be at least 1 − 𝑘 2 .
CHINESE POSTMAN PROBLEM: The problem of finding the least weighted circuit in a
connected graph. If an Eulerian cycle exists than such a cycle is the solution to the
problem, otherwise, it is necessary to repeat at least one edge and the problem can be
more complicated.
CHINESE REMAINDER THEOREM: Suppose 𝑛1 , . . . , 𝑛𝑘 are positive integers that
are pairwise coprime. Then, for any given sequence of integers 𝑎1 , . . . , 𝑎𝑘 , there exists
an integer 𝑥 solving the following system of simultaneous congruences.
Furthermore, all solutions 𝑥 of this system are congruent modulo the product,
𝑁 = 𝑛1 , . . . , 𝑛𝑘 . Hence
n P n +1 x P n y −P n +1 y P n x
r=0 2r + 1 Pr x Pr y = (n + 1) .
(x−y)
𝑛
1 + n + 1 [Pn+1 x Qn y − Pn x Qn+1 y
(2𝑟 + 1) Pr x Qr y =
y−x
𝑟=0
CHROMATIC NUMBER: For a graph or map 𝐺, the maximum number of colours needed
so that all regions touching one another (meeting at an edge or a vertex) are in a
different colour is the chromatic number, denoted by 𝜒(𝐺). The Four Colour Theorem
proved that 𝜒(𝐺) ≤ 4 for all planar graphs.
CIRCLE: The conic produced by slicing a right-circular cone at right angles to its central
axis
CIRCLE OF CONVERGENCE: A circle in the complex plane with the property that
∞
𝑖=1 𝑎𝑖 (𝑧 − 𝑧0 )𝑖 converges for all 𝑧 within a distance 𝑅 > 0 of 𝑧0 and diverges for all 𝑧
for which |𝑧 − 𝑧0 | > 𝑅 . 𝑅 is the radius of convergence and if the power series
converges for the whole of the complex plane then 𝑅 is infinite. The case where 𝑅 = 0
is trivial since convergence only occurs when 𝑧 − 𝑧0 = 0. For points on the
circumference of the circle the series may either converge or diverge.
CIRCLE OF CURVATURE: A circle which describes correctly the curvature of a curve for
the neighborhood of a point on the curve.
𝑤 = 𝑓 𝑧 + 𝑓 (𝑎2 /𝑧)
Note that the angular velocity (rate of rotation) at any point of the flowing fluid is equal
to the half the curl of the velocity at the point. The vector curl q is termed the vector or
the vorticity of the fluid at a point.
Body forces are those which act equally on all the matter within a small element of
volume and the total force is proportional to the size of the volume element or mass of
the fluid considered. The simplest example of such a force is the gravitational force.
Centrifugal force is treated as a body force when the coordinate system is rotating, but it
is not treated as a body force if the coordinates system is stationary. Thus the body can
be specified as per unit mass of the fluid. It may vary from point to point of the fluid, and
at any point it may have different values at different instances of times. The body forces
have three components and can be represented by a vector function of position and
time.
Surface forces are viewed s acting on any surface divided in the fluid including its
boundaries. Each point in the fluid may belong to several surfaces. Several such surf e
forces seem to co-exist at the point.
Surface forces have a direct molecular origin, decrease rapidly with increase of distance
between interacting elements. These are considerable only when that distance is of the
separation of molecules of the fluid. They are negligible unless there is direct
mechanical contact between the interacting elements. These are the forces exerted by
adjacent portions of the fluid upon one another and are in the nature of action and
reaction. The specification of these force are obtained from the concept of stress tensor
which has nine components.
CIRCULAR HELIX: A helix which lies on the surface of a circular cylinder is called a
circular helix or right circular helix.
CIRCULAR SECTIONS: When the intersection of a plane and a quadric is a circle, the
intersection is called a circular section. In general, circular sections are cut off by two
systems of parallel planes through a quadric. The point of contact on the tangent plane
parallel to these is an umbilical point of the quadric.
CIRCUMCENTRE: The centre of a circle which goes through all vertices of a polygon.
CIS: A commonly defined function in the study of complex numbers. 𝑐𝑖𝑠(𝜃) = 𝑐𝑜𝑠(𝜃) +
𝑖𝑠𝑖𝑛(𝜃) Incidentally, 𝑐𝑖𝑠(𝜃) = 𝑒𝑥𝑝(𝑖𝜃). As such, 𝑐𝑖𝑠 is seldom used apart from a
particular stage of learning in school as most favour the use of the simpler 𝑒𝑥𝑝(𝑖𝜃).
2 𝑊= 𝑐0 + 2𝑐𝑖 𝑒𝑖 , + 𝑐𝑖𝑗 𝑒𝑖 𝑒𝑗 + … … .,
Neglecting constant terms 𝑐𝑜 and third and higher order terms in the strains.
Differentiating partially (1) w.r.t 𝑒𝑖 , we have
2𝜕𝑊
= 2𝑐𝑖 + 𝑐𝑖𝑗 𝑒𝑗 + 𝑐𝑗𝑖 𝑒𝑖
𝜕𝑒𝑖
2𝜕𝑊 1
Or = 𝜏𝑖 = 𝑐𝑖 + 2 𝑐𝑖𝑗 + 𝑐𝑗𝑖 𝑒𝑗 ∵ 𝑖 𝑖𝑠 𝑑𝑢𝑚𝑚𝑦
𝜕𝑒 𝑖
1
𝑊 = 2 𝑐𝑖𝑗 𝑒𝑗
𝜕𝑊 1
𝐻𝑒𝑛𝑐𝑒 𝜏𝑖 = = 𝑐 + 𝑐𝑗𝑖 𝑒𝑗 .
𝜕𝑒𝑖 2 𝑖𝑗
Also the coefficient in the generalized Hooke’s law is symmetric of the strain- energy
density function W, with the property stated above, exists.
This gives
1
𝑊 = 2 𝜏𝑖𝑒 𝑖 𝑖 = 1,2, … . .6 . This formula is known as the Clapeyron’s formula.
CLASS: A collection of objects, not necessary a set. The distinction generally is that
certain operations on sets are not allowed so as to allow us to refer to a (usually large)
collection of objects without causing contradictions such as Russell's paradox.
CLOSED GRAPH THEOREM: Let 𝐵 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝐵′ be Banach spaces and let 𝑇 be a linear
treansformation of 𝐵 into 𝐵 ′ . Then 𝑇 is a continuous mapping of and only if its graph is
closed.
CLOSED INTERVAL: The closed interval [𝑎, 𝑏] is the set of all real numbers between 𝑎
and 𝑏 including 𝑎 and 𝑏 i.e. {𝑥|𝑥 ∇ 𝑹, 𝑎 ≤ 𝑥 ≤ 𝑏}.
CLOSED RANGE THEOREM: Let 𝑋 and 𝑌 be Banach spaces, 𝑇: 𝐷(𝑇) → 𝑌 a closed linear
operator whose domain 𝐷(𝑇) is dense in 𝑋, and 𝑇 ′ the transpose of 𝑇. The theorem
asserts that the following conditions are equivalent:
.
CLOSED REGION: It is a set of points containing all limit points and is connected.
CLOSED SET: The complement of an open set in a metric space or in a topological space
is called a closed set. Therefore, a subset of a topological space is called closed if it is the
complement of an open set
a12 a13
=− a a33 ,
32
a11 a13
The cofactor of the element a32 = A32 = − a a23 ,
21
a22 a23
The cofactor of the element a11 = A11 = − a a33 , and so no
32
Thus the cofactor of any element aij = (−1)i+j × the determinant obtained by leaving
the row and the column passing through that element.
Therefore, in a determinant the sum of the products of the elements of any row or
column with the corresponding cofactors is equal to the value of the determinant.
COINCIDENT: The property of two geometric figures to have all points in common.
CO-INTIAL VECTOR: The vectors which have the same initial point are called co-initial
vectors.
COLATITUDE: The angle between the vector and the polar axis (z-axis) in a
Spherical polar coordinate system, whereas latitude is the value subtracting colatitude
from 90 degrees, the smallest angle between the radius vector and the plane
perpendicular to the polaw axis through the origin. (the equator)
COLLINEAR: A set of three or more points is collinear if they all lie on the same line.
COLLINEARITY OF THREE POINTS: The necessary and sufficient condition for three
points with position vectors 𝒂, 𝒃, 𝒄 to be collinear is that there exist three scalars x, y, z
not all zero, such that x𝒂 + y𝒃+ z𝒄=0 where x + y + z= 0.
COLLINEAR OR PARALLEL VECTORS: Vectors having the same line of action or having
the lines of action parallel to one another are called collinear or parallel vectors.
COLLISION: The interaction of two objects with each other through contact transitioned
from a state of non-contact prior.
COLLUSION: Several customers may collaborate and only one of them may stand in the
queue.
COLUMN RANK OF A MATRIX: Let A = aij be any 𝑚 × 𝑛 matrix. Each of the 𝑛 rows of 𝐴
consists of 𝑚 elements. Therefore the column vectors of 𝐴 are 𝑚-vectors. These column
vectors of 𝐴 will span a subspace 𝐶 to 𝑉𝑚 . This subspace 𝐶 is called the column space of
the matrix 𝐴. The dimension 𝑐 of 𝐶 is called the column rank of 𝐴. In other words the
column rank of a matrix 𝐴 is equal to the maximum number of linearly independent
column of 𝐴.
if,
𝑎⟪ 𝑏 = 𝑏 ⟪𝑎 ∀ 𝑎 , 𝑏 ∇ 𝑆
COMMUTATIVE ALGEBRA: An algebra A is called commutative algebra if
COMPACT OPEN TOPOLOGY: Let 𝑋 and 𝑌 be two topological spaces. Let 𝐶(𝑋, 𝑌) be the
set of all continuous functions from 𝑋 to 𝑌. The topology on generated by all sets of the
form 𝑆(𝐴, 𝑈) = { 𝑓 ∇ 𝐶(𝑋, 𝑌) | 𝑓(𝐴) ⊂ 𝑈} where 𝐴 ⊂ 𝑋 is compact and 𝑈 ⊂ 𝑌 is
open is called the compact-open topology on 𝐶 𝑋, 𝑌 . The compact-open topology on the
set 𝐶(𝑋, 𝑌) of all continuous maps between two spaces 𝑋 and 𝑌 is defined as follows:
Given a compact subset 𝐾 of 𝑋 and an open subset 𝑈 of 𝑌, let 𝑉(𝐾, 𝑈) denote the set of
all maps 𝑓 in 𝐶(𝑋, 𝑌) such that 𝑓(𝐾) is contained in 𝑈. Then the collection of all
such 𝑉(𝐾, 𝑈) is a subbase for the compact-open topology.
COMPACT SET IN A METRIC SPACE: A compact set in a metric space is defined by the
property that any its covering by a family of open sets contains a subcovering by a finite
subfamily. In the finite dimensional vector spaces ℝn or ℂn there is the following
equivalent definition of compactness:
COMPACT SPACE: A topological space in which any collection of open sets whose union
is the whole space (open cover of space) has a finite number of open sets from this
collection (finite subcover of the cover) whose union is also the whole space.
A topological space is compact when
(i) Each open cover contains a finite subcover OR
(ii) Every convergent net has a convergent subnet OR
(iii) Every filter on X has a convergent refinement OR
(iv) Every ultrafilter converges to at least one point.
COMPARATIVE STATICS: Comparative static is concerned with the dependencies of
optimal solutions on the parameter.
COMPARISON OF FILTERS: If 𝐹 and 𝐹0 are two filters on the same set 𝐸, 𝐹 is said to be
finer than 𝐹0 , or 𝐹0 is coarser than 𝐹, if the fundamental family 𝐹 is finer than 𝐹0 , i.e. if
every 𝐴0 ∇ 𝐹0 contains an 𝐴 ∇ 𝐹. If 𝐹 is finer than 𝐹0 and 𝐹0 is finer than 𝐹, 𝐹0 and 𝐹
are said to be equivalent.
∞
COMPARISON TEST: If 𝑎𝑛 , 𝑏𝑛 ∇ 𝑅 and 0 ≤ 𝑎𝑛 ≤ 𝑏𝑛 then whenever 𝑛=1 𝑏𝑛
∞
converges 𝑛=1 𝑎𝑛 must converge.
COMPATIBLE ATLASES: Two m-dimensional smooth atlases on 𝑀 are said to be
compatible, if every chart from one atlas has smooth transition on its overlap with every
chart from the other atlas (or equivalently, if their union is again an atlas). It can be seen
that compatibility is an equivalence relation. An equivalence class of smooth atlases is
called a smooth structure. All atlases on a given manifold 𝑆 in 𝑅 𝑛 are compatible. The
smooth structure so obtained on 𝑆 is called the standard smooth structure.
COMPATIBLE MATRICES: Two matrices in a particular order so that they can be
multiplied. In the usual convention, the number of columns in the first matrix and the
number of rows in the second matrix must be the same. In more abstract terms,
considering the matrices as transformations, it amounts to maintaining that the number
of dimensions (rank) of the co-domain of the first transformation be the same as the
dimensions (rank) of the domain of the second transformation.
COMPETITIVE GAME: A game is said to be competitive game if it has the following four
properties:
COMPLEMENTARY ANGLES: Two angles that sum to a right angle. In this case, each
angle is called the complement of the other angle.
COMPLEMENTARY FUNCTION: Along with the particular integral, it forms the general
solution of a linear differential equation. It is essentially an element in the kernel of
the differential operator.
and so on. At some stage we arrive at a function 𝐹(𝑧) such that for any 𝑣, 𝐹(𝑣) denotes
the value of values obtained for 𝑣 by all possible continuation to 𝑣, that is to say.
𝑓1 𝑧 𝑖𝑓 𝑧 ∇ 𝐷1
𝑓2 𝑧 𝑖𝑓 𝑧 ∇ 𝐷2
𝐹 𝑧 =
…………………
𝑓𝑛 𝑧 𝑖𝑓 𝑧 ∇ 𝐷𝑛
Such a function 𝑓(𝑧) is called complete analytic function. In this process of continuation,
we may arrive at a closed curve beyond which it is not possible to take analytic
continuation. Such a closed curve is called the natural boundary of the complete analytic
function. A point outside the natural boundary is called the singularity of complete
analytic function.
COMPLETE INDUCTION: Also known as strong induction. This method assumes that the
statement is true for all values below a certain finite value in the inductive step of
proving the next statement. Logically strong induction is equivalent to weak induction
and is not "stronger" in this logical sense.
COMPLETE LATTICE: A poset where all subsets have a supremum and an infimum.
there is a map 𝑓 ∇ 𝐶(𝑋) such that 𝑓(𝑥) = 𝑎 and 𝑓(𝐴) = {𝑏} where 𝑎 ≠ 𝑏. Thus in a
completely regular space a point and a closed set disjoint from it can be separated by a
continuous real function.
COMPLETE GRAPH: A simple graph in which every vertex is joined to every other. The
complete graph with 𝑛 vertices, denoted by 𝐾𝑛 , is regular of degree 𝑛 – 1 and has edges.
𝐾4 𝐾5 𝐾6
COMPLETING THE SQUARE: It is the method for solving a quadratic equation in general
by writing a quadratic expression in the vertex form. Note that the quadratic formula is
derived from the method of completing the square for the general quadratic expression.
An equivalent way of stating condition (ii) is that 𝑋0 is dense of 𝑋 ′ . It means that every
point of 𝑋 ′ is either a point or a limit point of 𝑋0, which in turn implies that, given any 𝑓
of 𝑋 ′ , there exists a sequence of points in 𝑋0 which converges to 𝑓.
COMPLEX ANALYSIS: Complex analysis is the area of mathematics relating to the study
of complex functions.
COMPLEX CONJUGATE: Given a complex number, the complex conjugate is the complex
number whose real part is the same, while the imaginary part (being a real number)
has opposite signs. The significance of complex conjugates stems from the theorem that
says the complex conjugates of all roots of real polynomials are also roots themselves.
𝑧0 , 𝑧1 , 𝑧2 , … , 𝑧𝑛 ,
Let 𝑎 = 𝑧0 , 𝑏 = 𝑧𝑛
𝑆𝑛 = 𝑓 𝜉𝑘 (𝑧𝑟 − 𝑧𝑟 − 1)
𝑟=1
𝑏
𝑓 𝑧 𝑑𝑥 𝑜𝑟 ∫𝑐 𝑓 𝑧 𝑑𝑧
𝑧
Which is called the complex line integral or line integral of 𝑓(𝑧) along 𝐶. An evaluation
of integral by such method is also called ab-initio method.
𝐹 𝑧 = ∅ 𝑥, 𝑦 + 𝑖Ψ(𝑥, 𝑦)
To be an analytic function of the complex variable 𝑧 = (𝑥 + 𝑖𝑦). Thus the real and
imaginary parts of any analytic function may be regarded as the potential function and
stream function of a flow of an inviscid fluid in two dimensions. The complex function 𝐹,
whose real and imaginary parts are the velocity potential and stream function
respectively, is termed the complex potential of the liquid motion. It ceases to exist at
exist at point occupied by sources, sinks to vortices. Differentiating (1) partially with
regard to 𝑥, we have
dF ∂z ∂∅ ∂Ψ
∙ = +i
dz ∂x ∂x ∂x
dF ∂F
=
dz ∂z
as F is a function of z only .
or
dF ∂∅ ∂∅ ∂Ψ ∂∅
= −i = −𝑢 + 𝑖𝑣; =
dz ∂x ∂y ∂x ∂y
COMPLEX VARIABLE: If a simple z takes any one of the values of a set of complex
numbers, then z is called a complex variable.
𝑇2 𝑇1 𝑢 = 𝑇2 𝑇1 𝑢 ∀𝑢 𝜖 𝑈
Computational fluid dynamics has been around since the early 20th century and many
people are familiar with it as a tool for analyzing air flow around cars and aircraft. As
the cooling infrastructure of server rooms has increased in complexity, CFD has also
become a useful tool in the data center for analyzing thermal properties and modeling
air flow. CFD software requires information about the size, content and layout of the
data center. It uses this information to create a 3D mathematical model on a grid that
can be rotated and viewed from different angles. CFD modeling can help an
administrator identify hot spotsand learn where cold air is being wasted or air is
mixing.
Simply by changing variables, the administrator can visualize how cold air will flow
through the data center under a number of different circumstances. This knowledge can
help the administrator optimize the efficiency of an existing cooling infrastructure and
predict the effectiveness of a particular layout of IT equipment. For example, if an
administrator wanted to take one rack of hard drive storage and split the hard drives
over two racks, a CFD program could simulate the change and help the administrator
understand what adjustments would be need to be made to deal with the additional
heat load before any time or money has been spent.
CONCAVE: A geometric figure where it is possible to form a line between two points in
the figure where the line consists of points not from the figure. For a plane figure, it
is equivalent to a shape having an interior angle of greater than 180 degrees.
CONCAVE FUNCTION: A function whose graph is such that, for any two points of the
graph, the function for arguments between the two points are higher than the straight
line joining the two points. For a differentiable function, it is equivalent to a function
with a monotonically decreasingly gradient. Note that a function can be described
as concave for a certain interval only.
CONCYCLIC POINTS: A number of points are said to be concyclic points if there is a circle
that passes though all of them.
CONDITIONAL DISTRIBUTION: The distribution of a random variable given that another
random variable is known to be of a certain value.
CONFIDENCE LIMITS: Two values between which the true value of a population
parameter is thought to lie with some given probability. This probability represents the
proportion of occasions when such limits calculated from repeated samples actually
include the true value of the parameter. An essential feature of the interval is that the
distance between the limits depends on the size of the sample, being smaller for a larger
sample. CONFOCAL CONICS: Two central conics are said to be confocal conics if they
have the same foci. An ellipse and a hyperbola that are confocal intersect at right angles.
CONFOCAL QUADRICS: A family of central quadrics represented by the following
equations is called a family of confocal quadrics.
𝑥2 𝑦2 𝑧2
+ 𝑏+𝑘 + 𝑐+𝑘 = 1, 𝑎 > 𝑏 > 𝑐 > 0,
𝑎+𝑘
Where 𝑘 is a parameter. For a quadric belonging to this family, any point on the ellipse
𝑥2 𝑎 − 𝑐 + 𝑦2 𝑏 − 𝑐 = 1, 𝑧 = 0 or the hyperbola
𝑥2 𝑎 − 𝑏 − 𝑧2 𝑏 − 𝑐 = 1, 𝑦 = 0 is called a focus. The ellipse and hyperbola are
called focal conics of the quadric.
CONFORMABLE MATRICES: Two matrices A and B are said to be conformable matrices
(for multiplication) if the number of columns of A equals the number of rows of B. Then
A has order 𝑚 × 𝑛 and B has order 𝑛 × 𝑝, for some 𝑚, 𝑛 and 𝑝, and the product AB, of
order 𝑚 × 𝑝, is defined.
If the angle between 𝑐1 and 𝑐2 at 𝑧0 is equal to the angle between 𝑐1 and 𝑐2 at 𝑤0 then the
transformation is called isogonal. If the sense of rotation as well as the magnitude of the
angle is preserved the transformation is called conformal.
CONGRUENCE (modulo n): For each positive integer 𝑛, the relation of congruence
between integers is defined as follows: 𝑎 is congruent to 𝑏 modulo 𝑛 if 𝑎 – 𝑏 is a
multiple of 𝑛. This is written as 𝑎 ≡ 𝑏 (𝑚𝑜𝑑 𝑛). The integer 𝑛 is the modulus of the
congruence. Then 𝑎 ≡ 𝑏 (𝑚𝑜𝑑 𝑛) if and only if 𝑎 and 𝑏 have the same remainder upon
division by 𝑛. For example, 33 is congruent to 8 modulo 5.
The following properties hold, if 𝑎 ≡ 𝑏 (𝑚𝑜𝑑 𝑛) and 𝑐 ≡ 𝑑 (𝑚𝑜𝑑 𝑛):
𝑎 + 𝑐 ≡ 𝑏 + 𝑑 (𝑚𝑜𝑑 𝑛),
𝑎 – 𝑐 ≡ 𝑏 – 𝑑 (𝑚𝑜𝑑 𝑛),
𝑎𝑐 ≡ 𝑏𝑑 (𝑚𝑜𝑑 𝑛).
It can be shown that congruence modulo n is an equivalence relation and so defines a
partition of the set of integers, where two integers are in the same class if and only if
they are congruent modulo n. These classes are the residue (or congruence) classes
modulo n.
CONGRUENCE EQUATION: congruence equations are the equations involving
congruence modulo n. The following are examples of congruence equations:
(i) 𝑥 + 5 ≡ 3 (𝑚𝑜𝑑 7); this has the solution 𝑥 ≡ 5 (𝑚𝑜𝑑 7).
(ii) 2𝑥 ≡ 5 (𝑚𝑜𝑑 4); this has no solutions.
In seeking solutions to a congruence equation, it is necessary only to consider a
complete set of residues and find solutions in this set.
The linear congruence equation 𝑎𝑥 ≡ 𝑏 (𝑚𝑜𝑑 𝑛) has a solution if and only if (𝑎, 𝑛)
divides 𝑏, where (𝑎, 𝑛) is the greatest common divisor of 𝑎 and 𝑛.
CONGRUENCE OF MATRICES: A square matrix B of order 𝑛 over a field 𝐹 is said to be
congruent to another square matrix 𝐴 of order 𝑛 over 𝐹, if there exists a non-singular
matrix 𝑃 over 𝐹 such that 𝐵 = 𝑃 −1 𝐴𝑃.
For triangles, there are certain conditions that make it easier to decide if two such
figures are the same. (Without having to consider the transformations)
I - SSS - The length of all three sides of a triangle are the same as the lengths of the
corresponding sides of another.
II - SAS - The lengths of any two pairs of sides correspond, and the angles between those
sides are also the same as each other.
III - ASA/AAS - Any pair of angles on one shape correspond with the other shape, while
any side of either shape is the same as the corresponding side of the other.
IV - RHS (also known as LH) - Both triangles are right-angled, their hypotenuses are of
the same length and they share another side of the same length.
CONICOID: A surface generated by the rotation about an axis of one of the conics -
ellipsoids, paraboloids, hypocycloids and a sphere.
CONJECTURE: An assertion that is not yet proven. In this sense, it is the same as
an hypothesis.
CONJUGATE OF A MATRIX: The matrix obtained from any given matrix A on replacing its
elements by the corresponding conjugate complex numbers is called the conjugate of A
and is denoted by A.
If A be a matrix over the field of real numbers, then obviously A coincides with A.
2 + 3i 4 − 7i 8 2 − 3i 4 + 7i 8
A= , then A = .
−i 6 9+i i 6 9−i
(i) A = A; (ii) A + B = A + B;
(i) kA = k A; 𝑘 being any complex number;
(ii) AB = A B, A and B being conformable to multiplication.
CONNECTED GRAPH: A connected graph is a graph in which there always exists a path
from any one vertex to any other vertex. So a graph is connected if it is ‘all in one piece’;
that is, if it has precisely one component.
CONNECTED METRIC SPACE: A metric space (𝑋, 𝑑) is said to be connected if there do
not exist two nonempty and disjoint open sets 𝐴 and 𝐵 in 𝑋 such that 𝐴 ∪ 𝐵 = 𝑋. A
metric space (𝑋, 𝑑) is connected if, and only if, the only subsets of 𝑋 that are both open
and closed in 𝑋 are ∅ and 𝑋. Let 𝑋 and 𝑌 be metric spaces, and let 𝑓 ∶ 𝑋 → 𝑌 be a
continuous function. If 𝑋 is connected, then 𝑓(𝑋) is a connected subset of 𝑌.
CONNECTED SET: A set that can't be split into a union of two sets each of which is
both open and closed.
CONNECTED SUM: Let S and T be two surfaces. From each surface, delete an open disk,
then glue the two boundary circles. The resulting surface is called the connected sum of
the two surfaces, denoted by S#T. It is known that the connected sum does not depend
on the choices of the disks.
CONSECUTIVE ANGLES: A set of angles where every member can be considered to be
"next" to another angle within the set. This idea of "next" or adjacency can be sharing
a side or sharing a side as well as a point depending on the context.
CONSECUTIVE SIDES: A set of sides (edges) where every memeber can be considered to
be "next" to another side within the set. This idea of "next" or adjacency can be sharing
a vertex or sharing an angle depending on the context.
CONSERVATION LAWS: Any theorem or assertion that states that certain measurable
quantities remains unchanged, and the condition under which this happens.
CONSERVATION OF ENERGY: The law that states that the amount of energy in a closed
system remains unchanged. The exactness of this law, in our current understanding,
depends on whether we use mass-energy as the measure or simply energy in the
classical sense.
CONSERVATION OF MOMENTUM: The law that states that the total momentum of a
closed system of objects remains unchanged.
CONSISTENCY: An axiomatic theory is consistent if it's impossible (in the confines of the
theory) to prove simultaneously a statement and its negation. The Godel's Theorem
states that any (sufficiently powerful) consistent axiomatic theory is incomplete.
CONSISTENT SET OF EQUATIONS: A set of equations is consistent if there is a
solution.
CONSTANT FUNCTION: In real analysis, a constant function is a real function 𝑓 such that
𝑓(𝑥) = 𝑎 for all 𝑥 ∇ 𝑹, where 𝑎, the value of 𝑓, is a fixed real number.
CONSTANT OF INTEGRATION: If 𝜑 is a particular antiderivative of a continuous function
𝑓, then any antiderivative of 𝑓 differs from 𝜑 by a constant. It is common practice,
therefore, to write
∫ 𝑓(𝑥)𝑑𝑥 = 𝜑(𝑥) + 𝑐,
where 𝑐, an arbitrary constant, is the constant of integration.
CONSTANT VALUE THEOREM: If 𝑓 ′ (𝑡) = 0 for all 𝑡 ∇ (𝑎, 𝑏) then 𝑓 is constant on
[𝑎, 𝑏]. (That is, 𝑓(𝑦) = 𝑓(𝑥) whenever 𝑏 ≥ 𝑦 > 𝑥 ≥ 𝑎.)
Thus there are six hypergeometric functions continuous to 𝐹 a; b; c; z and are denoted
as
𝐹 a + 1; b; c; z = Fa+, 𝐹 a − 1; b; c; z = Fa−
𝐹 a; b + 1; c; z = Fb+, 𝐹 a; b − 1; c; z = Fb−
𝐹 a; b; c + 1; z = Fc+, 𝐹 a; b; c − 1; z = Fc−
contravariant (or covariant) vector is also called a contravariant (or Covariant) tensor
of rank one.
CONVENIENCE SAMPLE: Quick, easy, and readily available people or objects selected to
conduct a survey. It is convenient for the person compiling the statistics. If you conduct
a survey on people´s opinions about a specific movie by interviewing people who just
walked out of that movie, you are taking a convenience sample.
CONVENIENCE SAMPLING: In convenience sampling, a sample is chosen by using the
most conveniently available group. Data collected from such a sample are unlikely to
contain much worthwhile information about a larger population.
CONVERGE (NET): A net 𝑓𝑛 is said to said to converge to a point 𝑥 of the directed set 𝐷,
CONVERGE (SEQUENCE): A real sequence 𝑥𝑛 is said to be convergent to a real number 𝑎
if for every ∇> 0 there exists a 𝑚∇ ∇ 𝑁 such that 𝑥𝑛 − 𝑎 <∇ whenever 𝑛 ≥ 𝑚∇ .
CONVERGE (SEQUENCE IN A TOPOLOGICAL SPACE): A sequence 𝑥𝑛 in a topological
space is said to be convergent to a number 𝑎 if for every for every nbd 𝑁𝑎 of 𝑎 there
exists a 𝑚𝑎 ∇ 𝑁 such that 𝑥𝑛 ∇ 𝑁𝑎 whenever 𝑛 ≥ 𝑚𝑎 .
CONVERGE (SERIES): The infinite series 𝑎1 + 𝑎2 + 𝑎3 + … is said to converge to a
limit 𝐿 if for every 𝜀 > 0 there exists an 𝑁 such that
𝑛
𝑖=1 𝑎𝑛 − 𝐿 <∇ for all 𝑛 > 𝑁.
CONVERGENCE AND DIVERGENCE OF INFINITE SERIES: Let 𝑎𝑛 𝑛 = 1,2,3, … be a
sequence of real or complex numbers. Then the formal infinite sum 𝑎1 + 𝑎2 + ⋯ is
∞
called an infinite series (or series) and is denoted by 𝑛=1 𝑎𝑛 𝑜𝑟 𝑎𝑛 . The number 𝑎𝑛 is
the 𝑛𝑡 term of the series 𝑎𝑛 , 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑠𝑛 = 𝑎1 + 𝑎2 + ⋯ + 𝑎𝑛 is the 𝑛𝑡 partial sum of
𝑎𝑛 . Also for a finite sequence 𝑎1 , 𝑎2 , … , 𝑎𝑛 , the sum 𝑎1 + 𝑎2 + ⋯ + 𝑎𝑛 is called a series.
To distinguish these two series, the latter is called a finite series. Series means an
infinite series. If the sequence of partial sums 𝑠𝑛 converges to s, we say that the series
∞
𝑎𝑛 converges or is convergent to the sum 𝑠 and write 𝑛=1 𝑎𝑛 = 𝑠 𝑜𝑟 𝑎𝑛 = 𝑠. If the
sequence 𝑠𝑛 is not convergent, we say that the series diverges or divergent. In
particular, if 𝑠𝑛 is divergent to +∞(−∞) or oscillating, we say that the series is
properly divergent to +∞(−∞) or oscillating, respectively.
CONVERGENT ITERATION: An iterative process for which the sequence of each state (in
order) is a convergent sequence
CONVEX HULL: The convex hull C(x) of any given set of points X is the set of all convex
combination of sets of points from X. For examples, if x is just the eight vertices of a
cube, then the convex hull C(x) is the whole cube.
CONVEX POLYHEDRON: The set of all convex combinations of finite number of points is
called the convex polyhedron generated by these points.
For example: The set of the area of the triangle is a convex polyhedron its vertices.
𝐹 𝐹∗𝑔 = 𝐹 𝑓 𝑡 𝐹 𝑔 𝑡
COORDINATE: One within a set of such numbers, called coordinates, which specifies the
position of a point e.g. abscissa and ordinate.
… … … … … … … …
… … … … … … … …
Suppose A11 , A12 , A13 ,………. etc. denote the cofactors if a11 , a12 , a13, ………. etc, in ∆. Then
multiplying the given equation respectively byA11 , A12 , A13 ,……… An1 and adding, we get
Or 𝑥1 ∆= ∆1 ,
Where ∆1 is the determinant obtained by replacing the elements in the first column of ∆
by the elements b1 , b2 , … , bn .
Again multiplying the given equation respectively by A12 , A22 , … , An2 and adding, we get
𝑥2 ∆= ∆2 ,
Where ∆2 is the determinant obtained by replacing the elements in the second column
of ∆ by the elements b1 , b2 , … , bn .
Similarly, we get
𝑥3 ∆= ∆3
…………
𝑥𝑛 ∆= ∆𝑛 .
∆i
xi = , i = 1,2, … , n,
∆
Where ∆𝑖 is the determinant obtained by replacing the ith column of ∆ by the elements
b1 , b2 , … , bn .
CRITICAL POINT: A critical point for a function is a point where the first derivative(s) is
(are) zero.
CRITICAL POINTS (COMPLEX ANALYSIS): Consider the bilinear transformation
𝑎𝑧 + 𝑏
𝑤=𝑇 𝑧 =
𝑐𝑧 + 𝑑
𝑏 − 𝑤𝑑
𝑧 = 𝑇 −1 𝑤 =
𝑤𝑐 − 𝑎
𝑑𝑤 𝑎𝑑 −𝑏𝑐
From (1) = (𝑐𝑧 +𝑑)²
𝑑𝑧
𝑑
𝑑𝑤 ∞ 𝑖𝑓 𝑧 = − 𝑐
This ⟹ =
𝑑𝑧
0 𝑖𝑓 𝑧 = ∞
𝑑
The points 𝑧 = − 𝑐 , 𝑧 = ∞ are called Critical points where the conformal property does
CRITICAL REGION: If the calculated value of a test statistic falls within the critical region,
then the null hypothesis is rejected.
CROSS RATIO: For a set of coplanar points 𝐴, 𝐵, 𝐶, 𝐷, it is,
𝐴𝐶 × 𝐵𝐷
𝐴𝐷 × 𝐵𝐶
and for points 𝑧1 , 𝑧2 , 𝑧3 , 𝑧4 in the complex plane it is
𝑧1 − 𝑧3 𝑧2 − 𝑧4
𝑧1 − 𝑧4 𝑧2 − 𝑧3
The definition in the complex plane can be extended to the Riemann sphere by
continuity.
CRYPTOGRAPHY: Cryptography is the area of mathematics concerning the secure
coding and decoding of information, often relying on mathematics such as prime
factorizations of very large numbers.
csc: It is the abbreviation for cosecant function. (Also written as cosec).
csch: It is the abbreviation for hyperbolic cosecant function. (Also written as cosech).
CUBE ROOT OF UNITY: A complex number z such that 𝑧 3 = 1. The three cube roots of
−1+𝑖 3 −1−𝑖 3
unity are 1, 𝜔 and 𝜔2 , where 𝜔 = and 𝜔2 = .
2 2
CUBIC EQUATION: A polynomial having a degree of 3 (i.e. the highest power is 3), of the
form 𝑎𝑥 3 + 𝑏𝑥 2 + 𝑐𝑥 + 𝑑 = 0, which can be solved by factorization or formula to
find its three roots.
CUMULATIVE DISTRIBUTION FUNCTION: For a random variable 𝑋, the cumulative
distribution function (c.d.f.) is the function 𝐹 defined by 𝐹(𝑥) = 𝑃(𝑋 ≤ 𝑥). Thus, for a
discrete random variable
𝐹 𝑥 − 𝑝(𝑥𝑖 )
𝑥 𝑖 ≤𝑋
where p is the probability mass function, and, for a continuous random variable,
𝑥
𝐹 𝑥 = 𝑓 𝑡 𝑑𝑡
−∞
𝜕𝑽 𝜕𝑽 𝜕𝑽
𝑐𝑢𝑟𝑙 𝑽 = ∆ × 𝑽 = 𝒊 × +𝒋× +𝒌×
𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑦 𝜕𝑧
which can be written in determinant form as
𝑖 𝑗 𝑘
𝜕 𝜕 𝜕
𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑦 𝜕𝑧
𝑉𝑥 𝑉𝑦 𝑉𝑧
CURVATURE: The rate of change of direction of a curve at a point 𝑃 on the curve. The
Greek letter 𝜅 is used to denote curvature and
𝑦 ′′
𝜅= .
1 + 𝑦′ 2 3/2
1
𝜌 = 𝜅 is the radius of curvature which is the radius of the circle which best fits the curve
at that point, matching the position, the gradient and the second differential of the curve
at that point. The centre of curvature is the centre of that best-fitting circle, known as
the circle of curvature.
CURVE: A curve is a continuous mapping of the segment [0, 1] into another space -
container of the curve. A curve may not look as a line. For example, there are space
filling curves.
CUSP: A point at which two or more branches of a curve meet, and at which the limits of
the tangents approaching that point along each branch coincide. There are two main
characteristics used to describe cusps. In a single or simple cusp there are only two
branches, and the limits of the second differentials approaching that point are different.
If the branches are on opposite sides of the common tangent, it is said to be a cusp of the
first kind, and if the branches are on the same side of the common tangent it is a cusp of
the second kind.
A double cusp or point of osculation has four branches, comprising two continuously
differentiable curves meeting at a point with a common tangent. Double cusps can also
be of the first or second kind, or one or both curves can have a point of inflexion at the
cusp, so the tangent intersects the curve, in which case it is a point of osculinflection.
C(X) SPACES: All our topological spaces are assumed Hausdorff. Let X be a compact
space, and let 𝐶𝐾 (𝑋) be the space of continuous functions from 𝑋 to 𝐾, with pointwise
operations, so that 𝐶𝐾 (𝑋) is a vector space. We norm 𝐶𝐾 (𝑋)by setting 𝑓 ∞ =
𝑠𝑢𝑝
𝑓(𝑥) ; 𝑓 ∇ 𝐶𝐾 (𝑋).
𝑥∇𝑋
Note that
Let 𝑋 be a compact space. Then 𝐶𝐾 (𝑋) is a Banach space.
Let 𝐸 be a vector space, and let || · || (1) and || · || (2) be norms on 𝐸. These norms
are equivalent if there exists 𝑚 > 0 with 𝑚−1 𝑥 (2) ≤ 𝑥 (1) ≤𝑚 𝑥 (2) . (𝑥 ∇
𝐸)
Let E be a finite-dimensional vector space with basis {𝑒1 , … , 𝑒𝑛 }, so we can
identify 𝐸 with 𝐾 𝑛 as vector spaces, and hence talk about the norm || · || (2) on E.
If || · || is any norm on 𝐸, then || · || and || · || (2) are equivalent.
Let E be a finite-dimensional normed space. Then a subset 𝑋 ⊆ 𝐸 is compact if
and only if it is closed and bounded.
Let 𝐸 be a normed vector space, and let 𝐹 be a closed subspace of 𝐸 with 𝐸 ≠ 𝐹.
For 0 < 𝜃 < 1, we can find 𝑥0 ∇ 𝐸 with ||𝑥0 || ≤ 1 and ||𝑥0 − 𝑦|| > 𝜃 for 𝑦 ∇ 𝐹.
Let 𝐸 be an infinite-dimensional normed vector space. Then the closed unit ball
of 𝐸, the set {𝑥 ∇ 𝐸 ∶ ||𝑥|| ≤ 1}, is not compact.
CYCLE (GRAPH THEORY): A closed path with at least one edge. In a graph, a cycle is a
sequence 𝑣0 , 𝑒1 , 𝑣1 , … , 𝑒𝑘 , 𝑣𝑘 (𝑘 ≥ 1) of alternately vertices and edges (where 𝑒𝑖 is an
edge joining 𝑣𝑖—1 and 𝑣𝑖 ), with all the edges different and all the vertices different,
except that 𝑣0 = 𝑣𝑘 .
CYCLIC GROUP: Let 𝑎 be an element of a multiplicative group 𝐺. The elements 𝑎𝑟 , where
𝑟 is an integer (positive, zero or negative), form a subgroup of 𝐺, called the subgroup
generated by 𝑎. A group 𝐺 is cyclic if there is an element a in 𝐺 such that the subgroup
generated by 𝑎 is the whole of 𝐺. If 𝐺 is a finite cyclic group with identity element 𝑒, the
set of elements of 𝐺 may be written as {𝑒, 𝑎, 𝑎2 , … , 𝑎𝑛−1 }, where 𝑎𝑛 = 𝑒 and 𝑛 is the
smallest such positive integer. If 𝐺 is an infinite cyclic group, the set of elements may be
written { … , 𝑎−2 , 𝑎−1 , 𝑒, 𝑎, 𝑎2 , … }.
CYCLIC POLYGON: A polygon whose vertices all lie on the same circle. All triangles, all
rectangles, and all regular polygons are cyclic. Convex quadrilaterals, whose opposite
angles are supplementary, are also cyclic.
CYCLIC QUADRILATERAL: A four-sided figure whose four vertices all lie on a
circumscribed circle. If the opposite angles of a quadrilateral add to 180°, it is a cyclic
quadrilateral.
CYCLOID: The curve traced out by a point on the circumference of a circle that rolls
without slipping along a straight line. With suitable axes, the cycloid has parametric
equations 𝑥 = 𝑎(𝑡 — 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝑡), 𝑦 = 𝑎(1 — 𝑐𝑜𝑠 𝑡)(𝑡 ∇ 𝑹), where 𝑎 is a constant (equal
to the radius of the rolling circle). In the figure, 𝑂𝐴 = 2𝜋𝑎.
CYCLOTOMIC NUMBER FIELDS: The starting point for cyclotomic number fields is the
irreducibility of the cyclotomic polynomial 𝑓(𝑡) = 𝑡 𝑛 −1 + 𝑡 𝑛 −2 + … + 𝑡 + 1 in 𝑄[𝑡]
for any positive rational prime 𝑝. To see this, note that 𝑓(𝑡 + 1) = 𝑡 𝑝 −1 +
𝑝(𝑡 𝑝−2 + . . . ) + 𝑝, and the irreducibility now follows immediately from Eisenstein’s
criterion. For any positive rational prime 𝑝, the 𝑝-th cyclotomic number field is the
algebraic number field 𝑄(𝜁), where 𝜁 = 𝑒 2𝜋𝑖 /𝑝 is a primitive 𝑝-th root of unity.
CYCLOTOMIC POLYNOMIAL Φn(z): The polynomial whose roots are all the primitive n-
th roots of unity. We know
𝑧 𝑛 — 1 ≡ (𝑧 — 1)(𝑧 𝑛−1 + 𝑧 𝑛−2 + … + 𝑧 + 1),
so when n is prime 𝛷𝑛 (𝑧) = 𝑧 𝑛 −1 + 𝑧 𝑛 −2 + … + 𝑧 + 1 is the cyclotomic polynomial,
but when 𝑛 = 4, 𝑧 4 — 1 = (𝑧 — 1)(𝑧 + 1)(𝑧 2 + 1), and so 𝛷4 (𝑧) = (𝑧 2 + 1).
CYLINDRICAL HELICES: A cylindrical helix is a curve traced out on the surface of the
cylinder and cuts the generators at a constant angle.
Thus the tangent at any point on the helix makes a constant angle say 𝛼, with a fixed
line, this fixed line is known as axis (generator) of the cylinder, the axis of the cylinder is
also called the axis of the helix.
CYLINDRICAL POLAR COORDINATES: Suppose that three mutually perpendicular
directed lines 𝑂𝑥, 𝑂𝑦 and 𝑂𝑧, intersecting at the point 𝑂 and forming a right-handed
system, are taken as coordinate axes. For any point 𝑃, let 𝑀 and 𝑁 be the projections of
𝑃 onto the 𝑥𝑦 −plane and the 𝑧 −axis respectively. Then 𝑂𝑁 = 𝑃𝑀 = 𝑧, the
𝑧 −coordinate of 𝑃. Let 𝜌 = |𝑃𝑁|, the distance of 𝑃 from the 𝑧 −axis, and let ø be the
angle ∠𝑥𝑂𝑀 in radians (0 ≤ ø < 2 𝜋). Then
(𝜌, ø, 𝑧) are the cylindrical polar coordinates of 𝑃.
(It should be noted that the points of the 𝑧 −axis
give no value for ø.) The two coordinates (𝜌, ø) can be seen as polar coordinates of the
point 𝑀 and, as with polar coordinates, ø + 2 𝑘𝜋, where 𝑘 is an integer, may be allowed
in place of ø.
D
D’ ALEMBERT’S PARADOX: If we super- impose on the system a uniform velocity 𝑈 in
the direction opposite to that of the current the inviscid fluid at a great distance remain
undisturbed and the body moves with uniform velocity 𝑈. The dynamical conditions
remain unaltered by superposing a uniform velocity therefore, the resistance to a body
moving with uniform velocity through an unbounded inviscid fluid, otherwise at rest,
vanishes. This is in contradiction to the common experience and is called 𝐷’ Alembert’s
Paradox.
1. 𝑢𝑛 converges if 𝑙 < 1.
2. 𝑢𝑛 diverges if 𝑙 > 1.
3. The test fails if 𝑙 = 1.
DARBOUX FUNCTION: For topological spaces 𝑋 and 𝑌, a function 𝑓 ∶ 𝑋 → 𝑌 is a
Darboux function (or has the Darboux property), 𝑓 ∇ 𝐷(𝑋, 𝑌 ), provided the image
𝑓 [𝐶] of 𝐶 under 𝑓 is a connected subset of 𝑌 for every connected subset 𝐶 of 𝑋. In
particular, 𝑓 ∶ 𝑅 → 𝑅 is Darboux provided 𝑓 maps intervals onto intervals, that is,
when it has the intermediate value property.
DARBOUX THEOREM: Let 𝑓 be a bounded function defined on [𝑎, 𝑏]. Then to every ∇> 0,
there corresponds 𝛿 > 0 such that
𝑏
𝑈 𝑃, 𝑓 < 𝑓𝑑𝑥+∇
𝑎
and
𝑏
𝐿 𝑃, 𝑓 > 𝑓𝑑𝑥−∇
𝑎
DATA ANALYTICS: Data analytics (DA) is the science of examining raw data with the
purpose of drawing conclusions about that information. Data analytics is used in many
industries to allow companies and organization to make better business decisions and
in the sciences to verify or disprove existing models or theories. Data analytics is
distinguished from data mining by the scope, purpose and focus of the analysis. Data
miners sort through huge data sets using sophisticated software to identify
undiscovered patterns and establish hidden relationships. Data analytics focuses on
inference, the process of deriving a conclusion based solely on what is already known by
the researcher.
𝐻 = 𝐺 ⊕ 𝐺⊥
= 𝑖𝑛𝑓𝑖𝑚𝑢𝑚 𝑜𝑓 − 𝑔′ ,
𝑓 𝑥 𝑑𝑥
𝑎
(i) Basic feasible solutions may be degenerate from the initial stage onward.
(ii) They may become degenerate at any intermediate stage.
A special technique called as the Assignment technique is used to solve the special type
of problems called Assignment problem. This type of problems may be defined as the
traditional or classical problems where the main motive is to allot a number of origins
to the equal number of destinations at a least cost are called assignment problems.
The assignment problems can be stated in the form of 𝑛 × 𝑛 matrix 𝑐𝑖𝑗 of real
numbers called cost matrix or effectiveness matrix.
DEGENERACY PROBLEM (TIE FOR MINIMUM RATIO): At the stage of improving the
solution during simplex procedure, minimum ratio 𝑥8 /𝑥𝑘 (𝑥𝑘 > 0) is determined in the
last column of simplex table to find the key row (i.e. a row containing the key element).
But, sometimes this ratio may not be unique, i.e, the key element (hence the variable to
leave the basis) is not uniquely determined or at the very first iteration, the value of one
or more basic variables in the XB column become equal to zero, this causes the problem
of degeneracy.
However, if the minimum ratio is zero for two or more basic variables, degeneracy may
result the simplex routine to cycle indefinitely. That is, the solution which we have
obtained in one iteration may repeat again after few iterations and therefore no
optimum solution may be obtained under such circumstances.
DEGENERATE CONIC SECTION: A point, line, or pair of lines that arise as a limiting form
of a conic.
DEGREE OF AN ALGEBRAIC NUMBER: The degree of an algebraic number field 𝐾 is the
dimension [𝐾: 𝑄] of K considered as a vector space over the field 𝑄 of rational numbers.
DEGREE OF A VERTEX OF A GRAPH: The degree of a vertex 𝑉 of a graph is the number of
edges ending at 𝑉. If loops are allowed, each loop joining 𝑉 to itself contributes two to
the degree of 𝑉.
DEGREES OF FREEDOM (MECHANICS): The number of degrees of freedom of a body is
the minimum number of independent coordinates required to describe the position of
the body at any instant, relative to a frame of reference. A particle in straight-line
motion or circular motion has one degree of freedom. A rigid body rotating about a fixed
axis also has one degree of freedom. A particle moving in a plane, such as a projectile, or
a particle moving on a cylindrical or spherical surface has two degrees of freedom. A
rigid body in general motion has six degrees of freedom.
DEGREES OF FREEDOM (STATISTICS): A positive integer normally equal to the number
of independent observations in a sample minus the number of population parameters to
be estimated from the sample. When the chi-squared test is applied to a contingency
table with rows and 𝑘 columns, the number of degrees of freedom equals
( – 1)(𝑘 – 1).
DEL: The del symbol ∆ is used to represent this vector of differential operators:
𝜕 𝜕 𝜕
∆= , ,
𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑦 𝜕𝑧
DELETED NEIGHBOURHOOD OF A POINT: If from a nbd of a point 𝑝, the point 𝑝 itself is
deleted, then we get a deleted nbd of the point 𝑝.
DELTA FUNCTION 𝛅 𝐱 − 𝐚 : It is defined as
∞ if x = a
δ(x − a) =
0 if x ≠ a
∞
together with the condition ∫−∞ δ x − a dx = 1.
DENSITY PROPERTY: The property that states that there always exists another rational
number between any two given rational numbers. This means that the set of rational
numbers is dense.
DENSITY PROPERTY FOR REAL NUMBERS: The property that states that there always
exists another real number between any two given real numbers. This means that the
set of real numbers is dense.
DENUMERABLE SET: A set 𝑋 is said to be a denumerable set if there is a one-to-one
correspondence between X and the set of natural numbers. It can be shown that the set
of rational numbers is denumerable but that the set of real numbers is not.
DEPENDENT EQUATIONS: A set of equations where at least one of the set may be
expressed as a linear combination of the others.
DEPENDENT EVENT: An event that is affected by the occurrence of other events
DEPENDENT VARIABLE: The dependent variable stands for the output number of a
function. In the equation 𝑦 = 𝑓 (𝑥), 𝑦 is the dependent variable and 𝑥 is the
independent variable. The value of 𝑦 depends on the value of 𝑥. In statistics, the variable
which is thought might be influenced by certain other explanatory variables. In
regression, a relationship is sought between the dependent variable and the
explanatory variables. The purpose is normally to enable the value of the dependent
DERIVATIVE: The derivative of a function is the rate of change of that function. On the
graph of the curve 𝑦 = 𝑓 (𝑥), the derivative at 𝑥 is equal to the slope of the tangent line
at the point (𝑥, 𝑓 (𝑥)). If the function represents the position of an object as a function of
time, then the derivative represents the velocity of the object. Derivatives can be
calculated from this expression:
Function Derivative
𝑦 = 𝑓(𝑥) 𝑓 𝑥 + − 𝑓(𝑥)
𝑦 ′ = 𝑓 ′ 𝑥 = lim
→0
DERIVED SET: The set of all limit points of 𝐴 is called derived set of 𝐴.
DERIVED UNIT: It is a unit that is defined or obtained in terms of the fundamental units.
For example, a unit of force, one Newton (N), is defined as the amount of force that will
accelerate a mass of one kilogram at the rate of one meter per second per second.
Therefore, its formal definition is kg·m·s-2.
DEROGATORY AND NON-DEROGATORY MATRIX: An 𝑛-rowed matrix is said to be
derogatory or non-derogatory, according as the degree of its minimal equation is less
than or equal to 𝑛.
If the roots of the characteristic equation of a matrix are all distinct, then the matrix is
non-derogatory.
DESCARTES, RENE: Rene Descartes (1596 to 1650) was a French mathematician and
philosopher who is noted for the sentence “I think, therefore I am” and for developing
the concept now known as rectangular, or Cartesian coordinates. He was the
mathematician who in mathematics is known mainly for his methods of applying
algebra to geometry, from which analytic geometry developed. He expounded these in
La Géométrie, in which he was also concerned to use geometry to solve algebraic
problems.
DESCARTES’ RULE OF SIGNS: Descartes’ rule of signs states that the number of positive
roots of a polynomial equation will equal the number of sign changes among the
coefficients, or that number minus a multiple of 2. To count the sign changes, be sure the
polynomial terms are arranged in descending order by power of x, and ignore any zero
coefficients.
DESCENDING CHAIN CONDITION: A collection 𝑆 of subsets of a set 𝑋 satisfies the
ascending chain condition or DCC if there does not exist an infinite descending chain
𝑆1 ⊇ 𝑆2 ⊇ · · · of subsets from 𝑆.
DESCRIPTIVE GEOMETRY: A method of representing three-dimensional objects by
projections on the two-dimensional plane using a specific set of procedures.
DESCRIPTIVE STATISTICS: This is the part of the subject of statistics concerned with
describing the basic statistical features of a set of observations. Simple numerical
summaries, using notions such as mean, range and standard deviation, together with
appropriate diagrams such as histograms, are used to present an overall impression of
the data. Descriptive statistics is the study of ways to summarize data. For example, the
mean, median, and standard deviation are descriptive statistics that summarize some of
the properties of a list of numbers.
det: It is the abbreviation for determinant of a matrix or linear transformation.
DETERMINANT: The determinant of a matrix is a number that is useful in describing the
characteristics of the matrix. The determinant is symbolized by enclosing the matrix in
vertical lines. The determinant of a 2 × 2 matrix is:
𝑎 𝑏
= 𝑎𝑑 − 𝑏𝑐
𝑐 𝑑
The determinant of a 3 × 3 matrix can be found from:
𝑎 𝑏 𝑐
𝑓 𝑑 𝑑 𝑒
𝑑 𝑒 𝑓 =𝑎 𝑒 𝑓
+𝑏 +𝑐
𝑖 𝑖 𝑔 𝑔
𝑔 𝑖
= 𝑎 𝑒𝑖 − 𝑓 + 𝑏 𝑓𝑔 − 𝑑𝑖 + 𝑐(𝑑 − 𝑔𝑒)
The following properties hold:
(i) If two rows or two columns of a square matrix 𝑨 are identical, then 𝑑𝑒𝑡 𝑨 = 0.
(ii) If two rows or two columns of a square matrix 𝑨 are interchanged, then only the
sign of 𝑑𝑒𝑡 𝑨 is changed.
(iii) The value of 𝑑𝑒𝑡 𝑨 is unchanged if a multiple of one row is added to another row, or
if a multiple of one column is added to another column.
(iv) If 𝑨 and 𝑩 are square matrices of the same order, then 𝑑𝑒𝑡(𝑨𝑩) = (𝑑𝑒𝑡𝑨) (𝑑𝑒𝑡𝑩).
The value of a determinant does not change when rows and columns are interchanged.
If any two rows (or two columns) of a determinant are interchanged, the value of the
determinant is multiplied by–1.
If all the elements of one rows (or one column) of a determinant are multiplied by the
same number k, the valuye of the new determinant is k times the value of the given
determinant.
If two rows (or two columns) of a determinant are identical, the value of the
determinant is zero.
In a determinant the sum of the products of the elements of any row (column) with the
cofactors of the corresponding elements of any other row (column) is zero.
If in a determinant each element in any row (or column) consists of the sum of two
terms, then the determinant can be expressed as the sum of two determinants of the
same order.
If to the elements of a row (or column) of a determinant are added m times the
corresponding elements of another row (or column), the value of the determinant thus
obtained is equal to the value of the original determinant.
The cofactor Aij of the element aij in ∆ is equal to (−1)i+j times the determinant of order
n − 1 obtained from ∆ by leaving the row and the column passing through the element
aij . Then we have
DIAGONAL FORMS: Diagonal forms are some of the simplest projective varieties to
study from an arithmetic point of view (including the Fermat varieties). Their local zeta-
functions are computed in terms of Jacobi sums. Waring's problem is the most classical
case.
DIAGONALIZABLE MATRIX: A matrix is said to be diagonalizable if it is similar to a
diagonal matrix.
An 𝑛 × 𝑛 matrix is diagonalizable if and only if it possesses 𝑛 linearly independent
eigenvectors.
DIAGONAL MATRIX: A square matrix in which all entries, except the main diagonal
entries, are zero. A square matrix A = aij those elements above and below the
n×n
principle diagonal are all zero, i.e., aij = 0 for all i ≠ j, is called a diagonal matrix
Thus a diagonal matrix is both upper and lower triangular. An n- rowed diagonal matrix
whose diagonal elements in order are d1 , d2 , d3 , … , dn will often be denoted by the
symbol
Diag [d1 , d2 , … , dn ]
For example
2 0 0 2 0 0
A = 0 0 0 and 0 2 0 are diagonal matrices.
0 0 5 0 0 2
DIAMETRAL PLANE: The locus of points which bisect a system of parallel chords of a
given sphere is called the diametric plane, all chords being parallel to a given line.
A vector space of dimension 1 over ℂ ,with one possible basis being the single
element 1.
A vector space of dimension 2 over ℝ, with one possible basis given by the two
elements 1,i
A vector space of infinite dimension over ℚ.
Note the following:
Suppose that the vectors 𝑣1 , 𝑣2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝑣𝑛 , 𝑤 span 𝑉 and that 𝑤 is a linear
combination of 𝑣1 , 𝑣2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝑣𝑛 .Then 𝑣1 , 𝑣2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝑣𝑛 span 𝑉.
Suppose that the vectors 𝑣1 , 𝑣2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝑣𝑟 span the vector space 𝑉.Then there is a
subsequence of 𝑣1 , 𝑣2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝑣𝑟 which forms a basis of 𝑉.
Let 𝑉 be the vector space over 𝐾 which has a finite spanning set, and suppose
that the vectors 𝑣1 , 𝑣2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝑣𝑟 are linearly independent in 𝑉. Then we can extend
the sequence to a basis 𝑣1 , 𝑣2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝑣𝑛 of 𝑉 where 𝑛 ≥ 𝑟.
Suppose that the vectors v𝟏 , v𝟐 , ⋯ ⋯ , v𝒏 span 𝑉 and that vectors
w𝟏 , w𝟐 , ⋯ ⋯ , w𝒎 ϵ V are linearly independent. Then 𝑚 ≤ 𝑛.
Let V be a vector space of dimension n over K. Then any n vectors which span V
forms a basis of V, and no n-1 vectors can span V.
Let V be a vector space of dimension n over K. Then any linearly independent
vectors form a basis of V and no 𝑛 + 1 vectors can be linearly independent.
If a non-trivial vector space V is spanned by a finite number of vectors, then it
has a basis.
DIMENSION THEOREM FOR VECTOR SPACES: Given a vector space 𝑉, any two linearly
independent generating sets (in other words, any two bases) have the same cardinality.
If 𝑉 is finitely generated, then it has a finite basis, and the result says that any two bases
have the same number of elements.
𝑑𝑠 ∗2 = 𝑉 −1 − 𝑈 −1 (𝑈 −1 + 𝑑𝑢2 + 𝑉 −1 𝑑𝑣 2 )
Where 𝑈 = 𝑈 𝑢 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑉 = 𝑉 𝑣 .
1
, t >𝜖
δϵ t = 2ϵ ………….. 1
0, t <𝜖
∞ 𝜖 1
Thus ∫−∞ δϵ t dt = ∫−𝜖 2ϵ dt. ………….. 2
Again if 𝑓 𝑡 is any function which is integrable in the interval −ϵ, ϵ then using the
mean value theorem of the integral calculus, we have
∞ 1 𝜖
∫−∞ 𝑓(𝑡)δϵ t dt = 2ϵ ∫−𝜖 𝑓(𝑡)dt = 𝑓 𝜃𝜖 , 𝜃 ≤ 1. ……….…. 3
∞ if t = 0
δ t = limϵ→0 δϵ(t) = ………….. 5
0 if t ≠ 0
∞
and ∫−∞ δ t dt = 1. ………… 6
this limiting function δ t defined by equations (5) and (6) is known a the Dirac delta
function (or the unit impulse function) after Dirac who first introduced it. Dirac called
this delta function as improper function as there cannot be proper function satisfying
such conditions.
𝑎𝑛 𝑒 −𝜆 𝑛 𝑧
𝑛 =1
where 𝑎𝑛 and 𝑧 are complex and {𝜆𝑛 } is a monotonic increasing sequence of real
numbers. When 𝜆𝑛 = log 𝑒 𝑛, the series reduces to
∞
𝑎𝑛 𝑛−𝑧
𝑛=1
𝑎𝑛 < 𝐾
𝑛=1
for all values of 𝑚, and {𝑏𝑛 } is decreasing sequence converging to zero, then 𝑎𝑛 𝑏𝑛
converges.
DISCONNECTED GRAPH: D is connected graph is a graph in which the vertices are
separated into two or more distinct groups and cannot be linked from a vertex in one
group to a vertex in the other group through a series of edges.
DISCRETE: Discrete refers to a situation where the possibilities are distinct and
separated from each other. For example, the number of people in a city is discrete,
because there is no such thing as a fractional person.
DISCRETE RANDOM VARIABLE: A discrete random variable is a random variable which
can only take on values from a discrete list. The probability function (or density
function) lists the probability that the variable will take on each of the possible values.
The sum of the probabilities for all of the possible values must be 1. Binomial
distribution, Poisson distribution, Geometric distribution, Hypergeometric distribution
etc are examples of discrete random variable.
DISCRETE TOPOLOGY: Let 𝑋 be any non-empty set and let 𝑃(𝑋) be the collection of all
subsets of 𝑋. Then 𝑃(𝑋) is called the discrete topology on the set 𝑋. The topological
space (𝑋; 𝑃(𝑋)) is called a discrete space.
DISCRETE VALUATION: Let 𝐾 be a field, and let 𝑍 ∪ {∞} be the set obtained from the
ring 𝑍 of integers by adding a symbol ∞ with the properties that ∞ + ∞ = ∞, 𝑛 +
∞ = ∞ + 𝑛 = ∞, ∞ − 𝑛 = ∞ 𝑎𝑛𝑑 ∞ > 𝑛 for all integers 𝑛. A discrete valuation on
the field 𝐾 is a function 𝜈: 𝐾 → 𝑍 ∪ {∞} which satisfies the following conditions:
(i) 𝜈(𝑎) = ∞ if and only if 𝑎 = 0𝐾 ;
(ii) 𝜈(𝑎𝑏) = 𝜈(𝑎) + 𝜈(𝑏) for all 𝑎, 𝑏 ∇ 𝐾;
(iii) 𝜈(𝑎 + 𝑏) ≥ 𝑚𝑖𝑛(𝜈(𝑎), 𝜈(𝑏)) for all 𝑎, 𝑏 ∇ 𝐾.
Let 𝑝 be a prime number. Then, given any non-zero rational number 𝑟, there exist
integers 𝑘, 𝑢 and v such that 𝑟 = 𝑝𝑘 𝑢𝑣 −1 and neither 𝑢 nor 𝑣 is divisible by 𝑝. The
integer 𝑘 is uniquely determined by 𝑟, and we define 𝑣𝑝 (𝑟) = 𝑘. We also define
𝑣𝑝 (0) = ∞. Then the function 𝑣𝑝 ∶ 𝑄 → 𝑍 ∪ {∞} defined in this fashion is a discrete
valuation on the field 𝑄 of rational numbers.
DISCRETE VALUATION RING: A discrete valuation ring is an integral domain 𝑅 with a
unique maximal ideal 𝑀 whose proper ideals are all of the form 𝑀𝑘 for some positive
integer 𝑘. Every discrete valuation ring is a principal ideal domain.
DISCRIMINANT: The discriminant D of a quadratic equation 𝑎𝑥 2 + 𝑏𝑥 + 𝑐 = 0 is
𝐷 = 𝑏 2 + 4𝑎𝑐. If 𝑎, 𝑏 and 𝑐 are real numbers, the discriminant allows us to determine
the characteristics of the solution for 𝑥. If 𝐷 is a positive perfect square, then 𝑥 will have
two rational values. If 𝐷 = 0, then 𝑥 will have two real and equal solutions. If 𝐷 is
positive but is not a perfect square, then 𝑥 will have two irrational solutions. If 𝐷 is
negative, then 𝑥 will have two complex solutions. In other words, the equation has two
distinct real roots, equal roots (that is, one root) or no real roots according to whether
the discriminant is positive, zero or negative.
DISJOINT SETS: Two sets are said to be disjoint if they have no elements in common,
that is, if their intersection is the empty set.
DISJOINT UNION: The disjoint union 𝑈 ⊔ 𝑉 is the union of two disjoint sets , 𝑉 ; the
notation 𝑈 ⊔ 𝑉 simply means 𝑈 ∪ 𝑉 together with an assertion (or reminder) that 𝑈
and 𝑉 are disjoint. The disjoint union of any collection of (disjoint) sets is defined and
denoted similarly.
DISJUNCTION: A disjunction is an OR statement of the form: “A OR B.” It is true if either
A or B is true.
DISPERSION: The spread of values of a variable in a distribution. A measure of
dispersion is a way of describing how scattered or spreads out the observations in a
sample are. The term is also applied similarly to a random variable. Common measures
of dispersion are the range, interquartile range, mean absolute deviation, variance and
standard deviation. The range may be unduly affected by odd high and low values. The
mean absolute deviation is difficult to work with because of the absolute value signs.
The standard deviation is in the same units as the data, and it is this that is most often
used. The interquartile range may be appropriate when the median is used as the
measure of location.
DISPLACEMENT VECTOR: A vector that describes a movement from one point to
another, using both direction and magnitude.
DISTANCE BETWEEN TWO CODEWORDS: The distance between two codewords in a
binary code is the number of bits in which the two codewords differ. For example, the
distance between 010110 and 001100 is 3 because they differ in the second, third and
fifth bits. If the distance between any two different codewords in a binary code is at
least 3, the code is an error-correcting code capable of correcting any one error.
DISTANCE FROM A POINT TO A LINE IN THE PLANE: If a point 𝑃 has coordinates (𝑥1 , 𝑦1 )
and a line 𝑙 has equation 𝑎𝑥 + 𝑏𝑦 + 𝑐 = 0, then the distance from 𝑃 to 𝑙 is equal to
𝑎𝑥1 + 𝑏𝑦1 + 𝑐
𝑎2 + 𝑏 2
DISTANCE FROM A POINT TO A PLANE IN 3-DIMENSIONAL SPACE: If a point 𝑃 has
coordinates (𝑥1 , 𝑦1 , 𝑧1 ) and a plane 𝑝 has equation 𝑎𝑥 + 𝑏𝑦 + 𝑐𝑧 + 𝑑 = 0, the
distance from 𝑃 to 𝑝 is equal to
𝑎𝑥1 + 𝑏𝑦1 + 𝑐𝑧1 + 𝑑
𝑎2 + 𝑏 2 + 𝑐 2
DISTANCE OF THE CODE: Let 𝐶 be a code. The distance of the code, denoted 𝑑(𝐶), is
defined by 𝑑(𝐶) = 𝑚𝑖𝑛{𝑑(𝑐1 , 𝑐2 ) | 𝑐1 , 𝑐2 ∇ 𝐶, 𝑐1 , ≠ 𝑐2 }. An (𝑛, 𝑀) −code of distance 𝑑 is
called an (𝑛, 𝑀, 𝑑) −code. The values 𝑛, 𝑀, 𝑑 are called the parameters of the code.
DISTRIBUTIVE PROPERTY: The distributive property says that
𝑎 𝑏 + 𝑐 = 𝑎𝑏 + 𝑎𝑐 ∀ 𝑎, 𝑏 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑐.
DIVERGENCE: The divergence of a vector field 𝒇 (written as ∆. 𝒇) is defined to be the
scalar
𝜕𝑓𝑥 𝜕𝑓𝑦 𝜕𝑓𝑧
∆. 𝒇 = + +
𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑦 𝜕𝑧
It can be thought of as the dot product of the operator ∆ (del) with the field f.
DIVERGENCE THEOREM: The divergence theorem states that if E is a three-dimensional
vector field, then the surface integral of E over a closed surface is equal to the triple
integral of the divergence of E over the volume enclosed by that surface:
𝐸. 𝑑𝑆 = (∆. 𝐸)𝑑𝑉
DIVISION ALGORITHM: For integers 𝑎 and 𝑏, with 𝑏 > 0, there exist unique integers 𝑞
and 𝑟 such that 𝑎 = 𝑏𝑞 + 𝑟, where 0 ≤ 𝑟 < 𝑏. In the division of 𝑎 by 𝑏, the number 𝑞
is the quotient and 𝑟 is the remainder.
DIVISOR OF ZERO: If in a ring there are non-zero elements 𝑎 and 𝑏 such that 𝑎𝑏 = 0,
then 𝑎 and 𝑏 are divisors of zero. For example, in the ring of 2 × 2 real matrices,
0 1 0 0 0 0
=
0 0 1 0 0 0
and so each of the matrices on the left-hand side is a divisor of zero. In the ring 𝑍6 ,
consisting of the set 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 with addition and multiplication modulo 6, the
element 4 is a divisor of zero since 4.3 = 0.
DNE: It is the abbreviation for a solution for an expression does not exist, or is
undefined. Generally used with limits and integrals.
DOMAIN: The domain of a function is the set of all possible values for which the function
is well defined.
DOMAIN OF A RELATION: The set of all first coordinates of the ordered pairs.
DOMAIN OF A VARIABLE: The base set of numbers or quantities that can be mapped to a
second set. In elementary algebra, the domain of a function 𝑦 = 𝑓(𝑥) is the set of
values that the independent variable 𝑥 can take. For example, if 𝑦 = 𝑓(𝑥) = 𝑎𝑟𝑐𝑠𝑖𝑛(𝑥),
then the domain might be defined as all the numbers whose absolute value is no more
than 1, that is, |𝑥| < 1.
DOMAIN WITH SMOOTH BOUNDARY: Let 𝑀 be an 𝑚-dimensional abstract manifold. A
nonempty open subset 𝐷 ⊂ 𝑀 is said to be a domain with smooth boundary if for each
𝑝 ∇ 𝜕𝐷 there exists an open neighborhood 𝑊 of 𝑝 in 𝑀, and a smooth function
𝑓: 𝑊 → 𝑅 such that 0 is a regular value, 𝑓(𝑝) = 0 and
𝑊 ∩ 𝐷 = {𝑥 ∇ 𝑊 | 𝑓(𝑥) > 0}.
DORN’S CONVERSE DUALITY THEOREM: Let 𝐶 be positive semi- definite. If x, u solves
Quadratic Duality Problem, then some x ∇ Rn (not necessarily equal to x), satisfying
𝐶 x − x = 0 solves Quadratic maximization Problem and the two extremes are equal.
DOT PRODUCT: Let a and b be two n-dimensional vectors, whose components are:
𝒃 = ( 𝑏1 , 𝑏2 , 𝑏3 , − − − 𝑏𝑛 )
𝒂 = ( 𝑎1 , 𝑎2 , 𝑎3 , − − − 𝑎𝑛 )
Then
𝒃. 𝒂 = 𝑏1 𝑎1 + 𝑏2 𝑎2 + 𝑏3 𝑎3 + − − − + 𝑏𝑛 𝑎𝑛
DOUBLE-ANGLE FORMULA: The trigonometric functions of a double-angle that are
expressed in terms of separate functions of the angle.
Where P,Q, R are continuous functions of 𝑢 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑣 and do not vanish together represents
two families of curves on the surface provided 𝑄 2 − 𝑃𝑅 > 0.
𝑑𝑢
Which is quadratic in 𝑑𝑣 and by solving this equation the separate differential equations
𝑓 𝑥, 𝑦 𝑑𝑥𝑑𝑦
𝑥=𝑎,𝑦=𝑐
represents the volume under the surface 𝑧 = 𝑓 (𝑥, 𝑦) over the rectangle from 𝑥 = 𝑎 to
𝑥 = 𝑏 and 𝑦 = 𝑐 to 𝑦 = 𝑑.
DOUBLE-NAPPED CONE: Two identical but opposite cones that share a common vertex.
DOUBLE SERIES: A sequence with the indices, i.e., a mapping from the Cartesian
product 𝑁 × 𝑁 of two copies of the set of natural numbers 𝑁 to a subset of the real or
complex numbers, is called a double sequence and is denoted by 𝑎𝑚𝑛 or 𝑎𝑚 ,𝑛 . If
there exists a number 𝐼 such that for any positive 𝜀, there is a natural number 𝑁(𝜀)
satisfying 𝑎𝑚𝑛 − 1 < 𝜀 for all 𝑚 > 𝑁(𝜀) and 𝑛 > 𝑁(𝜀), then we say that the sequence
𝑎𝑚𝑛 has a limit 𝐼 and write lim𝑚 →∞ 𝑎𝑚𝑛 = 𝛼𝑛 uniformly in 𝑛 and lim𝑚 →∞,𝑛→∞ 𝑎𝑚𝑛 =
∞
𝐼. For a given double sequence 𝑎𝑚𝑛 , the formal series m,n=1 𝑎𝑚𝑛 is called a double
series and is sometimes denoted by 𝑎𝑚𝑛 . In contrast with double series, the ordinary
series discussed previously is called a simple series.
𝑧 = 𝑐1 𝑥2 + 𝑐2 𝑥2 + ⋯ + 𝑐𝑛 𝑥𝑛 ≤ 𝑏1
⋮ ⋮ ⋮
The corresponding dual problem is obtained by transposing the rows and columns of
constraint coefficients, transporting the coefficients of the objectives function and the
right hand side of the constraints, reversing the inequalities and minimizing instead of
maximizing.
DUALITY SPECULATION: Every primal linear programming problem has associated with
it another linear programming problem called the dual linear programming problem.
Constraint parameters in one are variable coefficients in other.
Coefficients for the objective function of either are the RHS for other problem.
DUALITY THEOREM:
Feasible solutions exist and objective function is bounded, then same is true for
other problem.
Feasible solutions exist and objective function is unbounded, then other problem
is infeasible.
No feasible solutions exist, then other problem is either infeasible or has
unbounded objective function.
Some properties of this theory are:
Weak duality If 𝒙 is a feasible solution for the primal problem and 𝒚 is a
property feasible solution for the dual problem, then 𝒄𝒙 ≤ 𝒚𝒃.
Strong duality If 𝒙∗ is an optimal solution for the primal problem and 𝒚∗ is an
property optimal solution for the dual, then 𝒄𝒙∗ = 𝒚∗ 𝒃.
Complementary At each iteration, the simplex method simultaneously identifies
solutions property a CPF solution 𝒙 for the primal problem and a complementary
solution 𝒚 for the dual (found in row 0, the coefficient of the
slack variables), where 𝒄𝒙 = 𝒚𝒃.
Complementary At the final iteration, the simplex method simultaneously
optimal solutions identifies an optimal solution 𝒙∗ for the primal problem and a
property complementary optimal solution 𝒚∗ for the dual problem (found
in row 0, the coefficient of the slack variables), where
𝒄𝒙∗ = 𝒚∗ 𝒃.. In this solution, 𝒚∗ gives the shadow prices for the
primal problem.
Symmetry property The dual of the dual is the primal.
Complementary basic Each basic solution in the primal problem has a complementary
solutions property basic solution in the dual, where their respective objective
function values (Z and W) are equal.
Complementary The variables in the primal basic solution and the
slackness property complementary dual basic solution satisfy the complementary
slackness as shown:
Primal variable Dual variable
Basic Non-basic (m variables)
Non-basic Basic (n variables)
Primal Dual
Maximize Z Minimize W
Constraint i: Variable yi:
≤ form yi ≥ 0
= form unconstrained
≥ form y’i ≤ 0
Variable xj: Constraint j:
xj ≥ 0 ≥ form
unconstrained unconstrained
x’j ≤ 0 ≤ form
DUAL OF A QUOTIENT SPACE: Next, consider the projection map 𝜋 ∶ 𝑋 → 𝑋/𝑆 where 𝑆
is a closed subspace. We then have 𝜋 ∗ ∶ (𝑋/𝑆)∗ → 𝑋 ∗ . Since 𝜋 is surjective, this map is
injective. It is easy to see that the range is contained in 𝑆 𝑎 . In fact we now show that 𝜋 ∗
maps (X/S) ∗ onto 𝑆 𝑎 , hence provides a canonical isomorphism of 𝑆 𝑎 with (𝑋/𝑆)∗ .
Indeed, if 𝑓 ∇ 𝑆 𝑎 , then we have a splitting 𝑓 = 𝑔 ∘ 𝜋 with 𝑔 ∇ (𝑋/𝑆)∗ (just define
𝑔(𝑐) = 𝑓(𝑥) where x is any element of the coset c). Thus 𝑓 = 𝜋 ∗ 𝑔 is indeed in the
range of 𝜋 ∗ . This correspondence is again an isometry.
𝑧 = 𝑏1 𝑦1 + 𝑏2 𝑦2 + … + 𝑏𝑚 𝑦𝑚
DUAL SIMPLEX METHOD: For a L.P.P. (maximization problem) the optimality criterion
of the simplex method 𝑐𝑗 − 𝑧𝑗 = 𝑐𝑗 − 𝑐𝐵 𝐵 −1 . 𝛼𝑗 ≤ 0, for all 𝑗 where 𝐵 is the basis,
depends only on 𝛼𝑗 , and 𝑐𝑗 and is independent of the requirement vector 𝑏. Thus, every
basic solution with all 𝑐𝑗 − 𝑧𝑗 ≤ 0, will not be feasible but any basic feasible solution
with all 𝑐𝑗 − 𝑧𝑗 ≤ 0 will certainly be an optimal solution.
DUAL SPACE (FUNCTIONAL ANALYSIS): The dual space X* of a normed space X is the set
𝑠𝑢𝑝
of continuous linear functionals on X. Define a norm on it by 𝛼 = 𝑥 ≤ 1 𝛼(𝑥)
DUAL SPACE (LINEAR ALGEBRA): For fixed vector spaces 𝑈 and 𝑉 over 𝐾, the
operations of addition and scalar multiplication on the set 𝐻𝑜𝑚𝐾 (𝑈, 𝑉) of all linear
maps from 𝑈 to 𝑉 makes 𝐻𝑜𝑚𝐾 (𝑈, 𝑉) into a vector space over 𝐾.
Given a vector space 𝑈 over a field 𝐾, the vector space 𝑈 ∗ = 𝐻𝑜𝑚𝐾 (𝑈, 𝑉) plays a
special role.It is often called the dual space or the space of convectors of 𝑈. One can
think of coordinates as elements of 𝑈 ∗ .Indeed,let 𝑒𝑖 be a basis of U. Every x 𝜖 𝑈 can be
uniquely written as x =𝛼1 𝑒1 + 𝛼2 𝑒2 + ⋯ ⋯ + 𝛼𝑛 𝑒𝑛 , 𝛼𝑖 𝜖 𝐾
The elements 𝛼𝑖 depends on 𝑥 as well as on a choice of the basis, so for each I one can
write the coordinate function 𝑒 𝑖 : 𝑈 → 𝐾 , 𝑒 𝑖 𝑥 = 𝛼𝑖
It is easy to check that 𝑒 𝑖 is a linear map, and indeed the function 𝑒 𝑖 form a basis of the
dual space 𝑈 ∗ .
DUAL SPHERICAL TRIANGLES: Let ∆ be a spherical triangle with angles 𝛼, 𝛽, 𝛾 and side
lengths 𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐. Then the dual triangle ∆∗ has sides of length 𝑎∗ = 𝜋 − 𝛼, 𝑏 ∗ = 𝜋 − 𝛽, 𝑐 ∗ =
𝜋 − 𝛾 and angles 𝛼 ∗ = 𝜋 − 𝑎, 𝛽 ∗ = 𝜋 − 𝑏, 𝛾 ∗ = 𝜋 − 𝑐.
DYADIC TENSOR: A dyadic tensor has order two, and may be represented as a square
matrix. The conventions aij, aij, and aij, do have different meanings (the position of the
index determines its valence (variance), in that the first may represent a quadratic
form, the second a linear transformation, and the differention is significant in contexts
that require tensors that aren't orthogonal. A dyad is a tensor such as aibj, product
component-by-component of rank-one tensors. In this case it represents a linear
transformation, of rank one in the sense of linear algebra - a clashing terminology that
can cause confusion.
DYNAMIC PROGRAMMING: The area of mathematics relating to the study of
optimization problems where a step-wise decision making approach is employed. This
is often done iteratively.
E
ECCENTRICITY: The ratio of the distances between a point on a conic and a fixed point
(the focus) and between the point and a fixed line (the directrix). For 𝑒 = 0 a circle is
produced, for 0 < 𝑒 < 1 an ellipse is produced, for 𝑒 = 1 a parabola is produced and
for 𝑒 > 1 the conic produced is a hyperbola.
ECHELON FORM OF A MATRIX: A matrix is in echelon form if
All the zero rows come below the non-zero rows.
The first non-zero entry in each non-zero row is 1 and occurs in a column to the
right of the leading 1 in the row above.
EDGE: The edge of a polyhedron is a line segment where two faces intersect.
𝑎. 𝑒
EGOROV THEOREM: If 𝑓𝑛 𝑓 on a finite measure set 𝑋 then for any 𝜍 > 0 there is
→
𝐸𝜍 ⊂ 𝑋 with µ(𝐸𝜍 ) < 𝜍 and 𝑓𝑛 ⇒ 𝑓 on 𝑋 ∖ 𝐸𝜍 .
𝜇 𝑎. 𝑒
If 𝑓𝑛 𝑓 then there is a subsequence (𝑛𝑘 ) such that 𝑓𝑛 𝑘 𝑓 for 𝑘 → ∞.
→ →
1: 𝑥 ∇ 𝐴
𝜒𝐴 𝑥 = . Then, if 𝜒𝐴 is measurable, then 𝜒𝐴 −1 ( (1/2,3/2) ) = 𝐴 ∇ 𝐿;
0: 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴
conversely, if 𝐴 ∇ 𝐿, then 𝑋 ∖ 𝐴 ∇ 𝐿, and we see that for any 𝑈 ⊆ ℝ open, 𝜒𝐴 −1 (𝑈) is
either ∅, 𝐴, 𝑋 ∖ 𝐴, or 𝑋, all of which are in 𝐿. So 𝜒𝐴 is measurable if and only if 𝐴 ∇ 𝐿.
ELEMENTARY MATRIX: Elementary matrix is a square matrix obtained from the identity
matrix 𝐼 by an elementary row operation. A matrix obtained from a unit matrix by a
single elementary transformation is called an elementary matrix (or 𝐸- matrix). For
0 0 1 1 0 0 1 2 0
example 0 1 0 , 0 4 0 , 0 1 0 are the elementary matrices obtained from
1 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 1
Is by subjecting it to the elementary operations C1 ⟷ C3 , R 2 → 4R 2 , R1 → R1 + R 2
respectively.
3 1 9 𝑅3 →𝑅3 −3𝑅1 3 1 9
Example: 4 6 7 4 6 7
2 5 8 −7 2 −19
2 0 5 𝑅2 →2𝑅2 2 0 5
Example: 1 −2 3 2 −4 6
5 1 2 5 1 2
ELLIPSE: An ellipse is the set of all points in a plane such that the sum of the distances
to two fixed points is a constant. Each of these two fixed points is known as a focus or
focal point. The plural of focus is foci. The longest distance across the ellipse is known as
the major axis. The shortest distance across is the minor axis. The center of the ellipse
is the midpoint of the segment that joins the two foci. The equation of an ellipse with
center at the origin is
𝑥2 𝑦2
+ =1
𝑎2 𝑏 2
where 2𝑎 is the length of the major axis, and 2𝑏 is the length of the minor axis. Area of
this ellipse is 𝜋𝑎𝑏.
ELLIPSOID: A quadric whose equation in a suitable coordinate system is
𝑥2 𝑦2 𝑧2
+ + =1
𝑎2 𝑏 2 𝑐 2
The three axial planes are planes of symmetry. All non-empty plane sections are
ellipses. If the ellipse has major axis 2𝑎 and minor axis 2𝑏, then the ellipsoid formed by
4
rotating the ellipse about its major axis will have the volume 𝜋𝑎𝑏 2 .
3
2
𝜆 + 𝑎2 𝜇 + 𝑎2 𝜈 + 𝑎2
𝑥 =
𝑏 2 − 𝑎2 𝑐 2 − 𝑎2
2
𝜆 + 𝑏2 𝜇 + 𝑏2 𝜈 + 𝑏2
𝑦 =
𝑎2 − 𝑏 2 𝑐 2 − 𝑏 2
𝜆 + 𝑐2 𝜇 + 𝑐2 𝜈 + 𝑐2
𝑧2 =
𝑎2 − 𝑐 2 𝑏 2 − 𝑐 2
𝜍 + 𝑎2 𝜏 + 𝑎2
𝑥2 =
𝑎2 − 𝑏 2
𝜍 + 𝑏2 𝜏 + 𝑏2
𝑦2 =
𝑏 2 − 𝑎2
where −𝑎2 < 𝜏 < −𝑏 2 < 𝜍 < ∞ .
ELLIPTIC CYLINDER: Elliptic cylinder is a cylinder in which the fixed curve is an ellipse
and the fixed line to which the generators are parallel is perpendicular to the plane of
the ellipse. It is a quadric, and in a suitable coordinate system has equation
ELLIPTIC FUNCTION: A function defined on the complex plane for which 𝑓(𝑧) = 𝑓(𝑧 +
𝑎) = 𝑓(𝑧 + 𝑏) where 𝑎/𝑏 is not real. From this it follows that 𝑓(𝑧 + 𝑚𝑎 + 𝑛𝑏) =
𝑓(𝑧) for all integers 𝑚, 𝑛 and that the function is periodic in two distinct directions on
the complex plane.
All the meromorphic functions which have two distinct periods are called elliptic
functions.
Primitive period parallelogram, Mess and cell: Let 𝑓 𝑧 be an elliptic function with 2ω1
and 2ω2 as a pair of primitive periods.
ω2
Supposing that imaginary part of which is not zero to be positive, we see that the
ω1
points 0, 2ω1 , 2ω1 + 2ω2 , 2ω1 taken in order are the vertices of a parallelogram
described in the positive sense. This is called the primitive period-parallelogram of the
elliptic function 𝑓 𝑧 . There are the unlimited number of such primitive period
parallelograms. Now the only periods of 𝑓 𝑧 (double periodic function) are of the form
2mω1 + 2nω2 , where m and n are integers. Therefore the vertices are the only points
within or on a primitive period- parallelogram. Whose affixes are periods in the Argand
plane the points of affix 2mω1 + 2nω2 where m = 0, ±1, ±2, … , n = 0, ±1, ±2…. Are
denoted by Ωm,n
Thus, the four points Ωm,n, Ωm+1,n Ωm+1,n+1 are the vertices of a parallelogram. This
parallelogram may be obtained from the primitive period-parallelogram by a
translation without rotation. This parallelogram with vertices
Ωm′n′ Ωm+1′n Ωm+1,n+1′ Ωm ′ n+1 is called a period parallelogram or a mesh. The Argand
plane may be covered by this system of non overlapping meshes. In each mesh (within
and on the boundary) there are only a finite number of poles and zeros, and hence we
can translate the mesh without rotation until no pole or zero lies on its boundary. The
parallelogram thus obtained is called a cell.
The set of poles (or zeros) in a given cell is called an irreducible set.
𝜔 𝑑𝑡
𝑧 = ∫0 𝑘 <1 ……. i
1−𝑡 2 1−𝑘 2 𝑡 2
is called an elliptic integral of the first kind. The integral exists if ω is real and such that
ω < 1. By analytical continuation it can be extended to other values of ω.
∅ 𝑑𝑡
𝑧 = ∫0 ………. ii
1−𝑘 2 𝑠𝑖𝑛 2 𝜃
𝜔
𝑑𝑡
= 𝑠𝑖𝑛−1 𝜔
0 1− 𝑡2
∴ 𝜔 = 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝑍.
∴ when 𝑘 ≠ 0, the integral (i) is deputed by Sn −1 (𝜔/𝑘) or briefly Sn −1 (𝜔), when k doe
not change during a given discussion.
Thus we have
𝜔 𝑑𝑡
𝑧 = Sn −1 𝜔 = ∫0 1−𝑡 2 1−𝑘 2 𝑡 2
This gives the function Sn (z), which is called a Jacobi’s elliptic function.
𝐿𝑁−𝑀² 𝐿𝑁−𝑀²
Again 𝐾 = 𝜅𝑎 𝜅𝑏 = =
𝐸𝐺−𝐹² 𝐻²
ENDOMORPHISM RING: The associative ring 𝑬𝒏𝒅 𝑨 = 𝑯𝒐𝒎 (𝑨, 𝑨) consisting of all
morphisms of into itself, where is an object in some additive category. The
multiplication in 𝑬𝒏𝒅 𝑨 is composition of morphisms, and addition is the addition of
morphisms defined by the axioms of the additive category. The identity morphism 𝟏𝑨 is
the unit element of the ring 𝑬𝒏𝒅 𝑨. An element 𝝋 in 𝑬𝒏𝒅 𝑨 is invertible if and only
if 𝝋 is an automorphism of the object 𝑨. If 𝑨 and 𝑩 are objects of an additive category 𝑪,
then the group 𝑯𝒐𝒎 (𝑨, 𝑩) has the natural structure of a right module over 𝑬𝒏𝒅 𝑨 and
of a left module over 𝑬𝒏𝒅 𝑩. Let 𝑻: 𝑪 → 𝑪𝟏 be a covariant (or contravariant) additive
functor from an additive category 𝑪 into an additive category 𝑪𝟏 . Then for any
object 𝑨 in 𝑪 the functor 𝑻 induces a natural homomorphism (or anti-
homomorphism) 𝑬𝒏𝒅 𝑨 → 𝑬𝒏𝒅 𝑻(𝑨).
END-POINT: End point of an interval is a number defining one end of an interval on the
real line. Each of the finite intervals [𝑎, 𝑏], (𝑎, 𝑏), [𝑎, 𝑏) and (𝑎, 𝑏] has two end-points, 𝑎
and 𝑏. Each of the infinite intervals [𝑎, ∞), (𝑎, ∞), (– ∞, 𝑎] and (– ∞, 𝑎) has one end-
point, 𝑎.
ENERGY EQUATION: The principle of energy enunciates that the change in the total
energy (Kinetic 𝑇, Potential 𝑊 and Intrinsic 𝐼) is equal to work done by the extraneous
forces. The potential due to external forces is supposed to the independent of time.
∂q 1
The Euler’s equation of motion is = −∆Ω − ρ ∆ρ, where the extraneous forces are
∂t
conservative.
∂q
ρ = −ρ ∆Ω − ∆ρ
∂t
Multiplying the above equation scalarly by q, we get
∂q 1 d
ρq ∂t = −ρq ∆Ω − q∆ρ or ρ dt q2 + ρq. ∆Ω = −q. ∆ρ
2
1 d dΩ d 1
or ρ dt q2 + ρ dt = −q. ∆ρ or ρ dt q2 + Ω − q. ∆ρ .
2 2
d 1 2
ρ q + Ω dv = − q. ∆ρ dv
V dt 2 V
Or
𝑑 1 2
ρq dv + ρΩ dv = − q. ∆ρ dv
𝑑𝑡 V2 V V
𝑑
Or 𝑇 + 𝑊 = − ∫V ∆. ρq dv + ∫V ρ ∆. q dv
𝑑𝑡
𝑑 ρ dρ
𝑇 + 𝑊 = − ∫V ∆. ρq dv − ∫V dv.
𝑑𝑡 ρ dt
By virtue of divergence theorem and the equation of continuity,
𝑑 dI
𝑇+𝑊 =− ρq ∙ n ds −
𝑑𝑡 s dt
𝑑
Or 𝑇 + 𝑊 + 𝐼 †= − ∫s ρq ∙ n ds,
𝑑𝑡
ENERGY PRINCIPLE: Denote by 𝐸 the class of all measures of finite energy. A symmetric
kernel is called positive definite (or of positive type) if 𝜇 − 𝑣, 𝜇 − 𝑣 = 𝜇, 𝜇 + 𝑣, 𝑣 −
2(𝜇, 𝑣) ≥ 0 for any 𝜇, 𝑣𝜖 𝐸. If the equality (𝜇 − 𝑣, 𝜇 − 𝑣) = 0 always implies 𝜇 = 𝑣, then
the kernel is said to satisfy the energy principle.
ENTIRE FUNCTION: A function which has no singularity in the finite part of plane is
called an entire function.
𝑎𝑛
𝑛=𝑜
such that
for all 𝑛 = 0,1, …. An enveloping series may converge or diverge; if it converges, then its
sum is equal to 𝐴.
EPICYCLOID: The curve traced out by a point on the circumference of a circle rolling
round the outside of a fixed circle. When the two circles have the same radius, the curve
is a cardioid. A planar curve given by the trajectory of a point on a circle rolling on the
exterior side of another circle. The parametric equations are:
𝜃
𝑥 = (𝑟 + 𝑅)𝑐𝑜𝑠𝜃 − 𝑟𝑐𝑜𝑠[(𝑟 + 𝑅) ],
𝑟
𝜃
𝑦 = (𝑟 + 𝑅)𝑠𝑖𝑛𝜃 − 𝑟𝑠𝑖𝑛[(𝑟 + 𝑅) ],
𝑟
where r is the radius of the rolling and 𝑅 that of the fixed circle, and 𝜃 is the angle
between the radius vector of the point of contact of the circles and the x-axis.
EQUAL VECTORS: Two vectors are said to be equal if, and only if, they are parallel, have
the same sense of direction and the same magnitude. The starting points of the vectors
are immaterial. It is the direction and magnitude which are important. To denote the
equality of vectors, the usual equality sign (=) is used. Thus, if 𝒂 and 𝒃 are equal
vectors, we write 𝒂 = 𝒃.
zz + bz + bz + 𝑐 = 0
this is the content of the Arzelà–Ascoli theorem. The idea of equicontinuity can be
transferred to uniform spaces.
𝑎 𝑓 1 ≤ 𝑓 2 ≤ 𝑏 𝑓 1 , for all 𝑓 𝜖 𝑁.
EULER ANGLES: The angles 𝜙, 𝜓 and 𝜃 that determine the position of one Cartesian
rectangular coordinate system 0𝑥𝑦𝑧 relative to another one 0𝑥′𝑦′𝑧′ with the same origin
and orientation. The Euler angles are regarded as the angles through which the former
must be successively rotated about the axes of the latter so that in the end the two
systems coincide.
EULER EQUATION: A linear ordinary differential equation of order 𝑛 of the form
𝑛
𝑑𝑖 𝑦
𝑎𝑖 𝑥 𝑖 = 𝑓(𝑥)
𝑑𝑥 𝑖
𝑖=0
𝑒 𝑖𝑧 + 𝑒 −𝑖𝑧 𝑒 𝑖𝑧 − 𝑒 −𝑖𝑧
𝑐𝑜𝑠𝑧 = , 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝑧 = .
2 2𝑖
These hold for all values of the complex variable 𝑧. In particular, for a real value 𝑧 =
𝑥 the Euler formulas become
𝑒 𝑖𝑥 + 𝑒 −𝑖𝑥 𝑒 𝑖𝑥 − 𝑒 −𝑖𝑥
𝑐𝑜𝑠𝑥 = , 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝑥 = .
2 2𝑖
called the Euler integral of the first kind, or the beta-function, and
𝑥 𝑠−1 𝑒 −𝑥 𝑑𝑥
0
called the Euler integral of the second kind. (The latter converges for 𝑠 > 0 and is a
representation of the gamma-function.)
EULER, LEONHARD (1707–83): Leonord Euler was the most prolific of famous
mathematicians. He was born in Switzerland. He worked in a highly productive period
when the newly developed calculus was being extended in all directions at once, and he
made contributions to most areas of mathematics, pure and applied. Euler, more than
any other individual, was responsible for notation that is standard today. Among his
contributions to the language are the basic symbols, 𝜋, 𝑒 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑖, the summation notation
𝛴 and the standard function notation 𝑓(𝑥). His Introduction in analysis in infinitorum
was the most important mathematics text of the late eighteenth century.
EULER NUMBERS: The coefficients in the expansion
The recurrence formula for the Euler numbers ( in symbolic notation) has the
form
Thus, , the are positive and the are negative integers for
all ; , , , , and . The
Euler numbers are connected with the Bernoulli numbers by the formulas
EULERIAN CIRCUIT: An Eulerian circuit in a graph is a circuit that traverses every edge
of the graph. It follows from these definitions that any closed Eulerian trail is an
Eulerian circuit.
EULERIAN GRAPH: One area of graph theory is concerned with the possibility of
travelling around a graph, going along edges in such a way as to use every edge exactly
once. A connected graph is called Eulerian graph if there is a sequence 𝑣0 , 𝑒1 , 𝑣1 , … , 𝑒𝑘 , 𝑣𝑘
of alternately vertices and edges (where 𝑒𝑖 is an edge joining 𝑣𝑖−1 and 𝑣𝑖 ), with 𝑣0 = 𝑣𝑘
and with every edge of the graph occurring exactly once.
EULERIAN TRAIL: An Eulerian trail in a graph is a trail that traverses every edge of the
graph. Note that an Eulerian trail in a graph must traverse every edge of the graph
exactly once, since a trail traverses an edge of the graph at most once.
𝑛
𝑠𝑛 = 𝑘=0 𝑢𝑘 converges to 𝑠 as 𝑘 → ∞, then 𝑢𝑛 is said to be summable by Eular’s
method, and we write 𝑢𝑛 = 𝑠(𝐸). The transformation thus obtained is called Eular’s
method of summation.
where 𝑠 is a real number and 𝑝 runs through all prime numbers. This product converges
absolutely for all 𝑠 > 1. The analogous product for complex numbers 𝑠 = 𝜍 + 𝑖𝑡
converges absolutely for 𝜍 > 1 and defines in this domain the Riemann zeta-function
1
𝜁(𝑠) = 1− − 1,
𝑝𝑠
𝑝
∞
1
= .
𝑛𝑠
𝑛=1
EULER STRAIGHT LINE: The straight line passing through the point 𝐻 of intersection of
the altitudes of a triangle, the point 𝑆 of intersection of its medians, and the centre 𝑂 of
the circle circumscribed to it. If the Euler line passes through a vertex of the triangle,
then the triangle is either isosceles or right-angled, or both right-angled and isosceles.
The segments of the Euler line satisfy the relation
𝑂𝐻: 𝑆𝐻 = 1: 2
1 1 1
EULER’S CONSTANT: Let 𝑎𝑛 = 1 + 2 + 3 + − − − + 𝑛 − ln 𝑛. This sequence has a limit
whose value is known as Euler’s constant, 𝛾; that is, 𝑎𝑛 → 𝛾. The value equals 0.577
215 66 to 8 decimal places. It is not known whether 𝛾 is rational or irrational.
𝑥
EULER’S EQUATIONS: The necessary condition for ∫𝑥 2 𝑓 𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑦′ 𝑑𝑥 to be an extremum
1
is that
𝜕𝑓 𝑑 𝜕𝑓
− =0
𝜕𝑦 𝑑𝑥 𝜕𝑦′
This is called Euler’s equation
EULER’S EQUATION OF MOTION ALONG A STREAMLINE: Consider an elementary
section of a stream tube. Let 𝛿𝑠 be the length of the stream tube element. Mass of the
fluid particle moving along a streamline in the positive direction is 𝜌 𝛿𝐴 𝛿𝑠. The force
acting on the element are of two types: (i) Body force and (ii) Surface force exerted due
to hydrostatics pressure on the end areas of the particle.
The body force is (𝜌𝐹𝑠 ) 𝛿𝐴𝛿𝑠. On the upstream face the pressure force is 𝜌𝛿𝐴 in the (+𝑠)
𝜕𝑝
direction face it is 𝜌 + 𝜕𝑠 𝛿𝐴 , 𝛿𝐴 acting in the (−𝑠) direction. The total force along the
𝜕𝑝
𝜌𝐹𝑠 𝛿𝑠𝛿𝐴 + 𝜌𝛿𝐴 − 𝜌 + 𝛿𝐴
𝜕𝑠
𝜕𝐴
= 𝜌𝐹𝑠 𝛿𝑠𝛿𝐴 − 𝜕𝑠 𝛿𝑠𝛿𝐴.
dq
The acceleration of the fluid flowing along 𝛿𝑠 is . By using Newton’s second law of
dt
dq 𝜕𝜌
𝜌𝛿𝑠𝛿𝐴 = 𝜌𝐹𝑠 𝛿𝑠𝛿𝐴 − 𝜕𝑠 𝛿𝑠𝛿𝐴
dt
dq 1 𝜕𝑝
Or = 𝐹𝑠 − 𝜌 𝜕𝑠 ,
dt
𝜕𝑝 𝜕𝑝 1 𝜕𝑝
Or + 𝑞 𝜕𝑠 = 𝐹𝑠 − 𝜌 𝜕𝑠 ,
𝜕𝑠
EULER’S FORMULA: The name given to the equation 𝑐𝑜𝑠 𝜃 + 𝑖 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝜃 = 𝑒 𝑖𝜃 , a special
case of which gives 𝑒 𝑖𝜋 + 1 = 0.
EULER FORMULA ( DIFFERENTIAL GEOMETRY): A formula expressing the normal
curvature of a surface in a given direction l in terms of the principal
curvatures 𝑘1 and 𝑘2 :
𝑘𝑙 = 𝑘1 𝑐𝑜𝑠 2 𝜙 + 𝑘2 𝑠𝑖𝑛2 𝜙,
where ϕ is the angle between the direction 𝑙 and the principal direction corresponding
to the principal curvature 𝑘1 . This formula was established by L. Euler (1760).
EULER’S FUNCTION: For a positive integer 𝑛, let 𝜑(𝑛) be the number of positive integers
less than 𝑛 that are relatively prime to 𝑛. For example, 𝜑(12) = 4, since four numbers,
1, 5, 7 and 11, are relatively prime to 12. This function 𝜑, defined on the set of positive
integers, is Euler’s function. The arithmetic function 𝜙 whose value at 𝑛 is equal to the
number of positive integers not exceeding 𝑛 and relatively prime to 𝑛 . The Euler
function is a multiplicative arithmetic function, that is 𝜙(1) = 1 and 𝜙(𝑚𝑛) =
𝜙(𝑚)𝜙(𝑛) for (𝑚, 𝑛) = 1. The function 𝜙(𝑛) satisfies the relations
𝜙(𝑑) = 𝑛,
𝑑|𝑛
𝜙(𝑛) = 3𝜋 2 𝑥 2 + 𝑂(𝑥𝑙𝑛𝑥).
𝑛≤𝑥
where 𝑠 > 1 is an arbitrary real number and the product extends over all prime
numbers 𝑝. The Euler identity also holds for all complex numbers 𝑠 = 𝜍 + 𝑖𝑡 with 𝜍 > 1.
which holds for every totally-multiplicative arithmetic function 𝑓(𝑛) > 0 for which the
∞
series 𝑛=1 𝑓(𝑛) is absolutely convergent.
EULER’S INTEGRALS- BATA AND GAMMA FUNCTIONS: We define the first and second
Eulerian integrals as
1
𝐵 𝐼, 𝑚 = 𝑥 𝑏−1 1 − 𝑥 𝑚 −1
𝑑 𝑥
0
and
∞
𝑇 𝑛 = 𝑒 −𝑥 𝑥 𝑛−1 𝑑 𝑥
0
and refer to them as the Beta and Gamma Functions respectively. These integrals
occupy a very important place in definite integrals and have got wide application in
Mechanics, Physics, Statistics and many other applied sciences.
We shall assume that all the quantities 𝐼, 𝑚, 𝑛 are positive but not necessarily integrals.
i.e.,
𝐵 𝐼, 𝑚 = 𝐵 𝑚, 𝑙
EULER’S METHOD: The simplest numerical method for solving differential equations. If
and an initial condition is known, 𝑦 = 𝑦0 when 𝑥 = 𝑥0 , then Euler’s method generates
a succession of approximations 𝑦𝑛+1 = 𝑦𝑛 + 𝑓 (𝑥𝑛 , 𝑦𝑛 ) where 𝑥𝑛 = 𝑥0 + 𝑛, 𝑛 =
1, 2, 3, …. This takes the known starting point, and moves along a straight line segment
with horizontal distance h in the direction of the tangent at (𝑥0 , 𝑦0 ). The process is
repeated from the new point (𝑥1 , 𝑦1 ) etc. If the step length is small enough, the
tangents are good approximations to the curve. The method provides a reasonably
accurate estimate.
EULER SERIES: The expression
1
,
𝑝
𝑝
where the sum extends over all prime number 𝑝. L. Euler (1748) showed that this series
diverges, thus providing another proof of the fact that the set of prime numbers is
infinite. The partial sums of the Euler series satisfy the asymptotic relation
1 1
= ln
(ln 𝑥) + 𝐶 + 𝑂
𝑝 ln 𝑥
𝑝≤𝑥
where C=0.261497….
EULER’S THEOREM: Let 𝐺 be a connected planar graph drawn in the plane. If there are 𝑣
vertices, 𝑒 edges and 𝑓 faces, then 𝑣 – 𝑒 + 𝑓 = 2.
EVEN FUNCTION: The real function 𝑓 is an even function if 𝑓(– 𝑥) = 𝑓(𝑥) for all 𝑥 in the
domain of the function 𝑓. Thus the graph 𝑦 = 𝑓(𝑥) of an even function has the 𝑦-axis as
a line of symmetry. For example, 𝑓 is an even function when 𝑓(𝑥) is defined as any of the
2
following: 3, 𝑥 4 , 𝑥 6 + 4, 𝑥 4 + 1, 1/(𝑥 5 ), 𝑐𝑜𝑠 4 𝑥.
EVEN PERMUTATION: A rearrangement of the original ordering which can be obtained
by an even number of exchanges of pairs of elements.
EVENT: A subset of the sample space relating to an experiment. It is a set of outcomes of
an experiment; a subset of a sample space. For example, suppose that the sample space
for an experiment in which a coin is tossed three times is {HHH, HHT, HTH, HTT, THH,
THT, TTH, TTT}, and let A = {HHH, HHT, HTH, THH}. Then A is the event in which at
least two ‘heads’ are obtained. If, when the experiment is performed, the outcome is one
that belongs to A, then A is said to have occurred. The intersection A ∩ B of two events is
the event that can be described by saying that ‘both A and B occur’. The union A ∪ B of
two events is the event that ‘either A or B occurs’. Taking the sample space as the
universal set, the complement A′ of A is the event that ‘A does not occur’. The
probability Pr(A) of an event A is often of interest. The following laws hold:
𝑃(𝐴 ∪ 𝐵) = 𝑃(𝐴) + 𝑃(𝐵) – 𝑃(𝐴 ∩ 𝐵).
When 𝐴 and 𝐵 are mutually exclusive events, 𝑃(𝐴 ∪ 𝐵) = 𝑃(𝐴) + 𝑃(𝐵).
When 𝐴 and 𝐵 are independent events, 𝑃(𝐴 ∩ 𝐵) = 𝑃(𝐴) 𝑃(𝐵).
𝑃(𝐴′) = 1 – 𝑃(𝐴).
EVOLVENT: An evolvent is a region in the plane that is isometric to a given region on a
developable surface. Example: The evolvent of the side surface of a cone cut along a
generator is a planar sector. The approximate construction of an evolvent can be
achieved graphically by means of descriptive geometry.
EXACT DIFFERENTIAL: If 𝑧 = 𝑓(𝑥, 𝑦) is a function of two independent variables then
𝜕𝑧 𝜕𝑧
𝑑𝑧 = 𝑑𝑥 + 𝑑𝑦
𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑥
is the exact differential. For a function of more than two variables the exact differential
will have similar partial derivative terms for each of its independent variables.
EXACT DIFFERENTIAL EQUATION: An equation in which the exact differential of a
function is equal to zero. If 𝑧 = 𝑓(𝑥, 𝑦) then
𝜕𝑧 𝜕𝑧
𝑑𝑥 + 𝑑𝑦 = 0
𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑥
is an exact differential equation.
EXACT DIVISOR: An exact divisor of a number is a factor of a given number. e.g. 7 is an
exact divisor of 35.
EXACT HOMOMORPHISM: Let 𝑹 be a unital ring, let 𝑭, 𝑮 and 𝑯 be 𝑹-modules, and let
𝒑: 𝑭 → 𝑮 and 𝒒: 𝑮 → 𝑯 be 𝑹-module homomorphisms. The sequence 𝑭(𝒑) −→
𝑮(𝒒) −→ 𝑯 of modules and homomorphisms is said to be exact at 𝑮 if and only if
𝒊𝒎𝒂𝒈𝒆 (𝒑: 𝑭 → 𝑮) = 𝒌𝒆𝒓(𝒒: 𝑮 → 𝑯). A sequence of modules and homomorphisms is
said to be exact if it is exact at each module occurring in the sequence (so that the image
of each homomorphism is the kernel of the succeeding homomorphism). A
monomorphism is an injective homomorphism. An epimorphism is a surjective
homomorphism. An isomorphism is a bijective homomorphism.
EXAMPLE: A particular instance of a generalized statement. A counter-example will
disprove a generalized claim, but examples do not provide proof. EXCELLENT RING: A
commutative Noetherian ring satisfying the three axioms stated below. It is known that
a geometric ring possesses several qualitative properties not inherent in arbitrary
Noetherian rings. The concept of an excellent ring makes it possible to take the most
important properties of geometric rings axiomatically into account.
A1: The ring 𝐴 is a universal chain ring. (A ring 𝐴 is said to be a chain ring if for any two
prime ideals 𝑃 ≠ 𝑃′ of it the lengths of any two saturated chains 𝑃 = 𝑃0 ⊆ 𝑃1 ⊆
𝑃2 … … … ⊆ 𝑃𝑛 = 𝑃′ of prime ideals are the same. A ring 𝐴 is said to be a universal
chain ring if any polynomial ring 𝐴[𝑇1 , 𝑇2 , … … … , 𝑇𝑘 ] is a chain ring.)
A2: The formal fibres of 𝐴 are geometrically regular, i.e. for any prime ideal 𝑃 ⊂ 𝐴 and
any homomorphism from 𝐴 into a field 𝐾, the ring 𝐴𝑝 ⨂𝑘 𝐾 is regular. Here 𝐴𝑝 is the
completion of the local ring 𝐴𝑝 .
A3: For any integral finite 𝐴 -algebra there is a non-zero element 𝑏 ∇ 𝐵 such that the
ring of fractions, 𝐵[𝑏 −1 ], is regular.
1) For an excellent ring 𝐴, the set of regular (normal) points of the scheme 𝑆𝑝𝑒𝑐 𝐴 is
open.
3) The integral closure of an excellent ring 𝐴 in a finite extension of the field of fractions
of 𝐴 is a finite 𝐴 -algebra.
4) If a ring 𝐴 is excellent, then any 𝐴 -algebra of finite type is also an excellent ring.
Two important examples of excellent rings are the complete local rings (or analytic
rings) and the Dedekind rings with field of fractions of characteristic zero. Therefore,
the class of excellent rings is sufficiently large and contains, in particular, all algebras of
finite type over a field or over the ring 𝑍 of integers.
EXCEPTIONAL ANALYTIC SET: An analytic set in a complex space 𝑿 for which there
exists an analytic mapping 𝒇: 𝑿 → 𝒀 such that 𝒇(𝑨) → 𝒀 is a point in the complex
space 𝒀, while 𝒇: 𝑿 − 𝑨 → 𝒀 − 𝒚 is an analytic isomorphism. The modification 𝒇 is
called a contraction of 𝑨 to 𝒚.
EXCLUSIVE DISJUNCTION: The proposition 𝐴 ∨ ˙𝐵, obtained from two
propositions 𝐴 and 𝐵 using the exclusive disjunction ∨ ˙, is taken to be true if 𝐴 is true
and 𝐵 is false, or if 𝐴 is false and 𝐵 is true. In the remaining cases it is taken to be false.
Thus, the exclusive disjunction can be expressed in terms of the ordinary (non-
exclusive) disjunction by the formula
𝐴 ∨ ˙𝐵 ⇔ (𝐴 ∨ 𝐵)&¬(𝐴 ∧ 𝐵).
EXPECTED VALUE: The expected value 𝐸(𝑋) of a random variable 𝑋 is a value that gives
the mean value of the distribution, and is defined as follows. For a discrete random
variable 𝑋, 𝐸(𝑋) = 𝛴 𝑝𝑖 𝑥𝑖 , where 𝑝𝑖 = 𝑃 (𝑋 = 𝑥𝑖 ). For a continuous random variable
𝑋,
∞
𝐸 𝑥 = 𝑥𝑓 𝑥 𝑑𝑥
−∞
A process which changes by a fixed factor over a fixed time period: exponential
growth or decay.
Such a module 𝑋 always exists (for example, the direct sum of 𝐴 and 𝐵), but need not be
uniquely determined by 𝐴 and 𝐵.
EXTENSION OF AN OPERATOR: A linear operator whose graph contains the graph of the
given linear operator. When the operator 𝑩 is an extension of a given operator 𝑨, one
writes 𝑨 ⊂ 𝑩. The usual problems in the theory of extensions are as follows: extend an
operator maximally while preserving a specific property, or study extensions of an
operator having various additional properties.
For example, let 𝐴 be a given isometric operator on a Hilbert space 𝐻 with domain of
definition 𝐷(𝐴) ⊂ 𝐻 and range of values 𝑅(𝐴) ⊂ 𝐻; then the isometric extensions
of 𝐴 are in one-to-one correspondence with the isometric mappings from 𝐻+ =
𝐷(𝐴)⊥ to 𝐻− = 𝑅(𝐴)⊥ . In particular, 𝐴 has unitary extensions if the dimensions
of 𝐻+and 𝐻− coincide.
1 𝑓(𝑧) 1 𝑓(𝑧)
𝑓 𝑎 = ∫𝐶 𝑑𝑧 − ∫𝐶 𝑑𝑧
2𝜋𝑖 2 𝑧 − 𝑎 2𝜋𝑖 1 𝑧 − 𝑎
𝐽= 𝐹 𝑥, 𝑦1 , 𝑦2 , … … … , 𝑦𝑛 , 𝑦 ′ , … … … , 𝑦𝑛′ 𝑑𝑥
⌌𝐴⌍
where 𝐴 and 𝐵 are the initial and final points through which the extremals of the family
pass. One must distinguish between proper (or general) and central extremal fields. A
proper extremal field corresponds to the case when the extremals of the family are
transversal to some surface
𝜑 𝑥, 𝑦1 , 𝑦2 , … … … , 𝑦𝑛 = 0.
For a proper extremal field the point 𝐴 (or 𝐵) in (1) belongs to the surface (2) and the
condition (3) is satisfied at it.
A central extremal field corresponds to the case when the extremals of the family
emanate from one point lying outside the field, for example, from a common initial
point 𝐴. The slope of an extremal field is the vector-function
𝑢 𝑥, 𝑦 = (𝑢1 𝑥, 𝑦 , … … … , 𝑢𝑛 𝑥, 𝑦 associating with every point
𝑥, 𝑦 = (𝑥, 𝑦1 , 𝑦2 , … … … , 𝑦𝑛 ) of the field the vector 𝑦 𝑥 = (𝑦1′ 𝑥 , … … … . 𝑦𝑛′ 𝑥 ).
The method of the extremal metric has various forms. The original one is Grötzsch's
strip method, which is an essential refinement of the arguments connecting length and
area, operating with the characteristic conformal invariants of doubly-connected
domains and quadrangles. Using his strip method, H. Grötzsch obtained a number of
classical results in the theory of conformal and quasi-conformal mappings
Mathematically, a point is a extreme point of a convex set if there do not exist other
points 𝑥1 ,𝑥2 (𝑥1 ≠ 𝑥2 ) in the set , such that
𝑥 = 𝜆𝑐1 + 1 − 𝜆 𝑥2 , 0 ≤ 𝜆 ≤ 1
EXTREMUM: A point at which a function has a turning point, i.e. at least a local
maximum or minimum. An extremum is a point where a function attains a maximum or
minimum. This article will consider only functions that are continuous and
differentiable. A global maximum is the point where a function attains its highest value.
A local maximum is a point where the value of the function is higher than the
surrounding points. Similar definitions apply to minimum points. Both local maximum
and local minimum points can be found by determining where the curve has a
horizontal tangent, which means that the derivative is zero at that point. If the first
derivative is zero and the second derivative is positive, then the curve is concave up,
and the point is a minimum.
F
FACTORIAL NOTATION: The notation, 𝑛!, used to represent the product of the first n
natural numbers.
FACTORIAL RING: A ring with unique decomposition into factors. More precisely, a
factorial ring 𝑨 is an integral domain in which one can find a system of irreducible
elements 𝑷 such that every non-zero element 𝒂 ∇ 𝑨 admits a unique representation
𝒂=𝒖 𝒑𝒏(𝒑)
𝒑∇𝑷
where 𝑢 is invertible and the non-negative integral exponents 𝑛(𝑝) are non-zero for
only a finite number of elements 𝑝 ∇ 𝑃. Here an element is called irreducible
in 𝐴 if 𝑝 = 𝑢𝑣 implies that either 𝑢 or 𝑣 is invertible in 𝐴, and 𝑝 is not invertible in 𝐴.
FACTOR THEOREM: Suppose that 𝑓(𝑥) represents a polynomial in 𝑥. The factor theorem
says that, if 𝑓 𝑎 = 0, then (𝑥 − 𝑎) is one of the factors of 𝑓(𝑥).
FACTOR SPACE: If 𝑋 is a vector space and 𝑀 is a subspace of 𝑋, then 𝑋/𝑀 is a vector
space, called the factor space (or the quotient space) of 𝑋 with respect to 𝑀.
FAMILY OF CURVES: A set of similar curves which are of the same form and
distinguished by the values taken by one or more parameters in their general equation.
In particular, where the solution of a differential equation is obtained, the general
solution will involve one or more constants of integration, giving rise to a family of
curves. A particular member of the family may be identified as the required solution if
boundary conditions are known.
∫ 𝑓𝑛 𝑑µ ≤ 𝐶 for all 𝑛;
𝑎. 𝑒
𝑓𝑛 𝑓.,
→
kernel.
For example, the primes 5, 13, 17, 29 and 37 are all congruent to 1 modulo 4,
and they can be expressed as sums of two squares in the following ways:
FERRARI METHOD: The Ferrari method is a method for reducing the solution of an
equation of degree 4 over the complex numbers to the solution of one cubic and two
quadratic equations; it was discovered by L. Ferrari.
𝑦 4 + 𝑎𝑦 3 + 𝑏𝑦 2 + 𝑐𝑦 + 𝑑 = 0
consists in the following. By the substitution 𝑦 = 𝑥 − 𝑎/4 the given equation can be
reduced to
𝑥 4 + 𝑝𝑥 2 + 𝑞𝑥 + 𝑟 = 0, (1)
𝑝2
𝑥 4 + 𝑝𝑥 2 + 𝑞𝑥 + 𝑟 = (𝑥 2 + 𝑝2 + 𝛼)2 − [2𝛼𝑥 2 − 𝑞𝑥 + (𝛼 2 + 𝑝𝛼 + − 𝑟)]. (2)
4
One then chooses a value of α such that the quadratic trinomial in square brackets is a
perfect square. For this the discriminant of the quadratic trinomial must vanish. This
gives a cubic equation for 𝛼,
𝑝2
𝑞 2 − 4 ⋅ 2𝛼(𝛼 2 + 𝑝𝛼 + − 𝑟) = 0.
4
Let α0 be one of the roots of this equation. For 𝛼 = 𝛼0 the polynomial in square brackets
in (2) has one double root,
𝑞
𝑥0 = ,
4𝛼0
which leads to the equation
(𝑥 2 + 𝑝2 + 𝛼0 )2 − 2𝛼0 (𝑥 − 𝑥0 )2 = 0.
This equation of degree 4 splits into two quadratic equations. The roots of these
equations are also the roots of (1).
However, occasionally you need to be very careful. For example in 𝔽2 we have 1+1=0,
and so it is not possible to divide by 2 in this field.
𝓵
𝑐𝑜𝑠𝜋𝑆𝑡
𝐹𝑐 𝑓 𝑡 = 𝑓 𝑡 𝑑𝑡; 𝑠 𝜖 𝑁
𝟎 ℓ
𝓵
𝜋𝑆𝑡
𝐹𝑠 𝑓 𝑡 = 𝑓 𝑡 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝑑𝑡; 𝑠 𝜖 𝑁
𝟎 ℓ
FINITE INTERSECTION PROPERTY: A space has the finite intersection property when
every family of closed subsets such that all finite sub collections have non-empty
intersections means that the entire family also has a non-empty intersection. It can be
shown that this property is equivalent to the space being compact.
FINITELY GENERATED ABELIAN GROUPS: The theory of finitely generated Abelian
groups, i.e., Abelian groups generated by a finite number of elements, is as old as that of
finite Abelian groups. The direct product of infinite cyclic groups is called a free Abelian
group. A finitely generated Abelian group G is the direct product of a finite Abelian
group and a free Abelian group. The finite factor is the torsion subgroup of G. The free
factor of the group G is not necessarily unique; however, the number of infinite cyclic
factors of the free factor is uniquely determined and is called the rank of G. Two finitely
generated Abelian groups are isomorphic if they have isomorphic maximal torsion
subgroups and the same rank.
FINITELY GENERATED IDEAL: An ideal 𝑰 of the ring 𝑹 is said to be finitely generated if
there exists a finite subset of 𝑹 which generates the ideal 𝑰. Every ideal of the ring 𝒁 of
integers is generated by some non-negative integer 𝒏.
FINITE MATHEMATICS: The branch of mathematics concerned with the study of
properties of structures of finite character, that arise both within mathematics and in
applications. Among these structures one has, e.g., finite groups, finite graphs, and also
certain mathematical models of information processing, finite automata, Turing
machines, etc.. Sometimes the subject of finite mathematics is assumed to extend to
arbitrary discrete structures, and this leads to discrete mathematics, identifying the
latter with finite mathematics. Certain algebraic systems, infinite graphs, definite forms
of computing schemes, cellular automata, etc., can be regarded as belonging to this area.
The term discrete analysis sometimes serves as a synonym for the concepts of "finite
mathematics" and "discrete mathematics" .
FINITE RANK OPERATOR: Let 𝑋 and 𝑌 be normed spaces, 𝑇 ∇ 𝐵 𝑋, 𝑌 is a finite rank
operator if 𝐼𝑚 𝑇 is a finite dimensional subspace of 𝑌.
FINITE SEQUENCE: A sequence that has a last term.
FINSLER MANIFOLD: A Finsler manifold allows the definition of distance but does not
require the concept of angle; it is an analytic manifold in which each tangent space is
equipped with a norm, || · ||, in a manner which varies smoothly from point to point.
This norm can be extended to a metric, defining the length of a curve; but it cannot in
general be used to define an inner product. Any Riemannian manifold is a Finsler
manifold.
FIRST-COUNTABLE SPACES: The space (𝑋, 𝑇) is first countable if each point has a
countable base of neighborhoods, i.e., for each point 𝑝 in 𝑋 there is a countable
collection of open sets such that each neighborhood of 𝑝 contains at least one of them,
for all 𝑝 ∇ 𝑋 : ∃ {𝑂𝑛 | 𝑛 ∇ 𝐍, 𝑂𝑛 ∇ 𝑇 for all 𝑛}, such that for all 𝑈, 𝑝 ∇ 𝑈 ∇
𝑇 : ∃ 𝑂𝑛 ⊂ 𝑈 . All metric spaces are first countable (the countable bases of
neighborhoods are the balls of radius 1/𝑛).
is 𝑑𝑢, 𝑑𝑣 is called metric or first fundamental form of the surface and the quantities
𝐸, 𝐹, 𝐺 are called first fundamental coefficients or first order fundamental magnitudes.
Since 𝐸, 𝐹 and 𝐺 are functions of 𝑢, 𝑣 the quantities will generally vary form point to
point on the surface.
FIXED POINTS: The points which coincide with their transformation are called invariant
or fixed points of the transformation that is to say, fixed points of a transformation
𝑤 = 𝑓(𝑧) are obtained by the equation 𝑧 = 𝑓 𝑧 .
FIXED POINT THEOREM: Any theorem which gives conditions, under which a mapping
must have a fixed point, is known as Fixed point theorem. They have been important in
the development of mathematical economics.
FLOOR: For a real number 𝑟, its floor value [𝑟] is defined as the largest integer not
greater than 𝑟. Thus [5] = [5.1] = 5 and [−5] = −5 while [−5.1] = −6. A more recent
notation ⌊𝑟⌋ allows to distinguish with another frequently used function - ceiling -
⌈𝑟⌉ which is defined as the smallest integer not less than 𝑟.
𝑑𝑥
FLOQUET'S THEOREM: Let 𝑑𝑡 = 𝐴 𝑡 𝑥 be a linear first order differential equation,
FLOQUET THEORY: A theory concerning the structure of the space of solutions, and the
properties of solutions, of a linear system of differential equations with periodic
coefficients
𝒙′ = 𝑨 𝒕 𝒙; 𝒕 ∇ 𝑹, 𝒙 ∇ 𝑹𝒏 (𝟏)
the matrix 𝐴(𝑡) is periodic in 𝑡 with period 𝜔 > 0 and is summable on every compact
interval in 𝑅.
𝑋 𝑡 = 𝐹 𝑡 exp
(𝑡𝐾)
called the Floquet representation, where 𝐹 𝑡 is some 𝜔-periodic matrix and 𝐾 is some
constant matrix. There is a basis 𝑥1 , 𝑥2 , … … … , 𝑥𝑛 of the space of solutions of (1) such
that 𝐾 has Jordan form in this basis; this basis can be represented in the form
where 𝜓𝑘𝑖 are polynomials in 𝑡 with 𝜔-periodic coefficients, and the 𝛼𝑖 are the
characteristic exponents of the system (1). Every component of a solution of (1) is a
linear combination of functions of the form (of the Floquet solutions) 𝜓𝑘𝑖 exp( 𝛼𝑖 𝑡). In
the case when all the characteristic exponents are distinct, the 𝜓𝑘𝑖 are simply 𝜔-
periodic functions. The matrices 𝐹(𝑡) and 𝐾 in the representation (2) are, generally
speaking, complex valued. If one restricts oneself just to the real case, then 𝐹(𝑡) does
not have to be 𝜔-periodic, but must be 2𝜔-periodic.
FLUID: By definition, a fluid cannot withstand any tendency for applied forces to deform
it in such a way that volume is left unchanged. Such deformation may be resisted, but
not prevented, by a fluid. Ordinary gases and liquids are fluids.
FOCI “Foci” is the plural of “focus.”
FOCUS (1) A parabola is the set of points that are the same distance from a fixed point
(the focus) and a fixed line (the directrix). The focus, or focal point, is important
because starlight striking a parabolically shaped telescope mirror will be reflected back
to the focus.
(2) An ellipse is the set points such that the sum of the distances to two fixed points is a
constant. The two points are called foci. Planetary orbits are shaped like ellipses, with
the sun at one focus.
FOCUS OF A CURVE :A point 𝑭 lying in the plane of the second-order curve such that the
ratio of the distance of any point of the curve from 𝑭 to its distance from a given line
(the directrix) is equal to a constant (the eccentricity). The foci of a second-order curve
can be defined as the points of intersection of the tangents to that curve from
the circular points of the plane. This definition can also be extended to algebraic curves
of order 𝒏.
FOL: It is the abbreviation for first-order logic.
FOREST: A forest is an acyclic graph.
FORT’S THEOREM: If f is discontinuous at the points of a dense set, show that the set of
points x, where f′(x) exists, is of the first category.
FORWARD DIFFERENCE: If {(𝑥𝑖 , 𝑓𝑖 )}, 𝑖 = 0, 1, 2, … is a given set of function values with
𝑥𝑖+1 = 𝑥𝑖 + , 𝑓𝑖 = 𝑓(𝑥𝑖 ) then the forward difference at 𝑓𝑖 is defined by 𝑓𝑖+1 – 𝑓𝑖 =
𝑓 𝑥𝑖+1 − 𝑓(𝑥𝑖 ).
FOURIER INTEGRAL FORMULA: Let 𝑓 𝑥 be a function satisfying Dirichlet’s Conditions
∞
and is absolutely integrable in −∞ ∞ i.e. ∫−∞ f x dx converges,
∞
Then 𝑓 𝑥 = ∫0 𝐹 𝑠 cos 𝑠 𝑥 + 𝐺 𝑠 sin 𝑠 𝑥 𝑑𝑠
∞ ∞
Where 𝜋 𝐹 𝑠 = ∫−∞ f w cos s w dw, π G s = ∫−∞ f w sin s w dw
Also then 𝑓 𝑥 can be re-written as
∞ ∞ ∞
1 1
𝑓 𝑥 = 𝑓 𝑤 cos 𝑠 𝑤 𝑑𝑤 cos 𝑠 𝑥 + 𝑓 𝑤 sin 𝑠 𝑤 𝑑𝑤 sin 𝑠 𝑥 𝑑𝑠
0 𝜋 −∞ 𝜋 −∞
𝑠=∞ 𝑤=∞
1
= 𝑓 𝑤 cos 𝑠 𝑤 cos 𝑠 𝑥 + sin 𝑠 𝑤 sin 𝑠𝑥 𝑑𝑤 𝑑𝑠
𝜋 𝑠=0 𝑤=−∞
𝑠=∞ 𝑤=∞
1
= 𝑓 𝑤 cos 𝑠 𝑥 − 𝑤 𝑑𝑤 𝑑𝑠
𝜋 𝑠=0 𝑤=−∞
𝑠=∞ 𝑤=∞
1
= 𝑓 𝑤 cos 𝑠 𝑥 − 𝑤 𝑑𝑤 𝑑𝑠
2𝜋 𝑠= −∞ 𝑤=−∞
of Fourier series. As for Fourier series, the above conditions are necessary but not
sufficient.
∞
Also ∫0 𝐹 𝑠 cos 𝑠 𝑥 + 𝐺 𝑠 sin 𝑠 𝑥 𝑑𝑠 is known as Fourier integral expansion of 𝑓 𝑥
or simply Fourier integral.
1 ∞ ∞
(A) 𝑓 𝑥 = ∫−∞ 𝑓 𝑤 ∫0 cos 𝑠 𝑥 − 𝑤 𝑑𝑠 𝑑𝑤 is known as General Form
𝜋
2 ∞ ∞
(B) 𝑓 𝑥 = ∫0 sin 𝑠 𝑥 ∫0 𝑓 𝑤 sin 𝑠 𝑤 𝑑𝑤 𝑑𝑠 is known as Fourier sine
𝜋
The derivation of theses coefficients requires some knowledge about the orthogonality
properties of the trigonometric functions. The main properties that we need are given
by the following integrals,
𝐿 𝒏𝝅
∫−𝐿 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝑳
𝒙𝑑𝑥 = 0
𝐿 𝒏𝝅
∫−𝐿 𝑐𝑜𝑠 𝑳
𝒙𝑑𝑥 = 0, 𝑚 ≠ 0
𝐿 𝑚𝝅 𝒏𝝅
∫−𝐿 𝑐𝑜𝑠 𝑳
𝒙𝑐𝑜𝑠 𝑳
𝒙𝑑𝑥 = 0, 𝑖𝑓 𝑚 ≠ 𝑛
𝐿 𝑚𝝅 𝒏𝝅
∫−𝐿 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝑳
𝒙𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝑳
𝒙𝑑𝑥 = 0, 𝑖𝑓 𝑚 ≠ 𝑛
𝐿 𝑚𝝅 𝒏𝝅
∫−𝐿 𝑐𝑜𝑠 𝑳
𝒙𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝑳
𝒙𝑑𝑥 = 0,
𝐿 𝒏𝝅 𝐿 𝒏𝝅
∫−𝐿 𝑠𝑖𝑛2 𝑳
𝒙𝑑𝑥 = ∫−𝐿 𝑐𝑜𝑠 2 𝑳
𝒙𝑑𝑥 = 𝐿
𝐹 𝑦 = 𝑓(𝑥)𝑒 𝑖𝑦𝑥 𝑑𝑥
−∞
is called the Fourier transformation. The function 𝐹 is said to be the Fourier transform
of the function 𝑓. Let 𝑓 𝑡 be a function defined and piecewise continuous on −∞ ∞
∞
and is absolutely convergent on −∞ ∞ i.e. ∫−∞ 𝒇 t dt converges. Then Fourier
transform of 𝑓 𝑡 , denoted by
∞
𝐹 𝑓 𝑡 and is defined as 𝐹 𝑓 𝑡 = ∫−∞ 𝒇 𝒕 ei s t dt = G s say
𝑓 𝑡 = 𝐹 −1 𝐺 𝑠 ,
and defined as
∞
1
𝑓 𝑡 = G s
2𝜋 −∞
𝑒 −𝑎 𝑡 𝑔 𝑡 , 𝑡 > 0
𝑓 𝑡 =
0, 𝑡<0
∞
= 𝒇 𝒕 ei b t dt
−∞
𝟎 ∞
ibt
= 𝒇 𝒕 e dt + 𝒇 𝒕 ei b t dt
−∞ −∞
𝟎 ∞
= 𝟎. ei b t dt + e−at g t ei b t dt
−∞ 𝟎
∞
= 0+ e− −a−i b t g t dt
𝟎
∞
= 𝑒 −𝑠 𝑡 g t dt, where s = a − i b
𝟎
=𝐿 𝑔 𝑡 = 𝐿𝑎𝑝𝑙𝑎𝑐𝑒 𝑡𝑟𝑎𝑛𝑠𝑓𝑜𝑟𝑚 𝑜𝑓 𝑔 𝑡 .
FOUR SQUARES THEOREM: Any positive integer can be expressed as the sum of not
more than four positive integers.
FOUR-VERTEX THEOREM: Four-vertex theorem states that the curvature function of a
simple, closed, smooth plane curve has at least four local extrema (specifically, at least
two local maxima and at least two local minima). The name of the theorem derives from
the convention of calling an extreme point of the curvature function a vertex.
FRACTION: A fraction is a rational number expressed in the form 𝑛/𝑑, where 𝑛 is
designated the numerator and 𝑑 the denominator. The slash between them is known as
a solidus when the fraction is expressed as 𝑛/𝑑. If 𝑛/𝑑 < 1, then 𝑛/𝑑 is known as a
proper fraction. Otherwise, it is an improper fraction. If 𝑛 and 𝑑 are relatively prime,
then 𝑛/𝑑 is said to be in lowest terms. To get a fraction in lowest terms, simply divide
the numerator and the denominator by their greatest common divisor.
FRACTIONAL IDEAL: A fractional ideal of 𝑅 is a subset of the field 𝐾 of fractions of 𝑅 that
is of the form 𝑐𝐼, where 𝑐 is a non-zero element of 𝐾 and 𝐼 is an ideal of 𝑅. A fractional
ideal of 𝑅 is not an ideal of 𝑅 unless it is contained in 𝑅. If 𝑅 is not itself a field, then the
field 𝐾 of fractions of 𝐾 will contain fractional ideals of 𝑅 that are not ideals of 𝑅. Indeed,
given any element 𝑐 of 𝐾 \ 𝑅, the subset 𝑐𝑅 of 𝐾 is a fractional ideal of 𝐾, where
𝑐𝑅 = {𝑐𝑟 ∶ 𝑟 ∇ 𝑅}, but it is not an ideal of 𝑅. However any fractional ideal of 𝑅 that is
contained in 𝑅 is an ideal of 𝑅.
FREDHOLM EQUATION, NUMERICAL METHODS: Approximation methods for solving
Fredholm integral equations of the second kind, amounting to performing a finite
number of operations on numbers.
Let
𝜑 𝑥 − 𝜆 ∫ 𝐾 𝑥, 𝑠 𝜙 𝑠 𝑑𝑠 = 𝑓(𝑥) (1)
Similarly, the orthogonal complement of the column space of 𝑀 is the null space of the
adjoint:
FREE AND BOUND VARIABLES: Any function whose values are propositions is called a
propositional function. ∀𝑥 and ∃𝑥 can be regarded as operators that transform any
propositional function 𝐹(𝑥) into the propositions ∀𝑥𝐹(𝑥) and ∃𝑥𝐹(𝑥), respectively.
∀𝑥 and ∃𝑥 are called quantifiers; the former is called the universal quantifier and the
latter the existential quantifier. F(x) is transformed into ∀𝑥𝐹(𝑥) or ∃𝑥𝐹(𝑥) just as a
1
function 𝑓(𝑥) is transformed into the definite integral ∫0 𝑓(𝑥)𝑑𝑥; the resultant
propositions ∀𝑥𝐹(𝑥) and ∃𝑥𝐹(𝑥) are no longer functions of 𝑥. The variable 𝑥 in∀𝑥𝐹(𝑥)
and in ∃𝑥𝐹(𝑥) is called a bound variable, and the variable 𝑥 in 𝐹(𝑥), when it is not
bound by ∀𝑥 or ∃𝑥, is called a free variable.
FREE BASIS OF A MODULE: Let 𝑴 be a module over a unital commutative ring 𝑹.
Elements 𝒙𝟏 , 𝒙𝟐 , . . . , 𝒙𝒌 of 𝑴 are said to constitute a free basis of 𝑴 if these elements are
distinct, and if the 𝑹-module 𝑴 is freely generated by the set {𝒙𝟏 , 𝒙𝟐 , . . . , 𝒙𝒌 }.
FREE BOOLEAN ALGEBRA: A Boolean algebra with a system of generators such that
every mapping from this system into a Boolean algebra can be extended to a
homomorphism. Every Boolean algebra is isomorphic to a quotient algebra of some free
Boolean algebra.
For any cardinal number 𝛼 there is a unique (up to an isomorphism) free Boolean
algebra with 𝛼 generators. A finite Boolean algebra is free if and only if its number of
𝑛
elements is of the form 2𝑛 , where 𝑛 is the number of generators. Such a free Boolean
algebra is realized as the algebra of Boolean functions of 𝑛 variables. A countable free
Boolean algebra is isomorphic to the algebra of open-closed subsets of the Cantor set.
Every set of pairwise-disjoint elements of a free Boolean algebra is finite or countable.
An infinite free Boolean algebra cannot be complete. On the other hand, the cardinality
of any infinite complete Boolean algebra is the least upper bound of the cardinalities of
its free subalgebras.
FREE GROUP: A group 𝐹 with a system 𝑋 of generating elements such that any mapping
from 𝑋 into an arbitrary group 𝐺 can be extended to a homomorphism from 𝐹 into 𝐺.
Such a system 𝑋 is called a system of free generators; its cardinality is called the rank
of . The set 𝑋 is also called an alphabet. The elements of 𝐹 are words over the
alphabet 𝑋.
In other terms, Groups have generators, such elements that all other elements of a
group could be obtained from generators and their inverses using the group operation.
A group is said to be free if no relation exists between its generators other than between
an element and its inverse. The additive group of integers is free with a single generator
1. The multiplicative group of all positive rational numbers has prime numbers as its
generators. From the Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic representation of integers in
the form 𝑝𝑎 𝑞 𝑏 . . . 𝑟 𝑐 where 𝑝, 𝑞, . . . , 𝑟 are all different primes, is unique. Therefore the
group is free.
FREE MODULE: A module over a unital commutative ring is said to be free if there exists
some subset of the module which freely generates the module.
W = i g i x = 0, and g i is concave at x
FRITZ JOHN STATIONARY- POINT PROBLEM (FJP): The Fritz John stationary- point
problem means to find x ∇ X 0 , r0 ∇ Rm if they exist, such that ∆x ∅ x, r0 , r = 0,
∆r ∅ x, r0 , r ≤ 0, r∆r ∅ x, r0 , r = 0, r0 , r ≥ 0 and ∅ x, r0 , r = r0 ∅ x) + rg(x or
equivalently, r0 ∆θ x) + r ∆g(x = 0, g(x) ≤ 0, r g x = 0, (r0 , r) ≥ 0.
the length of the part of a generator between the top and bottom of the frustum. Then
the area of the curved surface of the frustum equals 𝜋 (𝑎 + 𝑏)𝑙.
F-SIGMA: In a topological space 𝑿, a subset which is the countable union of closed sets.
FUBINI'S THEOREM: Suppose 𝑋 and 𝑌 are measure spaces, and suppose that 𝑋 × 𝑌 is
given the maximal product measure (which is the only product measure if 𝑋 and 𝑌 are
𝜍-finite). Fubini's theorem states that if 𝑓(𝑥, 𝑦) is 𝑋 × 𝑌 integrable, meaning that it is
measurable and
then
The first two integrals are iterated integrals with respect to two measures, respectively,
and the third is an integral with respect to the maximal product of these two measures.
FUNCTIONAL ANALYSIS: The part of modern mathematical analysis in which the basic
purpose is to study functions 𝒚 = 𝒇(𝒙) for which at least one of the
variables 𝒙 or 𝒚 varies over an infinite-dimensional space. In its most general form such
a study falls into three parts:
1) the introduction and study of infinite-dimensional spaces as such;
2) the study of the simplest functions, namely, when takes values in an infinite-
dimensional space and in a one-dimensional space (these are called functionals,
whence the name "functional analysis" ); and
3) the study of general functions of the type indicated — operators.
Linear functions 𝒙 ∇ 𝑿 ⇒ 𝒇 𝒙 = 𝒚 ∇ 𝒀 , i.e. linear operators, have been most
completely studied. Their theory is essentially a generalization of linear algebra to the
infinite-dimensional case. A combination of the approaches of classical analysis and
algebra is characteristic for the methods of functional analysis, and this leads to
relations between what are at first glance very distant branches of mathematics.
FUNCTIONAL EQUATION: An equation (linear or non-linear) in which the unknown is
an element of some specific (function) or abstract Banach space, that is, an equation of
the form
𝑃 𝑥 =𝑦
𝑃 𝑥, 𝜆 = 𝑦
An integral such as above, which assume a definite value for functions of the type
𝑦 = 𝑦 𝑥 is called a functional.
FUNCTIONAL RELATION: A binary relation 𝑹 on a set 𝑨 satisfying 𝑹−𝟏 ∘ 𝑹 ⊆ 𝜟,
where 𝜟 is the diagonal of 𝑨. This means that (𝒂, 𝒃) ∇ 𝑹 and (𝒂, 𝒄) ∇ 𝑹 imply that 𝒃 = 𝒄,
that is, for each 𝒂 ∇ 𝑨 there is at most one 𝒃 ∇ 𝑨 such that (𝒂, 𝒃) ∇ 𝑹.
Thus, 𝑹 determines a function on 𝑨. When it satisfies 𝑹−𝟏 ∘ 𝑹 = 𝜟, this function is well-
defined everywhere and is one-to-one.
FUNCTION ELEMENT: An analytic function 𝑓 with domain 𝐷 is called a function element
and is denoted by 𝑓, 𝐷 .
FUNCTION FIELD ANALOGY: It was realized in the nineteenth century that the ring of
integers of a number field has analogies with the affine coordinate ring of an algebraic
curve or compact Riemann surface, with a point or more removed corresponding to the
'infinite places' of a number field. This thought is more precisely encoded in the theory
that global fields should all be treated on the same basis. The scheme goes further. Thus
elliptic surfaces over the complex numbers, also, have some quite strict analogies with
elliptic curves over number fields.
FUNCTION F SUMMABLE BY A MEASURE: A function 𝑓 is summable by a measure µ if
there is sequence (𝑓𝑛 ) ⊂ 𝑆(𝑋) such that
Note that
FUNCTIONS OF CLASS 𝒎: Let 𝐼 denote a real interval and let 𝑚 be a positive integer.
Then we say that a real-valued function 𝑓 defined on 𝐼is of class 𝑚 (or simple a Cm
function) if 𝑓 has a continuous derivative of 𝑚𝑡 order at every point 𝐼. In case 𝑓 is
differentiable an infinitely many number of times, it is said to be of class ∞ or a 𝐶 ∞ -
function. Also, the function 𝑓 is said to be analytic over 𝐼 if 𝑓 is single-valued and
possesses continuous derivatives of all orders at every point of 𝐼. An analytic function is
said to be of class ω or simply a 𝐶 ∞ - function.
FUNCTION THEORY: A branch of mathematics in which one studies the general
properties of functions. Function theory splits into two parts: the theory of functions of
a real variable and the theory of functions of a complex variable.
FUNDAMENTAL AXIOM OF ANALYSIS: If 𝑎1 , 𝑎2 , . ..is an increasing sequence in 𝑅 and
there exists an 𝐴 ∇ 𝑅 such that 𝑎𝑛 ≤ 𝐴 for all 𝑛, then there exists an 𝑎 ∇ 𝑅 such that
𝑎𝑛 → 𝑎 𝑎𝑠 𝑛 → ∞.
FUNDAMENTAL COUNTING PRINCIPLE: It is defined as the law for determining the
number of ways two or more operations can be performed together. If one operation
can be performed in 𝑚 ways and a second in 𝑛 ways, together they can be performed in
𝑚𝑛 ways.
FUNDAMENTAL MATRIX: The transition matrix 𝑋(𝑡) of solutions of a system of linear
ordinary differential equations
𝑥 = 𝐴 𝑡 𝑥; 𝑥 ∇ 𝑅 𝑛
normalized at the point 𝑡0 . The fundamental matrix is the unique continuous solution of
the matrix initial value problem
𝑋 = 𝐴 𝑡 𝑋; 𝑋 𝑡0 = 1
𝑓𝑛 − 𝑓𝑛 +𝑚 < 𝜀, 𝑚 ≥ 0.
Whenever 𝑛 ≥ 𝑁 𝜀 .
𝑓 𝑥 𝑑𝑥 = 𝜑 𝑏 − 𝜑(𝑎)
𝑎
Where 𝜅 is some function of 𝑢, 𝑣 called the Gaussian Curvature and 𝜅𝑔 is the geodesic
curvature of the arcs.
GAUSS, CARL FRIEDRICH GAUSS: Carl Friedrich Gauss (1777 to 1855), perhaps the
greatest pure mathematician of all time, was a German mathematician who studied
errors of measurement (so the normal curve is sometimes called the Gaussian error
curve); developed a way to construct a 17-sided regular polygon with geometric
construction; developed a law that says the electric flux over a closed surface is
proportional to the charge inside the surface and studied the theory of complex
numbers. By the age of 24, he was ready to publish his Disquisitiones arithmeticae, a
book that was to have a profound influence on the theory of numbers. In this, he proved
the Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic and the Fundamental Theorem of Algebra. In
later work, he developed the theory of curved surfaces using methods now known as
differential geometry. His work on complex functions was fundamental but, like his
discovery of non-Euclidean geometry, it was not published at the time. He introduced
what is now known to statisticians as the Gaussian distribution.
GAUSSIAN CURVATURE OF A SURFACE: The product of the principal curvatures of a
regular surface at a given point. If
𝒅𝒔𝟐 = 𝑬𝒅𝒖𝟐 + 𝟐𝑭𝒅𝒖𝒅𝒗 + 𝑮𝒅𝒗𝟐
is the first fundamental form of the surface and
is the second fundamental form of the surface, then the Gaussian curvature can be
computed by the formula
𝐿𝑁 − 𝑀2
𝐾=
𝐸𝐺 − 𝐹 2
2
GAUSSIAN FUNCTION: The function 𝑓(𝑥) = 𝑒 –𝑥 which has the property which is the
function underlying the normal distribution.
GAUSSIAN INTEGER: A complex number whose real and imaginary parts are both
integers, so 𝑧 = 𝑎 + 𝑖𝑏 is known as a Gaussian integer if 𝑎, 𝑏 ∇ 𝑍.
GAUSSIAN RING: The ring of Gaussian integers or Gauss numbers, Z[i].
GAUSS HYPERGEOMETRIC EQUATION: The differential equation
d2 y dy
𝑥 1−𝑥 2
+ 𝑐− 𝑎+𝑏+1 𝑥 − aby = 0
dx dx
GAUSS–MARKOV THEOREM: In a linear regression model in which the errors have zero
mean, are uncorrelated, and have equal variances the best linear unbiased estimators of
the coefficients are the least squares estimators. Here, ‘best’ means that it has minimum
variance amongst all linear unbiased estimators.
GAUSS MEAN VALUE THEOREM (COMPLEX ANALYSIS): If 𝑓(𝑧) is analytic in a domain 𝐷
and if the circular domain 𝑧 − 𝑧0 ≤ 𝜌 is contained in 𝐷, then
2𝜋
1
𝑓 𝑧0 = 𝑓 𝑧0 + 𝜌𝑒 𝑖𝜃 𝑑𝜃
2𝜋 0
That is to say, the value of 𝑓 𝑧 𝑎𝑡 𝑧0 is equal to the average of its value of the boundary
of the circle 𝑧 − 𝑧0 = 𝜌
GAUSS NUMBER: A complex integer 𝒂 + 𝒃𝒊, where 𝒂 and 𝒃 are arbitrary rational
integers. Geometrically, the Gauss numbers form the lattice of all points with integral
rational coordinates on the plane. Such numbers were first considered in 1832 by C.F.
Gauss in his work on biquadratic residues. He also discovered the properties of the
set 𝜞 of complex integers.
𝛤 is an integral domain; its units (i.e. divisors of the unit element) are 1, −1, 𝑖, −𝑖 and
there are no other units. One kind of primes (i.e. numbers that cannot be decomposed
into a non-trivial product) of 𝛤 (the Gaussian primes) are the numbers of the form
𝛼 = 𝑎 + 𝑏𝑖, the norms (moduli) 𝑁(𝛼) = 𝑎2 + 𝑏 2 = 𝑝 of which are rational prime
numbers 𝑝 of the form 4𝑛 + 1 or 𝑝 = 2; the other kind are rational prime numbers of
the form 4𝑛 + 3. Examples of Gaussian primes are 1 + 𝑖, 1 + 2𝑖, 3 + 4𝑖, 3, 7, etc.
Any number in 𝛤 can be uniquely decomposed into a product of primes in 𝛤, up to units
and ordering. Domains with this property are called unique factorization domains or
Gaussian rings.
In the theory of biquadratic residues the Gaussian numbers were the first simple and
important instance of an extension of the field of rational numbers.
According to the Gauss principle, "the motion of a system of material points, constrained
in an arbitrary manner, and subjected to arbitrary forces at any moment of time, takes
place in a manner which is as similar as possible to the motion that would be performed
by these points if they were free, i.e. with least-possible forcing — the measure of
forcing during the time dt being defined as the sum of the products of the mass of each
point and the square of the distance of the point from the position which it would
occupy if it were free".
GAUSS RECIPROCITY LAW: A relation connecting the values of the Legendre symbols
(𝒑/𝒒) and (𝒒/𝒑) for different odd prime numbers 𝒑 and 𝒒 . In addition to the principal
reciprocity law of Gauss for quadratic residues, which may be expressed as the relation
(𝑝𝑞)(𝑞𝑝) = (−1)(𝑝−1)/2⋅(𝑞−1)/2 ,
The reciprocity law for quadratic residues was first stated in 1772 by L. Euler. A.
Legendre in 1785 formulated the law in modern form and proved a part of it. C.F. Gauss
in 1801 was the first to give a complete proof of the law ; he also gave no less than eight
different proofs of the reciprocity law, based on various principles, during his lifetime.
Attempts to establish the reciprocity law for cubic and biquadratic residues led Gauss to
introduce the ring of Gaussian integers.
(𝑘) (𝑘−1)
(𝑘)
𝑏𝑖 − 𝑗 <𝑖 𝑎𝑖𝑗 𝑥𝑗 − 𝑗 >𝑖 𝑎𝑖𝑗 𝑥𝑗
𝑥𝑖 =
𝑎𝑖𝑗
so it uses the new values immediately they are available, unlike the Jacobi method.
GAUSS’S LEMMA: (a) Let p(x) be a polynomial with integer coefficients. Then if p(x) can
be factorized using rational numbers, p(x) can be factorized using only integers.
(b) Let 𝑔 and be polynomials with integer coefficients. If 𝑔 and are both primitive
then so is 𝑔.
GAUSS TEST: Let 𝑢𝑛 be a series of positive terms such that
𝑢𝑛 𝑎 𝑏
= 1+ +
𝑢𝑛 +1 𝑛 𝑜(𝑛2 )
Then
1. 𝑢𝑛 converges if 𝑎 > 1 or 𝑎 = 1 and 𝑏 > 1.
2. 𝑢𝑛 diverges if 𝑎 < 1 or 𝑎 = 1 and 𝑏 ≤ 1.
G-DELTA SET: In a topological space 𝑿 a subset which is the countable intersection of
open sets.
GELFAND–MAZUR LEMMA: If 𝑋 is a complex Banach division algebra, then 𝑋 is
isometrically isomorphic to 𝐶.
GENERAL ABELIAN GROUPS: An Abelian group is, in general, an extension of a torsion
group by a torsion-free group. A torsion group T is called bounded if there is an integer
𝑛 such that 𝑡 𝑛 = 1 for all 𝑡 ∇ 𝑇. Suppose there is a torsion group T. Then T is a direct
summand of an Abelian group G which contains T as its maximal torsion subgroup if
and only if T is the direct product of a divisible group and a bounded group.
GENERAL ASSOCIATIVE LAW: Let 𝑨,∗ be a semigroup, and let 𝒙, 𝒚, 𝒛 and w be elements
of A. We can use the associative property of ∗ to show that the value of a product
involving 𝒙, 𝒚, 𝒛, 𝒘 is independent of the manner in which that product is bracketed,
though it generally depends on the order in which 𝒙, 𝒚, 𝒛 and 𝒘 occur in that product
(unless that binary operation is also commutative). For example,
(𝒙 ∗ (𝒚 ∗ 𝒛)) ∗ 𝒘 = ((𝒙 ∗ 𝒚) ∗ 𝒛) ∗ 𝒘 = (𝒙 ∗ 𝒚) ∗ (𝒛 ∗ 𝒘)
= 𝒙 ∗ (𝒚 ∗ (𝒛 ∗ 𝒘)) = 𝒙 ∗ ((𝒚 ∗ 𝒛) ∗ 𝒘)
GENERALIZED ANALYTIC FUNCTION: A function 𝒘 𝒛 = 𝒖 𝒙, 𝒚 + 𝒊𝒗(𝒙, 𝒚) satisfying a
system
𝝏𝒖 𝝏𝒗 𝝏𝒚 𝝏𝒚
− + 𝒂𝒖 + 𝒃𝒗 = 𝟎, + + 𝒄𝒖 + 𝒅𝒗 = 𝟎
𝝏𝒙 𝝏𝒚 𝝏𝒙 𝝏𝒙
with real coefficients 𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐, 𝑑 that are functions of the real variables 𝑥 and 𝑦.
Φ 𝑓 ≤𝑞 𝑓 , for all 𝑓 𝜖 𝑀.
Then Φ can be extended to a linear functional Ψ defined on the whole of 𝑆, much that
Ψ ≤ 𝑞 , for every ∇ 𝑀.
where 𝑞 is the degree of the polynomial 𝑸(𝒛) and 𝑝 is the least integer satisfying the
condition
∞
1
𝑝+1
<∞
𝛼𝑘
𝑘=1
2𝜋𝑟 − 𝑙 𝜋𝐾
→
𝑟3 3
If 𝑟 is large, more than one radial geodesic may lead to the same point on the geodesic
circle, the circle may bound a non-convex region and may consist of several
components. A geodesic circle is frequently employed in studies in global geometry. A
geodesic circle in the sense of Darboux is a closed curve of constant geodesic curvature.
It is a stationary curve for the isoperimetric problem. It coincides with an ordinary
geodesic circle on surfaces of constant curvature.
GEODESIC CO-ORDINATES: If the parametric curves are orthogonal and one of the
families of parametric curves is geodesic then the co-ordinates of the any point on the
surface are called a set of geodesic co-ordinates. Since one of the parametric curves is
assumed to be geodesic and other is arbitrary therefore the geodesic co-ordinate can be
introduced in an arbitrary number of ways.
GEODESIC (TENSORS): We have ds 2 = g ij dx i dx j . The length of are from the point P0(t0)
to the point P1(t1) is given by
1/2
t dx i dx j
s = ∫t 1 g ij dt.
0 dt dt
Consider all the curves passing through two fixed point P0 and P1. If any of these curves
for which the distance P0P1 measured along the curve is stationary, then that curve is
called geodesic.
GEODESIC TRIANGLE: A figure consisting of three different points together with the
pairwise-connecting geodesic lines. The points are known as the vertices, while the
geodesic lines are known as the sides of the triangle. A geodesic triangle can be
considered in any space in which geodesics exist. If the sides of a geodesic triangle
situated in a region homeomorphic to an open disc constitute a simply-closed contour,
then the interior domain is added to the geodesic triangle. On a regular surface the sum
of the angles of a geodesic triangle minus π (the excess of the triangle) is equal to the
total curvature of the interior region.
Given a geodesic triangle in a metric space, a plane triangle with the same side lengths is
often considered. This makes it possible to introduce various concepts of an angle
between two shortest lines in metric spaces. In the two-dimensional case, after an angle
measurement has been introduced, it is possible to introduce the total curvature as a set
function expressed in terms of the excess of geodesic triangles. Nets of geodesic
triangles serve as a source of the approximation of metrics by the polyhedral metrics.
Estimates are available of the difference between the angle of a geodesic triangle in the
space under consideration and the respective angle in a triangle with the same side
lengths in a plane or on a surface of constant curvature
GEOMETRIC NUMBER THEORY: The branch of number theory that studies number-
theoretical problems by the use of geometric methods. Geometry of numbers in its
proper sense was formulated by H. Minkowski in 1896 in his fundamental monograph.
The starting point of this science, which subsequently became an independent branch of
number theory, is the fact that certain assertions which seem evident in the context of
figures in an 𝑛-dimensional Euclidean space have far-reaching consequences in number
theory.
GOLDEN RATIO: The division of a line segment 𝒂 into two parts the greater of which, 𝒙,
is the mean proportional between the whole segment a and the smaller part 𝒂 − 𝒙, i.e.
𝑎: 𝑥 = 𝑥: (𝑎 − 𝑥).
or
1
𝑥=𝑎 ,
1
1+ 1
1+1+⋯
GOLDSTINE THEOREM: Let 𝑋 be a Banach space, then the image of the closed unit
ball 𝐵 ⊂ 𝑋 under the canonical imbedding into the closed unit ball 𝐵′′ of the bidual
space 𝑋 ′′ is weakly-dense.
GOOGOL: A fanciful name for the number 10100, written in decimal notation as a 1
followed by 100 zeros.
GOSSET, WILLIAM SEALY (1876–1937): William Sealy Gosset was a British statistician
best known for his discovery of the t-distribution.
GOURSET LEMMA (COMPLEX ANALYSIS): Give 𝜀 > 0 it is possible to divide the region
inside 𝐶 into finite number of meshes either complete square 𝐶𝑛 or partial square 𝐷𝑛
such that within each mesh there exists a point 𝑧0 for which
𝑓 𝑧 −(𝑧0 )
− 𝑓 ′ (𝑧0 ) < 𝜀 ∀𝑧 in the mesh.
𝑧−𝑧0
GRADIENT: The gradient of a curve at a point 𝑃 may be defined as equal to the gradient
of the tangent to the curve at 𝑃. The gradient of a multivariable function is a vector
consisting of the partial derivatives of that function. If 𝑓 (𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧) is a function of three
variables, then the gradient of 𝑓, written as ∆𝑓, is the vector
𝜕𝑓 𝜕𝑓 𝜕𝑓
∆𝑓 = , ,
𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑦 𝜕𝑧
GRADIENT METHOD: A method for the minimization of a function of several variables. It
is based on the fact that each successive approximation of the function 𝐹 is obtained
from the preceding one by a shift in the direction of the gradient of the function:
𝑥 𝑛 +1 = 𝑥 𝑛 − 𝛿𝑛 𝑔𝑟𝑎𝑑 𝐹 𝑥 𝑛
The parameter 𝛿𝑛 can be obtained, e.g., from the condition of the magnitude
𝐹 𝑥 𝑛 − 𝛿𝑛 𝑔𝑟𝑎𝑑 𝐹 𝑥 𝑛 being minimal.
𝑔1 , 𝑔1 𝑔2 , 𝑔1 ⋯ 𝑔𝑛 , 𝑔1
𝑔1 , 𝑔2 𝑔2 , 𝑔2 ⋯ 𝑔𝑛 , 𝑔2
⋮ ⋮ ⋮ ⋮
𝑔1 , 𝑔𝑛 𝑔2 , 𝑔𝑛 ⋯ 𝑔𝑛 , 𝑔𝑛
ℸ 𝑔1 , 𝑔2 , … , 𝑔𝑛 = 0.
ℸ 𝑔1 , 𝑔2 , … , 𝑔𝑛 ≠ 0,
ℸ 𝑔1 , 𝑔2 , … , 𝑔𝑛 > 0.
GRAPH: A number of vertices (nodes), some of which are joined by edges. The edge
joining the vertex 𝑈 and the vertex 𝑉 may be denoted by (𝑈, 𝑉) or (𝑉, 𝑈). The vertex-set,
that is, the set of vertices, of a graph 𝐺 may be denoted by 𝑉(𝐺) and the edge-set by
𝐸(𝐺). For example, the graph shown here on the left has 𝑉(𝐺) = {𝑈, 𝑉, 𝑊, 𝑋} and
𝐸(𝐺) = {(𝑈, 𝑉), (𝑈, 𝑊), (𝑉, 𝑊), (𝑊, 𝑋)}. In general, a graph may have more than one
edge joining a pair of vertices; when this occurs, these edges are called multiple edges.
Also, a graph may have loops—a loop is an edge that joins a vertex to itself.
GRAPH HOMEOMORPHISM: An equivalence relation on the set of graphs, characterizing
their geometric properties. The notion of a graph homeomorphism is defined as follows.
Subdivision of an edge (𝑎, 𝑏) of a graph 𝐺 is an operation involving the addition of a new
vertex 𝑣, the removal of (𝑎, 𝑏), and the addition of two new edges (𝑎, 𝑣) and (𝑣, 𝑏).
Geometrically, this operation consists in addition of some (interior) point 𝑣 on the
line (𝑎, 𝑏); this point then becomes a new vertex. A graph 𝐺′ is called a subdivision of a
graph 𝐺 if it can be obtained from 𝐺 by repeating the operation of edge subdivision
several times. Two graphs 𝐺1 and 𝐺2 are said to be homeomorphic if they have
isomorphic subdivisions.
GRAPHICAL SOLUTION OF AN LPP: The solution of a LPP obtained by graphical method
is called the graphical solution of LPP.
GREGORY, JAMES (1638–75): James Gregory was a Scottish mathematician who studied
in Italy. He obtained infinite series for certain trigonometric functions and was one of
the first to appreciate the difference between convergent and divergent series. He died
at the age of 36.
Let 𝐼 denote an interval of the real line of the form [𝑎, ∞) or [𝑎, 𝑏] or [𝑎, 𝑏)
with 𝑎 < 𝑏. Let 𝛽 and 𝑢 be real-valued continuous functions defined on 𝐼.
If 𝑢 is differentiable in the interior 𝐼 and satisfies the differential inequality
then 𝑢 is bounded by the solution of the corresponding differential equation
𝑦 ′(𝑡) = 𝛽(𝑡) 𝑦(𝑡):
for all t ∇ I.
GROUP: A group is a set 𝐺 of elements for which an operation ⊚ is defined that meets
the following properties:
(1) 𝑎, 𝑏 ∇ 𝐺 ⇒ 𝑎 ⊚ 𝑏 ∇ 𝐺. (Closure Axiom)
(2) The associative property holds:
𝑎 ⊚ 𝑏 ⊚ 𝑐 = 𝑎 ⊚ 𝑏 ⊚ 𝑐 ∀ 𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐 ∇ 𝐺
(3) There is an identity element 𝑒 ∇ 𝐺 such that
𝑎⊚𝑒 =𝑎 = 𝑒⊚𝑎∀𝑎 ∇𝐺
(4) Each element 𝑎 ∇ 𝐺 has an inverse 𝑎 −1 ∇ 𝐺 such that
𝑎 ⊚ 𝑎−1 = 𝑒 = 𝑎−1 ⊚ 𝑎
If ⊚ is also commutative (that is, 𝑎 ⊚ 𝑏 = 𝑏 ⊚ 𝑎 ∀ 𝑎, 𝑏 ∇ 𝐺), then the group is called an
Abelian group.
For example, the real numbers form an Abelian group with respect to addition, and the
nonzero real numbers form an Abelian group with respect to multiplication.
The theory of groups can be applied to many sets other than numbers, and to operations
other than conventional multiplication.
GROUP ACTION OF A GROUP G ON A SET X: A map from 𝑿 × 𝑮 → 𝑿, written (𝒙, 𝒈) or 𝒙𝒈
satisfying
(𝑥, 1𝐺 ) = 𝑥
𝑓 𝑧 = 𝑧 𝑚 𝑒 𝑔(𝑧) 𝑃 (𝑧)
HADAMARD THEOREM: The function 𝜁(𝑠) has infinitely many zeros in the critical strip.
Let 𝑟1 < 𝑟2 < 𝑟3 and 𝑀𝑖 be the maximum value of 𝑓(𝑧) on the circles 𝑧 = 𝑟𝑖 , 𝑖 =
1,2,3 . Then
𝑟 𝑟 𝑟
log ( 3 ) log ( 3 ) log ( 2 )
𝑟1 𝑟2 𝑟1
𝑀2 ≤ 𝑀1 . 𝑀3
The three circles theorem as a convexity theorem: Suppose 𝑓(𝑧) is analytic in the closed
ring 𝑟1 ≤ 𝑧 ≤ 𝑟2 . Let 𝑟1 < 𝑟2 < 𝑟3 and 𝑀 (𝑟𝑖 ) be the maximum value of 𝑓(𝑧) on the
circles 𝑧 = 𝑟𝑖 , 𝑖 = 1,2,3 . Then
Let 𝐸 be a normed vector space, and let 𝐹 be a subspace of 𝐸. For 𝑥 ∇ 𝐸, the following
are equivalent:
1. 𝑥 ∇ 𝐹 the closure of 𝐹;
In simple words, let 𝑀 be a linear subspace of a normed linear space 𝑁 and let Φ be a
functional defined on 𝑀. Then Φ can be extended to a functional Φ0 defined on the
whole space 𝑁 such that Φ0 = Φ .
1. 𝑃 ∪ 𝑁 = 𝑋 and 𝑃 ∩ 𝑁 = ∅.
2. For each 𝐸 in 𝛴 such that 𝐸 ⊆ 𝑃 one has 𝜇(𝐸) ≥ 0; that is, 𝑃 is a positive
set for 𝜇.
3. For each 𝐸 in 𝛴 such that 𝐸 ⊆ 𝑁 one has 𝜇(𝐸) ≤ 0; that is, 𝑁 is a negative set
for 𝜇.
HALF-LIFE: The time it takes for a radioactive substance to decay to one-half its original
amount.
HALF PLANE: A half plane is the set of all points in a plane that lie on one side of an axis.
HALF-RANGE EXPANSIONS: In many physical problems, the function 𝑓(𝑥) is only known
over a finite interval, say 0 < 𝑥 < 𝐿. To express 𝑓(𝑥) as a Fourier series means that we
need to extend the function to be valid over all 𝑥. We can also extend the function in an
even manner to get a cosine series or as an odd function to get a sine series.
Figures:
(b) The even extension of the function onto the interval 0 < 𝑥 < 𝐿 is shown as a solid
curve and the periodic extension of period 2𝐿 is shown as a dot-dash curve.
(c) The odd extension of the function, solid curve, and the periodic extension of period
2𝐿, dot-dash curve.
The odd extension of 𝑓(𝑥) will generate a Fourier series that only involves sine terms
and is called the sine half-range expansion. It is given by
∞ 𝒏𝝅
𝒇 𝒙 = 𝒏=𝟏 𝒃𝒏 𝒔𝒊𝒏 𝑳 𝒙
2 𝐿 𝒏𝝅
where 𝑏𝑛 = 𝐿 ∫0 𝑓 𝑥 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝒙𝑑𝑥 and 𝑛 is a positive integer.
𝑳
On the other hand, the even extension generates the cosine half-range expansion
∞ 𝒏𝝅
𝒇 𝒙 = 𝒂𝟎 + 𝒏=𝟏 𝒂𝒏 𝒄𝒐𝒔 𝑳 𝒙
1 𝐿 2 𝐿 𝒏𝝅
where 𝑎0 = 𝐿 ∫0 𝑓 𝑥 𝑑𝑥 and 𝑎𝑛 = 𝐿 ∫0 𝑓 𝑥 𝒄𝒐𝒔 𝒙𝑑𝑥 and 𝑛 is a positive integer.
𝑳
HALL'S MARRIAGE THEOREM: Let 𝑆 be a family of finite sets, where the family may
contain an infinite number of sets and the individual sets may be repeated multiple
times.
A transversal for 𝑆 is a set T and a bijection 𝑓 from 𝑇 to 𝑆 such that for all 𝑡 in 𝑇, 𝑡 is a
member of 𝑓(𝑡). An alternative term for transversal is system of distinct
representatives or "SDR".
The collection 𝑆 satisfies the marriage condition (MC) if and only if for each
subcollection , we have
In other words, the number of sets in each subcollection 𝑊 is less than or equal to the
number of distinct elements in the union over the subcollection 𝑊. Hall's theorem states
that 𝑆 has a transversal (SDR) if and only if 𝑆 satisfies the marriage condition.
HAMEL BASE: A subject 𝐵 of 𝑆 is called a Hamel base (or simply base) for 𝑆 if and only if
𝐵 is a linealy independent set and 𝐿𝑀 𝐵 = 𝑆.
𝑆= (𝑇 − 𝑈)𝑑𝑡 = 𝐿𝑑𝑡
𝑡0 𝑡0
has a stationary value as compared with near, kinetically-possible, motions, with initial
and final positions of the system and times of motion identical with those for the real
motion. Here, 𝑇 is the kinetic energy, 𝑈 is the potential energy and 𝐿 = 𝑇 − 𝑈 is the
Lagrange function of the system.
HAMILTON’S PRINCIPLE OF LEAST ACTION: A particle moves in a conservative field in
𝑡
such a way that ∫𝑡 2 𝑇 − 𝑉 𝑑𝑡 is a minimum, where T is the total Kinetic energy and V is
1
𝑑(𝑥, 𝑦) = 𝑑 𝑥𝑖 , 𝑦𝑖
This distance is called Hamming distance. Note that that the Hamming distance is not
dependent on the actual values of 𝑥𝑖 and 𝑦𝑖 but only if they are equal to each other or
not equal.
HANKEL MATRIX: A matrix whose entries along a parallel to the main anti-diagonal are
equal, for each parallel. Equivalently, 𝑯 = (𝒉𝒊,𝒋 ) is a Hankel matrix if and only if there
exists a sequence 𝒔𝟏 , 𝒔𝟐 , … , such that 𝒉𝒊,𝒋 = 𝒔𝒊+𝒋−𝟏 . If 𝒔𝒌 are square matrices, then 𝑯 is
referred to as a block Hankel matrix. Infinite Hankel matrices are associated with the
representation of Hankel operators acting on the Hilbert space of square summable
complex sequences.
HANSON- HUARD STRICT CONVERSE DUALITY THEOREM: Let X 0 be an open set in Rn
and let 𝜃 and 𝑔 be differentiable on X 0 . Let x, u be a solution of the dual
(maximization) problem and let 𝜃 and 𝑔 be convex at 𝑥 if either.
then 𝑥 solves the (primal) minimization problem (MP) and θ x = Ψ(x, u).
𝑝 𝑝
except when all the 𝑎𝑛 are zero. The constant in this inequality is best possible.
𝑝−1
where 𝑓 * and 𝑔∗ are the symmetric decreasing rearrangements of 𝑓(𝑥) and 𝑔(𝑥),
respectively.
HARDY-RAMANUJAN THEOREM: For any integer 𝒏 ≥ 𝟐 , let 𝝎(𝒏) denote the number of
distinct prime factors of 𝒏. The Hardy–Ramanujan theorem states that the
function 𝝎(𝒏) has normal order 𝒍𝒐𝒈 𝒍𝒐𝒈 𝒏 in the sense that, given any 𝜺 > 0, almost all
positive integers 𝒏 satisfy
𝝎 𝒏 − 𝐥𝐨𝐠 𝐥𝐨𝐠 𝒏 ≤ 𝜺 𝐥𝐨𝐠 𝐥𝐨𝐠 𝒏
Here, "almost all" means that the number of positive integers 𝑛 ≤ 𝑥 for which the
indicated property holds is asymptotically equal to 𝑥 as 𝑥 → ∞. A stronger, and best-
possible, version of this result shows that, given any real-valued function 𝜑(𝑛) tending
to infinity as 𝑛 → ∞, almost all positive integers 𝑛 satisfy
𝜔 𝑛 − log log 𝑛 ≤ 𝜑(𝑛) 𝑙𝑜𝑔𝑙𝑜𝑔𝑛
HARDY'S THEOREM: Let 𝑓 be a holomorphic function on the open ball centered at zero
and radius 𝑅 in the complex plane, and assume that 𝑓 is not a constant function. If one
defines
for 0 < 𝑟 < 𝑅 then this function is strictly increasing and logarithmically convex.
where 𝑔 is the determinant defined by the components of the tensor 𝒈𝒊𝒌 In several cases
use of harmonic coordinates leads to a considerable simplification of the calculations:
an example is the derivation of the equations of motion in general relativity.
HARMONIC FUNCTION: A function 𝑢 𝑥, 𝑦 is called harmonic function if first and second
order partial derivatives of 𝑢 are continuous and 𝑢 satisfies Laplace’s equations ∆2 V =
0.
HARMONIC SEQUENCE: A sequence of numbers is a harmonic sequence if the
reciprocals of the terms form an arithmetic sequence.
HCF: It is the abbreviation for highest common factor of two numbers. (Also written as
gcd).
HEAVISIDE UNIT FUNCTIONS (OR THE UNIT STEP FUNCTION): The Heaviside unit step
function by H(x) is defined as
1 if x ≥ 𝑎
H x =
0 if x < 𝑎
If 𝑎 > 0, then
1 if x ≥ 𝑎
H x−𝑎 =
0 if x < 𝑎
HEIGHT OF A FUZZY SET: The height of a fuzzy set is the largest membership value
attained by any point.
HELICOID: A surface generated by a curve which is simultaneously rotated about a fixed
axis and translate in the direction of the axis with a velocity proportional to the velocity
of rotation, is called helicoids.
d2 y dy
2
− 2𝑥 + 2λy = 0
dx dx
th
HERMITIAN MATRIX: A square matrix A = aij is said to be Hermitian if the i, j
th
element A is equal to the conjugate complex of the j, i element A i.e., if aij = aji for all
i and j.
1 2 − 3i 3 + 4i
a b + ic
For example, , 2 + 3i 0 4 − 5i are Hermitian matrices. If A is a
b − ic d
3 − 4i 4 + 5i 2
Hermitian matrix, then
A Hermitian matrix over the field of real number is nothing but a real symmetric matrix.
Obviously, a necessary and sufficient condition for a matrix A to be Hermitian is that A
= A°.
HERMITIAN OPERATOR OR SELF-ADJOINT OPERATOR: An operator 𝑇: 𝐻 → 𝐻 is a
Hermitian operator or self-adjoint operator if
𝑇 = 𝑇 ∗ , 𝑖. 𝑒. ⟨ 𝑇𝑥, 𝑦 ⟩ = ⟨ 𝑥, 𝑇𝑦 ⟩ 𝑓𝑜𝑟 𝑎𝑙𝑙 𝑥, 𝑦 ∇ 𝐻.
𝑛! 𝑓 𝑧 𝑑𝑧
𝑓 (𝑛) 𝑎 = ∫𝐶
2𝜋𝑖 (𝑧 − 𝑎)𝑛+1
HILBERT, DAVID: David Hilbert (1862 to 1943) was a mathematician whose work
included a modern, rigorous, axiomatic development of geometry.
HILBERT'S BASIS THEOREM: If is a Noetherian ring, then 𝑅[𝑋] is a Noetherian ring.
Note that
HILBERT SPACE: An (abstract) Hilbert space is a linear inner product space which is
complete with respect to the norm generated by its inner product.
HINGE THEOREM: It states that if two sides of one triangle are congruent to two sides of
another triangle, and the included angle of the first is larger than the included angle of
the second, then the third side of the first triangle is longer than the third side of the
second triangle.
HISTOGRAM: A histogram is a bar diagram where the horizontal axis shows different
categories of values and the height of each bar is related to the number of observations
in the corresponding category. If all categories are the same width, then the height of
each bar is proportional to the number of observations in the category. If the categories
are of unequal width, then the height of the bar is proportional to the number of
observations in the category divided by the width of the category
HÖLDER’S INEQUALITY: For 1 < 𝑝 < ∞, let 𝑞 ∇ (1, ∞) be such that
1 1
+ = 1.
𝑝 𝑞
For 𝑛 ≥ 1 and 𝑢, 𝑣 ∇ 𝐾 𝑛 , we have that
1 1
𝑛 𝑛 𝑝 𝑛 𝑞
𝑝 𝑞
𝑢𝑖 𝑣𝑖 ≤ 𝑢𝑖 𝑣𝑖
𝑖=1 𝑖=1 𝑖=1
1 1
+ =1
𝑝 𝑞
And = 𝑔 1 , 𝑔 2 , … ∇ 𝑙 𝑞 ,
∞ ∞ 1/𝑝 ∞ 1/𝑝
𝑃 𝑞
𝑓 𝑘 𝑔(𝑘) ≤ 𝑓(𝑘) . 𝑔(𝑘)
𝑘=1 𝑘=1 𝑘=1
HOLOMORPHIC FUNCTION: Functions f that satisfy (𝜕/𝜕𝑧)𝑓 ≡ 0 are the main concern
of complex analysis. A continuously differentiable function 𝑓 ∶ 𝑈 → 𝐶 defined on an
open subset 𝑈 of 𝐶 is said to be holomorphic if 𝜕𝑓/ 𝜕𝑧 = 0 at every point of 𝑈. Note
that this last equation is just a reformulation of the Cauchy-Riemann equations.
HOMEOMORPHISM: (a) A continuous bijective map 𝑓 ∶ 𝑋 → 𝑌, such that 𝑓 −1 ∶ 𝑌 → 𝑋
is also continuous is called a homeomorphism (or a bicontinuous bijection) and denoted
by 𝑓 ∶ 𝑋 ≅ 𝑌 . Two spaces 𝑋, 𝑌 are homeomorphic, written 𝑋 ≅ 𝑌 , if there is a
homeomorphism 𝑓 ∶ 𝑋 ≅ 𝑌 .
(b) Let (𝐴,∗) and (𝐵,∗) be semigroups, monoids or groups. A function 𝑓: 𝐴 → 𝐵 from 𝐴
to 𝐵 is said to be a homomorphism if 𝑓(𝑥 ∗ 𝑦) = 𝑓(𝑥) ∗ 𝑓(𝑦) for all elements 𝑥 and 𝑦
of 𝐴. Let 𝑞 be an integer, and let 𝑓: 𝑍 → 𝑍 be a the function from the set of integers to
itself defined by 𝑓(𝑛) = 𝑞 𝑛 for all integers 𝑛. Then 𝑓 is a homomorphism from the
group (𝑍, +) to itself, since 𝑓(𝑚 + 𝑛) = 𝑞(𝑚 + 𝑛) = 𝑞 𝑚 + 𝑞 𝑛 = 𝑓(𝑚) + 𝑓(𝑛) for
all integers 𝑚 and 𝑛. Example Let 𝑅 ∗ denote the set of non-zero real numbers, let 𝑎 be a
nonzero real number, and let 𝑓: 𝑍 → 𝑅 ∗ be the function defined by 𝑓(𝑛) = 𝑎𝑛 for all
integers 𝑚 and 𝑛. Then 𝑓: 𝑍 → 𝑅 ∗ is a homomorphism from the group (𝑍, +) of integers
under addition to the group (𝑅 ∗ ,×) of non-zero real numbers under multiplication,
since 𝑓(𝑚 + 𝑛) = 𝑎 𝑚 +𝑛 = 𝑎𝑚 𝑎𝑛 = 𝑓(𝑚)𝑓(𝑛) for all integers 𝑚 and 𝑛.
HOMOGENEOUS LINEAR EQUATIONS: Suppose
The matrix 𝐴 is called the coefficient matrix of the system of equation (1).
Again suppose x1 and x2 are two solutions of (2). Then their linear combination,
k1 x1 + k 2 x2 , where k1 and k 2 are any arbitrary numbers, is also a solution of (2).
We have
Therefore the collection of all solution of the system of equation AX = O forms a sub-
space of the n variable, AX = O, is n − r , where r is the rank of the matrix A.
HOOKE’s LAW: Theory of elasticity deals with a study of the behavior of those
substances that possess the property of recovering their size and shape, when the forces
producing deformations are removed. The elastic response of a body to an applied load
is analyzed best through the introduction of the stress tensor. Deformations produced
are naturally relate to the applied loads and therefore to the stress tensor. These
relations are the stress- strain relations or the constitutive equations of the material.
In 1676, Robert Hooke, who as a result of his experiments with metallic rods under
axially applied tensile loads, concluded that “the extension is proportional to the force”,
a relation known as Hooke’s Law.
Mathematically it is expresses as T=𝐸ℯ, until the stress reaches the proportional limit.
The proportional limit means the stress at which the linear relationship between stress
and strains ceases. Its value, however, is not easily measured. The constant of
proportionality E is known as Young’s modulus of elasticity.
The stress T is assumed to vanish when ℯ vanishes. Since T and ℯ uniquely related, there
cannot be energy dissipation by the stress component during a loading and unloading
cycle. Such a solid, which allows linear stress-strain law for deformation without any
dissipation of energy, is called a linear elastic solid or Hookean solid.
HOROSPHERE: Horosphere is a level set of Busemann function.
HURWITZ'S THEOREM (COMPLEX ANALYSIS): Let {𝑓𝑘 } be a sequence of holomorphic
functions on a connected open set 𝐺 that converge uniformly on compact subsets of 𝐺 to
a holomorphic function 𝑓. If 𝑓 has a zero of order 𝑚 at 𝑧0 then for every small enough
𝜌 > 0 and for sufficiently large 𝑘 ∇ 𝑵 (depending on 𝜌), 𝑓𝑘 has precisely 𝑚 zeroes in
the disk defined by |𝑧 − 𝑧0 | < 𝜌, including multiplicity. Furthermore, these zeroes
converge to 𝑧0 as 𝑘 → ∞.
HURWITZ'S THEOREM (NUMBER THEORY): For every irrational number 𝜉 there are
infinitely many relatively prime integers 𝑚, 𝑛 such that
The hypothesis that 𝜉 is irrational cannot be omitted. Moreover the constant 5 is the
1+ 5
best possible; if we replace 5 by any number 𝐴 > 5 and we let 𝜉 = (the golden
2
ratio) then there exist only finitely many relatively prime integers 𝑚, 𝑛 such that the
formula above holds.
HYPERBOLA: A hyperbola is the set of all points in a plane such that the difference
between the distances to two fixed points is a constant. A hyperbola has two branches
that are mirror images of each other. Each branch looks like a misshaped parabola. The
general equation for a hyperbola with center at the origin is
𝑥2 𝑦2
− =1
𝑎2 𝑏 2
The two diagonal lines are called asymptotes, which are determined by the equations
𝑏𝑦 + 𝑎𝑥 = 0 = 𝑏𝑦 − 𝑎𝑥.
𝑇 α+r
α r = α α + 1 (α + 2)……….. α + r − 1 = (where r is a+ve integer)
𝑇 α
and α 0 = 1.
∞ α 1 r α 2 r … α m r xT
mFn (α1 , α2 …………..αm ; β1 , β2 ………,βn ; x)= r=0 β
1 r β2 r … βn r r !
α1 , α2 … αm ;
mFn = β , β … β 𝑥
1 2 n
ab a a + 1 b(b + 1) 2 a a + 1 a + 2 b b + 1 (b + 2) 3
1+ x+ x + x +
1! c 2! c(c + 1) 3! c c + 1 (c + 2)
is called the hypergeometric series.
It can be shown that the series converges absolutely if x < 1 and if x = 1, and series
converges absolutely if c − a − b > 0 or c > 𝑎 + 𝑏. Hypergeometric series is frequently
used in connection with the theory of Spherical Harmonics.
𝐶1 𝑥1 + 𝐶2 𝑥2 + ⋯ + 𝐶𝑛 𝑥𝑛 =Z (not all 𝐶𝑖 = 0)
𝐶
The vector C is called vector normal to hyperplane and ± are called unit normals.
𝐶
A hyper plane divides the whole space 𝐸 𝑛 into three mutually disjoint sets given by
𝑋1 = 𝑥: 𝐶𝑥 > 𝑍
𝑋2 = 𝑥: 𝐶𝑥 = 𝑍
𝑋3 = 𝑥: 𝐶𝑥 < 𝑍
HYPER SPHERE: A hyper sphere in 𝐸 𝑛 with the centre at a and radius 𝜀 > 0 is defined to
be the set of points
𝑋 = 𝑥: 𝑥 − 𝑎 = 𝜀
2 2 2
𝑥1 − 𝑎1 + 𝑥2 − 𝑎2 + ⋯ + 𝑥𝑛 − 𝑎𝑛 = 𝜀2
where 𝑎 = 𝑎1 , 𝑎2 , … , 𝑎𝑛 , 𝑋 = 𝑥1 , 𝑥2 , … , 𝑥𝑛
I
IDEA: IDEA (International Data Encryption Algorithm) is an encryption
algorithm developed at ETH in Zurich, Switzerland. It uses a block cipher with a 128-
bit key, and is generally considered to be very secure. It is considered among the best
publicly known algorithms. In the several years that it has been in use, no practical
attacks on it have been published despite of a number of attempts to find some.
IDEAL CLASS: Suppose that 𝐾 is an algebraic number field. Two fractional ideals 𝐴 and 𝐵
in 𝐾 are said to be equivalent, denoted by 𝐴 ∼ 𝐵, if there is a principal fractional ideal
⌌𝑤⌍ ≠ ⌌0⌍ such that 𝐴 = ⌌𝑤⌍𝐵. The equivalence of non-zero fractional ideals in an
algebraic number field is an equivalence relation. The equivalence classes are called the
ideal classes. Furthermore, all non-zero principal fractional ideals are equivalent to each
other. They form the principal class.
IDEALS: A subset of a ring 𝐴 is called a left (right) ideal of 𝐴 it is submodule of the left
(right) 𝐴- module of 𝐴. In otherwords, a left (right) ideal 𝐽 of 𝐴 is an additive subgroup
of 𝐴 such that 𝐴𝐽 ⊂ 𝐽(𝐽𝐴 ⊂ 𝐽). Under the operations induced from 𝐴, 𝐽 is a ring
(however, 𝐽 is not necessarily unitary). A subset if 𝐴 is called a two sided ideal or simple
an ideal of 𝐴 if it is a left and right ideal.
A left (right) ideal of a ring 𝐴 is said to be maximal if it is not equal to 𝐴 and is properly
contained in no left (right) ideal of 𝐴 other than 𝐴. Similarly, a left (right) ideal of 𝐴 is
said to be minimal if it is nonzero left (right) ideal of 𝐴.
IDEALS IN AN ALGEBRAIC NUMBER FIELD: Let 𝐾 be an algebraic number field, with ring
of integers 𝑂. A subset 𝐴 of 𝑂 is an ideal in 𝐾 if the following condition is satisfied:
If 𝛼, 𝛽 ∇ 𝐴, then 𝜆𝛼 + µ𝛽 ∇ 𝐴 for every 𝜆, µ ∇ 𝑂.
We denote by {0}, the zero ideal.
IDENTITY ELEMENT: If ⟪ stands for an operation (such as addition, subtraction,
multiplication), then the identity element (called 𝑒) for the operation is the number
such that 𝑒 ⟪ 𝑎 = 𝑎, for all a. For example, zero is the identity element for addition,
because 0 + 𝑎 = 𝑎, for all 𝑎 ∇ 𝑅 . 1 is the identity element for multiplication, because
1 × 𝑎 = 𝑎, for all 𝑎 ∇ 𝑅.
IDENTITY MATRIX: An identity matrix is a square matrix with ones along the diagonal
and zeros everywhere else and is denoted 𝐼𝑛 as where n is the order of the matrix 𝐼𝑛 .
For example:
1 0 0
1 0
𝐼2 = 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝐼3 = 0 1 0
0 1
0 0 1
IDENTITY THEOREM: If 𝑓, 𝑔 ∶ 𝐶 → 𝐶 are holomorphic near 𝑝, and there is a sequence
𝑝 ≠ 𝑧𝑛 → 𝑝 with 𝑓(𝑧𝑛 ) = 𝑔(𝑧𝑛 ), then 𝑓 = 𝑔 near 𝑝.
IMAGE OF A FILTER: If f is a mapping of a set 𝐸 into a set 𝐸0 :
1. The image by 𝑓 of a filter on 𝐸 is a filter on 𝐸0 ,
2. The inverse image by 𝑓 of a filter 𝐹0 on 𝐸0 is a filter on 𝐸 if every set of 𝐹0 meets 𝑓(𝐸).
In particular, if 𝑓 is a mapping of 𝐸 onto 𝐸0 the direct and inverse images of filters are
again filters.
IMAGE OF A POINT: The image of a point is the point that results after the original point
has been subjected to a transformation.
IMMERSED SUBMANIFOLD: Let 𝑀 be an abstract smooth manifold. An immersed
submanifold is a subset 𝑁 ⊂ 𝑀 equipped as a topological space (but not necessarily
with the topology induced from 𝑀) and a smooth structure such that the inclusion map
𝑖: 𝑁 → 𝑀 is smooth with a differential 𝑑𝑖𝑝 : 𝑇𝑝 𝑁 → 𝑇𝑝 𝑀 which is injective for each
𝑝 ∇ 𝑁.
IMMERSION: Let 𝑀 and 𝑁 be abstract manifolds, and let 𝑓: 𝑁 → 𝑀 be a map. Then 𝑓 is
called an embedding/immersion if its image 𝑓(𝑁) can be given the structure of an
embedded/immersed submanifold of 𝑀 onto which 𝑓 is a diffeomorphism.
IMPLICIT DIFFERENTIATION: Implicit differentiation provides a method for finding
derivatives if the relationship between two variables is not expressed as an explicit
function. For example, consider the equation 𝑥 2 + 𝑥𝑦 + 𝑦 2 = 𝑎. This equation defines a
relationship between 𝑥 and 𝑦, but it does not express that relationship as an explicit
function. To find the derivative 𝑑𝑦/𝑑𝑥, take the derivative of 𝑥 2 + 𝑥𝑦 + 𝑦 2 = 𝑎
𝑑 2 𝑑
𝑥 + 𝑥𝑦 + 𝑦 2 = 𝑎
𝑑𝑥 𝑑𝑥
𝑑𝑦 𝑑𝑦
⇒ 2𝑥 + 𝑥 + 𝑦 + 2𝑦 =0
𝑑𝑥 𝑑𝑥
𝑑𝑦 2𝑥 + 𝑦
⇒ =−
𝑑𝑥 𝑥 + 2𝑦
IMPOSSIBILITY OF CIRCLE SQUARING: We cannot construct a square of area equal to a
given circle by a ruler and compass construction.
IMPUTATION: Imputation, in statistics, is the insertion of a value to stand in for missing
data. Analytics programs and methods don't function properly with missing data.
Statistical packages, for example, commonly delete any case with data missing.
INCENTER: The incenter of a triangle is the center of the circle inscribed inside the
triangle. It is the intersection of the three angle bisectors of the triangle.
INCIDENT EDGE: If 𝑣 is a vertex of some graph, if 𝑒 is an edge of the graph, and if
𝑒 = 𝑣 𝑣 ′ for some vertex 𝑣 ′ of the graph, then the vertex 𝑣 is said to be incident to the
edge 𝑒, and the edge e is said to be incident to the vertex 𝑣.
INCIRCLE: The incircle of a triangle is the circle that can be inscribed within the triangle.
INCOMPLETENESS THEOREM: The Incompleteness Theorem is a pair of logical proofs
that revolutionized mathematics. The first result was published by Kurt Gödel (1906-
1978) in 1931 when he was 24 years old. The First Incompleteness Theorem states that
any contradiction-free rendition of number theory contains propositions that cannot be
proven either true or false on the basis of its own postulates. The Second
Incompleteness Theorem states that if a theory of numbers is contradiction-free, then
this fact cannot be proven with common reasoning methods.
Inductive reasoning is, unlike deductive reasoning, not logically rigorous. Imperfection
can exist and inaccurate conclusions can occur, however rare; in deductive reasoning
the conclusions are mathematically certain. Inductive reasoning is sometimes confused
with mathematical induction, an entirely different process. Mathematical induction is a
form of deductive reasoning, in which logical certainties are "daisy chained" to derive a
general conclusion about an infinite number of objects or situations.
∞
𝐹𝑐 𝑓 𝑡 = 𝑓 𝑡 cos 𝑠 𝑡 𝑑𝑡 = 𝐺𝑐 𝒔
𝟎
∞
2
𝑓 𝑡 = 𝐺𝑐 𝒔 cos s t ds
𝜋 𝟎
∞
𝐹𝑠 𝑓 𝑡 = 𝑓 𝑡 sin 𝑠 𝑡 𝑑𝑡 = 𝐺𝑠 𝒔
𝟎
and the function 𝒇 𝒕 is inverse fourier sine transform of 𝐺𝑠 𝑠 or 𝐹𝑠 𝑓 𝑡 and defined
as
∞
2
𝑓 𝑡 = 𝐺𝑠 𝒔 sin s t ds
𝜋 𝟎
The second is also known as Inversion Formula for Fourier sine transform.
INFINITE PRODUCT: Let 𝑎𝑛 be a given sequence with terms 𝑎𝑛 ≠ 0(𝑛 = 1,2, … 1). The
∞
dormal infinite product 𝑎1 . 𝑎2 . 𝑎3 … is denoted by n=1 𝑎𝑛 . We call 𝑝𝑛 = 𝑎1 . 𝑎2 … … 𝑎𝑛 its
𝑛𝑡 partial product. If the sequence 𝑝𝑛 is convergent to a nonzero limit 𝑝, then this
infinite product is said to converge to 𝑝, and 𝑝 is called the value of the infinite product.
We write 𝑎𝑛 = p. if 𝑝𝑛 is not convergent or is convergent to 0, then the infinite
product is called divergent.
In which the co-efficient are so small that their products can be neglected in comparison
with the linear terms is called an infinitesimal affine transformations.
INFLECTION POINT: An inflection point on a curve is a point such that the curve is
oriented concave-upward on one side of the point and concave-downward on the other
side of the point. If the curve represents the function 𝑦 = 𝑓(𝑥), then the second
derivative is equal to zero at the inflection point.
INITIAL-BOUNDARY-VALUE PROBLEMS: This time the infinite 𝒙 plane is replace by the
semi-infinite plane, with a boundary condition imposed on 𝒙 = 𝟎.
𝝏𝒖 𝝏𝒖
𝒄 + = 𝟎, 𝒙 > 0, 𝑡 > 0
𝝏𝒙 𝝏𝒕
𝒖 𝒙, 𝟎 = 𝒇(𝒙)
𝒖 𝟎, 𝒕 = 𝒈(𝒕)
.
Consider the case c>0, so that the waves are travelling from small 𝑥 to large 𝑥. The
𝑑𝑥 𝑑𝑡
characteristics are again given by = 𝑐, = 1 ⇒ 𝑥 = 𝑐𝑡 + 𝑥0 . The characteristic
𝑑𝑟 𝑑𝑟
𝝏𝒖 𝝏𝒖
Example: 2 𝝏𝒙 + = 𝟎, −∞ < 𝑥 < ∞, 𝑡 > 0 with
𝝏𝒕
1 − 𝑥, 𝑖𝑓 𝑥 ≤ 1
𝑢 𝑥, 0 = , 𝑢 0, 𝑡 = 𝑒 −𝑡 , 𝑡 > 0.
0, 𝑖𝑓 𝑥 > 1
Therefore the plane is split into three regions and the solution is
0, 𝑖𝑓 𝑥 − 2𝑡 > 1,
𝑢 𝑥, 𝑡 = 1 − 𝑥 − 2𝑡 , 𝑖𝑓 0 < 𝑥 − 2𝑡 ≤ 1,
𝑥
𝑒− 𝑡− ,
2 , 𝑖𝑓 𝑥 − 2𝑡 < 0
𝝏𝒖 𝝏𝒖
Example: 2𝑥𝑡 𝝏𝒙 + = 𝑢, −∞ < 𝑥 < ∞, 𝑡 > 0 with the initial condition 𝑢 𝑥, 0 = 𝑥.
𝝏𝒕
𝑑𝑥 𝑑𝑥 𝑑𝑡
= 2𝑥𝑡 ⇒ = 2𝑡𝑑𝑡 ⇒ log 𝑥 = 𝑡 2 + 𝑐 and 𝑑𝑟 = 1 ⇒ 𝑡 = 𝑟.
𝑑𝑟 𝑥
2 2 2
and rearranging we obtain 𝑥 = 𝐴𝑒 𝑡 ⇒ 𝑥 = 𝑥0 𝑒 𝑡 . Thus, 𝑥0 = 𝑥𝑒 −𝑡
𝑑𝑢 𝑑𝑥 𝜕𝑢 𝑑𝑡 𝜕𝑢 𝑑𝑢
On using = 𝑑𝑟 + 𝑑𝑟 , we can write = 𝑢 ⇒ 𝑢 = 𝐴𝑒 𝑟 , where the constant 𝐴 is
𝑑𝑟 𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑡 𝑑𝑟
actually constant along the characteristic defined by the value of 𝑥0 . Thus, 𝑥0 is really a
function of 𝑥0 and we write 𝑢 = 𝐹(𝑥0 )𝑒 𝑡 , since 𝑡 = 𝑟 and the function 𝐹 is determined
by the initial conditions. At 𝑡 = 0 , we have 𝑥 = 𝑥0 and 𝑢 𝑥0 , 0 = 𝑥0 so that 𝐹 𝑥0 = 𝑥0 .
Replacing 𝑥0 by the above expression involving 𝑥 and 𝑡, we obtain the final solution
2 2
𝑢 𝑥, 𝑡 = 𝑥0 𝑒 𝑡 = 𝑥𝑒 −𝑡 𝑒 𝑡 = 𝑥𝑒 𝑡−𝑡
𝝏𝒖 𝝏𝒖
Example: Consider the initial-boundary-value problem 𝑢2 𝝏𝒙 + = 0, 𝒙 > 0, 𝒕 > 0 with
𝝏𝒕
𝑢 𝑥, 0 = 𝑥, 𝑥 > 0, 𝑢 0, 𝑡 = 0, 𝑡 > 0.
𝑑𝑥 𝑑𝑡 𝑑𝑢
= 𝑢2 and 𝑑𝑟 = 1 ⇒ 𝑡 = 𝑟 and 𝑑𝑟 = 0 ⇒ 𝑢 =constant on characteristic = 𝐹 𝑥0 .
𝑑𝑟
Therefore, we have 𝑥0 = 𝑥 − 𝑢2 𝑡.
Thus, substituting for 𝑥0 into 𝐹(𝑥0 ) we obtain the implicit solution 𝑢 𝑥, 𝑡 = 𝐹(𝑥 − 𝑢2 𝑡),
where 𝐹 is determined by the initial condition, namely, 𝑡 = 0, 𝑥 = 𝑥0 , and 𝑢 = 𝑥0 .
Squaring both sides, we can manipulate this solution into an explicit solution for 𝑢 in
terms of 𝑥 and 𝑡.
𝑥 𝑥
𝑢2 = 𝑥 − 𝑢2 𝑡, 𝑢2 1 + 𝑡 = 𝑥, 𝑢2 = 1+𝑡 and so the final solution is 𝑢 = , 𝑥 > 0, 𝑡 >
1+𝑡
0.
𝜕2𝑢 𝜕2𝑢
= 𝑐 2 𝜕𝑥 2 (one dimensional wave equation),
𝜕𝑡 2
𝜕𝑢 𝜕2𝑢
= 𝑘 2 𝜕𝑦 2 one dimensional heat or diffusion equation ,
𝜕𝑡
𝜕2𝑢 𝜕2𝑢
+ 𝜕𝑦 2 = 0 two dimensional Laplace equation .
𝜕𝑥 2
𝜕2𝑢 𝜕2𝑢
+ 𝜕𝑦 2 = 𝑓 𝑥, 𝑦 .
𝜕𝑥 2
If 𝑢1 (𝑥, 𝑦) and 𝑢2 (𝑥, 𝑦) are both solutions to a partial differential equation, then
INITIAL-VALUE PROBLEMS: Here the problem is defined over an infinite range in 𝒙. The
general statement of the problem is
𝝏𝒖 𝝏𝒖
𝒄 𝝏𝒙 + = 𝟎, −∞ < 𝑥 < ∞, 𝑡 > 0. (1)
𝝏𝒕
𝒖 𝒙, 𝟎 = 𝒇 𝒙 . (2)
The initial value problem (IVP) defined in Equations (1) and (2), is also referred to as a
Cauchy problem and the solution is determined uniquely by the single condition at
𝑡 = 0. Also, we have
𝝏𝒖
𝑢 𝑥, 𝑡 = 𝑓 𝑥 − 𝑐𝑡 = 𝑓(𝑥0 ). If 𝑓 is continuously differentiable, then 𝝏𝒙 = 𝑓 ′′ (𝑥 − 𝑐𝑡) and
𝝏𝒖
= −𝑐𝑓 ′ (𝑥 − 𝑐𝑡) are continuous. Thus, 𝑢 = 𝐹 𝑥0 = 𝐹 𝑥 − 𝑐𝑡 is a classical solution of
𝝏𝒕
1 − (𝑥 − 𝑐𝑡)2 , 𝑖𝑓 0 ≤ (𝑥 − 𝑐𝑡)2 ≤ 1
𝑢= , then 𝑢 𝑥, 𝑡 = 𝑓 𝑥 − 𝑐𝑡 is called a weak
0, 𝑖𝑓 (𝑥 − 𝑐𝑡)2 > 1
solution.
𝝏𝒖 𝝏𝒖 1
Example: 2 𝝏𝒙 + = 𝟎, −∞ < 𝑥 < ∞, 𝑡 > 0 with the initial condition 𝑢 𝑥, 0 = 1+𝑥 2 .
𝝏𝒕
𝑑𝑥 𝑑𝑡
= 2 ⇒ 𝑥 = 2𝑟 + 𝑥0 and 𝑑𝑟 = 1 ⇒ 𝑡 = 𝑟. Hence, 𝑥 = 2𝑡 + 𝑥0 ⇒ 𝑥0 = 𝑥 − 2𝑡.
𝑑𝑟
𝑑𝑢
The partial differential equation becomes 𝑑𝑟 = 0 ⇒ 𝑢 = 𝑢(𝑥0 ).
1 1
At 𝑡 = 0, 𝑥 = 𝑥0 and 𝑢 = 1+𝑥 2 . Therefore, 𝑢 𝑥, 𝑡 = 1+(𝑥−2𝑡)2 .
0
𝝏𝒖 𝝏𝒖
Example: − 𝝏𝒙 + = 𝟎, −∞ < 𝑥 < ∞, 𝑡 > 0 with the initial condition
𝝏𝒕
1 − 𝑥 , 𝑖𝑓 𝑥 ≤ 1
𝑢 𝑥, 0 = .
0, 𝑖𝑓 𝑥 > 1
𝑑𝑥 𝑑𝑡
= −1 ⇒ 𝑥 = −𝑟 + 𝑥0 and 𝑑𝑟 = 1 ⇒ 𝑡 = 𝑟.
𝑑𝑟
𝑑𝑢
The partial differential equation reduces to the ODE 𝑑𝑟 = 0 ⇒ 𝑢 = 𝑢 𝑥0 .
1 − 𝑥0 , 𝑖𝑓 𝑥0 ≤ 1 1 − 𝑥 + 𝑡 , 𝑖𝑓 𝑥 + 𝑡 ≤ 1
𝑢(𝑥0 , 0) = and so 𝑢 𝑥, 𝑡 = .
0, 𝑖𝑓 𝑥0 > 1 0, 𝑖𝑓 𝑥 + 𝑡 > 1
𝑓, 𝑔 = 𝑔, 𝑓 ,
(𝑓1 + 𝑓2 , g) = (𝑓1 , 𝑔) + 𝑓2 , 𝑔 ,
𝑎𝑓, 𝑔 = 𝑎 𝑓, 𝑔 ,
𝑓, 𝑓 > 0, 𝑖𝑓 𝑓 ≠ 0
INNER PRODUCT SPACE: The linear space 𝑆 in which an inner product has been defined
is called an inner product space.
INTEGRAL ELEMENT OVER R: Let 𝑇 be a unital commutative ring, and let 𝑅 be a unital
subring of 𝑇. An element 𝛼 of 𝑇 is said to be integral over 𝑅 if 𝛼 is the root of some
monic polynomial with coefficients in 𝑅.
INTEGRAL HÖLDER INEQUALITY: Let 1 < 𝑝 < ∞, let 𝑞 ∇ (1, ∞) be such that
1/𝑝 + 1/𝑞 = 1. For 𝑓 ∇ 𝐿𝑝 (µ) and 𝑔 ∇ 𝐿𝑞 (µ), we have that 𝑓𝑔 is integrable, and
∫𝑋 𝑓𝑔 𝑑𝜇 ≤ 𝑓 𝑝 𝑔 𝑞
1. ||𝑎𝑓||𝑝 = | 𝑎 | ||𝑓||𝑝 ;
For 1 ≤ 𝑝 < ∞, the collection of equivalence classes 𝐿𝑝 (µ) / ∼ is a vector space, and
|| · ||𝑝 is a well-defined norm on 𝐿𝑝 (µ) / ∼.
INTEGRALLY CLOSED SUBRING: Let 𝑇 be a unital commutative ring, and let 𝑅 be a unital
subring of 𝑇. The subring 𝑅 of 𝑇 is said to be integrally closed in 𝑇 if every element of 𝑇
that is integal over 𝑅 is an element of 𝑅. Let 𝑇 be a unital commutative ring, let 𝑅 be a
unital subring of 𝑇, and let 𝑅 be the integral closure of 𝑅 in 𝑇. R is an integrally-closed
subring of 𝑇. Moreover 𝑅 is integrally closed in 𝑇 if and only if 𝑅 = 𝑅 . An integral
domain is said to be integrally closed if it is integrally closed in its field of fractions.
INTERCEPT: The 𝑥- intercept is the value of 𝑥 where the curve crosses the 𝑥-axis and 𝑦-
intercept of a curve is the value of 𝑦 where it crosses the 𝑦-axis. For the line
𝑐
𝑦 = 𝑚𝑥 + 𝑐, the 𝑥- intercept is − 𝑚 and the 𝑦-intercept is 𝑐.
INTERVAL: The interval [𝑎, 𝑏] is the set of points between 𝑎 and 𝑏 including both
endpoints 𝑎 and 𝑏 themselves and is called a closed interval. The interval (𝑎, 𝑏) is the set
of points between 𝑎 and 𝑏 excluding both endpoints 𝑎 and 𝑏 themselves and is called an
open interval.
ij ….k
INTRISIC DERIVATIVE (TENSORS): Consider a tensor 𝐴 ab ….p
defined along a curve
δ∅ 𝜕∅ dx i dx i 𝜕∅ d∅
Similarly intrinsic derivative of ∅ is = = ∅, i . Also = . Thus intrinsic
δt 𝜕𝑥 𝑖 dt dt 𝜕𝑡 dt
TYPES OF INVENTORY:
(i) RAW MATERIALS: The material used in manufacture of the products such as
fuels etc. is called raw material
(ii) PARTLY FINISHED ITEMS: The material which held between manufacturing stage
is called partly finished items.
(iii) FINISHED GOODS: The products which are ready for sale or distribution called
finished goods.
(iv) SPARE PARTS: The spare parts used in the production process but do not become
part of the product.
INVENTORY CONTROL: Inventory control is the process of deciding what and how much
of various terms are to be kept in stock. It also use to determines the time and quantity
of various items to be procured. It is useful to reduce investment in inventories and
ensuring that production process does not suffer at the same time.
∞
1 2 𝑐𝑜𝑠 𝜋 𝑠 𝑡
𝐹𝐶−1 𝐹𝐶 𝑓 𝑡 = 𝑓 𝑡 = 𝐹𝑐 0 + 𝐹𝑐 𝑠
ℓ ℓ ℓ
𝑠=1
∞
𝑎0 𝑐𝑜𝑠 𝜋 𝑛 𝑡
𝑓 𝑡 = + 𝑎𝑛 .
2 ℓ
𝑛=1
INVERSE FINITE FOURIER SINE TRANSFORM: Let f(t) be a function defined on 0, ℓ and
satisfying Dirichlet’s conditions on 0, ℓ . The finite Fourier sine transform of
𝑓 𝑡 , 𝑜 < 𝑡 < 𝑙 𝑖𝑠 𝑑𝑒𝑓𝑖𝑛𝑒𝑑 𝑎𝑠
𝓵
𝜋𝑆𝑡
𝐹𝑠 𝑓 𝑡 = 𝑓 𝑡 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝑑𝑡; 𝑠 𝜖 𝑁
𝟎 ℓ
∞
2 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝜋 𝑛 𝑡
𝐹𝑆−1 𝐹𝑠 𝑓 𝑡 =𝑓 𝑡 = 𝐹𝑠 𝑓 𝑡
ℓ ℓ
𝑠=1
∞ 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝜋 𝑛 𝑡
𝑇𝑖𝑠 𝑓𝑜𝑟𝑚𝑢𝑙𝑎 𝑖𝑠 𝑔𝑜𝑡 𝑓𝑟𝑜𝑚 𝐹𝑜𝑢𝑟𝑖𝑒𝑟 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝑒 𝑠𝑒𝑟𝑖𝑒𝑠 𝑓 𝑡 = 𝑛=1 𝑏𝑠 .
ℓ
∞ 2 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝜋 𝑠𝑡
Hence 𝑓 𝑡 = 𝑠=1 ℓ 𝐹𝑠 𝑓 𝑡 ℓ
∞
2 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝜋 𝑠𝑡
𝐹𝑠 𝑓 𝑡
ℓ ℓ
𝑠=1
INVERSE FUNCTION: An inverse function of a function is a function that does exactly the
opposite of the original function. If the function 𝑔 is the inverse of the function 𝑓 , and if
𝑦 = 𝑓 (𝑥), then 𝑥 = 𝑔(𝑦). It is to be noted that
1. The inverse function of a function 𝑓 ∶ 𝑋 → 𝑌 exists if and only if 𝑓 is a bijection, that
is, 𝑓 is an injection and a surjection.
2. When an inverse function exists, it is unique.
3. The inverse function and the inverse image of a set coincide in the following sense.
Suppose 𝑓 −1 (𝐴) is the inverse image of a set 𝐴 ⊂ 𝑌 under a function 𝑓 ∶ 𝑋 → 𝑌. If 𝑓 is
a bijection, then 𝑓 −1 (𝑦) = 𝑓 −1 ({𝑦}).
INVERSE FUNCTION THEOREM: For a holomorphic function 𝑓 ∶ 𝐶 → 𝐶 defined near 𝑝,
if 𝑓 ′ (𝑝) ≠ 0 then 𝑓 is a local biholomorphism near 𝑝. The theorem hands us a unique
holomorphic function 𝑔 ∶ 𝐶 → 𝐶 defined near 𝑓(𝑝) such that 𝑓(𝑔(𝑤)) = 𝑤 and
𝑔(𝑓(𝑧)) = 𝑧 (for all 𝑧, 𝑤 close enough to 𝑝, 𝑓(𝑝) respectively).
INVERSELY PROPORTIONAL: If the variables 𝑦 and 𝑥 are related by the equation
𝑦 = 𝑘/𝑥, where 𝑘 is a constant, then 𝑦 is said to be inversely proportional to 𝑥.
INVERSE MATRIX: The inverse of a square matrix 𝑨 is the square matrix of same order
that, when multiplied by 𝑨, gives the identity matrix 𝑰. Inverse of the matrix 𝑨 is written
as 𝑨−𝟏 . Note that 𝑨𝑨−𝟏 = 𝑰 = 𝑨−𝟏 𝑨. 𝑨−𝟏 exists if 𝑑𝑒𝑡 𝑨 ≠ 0.
The inverse of a 2 × 2 matrix can be found from the formula:
𝑎 𝑏 1 𝑑 −𝑏
=
𝑐 𝑑 𝑎𝑑 − 𝑏𝑐 −𝑐 𝑎
INVERSE OF A FUNCTION: Let 𝐴 and 𝐵 be sets, and let 𝑓: 𝐴 → 𝐵 be a function from 𝐴 to
𝐵. A function 𝑔: 𝐵 → 𝐴 from 𝐵 to 𝐴 is said to be the inverse of the function 𝑓 if
𝑔(𝑓(𝑎)) = 𝑎 for all elements 𝑎 of 𝐴 and 𝑓(𝑔(𝑏)) = 𝑏 for all elements 𝑏 of 𝐵. If there
exists a function 𝑔: 𝐵 → 𝐴 that is the inverse of 𝑓: 𝐴 → 𝐵, then the function 𝑓 is said to
be invertible and the inverse of a function 𝑓: 𝐴 → 𝐵 is denoted by 𝑓 −1 ∶ 𝐵 → 𝐴.
INVERSE POINTS W.R.T. A CIRCLE: Two points 𝐴(𝑧 = 𝑎) and 𝐵(𝑧 = 𝑏)are said to be
inverse points of a circle with centre 𝑂(𝑧 = 𝑧0 ) and radius 𝑟 if 𝑂. 𝐴, 𝐵 are collinear and
𝑂𝐴. 𝑂𝐵 = 𝑟 2
So that a − z0 ∙ b − z0 = r 2
INVERSE RULE: Suppose 𝑓 ∶ [𝑎, 𝑏] → 𝑅 is differentiable on [𝑎, 𝑏] and 𝑓 ′ (𝑥) > 0 for all
𝑥 ∇ [𝑎, 𝑏]. Let 𝑓(𝑎) = 𝑐 and 𝑓(𝑏) = 𝑑. Then the map 𝑓 ∶ [𝑎, 𝑏] → [𝑐, 𝑑] is bijective
1
and 𝑓 −1 is differentiable on [𝑐, 𝑑] with 𝑓 −1 ′ (𝑥) = .
𝑓 ′ (𝑓 −1 (𝑥))
Two lines through a vertex of a triangle are isogonal conjugate if they are
symmetric in the bisector of the triangle's angle at this vertex.
ISOLATED POINT: Let 𝑋 be a topological space, let 𝑆 ⊆ 𝑋, and let 𝑥 ∇ 𝑆. The point 𝑥 is
said to be an isolated point of 𝑆 if there exists an open set 𝑈 ⊆ 𝑋 such that 𝑈 ∩ 𝑆 =
{𝑥}.
The set 𝑆 is isolated if every point in 𝑆 is an isolated point.
𝜌 𝑓, 𝑔 = 𝜌′ Φ 𝑓 , Φ 𝑔 .
As an example of isometry, take both the metric spaces to be the real number system
with the usual metric (i.e. R with 𝜌 𝑓, 𝑔 = 𝑓 − 𝑔 , 𝑓, 𝑔 𝜖 𝑅), under the mapping
𝑓 → 𝑓 + 𝑎, where 𝑎 is a fixed real number.
Another mapping which is also an isometry in this context is the one that takes any real
number 𝑓 𝑡𝑜 − 𝑓. A one-one linear transformation 𝑇 of 𝑁 into 𝑁 ∗∗ is called an isometry if
𝑇𝑓 = 𝑓 , for all 𝑓 ∇ 𝑁, when 𝑁 ∗ is conjugate space of N.
ISOMORPHIC SPACE: Two normed linear spaces are said to be isomorphic if there exists
a one-one correspondence between them which preserves linearity and the norm.
𝑢 = 𝑢 𝑥, 𝑦 , 𝑣 = 𝑣(𝑥, 𝑦)
Maps a closed region 𝑅 of z-plane upon a closed region 𝑅′ of 𝜔 − 𝑝𝑙𝑎𝑛𝑒. Let 𝛿𝐴𝑧 and
𝛿𝐴𝜔 denote respectively areas of these regions. Then it is easy to show that
𝛿𝐴𝜔
lim =𝐽
𝛿𝐴 𝑧 →0 𝛿𝐴𝑧
𝜕𝑢 𝜕𝑢
𝜕(𝑢, 𝑣) 𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑦
𝒥= =
𝜕(𝑥, 𝑦) 𝜕𝑣 𝜕𝑣
𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑦
The sub division ring and the corresponding subalgebra are each other's commutants.
JENSEN'S COVERING THEOREM: Jensen's covering theorem states that if 0 does not
exist then every uncountable set of ordinals is contained in a constructible set of the
same cardinality. Informally this conclusion says that the constructible universe is close
to the universe of all sets.
JENSEN’S FORMULA COMPLEX ANALYSIS): If 𝑓(𝑧) is analytic within and on the circle 𝛾
such that 𝑧 = 𝑅, 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑖𝑓 (𝑧) has zeros at the points 𝑎𝑗 ≠ 0, (𝑗 = 1,2, … . , 𝑚) and poles at
𝑏𝑗 ≠ 0, (𝑗 = 1,2, … … , 𝑛) inside 𝛾, multiple zeros and poles being repeated, then
2𝜋 𝑚 𝑛
1 𝑅 𝑅
log 𝑓 𝑅𝑒 𝑖𝜃 𝑑𝜃 = log 𝑓(0) + log − log
2𝜋 0 𝑎𝑟 𝑏𝑠
𝑟=1 𝑠=1
JENSEN’S THEOREM COMPLEX ANALYSIS): Let 𝑓(𝑧) be analytic for 𝑓(𝑧) ≤ 𝑅. Let
𝑟1 , 𝑟2 , … 𝑟𝑛 , be moduli of the zeros of 𝑓(𝑧) in 𝑧 < 𝑅 arranged as a non-decreasing
sequence. Then, 𝑖𝑓 𝑟𝑛 ≤ 𝑟 < 𝑟𝑛+1 , prove that
2𝜋
𝑟 𝑛 𝑓(0) 1
log = log 𝑓 𝑟𝑒 𝑖𝜃 𝑑𝜃
𝑟1 , 𝑟2 , … 𝑟𝑛 2𝜋 0
JOCHIMSTHAL’S THEOREM DIFFERENTIAL GEOMETRY): If the curve of intersection of
two surface is a line of curvature on both the surfaces, then the surface cut a constant
angle. Conversely, if two surfaces cut a constant angle and the curve of intersection is a
line of curvature on one of them, then it is also a line curvature on the other.
JOCKEYING: If there are number of queues, then one may leave one queue to join
another.
JOHNSON’S METHDO For n-jobs 2- machines): Let suppose 𝑛 𝑗𝑜𝑏𝑠 1,2, … 𝑛 are to be
processed on two machines say 𝐴 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝐵 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝐴𝑖 , 𝐵𝑖 , 𝑖 = 1,2, … 𝑛 are the respective
processing times of 𝑖 𝑡 job on 𝐴 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝐵 machines respectively.
Assumptions
We want to find the sequence of jobs to be performed on two machines so that the total
time 𝑇 elapsed from the start of the first job to the completion of the last job to be
minimized.
Step1. Select the smallest processing time in the list 𝐴1 , 𝐴2 , … 𝐴𝑛 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝐵1 , 𝐵2 , … 𝐵𝑛 . If there
is a tie then either of these smallest processing time may be selected or in this case
consider the following cases:
(i) Minimum of all the processing times is 𝐴𝑟 which is also equal to 𝐵𝑠 . Then min
𝐴𝑖 , 𝐵𝑖 = 𝐴𝑟 = 𝐵𝑠 . . Then do the 𝑟 𝑡 job first and 𝑠 𝑡 job in the end.
(ii) If min 𝐴𝑖 , 𝐵𝑖 = 𝐴𝑟 but also 𝐴𝑟 = 𝐴𝑘 𝑠𝑎𝑦 then do anyone of these jobs for
which there is a tie, first.
(iii) If there is a tie for minimum among 𝐵𝑖′ 𝑠𝑖. 𝑒. , 𝑀𝑖𝑛 𝐴𝑖 , 𝐵𝑖 = 𝐵𝑠 = 𝐵𝑟 𝑠𝑎𝑦 then
do anyone of these jobs in the last.
Step5. Continuing the same process until all the jobs have been ordered and get optimal
sequence of jobs.
JOINT VARIATION: If 𝑧 = 𝑘𝑥𝑦, where k is a constant, then 𝑧 is said to vary jointly with x
and y.
JORDAN ARC: Suppose 𝑥 t and 𝑦 t are continuous real valued functions in the range
𝛼 ≤ 𝑡 ≤ 𝛽, then the set of points 𝑧 in the Argand plane determined by the equation
𝑧 = 𝑥 t + i𝑦 t is called a continuous arc. A point z1 is called multiple point of the arc if
the equation 𝑧 = 𝑥 t + i𝑦 t is called a continuous arc. A point z1 is called multiple
point of the arc if the equation 𝑧1 = 𝑥 t + i𝑦 t is satisfied by more than one value of t
in the given range. A multiple point z1 of the arc is called a double point if the equation
(1) is satisfied by two values of t in the given range. A continuous arc without multiple
points is called a Jordan arc.
If the end points t = α and t = β of the continuous arc are coincident and if the arc has
only one multiple point (which is the double point corresponding to the two terminal
values of t), then the arc is called simple closed Jordan closed curve.
One of these domain is bounded and is called interior domain while the other is
unbounded and is called exterior domain.
JORDAN DECOMPOSITION THEOREM: Let ν be an additive set function on an algebra 𝐴
of subsets of 𝑋, and suppose that 𝜈 has finite total variation. Then, for all 𝐴 ∇ 𝐴, 𝜈(𝐴) =
𝑉 (𝜈, 𝐴) + 𝑉 (𝜈, 𝐴) .
JORDAN–HÖLDER THEOREM: Any two composition series of a given group are
equivalent. That is, they have the same composition length and the same composition
factors, up to permutation and isomorphism.
Here 𝑅 is taken so large that all the singularities of 𝑓(𝑧) lie within the semi circle Γ. (No
singularity lies on the boundary of the semi circle).
JORDAN NORMAL FORM: Let 𝑉 be a finite dimensional vector space over a complete
field 𝐹 and α an endomorphism of 𝑉 . Then there is basis for 𝑉 such that 𝛼 has matrix 𝐴
(relative to this basis) which consists of zeros except for Jordan matrices 𝐽(𝜆𝑖 , 𝑛𝑖 ) [1 ≤
𝑖 ≤ 𝑠] down the diagonal.
c2
JOUKOWSKI TRANSFORMATION: The transformation ζ = z + is called the Joukowski
z
JULIA SET: The set of points for a function of the form 𝑧 2 + 𝑐 (where 𝑐 is a complex
parameter), such that a small perturbation can cause drastic changes in the sequence of
iterated function values and iterations will either approach zero, approach infinity or
get trapped in loop.
K
KELVIN’S CIRCULATION THEOREM: Kelvin’s theorem states that the circulation round
any closed material curve is invariant in an inviscid fluid provided that the body force
are conservative and the pressure is single-valued function of density only.
KEPLER, JOHANNES: Johannes Kepler (1571-1630) was a German astronomer who used
observational data to express the motion of the planets according to three mathematical
laws:
Planets move along orbits shaped like ellipses, with the sun at one focus;
A radius vector connecting the sun to the planet sweeps out equal areas in equal
times (this means that a planet travels fastest when closest to the sun);
The square of the orbital period is proportional to the cube of the mean distance
from the planet to the sun.
KERNEL OF LINEAR FUNCTIONAL: The kernel of linear functional 𝛼, write 𝑘𝑒𝑟𝛼, is the
set all vectors 𝑥 ∇ 𝑋 such that 𝛼(𝑥) = 0.
Note that
2. 𝛼 𝑥 ≤ 𝛼 · 𝑥 𝑓𝑜𝑟 𝑎𝑙𝑙 𝑥 ∇ 𝑋, 𝛼 ∇ 𝑋 ∗.
4. 𝑘𝑒𝑟𝛼 is a subspace of 𝑋.
KNOT THEORY: An area of topology that studies mathematical knots (a knot is a closed
curve in space formed by interlacing a piece of “string” and joining the ends .
This theorem can be generalized to ideals that are not principal, and the result is often
called Krull's height theorem. This says that if 𝑅 is a Noetherian ring and 𝐼 is a proper
ideal generated by 𝑛 elements of 𝑅, then 𝐼 has height at most 𝑛.
𝑋 = x: x ∇ X 0 , g(x) ≤ 0
𝑔 is said to satisfy the Kuhn- Tucker constraint qualification at x ∇ X if 𝑔 is differentiable
at x and if there exist an n – dimensional vector function e defined on the interval [0,1]
such that
e 0 = x, e τ ∇ X for 0 ≤ τ ≤ I
𝑑𝑒 (0)
and e is differentiable at 𝜏 = 0 and = 𝜆𝛾 for some 𝜆 > 0 where 𝛾 ∇ 𝑅 𝑛 ,
𝑑𝜏
∆g 𝑙 (x)𝛾 ≤ 0 and I = i g i x = 0
KUHN- TUCKER STATIONARY- POINT PROBLEM (KTP): The Kuhn- Tucker stationary-
point problem means to find x ∇ X 0 , u ∇ Rm if they exist, such that ∆x Ψ x, u = 0,
∆u Ψ x, u ≤ 0, u∆u Ψ x, u = 0, u ≥ 0 and Ψ x, u = θ x) + ug(x or equivalently,
∆θ x) + u ∆g(x = 0, g(x) ≤ 0, u g x = 0 and u ≥ 0
KURT GÖDEL: Kurt Gödel was born in the Czech Republic and grew up in Austria (which
was the Austro-Hungarian Empire in Gödel's early childhood). His primary language
was German. Although he is most famous for his contribution to mathematical logic, he
also did much work in set theory . He was a friend of Albert Einstein during the time
they were both at the Institute for Advanced Study at Princeton University
L
LAGRANGE, JOSEPH-LOUIS: Joseph-Louis Lagrange (1736-1813) was an Italian-French
mathematician who developed ideas in celestial mechanics, calculus of variations, and
number theory.
where the four numbers are integers. For illustration, 3, 31 and 310 can
be represented as the sum of four squares as follows:
The Lagrangian is 𝐿(𝑥, 𝜆) = 𝑓(𝑥) − 𝜆 ⊤ (𝑔(𝑥) − 𝑏), with 𝜆 ∇ 𝑅 𝑚 (one component for
each constraint).
Each component of 𝜆 is called a Lagrange multiplier. The following theorem is simple to
prove, and extremely useful in practice. If 𝑥 ∗ and 𝜆∗ exist such that 𝑥 ∗ is feasible for
𝑃 and 𝐿(𝑥 ∗ , 𝜆∗ ) ≤ 𝐿(𝑥, 𝜆∗ ) ∀𝑥 ∇ 𝑋, then 𝑥 ∗ is optimal for 𝑃.
d2 y dy
𝑥 2 + 1−𝑥 + λy = 0,
dx dx
d2 y dy
𝑥 2 + 1−𝑥 + ny = 0
dx dx
As that for which a0 = 1 and call it the Laguerre polynomial of order 𝑛, denote it by
𝑛
𝑛!
𝐿𝑛 𝑥 , = (−1)𝑟 𝑥′
𝑛 − 𝑟 ! (𝑟!)2
𝑟=0
∞ 𝑧𝑛
𝑛=1 𝑎𝑛 1−𝑧 𝑛 , 𝑧 ≠ 1, (1)
1 π n
Pn x =π ∫0 x ± x 2 − 1 cos∅ d∅.
1 π d∅
Pn x =π ∫0 n +1 .
x± x 2 −1 cos∅
LAPLACE TRANSFORMATION:
Laplace
Entry Function
Tranformation
unit impulse unit impulse
unit step
slope
parabola
tn
(n is integer)
exponential
time
multiplied
exponential
Asymptotic
exponential
double
exponential
asymptotic
double
exponential
asymptotic
critically
damped
differentiated
critically
damped
sine
cosine
decaying
sine
decaying
cosine
generic
decaying
oscillatory
generic
decaying
oscillatory
(alternate)
Prototype
2nd order
lowpass
step
response
Prototype
2nd order
lowpass
impulse
response
Prototype
2nd order
bandpass
impulse
response
LAPLACIAN: The Laplacian of a function 𝑓 (𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧) is:
2
∂2 f ∂2 f ∂2 f
∆ = 2+ 2+ 2
∂x ∂y ∂z
It is the divergence of the gradient of 𝑓 .
LATERAL AREA: The lateral area of a solid is the area of its faces other than its bases.
For example, the lateral area of a pyramid is the total area of the triangles forming the
sides of the pyramid.
LATUS RECTUM: The latus rectum of a parabola is the chord through the focus
perpendicular to the axis of symmetry. The latus rectum of an ellipse is one of the
chords through a focus that is perpendicular to the major axis.
LAURENT’S THEOREM COMPLEX ANALYSIS): Suppose a function 𝑓(𝑧) is analytic in the
closed ring bounded by two concentric 𝐶 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝐶′ of centre 𝑎 and radii 𝑅 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑅 ′ , 𝑅 ′ <
𝑅 . If 𝑧 is any point of the annulus, then
∞ ∞
𝑓 𝑧 = 𝑎𝑛 (𝑧 − 𝑎)𝑛 + 𝑏𝑛 (𝑧 − 𝑎)−𝑛
𝑛=0 𝑛=1
Where
1 𝑓 𝑡 𝑑𝑡 1 𝑓 𝑡 𝑑𝑡
𝑎𝑛 = ∫𝐶 , 𝑏𝑛 = ∫ ′
2𝜋𝑖 (𝑡 − 𝑎)𝑛+1 2𝜋𝑖 𝐶 (𝑡 − 𝑎)−𝑛+1
LAW OF AVERAGES: The law of averages is an erroneous generalization of the law of
large numbers, which states that the frequencies of events with the same likelihood of
occurrence even out, given enough trials or instances. The law of averages is usually
mentioned in reference to situations without enough outcomes to bring the law of large
numbers into effect.
A common example of how the law of averages can mislead involves the tossing of a fair
coin (a coin equally likely to come up heads or tails on any given toss). If someone
tosses a fair coin and gets several heads in a row, that person might think that the next
toss is more likely to come up tails than heads in order to "even things out." But the true
probabilities of the two outcomes are still equal for the next coin toss and any coin toss
that might follow. Past results have no effect whatsoever: Each toss is an independent
event. The law of large numbers is often confused with the law of averages, and many
texts use the two terms interchangeably. However, the law of averages, strictly defined,
LAW OF EXCLUDED MIDDLE: One of the two: either a statement is true or it is false.
There's nothing in-between. An axiom of 2-valued logic.
LAW OF LARGE NUMBERS: The law of large numbers states that if a random variable is
observed many times, the average of these observations will tend toward the expected
value (mean) of that random variable. For example, if you roll a die many times and
calculate the average value for all of the rolls, you will find that the average value will
tend to approach 3.5.
LEADER OF A COSET (CODING THEORY): The leader of a coset is defined to be the word
with the smallest hamming weight in the coset.
LEBESGUE'S DOMINATED CONVERGENCE THEOREM: Let {𝑓𝑛 } be a sequence of real-
valued measurable functions on a measure space (𝑆, 𝛴, 𝜇). Suppose that the sequence
converges pointwise to a function 𝑓 and is dominated by some integrable function 𝑔 in
the sense that
for all numbers 𝑛 in the index set of the sequence and all points 𝑥 ∇ 𝑆. Then 𝑓 is
integrable and
d2 y dy
(1 − x 2 ) 2
− 2x + n n + 1 y = 0
dx dx
𝑑 dy
1 − x2 + n n + 1 y = 0.
𝑑𝜇 dx
∂ 𝜕𝑉 1 𝜕 ∂V 1 ∂2 V
𝑟 2 𝜕𝑟 + 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝜃 𝜕𝜃 sin 𝜃 ∂θ + 𝑠𝑖𝑛 2 𝜃 ∂∅2 = 0 ……….. i
∂r
∂V ∂V ∂U n ∂ 2 V ∂2 U n
So that ∂r = nr n−1 Un , ∂θ = r n , ∂∅2 = r n .
∂θ ∂∅2
∂ 1 𝜕 ∂U n 1 ∂2 U n
𝑛𝑟 𝑛+1 𝑈𝑛 + 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝜃 𝜕𝜃 r 2 sin 𝜃 + 𝑠𝑖𝑛 2 𝜃 . 𝑟 𝑛 =0
∂r ∂θ ∂∅2
𝑟𝑛 𝜕 ∂U n 𝑟𝑛 ∂2 U n
Or n 𝑛 + 1 𝑟 𝑛 𝑈𝑛 + 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝜃 𝜕𝜃 sin 𝜃 + 𝑠𝑖𝑛 2 𝜃 . 𝑟 𝑛 =0
∂θ ∂∅2
1 𝜕 ∂U n
Or n 𝑛 + 1 𝑈𝑛 + 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝜃 𝜕𝜃 sin 𝜃 = 0. ………….. ii
∂θ
Supposing 𝑈𝑛 to be independent of ∅.
∂U n ∂y ∂ y ∂μ ∂y
So that = ∂θ = . = − sin θ ∂μ .
∂θ ∂μ ∂θ
1 𝜕 ∂y
n 𝑛 + 1 𝑦 + 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝜃 𝜕𝜃 −sin2 𝜃 ∂μ = 0
1 𝜕 ∂y ∂μ
or n 𝑛 + 1 𝑦 + 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝜃 𝜕𝜇 − 1 − μ2 . ∂θ = 0
∂μ
𝜕 ∂y
or − 1 − μ2 + n n + 1 y = 0.
𝜕𝜇 ∂μ
Solution Pn (μ) of Legendre’s equation is the surface spheric harmonic of degree 𝑛, which
is free from ∅.
LEGENDRE FUNCTION OF THE SECOND KIND: We define the Legendre’s function of the
second kind, Qn , such that
n! n + 1 (n + 2) −n−3
Qn x = x −n−1 + ∙x
1 ∙ 3 … (2n + 1) 2 ∙ (2n + 3)
n + 1 n + 2 n + 3 (n + 4) −n−5
+ x
2 ∙ 4 2n + 3 (2n + 5)
II
III
IV
VI
VII
VIII
(where 𝑁 and 𝑐 are relatively prime) will come up so often he will abbreviate them as:
This is now known as the Legendre symbol, and an equivalent definition is used today:
In the (x, y) plane, the lemniscate can be described in terms of the following general
equation:
(𝑥 2 + 𝑦 2 ) 2 = 2𝑎2 (𝑥 2 − 𝑦 2 )
where 𝑎 represents the greatest distance between the curve and the origin. There are
two points on the curve that meet this criterion; both of them lie on the x axis. In the
above graph, if each division represents one unit, then 𝑎 = 5.
LIE ALGEBRA: A Lie algebra is a vector space g over R, equipped with a map
[·,·]: 𝑔 × 𝑔 → 𝑔 satisfying the properties
[𝑎𝑋 + 𝑏𝑌, 𝑍] = 𝑎[𝑋, 𝑍] + 𝑏[𝑌, 𝑍], [𝑋, 𝑎𝑌 + 𝑏𝑍] = 𝑎[𝑋, 𝑌 ] + 𝑏[𝑋, 𝑍],
[𝑋, 𝑌 ] = −[𝑌, 𝑋],
[[𝑋, 𝑌 ], 𝑍] + [[𝑌, 𝑍], 𝑋] + [[𝑍, 𝑋], 𝑌 ] = 0,
for all 𝑋, 𝑌, 𝑍 ∇ 𝑔 and 𝑎, 𝑏 ∇ 𝑅.
LIE BRACKET: Let 𝑋, 𝑌 ∇ 𝑋(𝑀) be smooth vector fields on 𝑀. The Lie bracket [𝑋, 𝑌 ] is
the linear operator 𝐶 ∞ (Ω) → 𝐶 ∞ (Ω) defined by the equation
[𝑋, 𝑌 ]𝑓 = 𝑋𝑌 𝑓 − 𝑌 𝑋𝑓 𝑓𝑜𝑟 𝑓 ∇ 𝐶 ∞ (Ω).
The Lie bracket satisfies
[𝑎𝑋 + 𝑏𝑌, 𝑍] = 𝑎[𝑋, 𝑍] + 𝑏[𝑌, 𝑍], [𝑋, 𝑎𝑌 + 𝑏𝑍] = 𝑎[𝑋, 𝑌 ] + 𝑏[𝑋, 𝑍],
[𝑋, 𝑌 ] = −[𝑌, 𝑋],
[[𝑋, 𝑌 ], 𝑍] + [[𝑌, 𝑍], 𝑋] + [[𝑍, 𝑋], 𝑌 ] = 0,
[𝑓𝑋, 𝑔𝑌 ] = 𝑓𝑔[𝑋, 𝑌 ] + 𝑓(𝑋𝑔)𝑌 − 𝑔(𝑌 𝑓)𝑋.
for all 𝑋, 𝑌, 𝑍 ∇ 𝑋(𝑀), and 𝑎, 𝑏 ∇ 𝑅.
LIE GROUPS: Lie groups, named after Sophus Lie, are differentiable manifolds that carry
also the structure of a group which is such that the group operations are defined by
smooth maps. A Euclidean vector space with the group operation of vector addition is
an example of a non-compact Lie group. A simple example of a compact Lie group is the
circle: the group operation is simply rotation. This group, known as 𝑈(1), can be also
characterised as the group of complex numbers of modulus 1 with multiplication as the
group operation. Other examples of Lie groups include special groups of matrices, which
are all subgroups of the general linear group, the group of 𝑛 × 𝑛 matrices with non-zero
determinant. If the matrix entries are real numbers, this will be an 𝑛2 -dimensional
disconnected manifold. The orthogonal groups, the symmetry groups of
the sphere and hyperspheres, are 𝑛(𝑛 − 1)/2 dimensional manifolds, where 𝑛 − 1 is
the dimension of the sphere.
L’HOSPITAL’S RULE: L’ Hospital’s rule tells how to find the limit of the ratio of two
functions in cases where that ratio approaches 0/0 or 𝜘/𝜘. Let
𝑓 𝑥
𝑦=
𝑔 𝑥
𝑙𝑖𝑚 𝑥→𝑎 𝑓′ 𝑥
lim 𝑦 =
𝑙𝑖𝑚 𝑥→𝑎 𝑔′ 𝑥
LIKE TERMS: Two terms said to be like terms if all parts of both terms except for the
numerical coefficients are the same. For example. The terms 23𝑎2 𝑏 3 𝑐 4 and 5𝑎2 𝑏 3 𝑐 4 are
like terms. If two like terms are added , they can be combined into one tem. For example
, the sum of two terms above is 28𝑎2 𝑏 3 𝑐 4 .
LIMIT: The limit of a function is the value that the dependent variable approaches as the
independent variable approaches some fixed value. The expression “The limit of 𝑓 𝑥 as
𝑥 approaches 𝑎" is written as
𝑙𝑖𝑚 𝑥→𝑎 𝑓 𝑥
For example:
𝑥−1 𝑥+3
𝑓 𝑥 =
𝑥−1
LIMIT POINT OF A FILTER: Let (𝐸, 𝑇) be a topological space and 𝐹 a filter on 𝐸. We say
that a point 𝑥 ∇ 𝐸 is a limit or limit point of 𝐹 if 𝐹 is finer than the filter 𝐵(𝑥) (the basis
of open neighborhoods), i.e. if every 𝑋 ∇ 𝐵(𝑥) contains an 𝐴 ∇ 𝐹. We then say that 𝐹
converges to 𝑥 or has 𝑥 as a limit or that 𝐹 converges or is convergent.
A filter does not necessary converge. For example the natural filter on 𝑁 with the
discrete topology.
A filter may have more than one limit point.
If 𝑥 is a limit point of 𝐹, 𝑥 may belong to some 𝐴 ∇ 𝐹 or may not belong to any
𝐴 ∇ 𝐹.
For example the filter 𝐵(𝑥) consisting of the open neighborhoods of 𝑥 converges
to 𝑥, and 𝑥 belongs to every 𝑋 ∇ 𝐵(𝑥). On the other hand, the set of open
intervals of 𝑅 all having the same left-hand end point 𝑥 is a filter which
converges to 𝑥, but 𝑥 does not belong to any member of the filter.
LINDELÖF'S THEOREM: Let Ω be a half-strip in the complex plane:
and
Then 𝛼1 𝑣1 + 𝛼2 𝑣2 = 𝛼1 + 2𝛼2 , 3𝛼1 + 5𝛼2 = (0,0) iff 𝛼1 + 2𝛼2 = 0 and 3𝛼1 + 5𝛼2 = 0.
Thus we have a pair of simultaneous equations in 𝛼1 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝛼2 and the only solution is
𝛼1 = 𝛼2 = 0, so 𝑣1 , 𝑣2 are linearly independent. Let V=ℚ2
, 𝑣1 = 1,3 , 𝑣2 = 2,6 here the equations are 𝛼1 + 2𝛼2 = 0
And 3𝛼1 + 6𝛼2 = 0 , and there are non-zero solutions such as 𝛼1 = −2 , 𝛼2 = 1 and
Let
V = i g i x = 0, and g i is concave at x ,
and let
W = i g i x = 0, and g i is concave at x ,
∆θ x) + z < 0, 𝛻g 𝑤 (x z < 0,
∆g 𝑣 (x)z ≤ 0
has no solution in Rn .
LINE OF BEST FIT: The line of best fit minimizes the sum of the squares of the deviations
between each point and the line.
LINE SEGMENT: A line segment is like a piece of a line. It consists of two endpoints and
all of the points on the straight line between those two points.
LINEAR FACTOR: A linear factor is a factor that includes only the first power of an
unknown. For example, in the expression 𝑦 = 𝑥 − 3 𝑥 2 + 3𝑥 + 4 , 𝑡𝑒 𝑓𝑎𝑐𝑡𝑜𝑟 𝑥 −
3 is a linear factor, but the factor 𝑥 2 + 3𝑥 + 4 is a quadratic factor.
LINEAR FUNCTIONAL: A linear functional on a vector space 𝑉 is a linear mapping
𝛼: 𝑉 → ℂ (or 𝛼: 𝑉 → ℝ in the real case), i.e. 𝛼 𝑎𝑥 + 𝑏𝑦 = 𝑎𝛼 𝑥 + 𝑏𝛼 𝑦 for all
𝑥, 𝑦 ∇ 𝑉 and 𝑎, 𝑏 ∇ ℂ. In simple words, A functional Φ is said to be linear if
Examples:
Maximize 6𝑥 + 8𝑦 subject:
𝑦 ≤ 10
𝑥 + 𝑦 ≤ 15
2𝑥 + 𝑦 ≤ 25
𝑥≥0
𝑦≥0
This problem has two choice variables: 𝑥 and 𝑦 . The objective function is 6𝑥 + 8𝑦, and
there are three constraints (not counting the two no negativity constraints 𝑥 ≥ 0 and
𝑦 ≥ 0. It is customary to rewrite the
constraints so that thy contain equals sign instead of inequality signs. In order to do this
some new variables called slack variables are added. One slack variable is added for
each constraint. Here is how the problem given above looks when three slack variables
𝑠1 , 𝑠2 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑠3 are included.
𝑦 + 𝑠1 = 10
𝑥 + 𝑦 + 𝑠2 = 15
2𝑥 + 𝑦 + 𝑠3 = 25
𝑥 ≥ 0, 𝑦 ≥ 0, 𝑠1 ≥ 0, 𝑠2 ≥ 0, 𝑠3 ≥ 0
Each slack variable represents the excess capacity associated with the corresponding
constraint.
The feasible region consists of all points that satisfy the constraints . A theorem of linear
programming stated that the optimal solution will lie at one of the corner points of the
feasible region. In this case the optimal solution is at the point 𝑥 = 5, 𝑦 = 10.
A linear programming problem with two choice variables can be solved by drawing a
graph of the feasible region, as was done above. I there are more than two variables,
however it is not possible to draw a graph, and he problem must then be solved by an
algebraic procedure, such as the simplex method.
𝑥1 𝑎1 + 𝑥2 𝑎2 + ⋯ + 𝑥𝑛 𝑎𝑛 = 0 .
LINEARLY ORDERED: An ordering ≤ (or <) of 𝐴 is called linear or total if any two
elements of 𝐴 are comparable. The pair (𝐴, ≤) is then called a linearly ordered set.
LINEAR MANIFOLD (OR SUBSPACE): A subset of 𝑀 of a linear space is called a linear
manifold (or subspace) if
It contains all the sums of all the vectors contained in it, i.e. if 𝑓 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑔 are in 𝑀
then so is 𝑓 + 𝑔, and
It contains all the scalar multiples of all its vector, i.e. if 𝑓 is in 𝑀 then so is of for
any scalar 𝑎.
Both (i) and (ii) can be combined into a single condition by saying that if
𝑓 and 𝑔 are in 𝑀, then so is 𝑎𝑓 + 𝑏𝑔, for any scalars 𝑎, 𝑏.
Then
𝐹𝑠 𝑎 𝑓 𝑡 + 𝑏 𝑔 𝑡 = 𝑎 𝐹𝑠 𝑠 + 𝑏 𝐺𝑠 𝑠
and
𝐹𝑐 𝑎 𝑓 𝑡 + 𝑏 𝑔 𝑡 = 𝑎 𝐹𝑐 𝑠 + 𝑏 𝐺𝑐 𝑠
Then
𝐹 𝑎𝑓 𝑡 + 𝑏𝑔 𝑡 =𝑎𝐹 𝑠 +𝑏𝐺 𝑠
𝑓 + 𝑔 = 𝑔 + 𝑓, (commutativity)
2. A certain scalar system having been prescribed which is either the complex number
system, or the real number system (the elements of the scalar defined, i.e. to every
scalar a and every vector 𝑓, a vector of called the scalar multiple of 𝑓 by a (occasionally
also denoted 𝑓𝑎) is assigned, satisfying the properties: for any scalars 𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐 and any
vector 𝑓, 𝑔, ,
The linear space is called a complex linear space or a real linear space according as the
prescribed scalar system is the complex number system or the real number system.
LINEAR SPAN: Let 𝐴 be a subset (finite or infinite) of a normed space 𝑉. The linear span
of 𝐴, write 𝐿(𝐴), is the intersection of all linear subspaces of 𝑉 containing 𝐴, i.e. the
smallest subspace containing 𝐴, equivalently the set of all finite linear combination of
elements of 𝐴. The closed linear span of 𝐴 write 𝐶𝐿(𝐴) is the intersection of all closed
linear subspaces of 𝑉 containing 𝐴, i.e. the smallest closed subspace containing 𝐴.
Let U and V be two vector spaces over the field K. A linear transformation or linear map
T from U to V is a function T: U→ 𝑉 𝑠𝑢𝑐 𝑡𝑎𝑡
(i) 𝑇(0𝑣) = 0𝑣
(ii) 𝑇(−𝑢) = −𝑇(𝑢) for all u 𝜖 𝑈
Examples: Many familiar geometrical transformations, such as projections, rotations,
reflections and magnifications are linear maps. Note, however, that a nontrivial
translation is not a linear map, because it does not satisfy 𝑇(0𝑣) = 0𝑣.
3. Let us take U = V = ℝ2 . Let 𝑇(𝑣) be the vector obtained by resulting from reflecting
𝜃
𝑣 through a line through the origin that makes an angle 2 with the 𝑥 −axis. This is again
a linear map. We find that 𝑇(1,0) = (𝑐𝑜𝑠 𝜃, 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝜃) 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑇(0,1) = (−𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝜃, 𝑐𝑜𝑠 𝜃) and
𝑇(𝛼, 𝛽) = 𝛼 𝑇(1,0) + 𝛽T 0,1 = (α cos θ + β sin θ, α sin θ − β cos θ)
5. Let U= 𝐾 𝑥 , the set of polynomials over K. Every 𝛼 𝜖 𝐾 gives rise to two linear maps,
shift 𝑆𝛼 : 𝑈 → 𝑈, 𝑆𝛼 𝑓 𝑥 = 𝑓 𝑥 − 𝛼 and evaluation 𝐸𝛼 : 𝑈 → 𝐾, 𝐸𝛼 𝑓 𝑥 =𝑓 𝛼
7. For any vector space U, V over the field K, we define the map 0𝑈,𝑉 : U→ 𝑉 by 0𝑈,𝑉
(u)=0v for all 𝑢 𝜖 𝑈. This is also a linear map.
To any linear map 𝑇: 𝑈 → 𝑉,we can associate a special subspace of U and a special
subspace of V called Kernel and Range spaces.
The kernel of T, written as 𝐾𝑒𝑟(𝑇), is the set of vectors 𝑢 𝜖 𝑈 such that 𝑇(𝑢) = 0𝑣
𝐼𝑚 𝑇 = 𝑇 𝑢 : 𝑢 𝜖 𝑈 ; 𝐾𝑒𝑟(𝑇) = 𝑢 𝜖 𝑈: T(u) = 0v
⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯
⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯⋯
𝑚
𝑇 𝑒𝑗 = 𝑖=1 𝛼𝑖𝑗 𝑓𝑖 for 1 ≤ 𝑗 ≤ 𝑛.
The coefficients 𝛼𝑖𝑗 form an 𝑚 × 𝑛 matrix
over K. Then A is called the matrix of the linear map T with respect to the chosen bases
of U and V. In general, different choices of bases give different matrices.
Note the role of individual columns in A. The jth column of A consists of the coordinates
of 𝑇 𝑒𝑗 w.r.t the basis 𝑓1 , 𝑓2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝑓𝑚 of V.
LINE OF FLOW: A line of flow is a line whose direction coincides with the direction of
the resultant velocity of the fluid.
𝜅𝑔 = 𝜃 ′ + 𝑃𝑢′ + 𝑄𝑣′
1
Where 𝑃 = 2𝐸𝐹1 − 𝐹𝐸1 − 𝐸𝐸2
2𝐻𝐸
1
and 𝑄 = (𝐸𝐺 − 𝐹𝐸2 )
2𝐻𝐸
LIOUVILLE’S THEOREM COMPLEX ANALYSIS): If an entire function is bounded for all
values of 𝑧, then it is constant.
or, If a function 𝑓(𝑧) is analytic for finite values of 𝑧, and is bounded, then 𝑓(𝑧) is
constant.
or, if 𝑓 is regular in whole 𝑧 − 𝑝𝑙𝑎𝑛𝑒 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑖𝑓 𝑓(𝑧) < 𝑘∀𝑧, then 𝑓(𝑧) must be constant.
or, Every holomorphic function 𝑓 for which there exists a positive number 𝑀 such that
|𝑓(𝑧)| ≤ 𝑀 for all 𝑧 in 𝐶 is constant.
Let a fluid element moves in a steady and non-uniform flow field from a point 𝑟 to a new
position (𝑟 + 𝑞𝛿𝑡). Then the change in any fluid property 𝐹 is equal to (𝜕𝐹/𝜕𝑆)𝑞𝛿𝑡 (to
the first app. in 𝑞𝛿𝑡). This change due to movement of the element is known as the
convective change or the convective derivative.
The change in any fluid property 𝐹 for a fluid element moving in the unsteady and non-
∂F
uniform flow field is made up of both the local and convective changes, i.e., 𝛿𝑡 +
∂t
𝜕𝐹
𝑞𝛿𝑡 , which is the same as the rate of change of 𝐹 following a certain fluid element.
𝜕𝑆
LOCAL DOMAIN: A local domain is an integral domain that has exactly one maximal
ideal. A local domain is a discrete valuation ring if and only if it is a principal ideal
domain.
LOCALISED AND FREE VECTORS: A vector which is drawn parallel to a given vector
through a specified point in space is called a localized vector. There can be one and only
one such vector. But if the origin of vector is not specified , the vectors are said to be
free vectors.
LOCAL MINIMUM: A local minimum point for a function 𝑦 = 𝑓 𝑥 is a point where the
value of y is smaller than the points near it. If the first derivative is zero and the second
derivative is negative at a point 𝑥1 , 𝑓 𝑥1 , then the function has a local maximum at
that point . There may be more than one local minimum, so there is no guarantee that a
particular local minimum will be the absolute minimum.
LOCUS: The term “locus” is a technical way of saying “set of points”. For example, a circle
can be defined as being “the locus of points in a plane that are a fixed distance from a
given point”. The plural of “locus” is “loci”
LOG: The function y= log x is an abbreviation for the logarithm function to the base 10.
LOGARITHM: The equation 𝑥 = 𝑎 𝑦 can be written as 𝑦 = 𝑙𝑜𝑔𝑎 𝑥, which means "𝑦 is the
logarithm to the base 𝑎 of 𝑥 and 𝑦 is the exponent to which 𝑎 must be raised in order to
result in 𝑥. For example 𝑙𝑜𝑔2 8 = 3 means the same as 23 = 8". Any positive number
(except1) can be used as the base for a logarithm function. The two most useful bases
are 10 and 𝑒. Logarithms to the base 10 are called common logarithms.
𝑙𝑜𝑔1 = 0 100 = 1
𝑙𝑜𝑔10 = 1 101 = 10
𝑙𝑜𝑔 𝑥 𝑛 = 𝑛 𝑙𝑜𝑔 𝑥
Logarithms have also been very helpful as calculation aids, because a multiplication
problem can be turned into an addition problem by taking the logarithms.
LOGIC: Logic is the study of sound reasoning. The study of logic focuses on the study of
arguments. An argument is a sequence of sentences (called premises), that lead to a
resulting sentences (called the conclusion). An argument is a valid argument if the
conclusion does follow from the premises. In order words, if an argument is valid and all
its premises are true, then the conclusion must be true.
Logic can be used to determine whether an argument is valid: however, logic alone
cannot determine whether the premises are true or false. Once an argument has been
shown to be valid, then all other arguments of the same general form will also be valid,
even if their premises are different.
Arguments are composed of sentences. Sentences are said to have the truth value 𝑇
corresponding to what we normally think of as “true” or the truth value
𝐹 corresponding to “false” . In studying the general logical properties of sentences, it is
customary to represent a sentence by a lower-case letter, such as p, q or r called a
sentence variable or a Boolean variable. Sentences either can be simple sentences or can
consist of simple sentences joined by connectives and called compound sentences.
LOGICAL SYMBOLS: If A and B are propositions, the propositions (A and B), (A or B), (A
implies B), and (not A) are denoted by 𝐴 ⋀𝐵, 𝐴⋁𝐵, 𝐴 ⟶ 𝐵, ∼ 𝐴, respectively. We call ∼
the negation of ∼ 𝐴, 𝐴 ⋀𝐵 the conjunction (or logical product), 𝐴⋁𝐵 the disjunction (or
logical sum), and 𝐴 ⟶ 𝐵 the implication (or B by A). The proposition (𝐴 ⟶ 𝐵)⋀(𝐵 ⟶
𝐴) is denoted by 𝐴 ⟷ 𝐵 and is read “A and B are equivalent.” 𝐴⋁ 𝐵 means that at least
one of A and B holds.
LORENTZ TRANSFORMATION: The Lorentz transformation describes how events look
different to observes moving with different velocities, according to Einstein’s special
theory of relativity . let t, x, y, z be the time and space coordinates of an event in the
original frame of reference , and let t’ ,x’ ,y’ ,z’ be the coordinates of an event in a new
frame, which is moving with velocity v in the positive x direction with respect to the
original frame.
1
Define 𝛾 = 1−𝑣 2/ 𝑐 2
In everyday life, the velocity 𝛾is always very small compared to the speed of light. So 𝛾 is
always very close to 1.
LOXODROME: A loxodrome on a sphere is curve that makes a constant angle with the
parallels of latitude.
𝛼1 𝑣1 + 𝛼2 𝑣2 + ⋯ ⋯ + 𝛼𝑛 𝑣𝑛 = 0
𝛼1 = 0, 𝛼2 = 0, ⋯ ⋯ , 𝛼𝑛 = 0.
LOWER RIEMANN INTEGRAL: Let 𝑓 be a bounded function on a bounded interval [𝑎, 𝑏].
Then lower Riemann integral of f over [𝑎, 𝑏] is the supremum of 𝐿 𝑃, 𝑓 over all
𝑏
partitions 𝑃 of [𝑎, 𝑏] and is denoted as ∫𝑎 𝑓𝑑𝑥.
𝐿 𝑃, 𝑓, 𝑔 = 𝑚𝑖 ∆𝑔𝑖
𝑖=1
Where
𝑚𝑖 = sup 𝑓(𝑥)
𝑥∇[𝑥 𝑖−1 ,𝑥 𝑖 ]
LOWER RIEMANN SUM: Let 𝑓 be a bounded function on a bounded interval [𝑎, 𝑏]. Let
𝑃 = 𝑥0 , 𝑥1 , 𝑥2 , 𝑥3 , … , 𝑥𝑛 be a partition of [𝑎, 𝑏]. Then lower Riemann sum denoted by
𝐿(𝑃, 𝑓) is defined as
𝑛
𝐿 𝑃, 𝑓 = 𝑚𝑖 𝑥𝑖 − 𝑥𝑖−1
𝑖=1
Where
𝑚𝑖 = sup 𝑓(𝑥)
𝑥∇[𝑥 𝑖−1 ,𝑥 𝑖 ]
Thus in an lower triangular matrix all the elements above the principle diagonal are
zero.
a11 0 0 …0
a21 a22 0 …0
For example A = a31 a32 a33 …0
… … … ……
an1 an2 an3 … ann n×n
A triangular matrix A = aij is called strictly triangular if aij = 0 for all i = 1,2, … , n.
n×n
LOWSEST COST ENTRY (MINIMA) MEHOD: This method of solution can be taken similar
to the North-West corner rule. But the difference lies in the fact that in this case, we first
assign allocations to the cell having lowest value. But in case , if either two or three cells
have the same least value, then the allocation is allotted to that cell for which the value
of demand is also least. In this way, we proceed from most minimum to the next
minimum.
LOWEST UPPER BOUND: Let 𝑆 be a set with an ordering relation ≤, and let 𝑇 be a subset
of 𝑆. A lowest upper bound of 𝑇 is an upper bound 𝑥 of 𝑇 with the property that 𝑥 ≤ 𝑦
for every upper bound 𝑦 of 𝑇. A lowest upper bound of 𝑇, when it exists, is unique.
LUZIN’S THEOREM: Every bounded measurable functions on [a,b] is the limit in the
mean of p-th power of a sequence of continuous function i.e., if 𝑓 is a bounded
measurable function on 𝑎, 𝑏 , then for a given 𝜀 > 0, there exists a continuous function
𝑔 on [𝑎, 𝑏], such that
𝑓−𝑔 𝑝 < 𝜀.
MACLAURIN SERIES: The Maclaurin series is a special case of the Taylor series for
𝑓 𝑥 + , 𝑤𝑒𝑛 𝑥 = 0.
𝑎 = 𝑎∙𝑎
𝐿2 − 𝑀1 = 𝑚𝐿 − 𝑙 − 𝜇 𝑀 − 𝜆𝑁
and
𝑀2 − 𝑁1 = 𝑛𝐿 − 𝑚 − 𝑣 𝑀 − 𝜇𝑁
are called Mainardi-Codazzi equations.
MAJOR AXIS: The major axis of an ellipse is the line segment joining two points on the
ellipse that passes through the two foci. It is the longest possible distance across the
ellipse.
MANIFOLD WITH BOUNDARY: A manifold with boundary is a manifold with an edge, e.g.
a sheet of paper is a 2-manifold with a 1-dimensional boundary. The boundary of an 𝑛-
manifold with boundary is an (𝑛 − 1) manifold. A disk is a 2-manifold with boundary.
Its boundary is a circle, a 1-manifold. A square with interior is also a 2-manifold with
boundary. A closed ball is a 3-manifold with boundary. Its boundary is a sphere, a 2-
manifold.
MANTISSA: The mantissa is the part of a common logarithm to the right of the decimal
point. For example, in the expression log 115=2.0607, the quantity 0.0607 is the
mantissa.
MAPPING: A mapping is a rule that, to each member of one set, assigns a unique member
of another set.
𝑟 = 𝑟 𝑢, 𝑣 , 𝑟 ∗ = 𝑟 ∗ (𝑢∗ , 𝑣 ∗ )
𝑢∗ = 𝜙 𝑢, 𝑣 , 𝑣 ∗ = Ψ (𝑢, 𝑣)
This establishes a one-to-one correspondence between the permissible pair of values of
𝑢, 𝑣 and the permissible pairs of values of 𝑢∗ , 𝑣 ∗ where if is assumed that 𝜙 𝑎𝑛𝑑 Ψ are
analytic functions of u and v. The parameters u,v on the surface S may be introduced as
parameters on the surface 𝑆 ∗ by putting the values of 𝑢∗ , 𝑣 ∗ , in terms of 𝑢, 𝑣 in
𝑟 ∗ = 𝑟 ∗ 𝑢∗ , 𝑣 ∗ . Thus the corresponding points of the two surface have the same
curvilinear co-ordinates. Thus the parametric equations of the two surface can be
written as
𝑟 = 𝑟 𝑢, 𝑣 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑟 ∗ (𝑢, 𝑣)
These equations serve not only to define the surface but also the map established
between them.
MATERIAL LINE ELEMENT: A material line element is a small line element marked in
the fluid, i.e., made up of fluid parcels, with end points moving with the flow.
⋮
𝑎𝑚1 𝑎𝑚2 𝑎𝑚3 ⋯ 𝑎𝑚𝑛
𝑛 𝑛 𝑛
The formula for matrix multiplication looks very complicated , but we can make more
sense of it by using the dot product of two vectors. The dot product of two vector is
formed by multiplying together each pair of corresponding components and then
adding the results of all these products.
𝑎11 ⋯ 𝑎1𝑛 𝑎1
⋮ = ⋮
𝑎𝑚1 ⋯ 𝑎𝑚𝑛 𝑎𝑚
𝑎1 = 𝑎11 𝑎12, … , 𝑎𝑖𝑛
𝑏11 ⋯ 𝑏1𝑝
⋮ = 𝑏1 𝑏2, … , 𝑏𝑝
𝑏𝑛1 ⋯ 𝑏𝑛𝑝
𝑏11 𝑏1𝑝
𝑏1 = ⋮ ⋯ 𝑏𝑝 = ⋮
𝑏𝑛1 𝑏𝑛𝑝
For our purpose it is best to think of the left hand matrix 𝑨 as a collection of row
vectors, and the right hand matrix 𝑩 as a collection of column vectors. Then each
element in the matrix product AB can be found as a dot product of one row of 𝑨 with
one column of B:
𝑎1 ∙ 𝑏1 𝑎1 ∙ 𝑏2 𝑎1 ∙ 𝑏3 ⋯ 𝑎1 ∙ 𝑏𝑝
𝑎2 ∙ 𝑏1 𝑎2 ∙ 𝑏2 𝑎2 ∙ 𝑏3 ⋯ 𝑎2 ∙ 𝑏𝑝
𝐴𝐵 = ⋮
𝑎𝑚 ∙ 𝑏1 𝑎𝑚 ∙ 𝑏2 𝑎𝑚 ∙ 𝑏3 ⋯ 𝑎𝑚 ∙ 𝑏𝑝
The element in position 1,1 of the product matrix is the dot product of the first row of
𝑨 with the first column of B. In general, the element in position 𝑖, 𝑗 is formed by the
dot product of row 𝑖 in 𝐴 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑐𝑜𝑙𝑢𝑚𝑛 𝑗 𝑖𝑛 𝐵 . Examples of matrix multiplication are:
𝑎 𝑏 𝑒 𝑓 𝑎𝑒 + 𝑏𝑔 𝑎𝑓 + 𝑏
=
𝑐 𝑑 𝑔 𝑐𝑒 + 𝑑𝑔 𝑐𝑓 + 𝑑
1 0 131211 38
11 12 13 100 1 232221 68
21 22 23 =
10000 2 333231 98
31 32 33
Matrix multiplication is a very valuable tool, making it much easier to write systems of
linear simultaneous equations. The three –equation system
𝑎1 𝑥 + 𝑏1 𝑦 + 𝑐1 𝑧 = 𝑑1
𝑎2 𝑥 + 𝑏2 𝑦 + 𝑐2 𝑧 = 𝑑2
𝑎3 𝑥 + 𝑏3 𝑦 + 𝑐3 𝑧 = 𝑑3
𝑎1 𝑏1 𝑐1 𝑥 𝑑1
𝑎2 𝑏2 𝑐2 𝑦 = 𝑑2
𝑎3 𝑏3 𝑐3 𝑧 𝑑3
n n
MATRIX OF A QUADRATIC FORM: If ∅ = i−1 j−1 a ij xi xj is a quadratic form in n
variabes x1 , x2 , … … , xn , then there exists a unique symmetrix matrix B of order n such
that ∅ = 𝑋 𝑇 𝐵𝑋 where 𝑋 = [x1 , x2 , … … , xn ]𝑇 . The symmetrix matrix B is called the
n n
matrix of the quadratic form i−1 j−1 a ij xi xj .
MAXIMA: The maxima are the points where the value of a function is greater than it is at
the surrounding points.
(a) We must first select the greatest element of our given assignment problem and
must subtract each element from this element to obtain a new matrix. The new matrix
obtained can now be solved by the usual method of assignment technique used for
minimal problems.
(b) One another method is also used for the conversion of maximization to
minimization. Place minus sign before each element of the given assignment matrix to
obtain a anew matrix. The new matrix thus can be treated as the usual assignment
minimal problem.
MAXIMAL ATLAS: The atlas containing all possible charts consistent with a given atlas is
called the maximal atlas (i.e. an equivalence class containing that given atlas (under the
already defined equivalence relation given in the previous paragraph)). Unlike an
ordinary atlas, the maximal atlas of a given manifold is unique. Though it is useful for
definitions, it is an abstract object and not used directly (e.g. in calculations).
MAXIMAL IDEAL: Let 𝑅 be a ring. A proper ideal 𝐼 of 𝑅 is said to be maximal if the only
ideals 𝐽 of 𝑅 satisfying 𝐼 ⊂ 𝐽 ⊂ 𝑅 are 𝐽 = 𝐼 and 𝐽 = 𝑅.
MAXIMUM DISTANCE SEPARABLE (MDS) CODE: A linear code with parameters [𝑛, 𝑘, 𝑑]
such that 𝑘 = 𝑛 − 𝑑 + 1 is called a maximum distance separable (MDS) code.
MAXIMUM FLOW PROBLEM:
All flow through the directed, connected network originates from one node,
called the source; and, terminates at one other node, called the sink.
All remaining nodes are called transshipment nodes.
Directed arcs indicated direction of flow, and maximum amount of flow is given
by the arc capacity. At the source, all arcs point away; at the sink, all arcs point
into the node.
Objective: maximize total amount of flow from source to sink. The amount
leaving the source is equal to the amount entering the sink.
MAXIMUM LIKELIHOOD DECODING: Let 𝐶 be a code of length 𝑛 over an alphabet 𝐴. The
maximum likelihood decoding rule states that every 𝑥 ∇ 𝐴𝑛 is decoded to 𝑐𝑥 ∇ 𝐶 when
𝑃[𝑥 𝑟𝑒𝑐𝑒𝑖𝑣𝑒𝑑 | 𝑐𝑥 𝑤𝑎𝑠 𝑠𝑒𝑛𝑡] = max 𝑃[𝑥 𝑟𝑒𝑐𝑒𝑖𝑣𝑒𝑑 | 𝑐 𝑤𝑎𝑠 𝑠𝑒𝑛𝑡]
𝑐 ∇𝐶
If there exist more than one 𝑐 with this maximum probability, then ⊥ is returned.
MAXIMUM LIKELIHOOD ESTIMATOR: A maximum likelihood estimator has this
property: if the true value of the unknown parameter is the same as the value of the
maximum likelihood estimator, then the probability of obtaining the sample that was
actually observed is maximizes.
MAXWELL’S EQUATIONS: Maxwell’s four equations govern electric and magnetic fields.
They were put together by James Clerk Maxwell in the 1870s on the basis of
experiments data. These equations can be used to establish the wave nature of light.
First, here are the equations for free space in integral form, assuming there is no change
in current over time.
Let E be an electric field (a three- dimensional vector field) Theses two equations apply:
1 𝐸 ∙ 𝑑𝐿 = 𝑜
𝑐𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑒𝑑 𝑝𝑎𝑡
(That is, the line integral of the electric field over any closed path is zero)
𝑞𝑖𝑛𝑠𝑖𝑑𝑒
2 𝐸 ∙ 𝑑𝑆 =
𝑐𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑒𝑑 𝑝𝑎𝑡 𝜀0
(That is, the surface integral of the electric field around any closed surface is equal to 𝑞,
the total charge inside the surface, divided by a constant known as 𝜀0
Let 𝑩 𝑏𝑒 a magnetic field (a three- dimensional vector field). Then the line integral
around a closed path depends on the current flowing through the interior of the path:
Where 𝐼 stands for the amount of electric current , and 𝜇𝑜 is a constant. The surface
integral of B over a closed surface is zero:
4 𝐵 ∙ 𝑑𝑆 = 0
𝑐𝑙𝑜𝑠𝑒𝑑 𝑝𝑎𝑡
The four equations given above can also be written in alternate forms. Use Stroke’s
theorem to rewrite the two equations involving line integrals . Equation (1) becomes:
(5) ∆ ×𝐸 = 0
(6) ∆ × 𝐵 = 𝜇0 𝐽
Where 𝐽 , called the current density is defined by this integral:
𝐽 ∙ 𝑑𝑆 = 𝐼𝑖𝑛𝑠𝑖𝑑𝑒
𝑠𝑢𝑟𝑓𝑎𝑐𝑒 𝑆
By using the divergence theorem, the two equations involving surface integrals can be
rewritten. The left hand side of equation (2) is changed from
𝐸 ∙ 𝑑𝑆
𝑠𝑢𝑟𝑓𝑎𝑐𝑒 𝑆
Into
∆ ∙𝐸 𝑑𝑉
𝑖𝑛𝑡𝑒𝑟𝑖𝑜𝑟 𝑜𝑓 𝑆
The right-hand side of equation (2) is changed by defining 𝜌 over any volume is equal to
the total charge inside that volume:
𝑞𝑖𝑛𝑠𝑖𝑑𝑒 𝑆 = 𝜌𝑑𝑉
𝑖𝑛𝑡𝑒𝑟𝑖𝑜𝑟 𝑜𝑓 𝑆
𝜌
∆ ∙𝐸 𝑑𝑉 = 𝑑𝑉
𝑖𝑛𝑡𝑒𝑟𝑖𝑜𝑟 𝑜𝑓 𝑆 𝑖𝑛𝑡𝑒𝑟𝑖𝑜𝑟 𝑜𝑓 𝑆 𝜀0
Since this equation must hold true for any arbitrary surface S, we can write the equation
in this form:
𝜌
(7) ∆∙𝐸 =
𝜀0
In words: the divergence of the electric field is proportional to the charge density.
Equation(4) becomes:
(8) ∆ ∙ 𝐵 = 0
When equality holds one says that 𝐹, 𝑊, 𝑍 satisfies the strong max–min property
MAZUR–ULAM THEOREM: If 𝑉 and 𝑊 are normed spaces over R and the mapping
numbers are 𝑥1 , 𝑥2 , 𝑥3 , … … . 𝑥𝑛 . the mean proportional is the nth root of their product.
𝑛
𝑥1 × 𝑥2 × 𝑥3 × … × 𝑥𝑛 .
1. A function f is measurable;
1. µ(∅) = 0.
2. if (𝐴𝑛 ) is a finite subset of 𝑅, such that 𝐴𝑗 are pairwise disjoint (that is,
𝐴𝑛 ∩ 𝐴𝑚 = ∅ for 𝑛 ≠ 𝑚), then µ(⋃𝑛 𝐴𝑛 ) = 𝑛 µ(𝐴𝑛 ). This property is called
additivity of a measure. .
MEDIAN: (1) The median of a group of 𝑛 number is the number which divides the whole
data into two equal halves. For example the median of the set of numbers
1,2,3 𝑖𝑠 2; 𝑡𝑒 𝑚𝑒𝑑𝑖𝑎𝑛 𝑜𝑓 1,1,1,2,10,1516,20,100,110 is 15 . in order to determine
the median, the list should be placed in ascending or descending order. If there is an odd
number of items in the list , then the median is the element in the exact middle. If there
is an even number , then the medina is the average of the two numbers closest to the
middle.
(2) A median if a triangle is a line segment connecting one vertex to the midpoint of the
opposite side.
MEROMORPHIC FUNCTION: A function which has poles as its only singularities in the
finite part of the plane is said to be meromorphic function.
It takes the most powerful computer a long time to check a large number to determine if
it is prime, and an even longer time to determine if it is a Mersenne prime. For this
reason, Mersenne primes are of particular interest to developers of
strong encryption methods. In August 2008, Edson Smith, a system administrator at
UCLA, found the largest prime number known to that date. Smith had installed software
for the Great Internet Mersenne Prime Search (Gimps), a volunteer-based distributed
computing project. The number (which is a Mersenne prime) is 12,978,189 digits long.
It would take nearly two-and-a-half months to write out and, if printed, would stretch
out for 30 miles.
𝜕𝑢 𝜕𝑢
METHOD OF CHARACTERISTICS: The first order wave equation 𝑐 𝜕𝑥 − 𝜕𝑡 = 0
describes the movement of a wave in one direction with no change of shape. The aim of
the method of characteristics is to solve the PDE by finding curves in the 𝑥 − 𝑡 plane
that reduce the equation to an ODE. In general, any curve in the 𝑥 − 𝑡 plane can be
expressed in parametric form by 𝑥 = 𝑥 𝑟 , 𝑡 = 𝑡 𝑟 , where the parameter, 𝑟, gives a
measure of the distance along the curve. The curve starts at the initial point, 𝑥 = 𝑥0 ,
𝑡 = 0, when 𝑟 = 0. Assuming that we can solve the resulting ODE means that 𝑢 is known
everywhere along this curve, i.e. along the curve picked out by the value of 𝑥0 . Another
choice for 𝑥0 gives another curve and the value of 𝑢 is determined along this curve. In
this manner, 𝑢 can be determined at any point in the 𝑥 − 𝑡 plane by choosing the curve,
defined by 𝑥0 , that passes through this point and taking the correct value of 𝑥0 , the
distance along the curve. Hence, we can evaluate 𝑢(𝑥, 𝑡).
characteristic curves. 𝑢 = 𝑐𝑜𝑛𝑠𝑡. along a characteristic curve but the constant may be
different on different characteristic curves. As 𝑥0 gives us a different characteristic
curve, this implies that 𝑢 = 𝐹(𝑥0 ).
(i) 𝑑(𝑥, 𝑦) ≥ 0.
(ii) 𝑑(𝑥, 𝑦) = 0 𝑖𝑓𝑓 𝑥 = 𝑦.
(iii) 𝑑(𝑥, 𝑦) = 𝑑(𝑦, 𝑥).
(iv) 𝑑(𝑥, 𝑧) ≤ 𝑑(𝑥, 𝑦) + 𝑑(𝑦, 𝑧).
METRIC TENSOR: A metric tensor defines how to measure distances along a path using
an integral based on a particular set of coordinated. For the simplest example, consider
this integral in two-dimensional Euclidian space using Cartesian coordinates. The
calculation is based on the differential distance 𝑑𝑆:
𝑑𝑆 2 = 𝑑𝑥12 + 𝑑𝑥22
𝑑𝑆 2 = 𝑔11 𝑑𝑥12 + 𝑔12 𝑑𝑥1 𝑑𝑥2 + 𝑔21 𝑑𝑥2 𝑑𝑥1 + 𝑔22 𝑑𝑥22
𝑔11 = 1, 𝑔12 = 0,
𝑔21 = 0 𝑔22 = 1
The matrix 𝑔 is the metric (or the metric tensor). The components of 𝑔 determine how
to measure distances along curves in this particular space using these coordinates.
2 2
z+z z−z
MILNE’S THOMSON’S METHOD: We have 𝑧 = 𝑥 + 𝑖𝑦 so that x = ,y= .
2 2i
𝑤 = 𝑓 𝑧 = 𝑢 + 𝑖𝑣 = 𝑢 𝑥, 𝑦 + 𝑖𝑣 (𝑥, 𝑦)
𝑓 𝑧 = 𝑢 𝑧, 0 + 𝑖𝑣 (𝑧, 0)
We know that
𝑑𝑤 𝜕𝑤 𝜕𝑢 𝜕𝑣
𝑓′ 𝑧 = = = + 𝑖
𝑑𝑧 𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑥
𝜕𝑢 𝜕𝑢
= − 𝑖 𝜕𝑦 , by Cauchy-Riemann equations,
𝜕𝑥
𝜕𝑢
Taking 𝜕𝑥 = 𝜙1 𝑥, 𝑦 = 𝜙1 (𝑧, 0)
𝜕𝑢
= 𝜙2 𝑥, 𝑦 = 𝜙2 (𝑧, 0)
𝜕𝑦
We get 𝑓 ′ 𝑧 = 𝜙1 𝑧, 0 − 𝑖 𝜙2 (𝑧, 0)
𝑓 𝑧 = 𝜙1 𝑧, 0 − 𝑖𝜙2 (𝑧, 0) 𝑑𝑧 + 𝑐,
𝑓 𝑧 = Ψ1 𝑧, 0 + 𝑖Ψ2 (𝑧, 0) 𝑑𝑧 + 𝑐′
𝜕𝑣 𝜕𝑣
Where Ψ1 = 𝜕𝑦 , Ψ2 = 𝜕𝑥
MINDING THEOREM (DIFFERENTIAL GEOMETRY): If two surface S and S’ have the same
constant curvatures, then they are locally isometric.
MINIMA: The minima are the points where the value of a function is less than it is at the
surrounding points.
MINIMAL SURFACE: If mean curvature of a surface is zero at all points, then the surface
is called a minimal surface.
MINIMAX AND MAXMIN PRINIPLES: If a player lists his worst possible outcomes of all
his potential strategy, then he will choose the best strategy among all these outcomes.
Suppose further that 𝑓(𝑧) is not constant. Then 𝑓(𝑧) attains its minimum value at a
point on the boundary of 𝐶, that is to say, if 𝑚 is the minimum value of 𝑓(𝑧) inside and
on 𝐶, then
θ x = minx∇X θ x where 𝑥 ∇ 𝑋 = x: x ∇ X 0 , g x ≤ 0, h x = 0 .
Let θ and 𝑔 be differentiable at x, and let h have continuous first partial derivatives at x.
then there exists r ∇ R, r ∇ Rm , s ∇ Rk such that the following conditions are satisfied
𝑓 = 𝑓 1 ,𝑓 2 ,… 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑔 = 𝑔 1 , 𝑔 2 , … .
belonging to 𝑙 𝑃 ,
and
in particular,
and these bounds are attained when 𝑥 is an eigenvector of the appropriate eigenvalues.
Also note that the simpler formulation for the maximal eigenvalue 𝝀𝟏 is given by:
If we leave the row and the column passing through the element aij , then the second
order determinant thus obtained is called the minor of the element aij and we denote it
by Mij . In this way we can get 9 minors corresponding to the 9 elements of ∆.
For example,
a12 a13
The minor of the element a21 = a a33 = M21,
32
a11 a13
The minor of the element a32 = a a23 = M32,
21
a22 a23
The minor of the element a11 = a a33 = M11, and so on.
32
In terms of the notation of minors, if we expand ∆ along the first row, then
Thus we can express the determinant as a linear combination of the minors of the
elements of any row or any column.
MINOR ARC: A minor arc of a circle is an are with a measure less than 180.
MINOR AXIS: The minor axis of an ellipse is the line segment that passes through the
center of the ellipse that is perpendicular to the major axis.
MINUTE: A minute is a unit of measure for small angles equal to 1/60 of a degree,
Number of poles and zeroes of a meromorphic function. Let 𝑓 z be analytic inside and
on a simple closed curve C except for a finite number of poles inside C, and let 𝑓 z ≠ 0
on C. Then
1 𝑓 z dz
2πi
∫c 𝑓 z
=N−P
Where N and 𝑃 are respectively the number the zeroes and the number of poles of 𝑓 z
inside 𝐶. A pole or zero of order 𝑛 is counted 𝑛 times.
MOBIUS TRANSFORMATION: A Mobius transformation is a bijection on the extended
complex plane 𝐶 ∪ {∞} given by
𝑎𝑧 + 𝑏 𝑑
;𝑧 ≠ − ,∞
𝑐𝑧 + 𝑑 𝑐
𝑎
𝑓 𝑧 = ;𝑧 = ∞
𝑐
𝑑
∞; 𝑧 = −
𝑐
where 𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐, 𝑑 ∇ 𝐶 and 𝑎𝑑 − 𝑏𝑐 ≠ 0
It can be shown that the inverse, and composition of two mobius transformations are
similarly defined, and so the Mobius transformations form a group under composition.
MODE: The mode of a group of numbers is the number that occurs most frequently in
that group.
MODEL –I M/M/1 : ∞/𝑭𝑰𝑭𝑶 : This is a system with Poisson input, exponential waiting
time and Poisson output with single channel . Queue capacity of the system being
infinite with first in first out mode.
MODULE: Let 𝑅 be a unital commutative ring. A set 𝑀 is said to be a module over 𝑅 (or
𝑅-module) if
(i) given any 𝑥, 𝑦 ∇ 𝑀 and 𝑟 ∇ 𝑅, there are well-defined elements 𝑥 + 𝑦
and 𝑟𝑥 of 𝑀,
(ii) 𝑀 is an Abelian group with respect to the operation + of addition,
(iii) the identities 𝑟(𝑥 + 𝑦) = 𝑟𝑥 + 𝑟𝑦, (𝑟 + 𝑠)𝑥 = 𝑟𝑥 + 𝑠𝑥, (𝑟𝑠)𝑥 =
𝑟(𝑠𝑥), 1𝑥 = 𝑥 are satisfied for all 𝑥, 𝑦 ∇ 𝑀 and 𝑟, 𝑠 ∇ 𝑅.
Note that
(e) 𝜔(𝑓, 𝑡) ≤ 𝑡 𝑓 ′ ;
Note that
(b) 𝜔𝑘 𝑓, 𝑛𝑡 ≤ 𝑛 𝑘 𝜔𝑘 𝑓, 𝑡 , 𝑛 ∇ 𝑁 ;
(c) 𝜔𝑘 𝑓, 𝑡 ≤ 𝑡 𝑘 𝑓 (𝑘) ;
(2) The modulus of a complex number is the same as its absolute value.
MODULUS OF A COMPLEX NUMBER: The ordinary Euclidean distance of (𝑥, 𝑦) to (0, 0) is
𝑥 2 + 𝑦 2 . We also call this number the modulus of the complex number 𝑧 = 𝑥 + 𝑖𝑦
Premise 1: If 𝐴, 𝑡𝑒𝑛 𝐵.
Premise 2: 𝐴 is true
Conclusion: 𝐵 𝑖s true.
Premise 1: If 𝐴, 𝑡𝑒𝑛 𝐵.
Premise 2: 𝐵 is true
(i) magnitude
(ii) Direction
(iii) Point of application.
It is known from the principle of transmissibility of force that the effect of a force
remains unaltered if the point of application is shifted to any point on the line of action
of the force. If we use a single free vector F to represent a force, it gives us only the
magnitude and direction of the force. To specify the line of action another vector is
necessary along with F. In the following section, we will define a vector called moment
vector, which specifies the line of action of the force. Hence a force is determined by
MOMENT OF A FORCE F ABOUT ANY STRAIGHT LINE THROUGH A GIVEN POINT O: The
moment q of a force F acting at a point P about a line L is a scalar given by
𝒒 = 𝒓 × 𝑭 . 𝒂.
Where 𝒂. is a unit vector in the direction of the line, and 𝑶𝑷 = 𝒓, 𝑶 being any point on
the line.
Step (i) In order to have a general idea of the system, we first draw a flow diagram
of the system.
Step (ii) Then, we take correct sample observations to select some suitable model
for the system. In this step we compute the probability distributions for the variable of
our interest.
Step (iv) A sequence of random number is now selected with the help of random
number tables.
Step (v) Next, we determine the sequence of values of variables of interest with
the sequence of random numbers obtained in (iv).
Step (vi) Finally, we construct some standard mathematical function to the values
obtained in (v).
𝑓(𝑧) 𝑑𝑧 = 0,
𝑇
then 𝑓 is holomorphic.
MULTICOLLINEARITY: The multicollinearity problem in multiple regression arises
when two or more independent variables are highly correlated . In that case, it is
difficult to determine the individual effects of the different variables. In the extreme
case where two independent variables are perfectly correlated, the multiple regression
calculation cannot be performed because it would involve dividing by zero.
𝑌 = 𝛽1 𝑋1 + 𝛽2 𝑋2 + 𝛽3 𝑋3 + 𝜀
Where 𝛽1 , 𝛽2 , 𝛽3 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝛽4 are unknown coefficients and 𝜀 is an random variable called the
error term. The problem in multiple regression is to use observed values of the
𝑋 ′ 𝑠 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑦 to estimate the values of the 𝛽 ′ 𝑠
3 2 −1
For example if 𝑘 = 2 and 𝐴 =
4 −3 1 2×3,
2 × 3 2 × 2 2 × −1 6 4 −2
Then 2𝐴 = =
2 × 4 2 × −3 2 × 1 8 −6 2 2×3.
matrices such that the number of columns in A is equal to the rows in 𝐵. Then the 𝑚 × 𝑝
matrix C = cik m×p such that
The product AB of two matrices A and B exists if and only if the number of columns in A
is equal to the number of rows in 𝐵. Two such matrices are said to be comformable for
multiplication. If A is an 𝑚 × 𝑛 matrix and 𝐵 is an 𝑛 × 𝑝 matrix, then AB is an 𝑚 × 𝑝
matrix. Further if A = aij and B = bik n×p , then AB = cik m×p where
m×n
n
i.e., the (i, k)th element cik of the matrix AB is obtained by multiplying the corresponding
elements of the ith row of A and the k th column of B and then adding the products.
If the product AB exists, then it is not necessary that the product BA will also
exist. For example if A is a 4 × 5 matrix and B is a 5 × 3 matrix, then the product
AB exists while the product BA does not exist.
Matrix multiplication is associative if conformability is assured; i.e., A BC =
AB C if A, B, C are m × n, 𝑛 × 𝑝, 𝑝 × 𝑞 matrices respectively.
Multiplication of matrices is distributive with respect to addition of matrices i.e.,
A B + C = AB + AC
1
𝑎× =1
𝑎
1
The multiplicative inverse is also called the reciprocal. For example, 2 is the reciprocal of
2. There exists a multiplicative inverse for every real number except zero.
NAPIER: John Napier (1550 to 1617) was a Scottish mathematician who developed the
concept of logarithms.
𝑥
𝐼𝑛 𝑥 = 𝑡1 𝑑𝑡
𝑡
NATURAL NUMBERS: The natural numbers are the set of numbers 1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8 … . .
This set of numbers is also called the counting numbers, since they are the numbers
used to count something. They can also be called the positive integers.
NEAREST POINT THEOREM: Let 𝐾 be a non-empty convex closed subset of a Hilbert
space 𝐻. For any point 𝑥 ∇ 𝐻 there is the unique point 𝑦 ∇ 𝐾 nearest to 𝑥.
In ℝ2 with either norm ||·||1 or ||·||∞ , the nearest point could be non-unique.
Let 𝑀 be a subspace of a Hilbert space 𝐻 and a point 𝑥 ∇ 𝐻 be fixed.
Then 𝑧 ∇ 𝑀 is the nearest point to 𝑥 if and only if 𝑥 − 𝑧 is orthogonal to any
vector in 𝑀.
The minimal value of ||𝑥 − 𝑦|| for 𝑦 ∇ 𝐻1 is achieved when 𝑦 =
𝑛
𝑖=1⟨ 𝑥, 𝑒𝑖 ⟩ 𝑒𝑖 .
NEAR OPERATOR: Let 𝑋 be a set and 𝑌 a Banach space. Let 𝐴, 𝐵 be two operators from 𝑋
to 𝑌 . We say that 𝐴 is near 𝐵 if and only if there exist two constants 𝛼 > 0 and
𝑘 ∇ (0, 1) such that, for each 𝑥0 , 𝑦0 ∇ 𝑋, one has
𝐵(𝑥0 ) − 𝐵(𝑦0 ) − 𝛼(𝐴(𝑥0 ) − 𝐴(𝑦0 )) ≤ 𝑘 𝐵(𝑥0 ) − 𝐵(𝑦0 )
NEGATIVE: A negative number is any real number less than zero. The negative of any
number 𝑎 (written as – 𝛼) is defined by this equation : 𝑎 + −𝑎 = 0
NEIGHBOURHOOD: Topology starts with a definition of open sets which are often and
interchangeably called neighborhoods. A neighbourhood of 𝑥 ∇ 𝑋 is a subset of the
topological space which contains an open set 𝑈 with 𝑥 ∇ 𝑈.
By definition, the empty set is open and so are finite intersections and arbitrary unions
of open sets. A set is a topological space if some of its subsets are declared to be open
subject to these conditions. An open set is a neighborhood of all its points. A
function 𝑓: 𝐴 → 𝐵 from one topological space into another is continuous at a point
𝑎 ∇ 𝐴 if for every neighborhood V of 𝑓(𝑎) there exists a neighborhood U of a such that
𝑓(𝑈) ⊂ 𝑉. This is equivalent to saying that inverse images of sets open in 𝐵 are open in
𝐴. Complements of open sets are closed by definition.
NESBITT’S INEQUALITY: Nesbitt’s inequality says, that for positive real 𝑎, 𝑏 and 𝑐 we
have:
𝑎 𝑏 𝑐 3
+ + ≥
𝑏+𝑐 𝑎+𝑐 𝑎+𝑏 2
NEUMANN’S INTEGRAL: If n is zero or a positive integer, then
+1
1 Pn (x)
Q1 y = 2 dx
−1 y−x
NEWTON: Sir Isaac Newton (1643 to 1727) was an English mathematician and scientist,
who developed the theory of gravitation and the laws of motion, designed a reflecting
telescope using a paraboloid mirror, used a prism to split white light into component
colors, and was one of the inventors of calculus.
NEWTON METHOD: Newton method provides a way to estimate the places where
complicated functions cross the x- axis. First, make a guess 𝑥1 that seems reasonably
close to the true value. Then approximate the curve by its tangent line to estimate a new
value 𝑥2 from the equation
𝑓 𝑥1
𝑥2 = 𝑥1 −
𝑓′ 𝑥1
where 𝑓′ 𝑥1 is the derivative of the function 𝑓 at the point 𝑥1 . The process is iterative:
that is it can be repeated as often as we like. This mean that we can get as close to the
true value as we wish.
−1
If A be an 𝑛 × 𝑛 non-singular matrix, then A′ θ
= Aθ .
NON-TRIVIAL CLOSED TRAIL: Let (𝑉, 𝐸) be a graph. A circuit in the graph is a non-trivial
closed trail in the graph.
1 2/2𝑎𝑟 2
𝑓 𝑥 = 𝑒 − 𝑥−𝑝
𝜍 2𝜋
1 2/2
𝑓 𝑥 = 𝑒 −𝑥
2𝜋
The central limit theorem is one important application of the normal distribution . The
central limit theorem states that if 𝑋1 , 𝑋2 , … 𝑋𝑛 are independent, identically distrusted
random variables each with mean 𝜇 and variance 𝜍 2 , then in the limit that n goes to
infinity,
𝑆𝑛 = 𝑋1 + 𝑋1 + 𝑋3 + ⋯ + 𝑛
Will have a normal distribution with mean 𝑛𝜇 and variance 𝑛𝜍 2 . The reason that this
theorem is so remarkable is that it is completely general . It says that, no matter how 𝑋
is distributed , if you add up enough measurements, the sum of the 𝑋 ′ 𝑠 will have a
normal distribution. A normal distribution is an arrangement of a data set in which
most values cluster in the middle of the range and the rest taper off symmetrically
toward either extreme.
Height is one simple example of something that follows a normal distribution pattern:
Most people are of average height, the numbers of people that are taller and shorter
than average are fairly equal and a very small (and still roughly equivalent) number of
people are either extremely tall or extremely short.
Normal distribution curves are sometimes designed with a histogram inside the curve.
The graphs are commonly used in mathematics, statistics and corporate data analytics.
NORMAL FUZZY SET: A fuzzy subset 𝐴 of a classical set 𝑋 is called normal if there exists
an 𝑥 ∇ 𝑋 such that 𝐴(𝑥) = 1. Otherwise A is subnormal.
NORMALISED FUNCTIONS OF BOUNDED VARIATION: The function 𝑔 𝑡 ∇ 𝐵𝑉 𝑎, 𝑏 is
said to be normalized function of bounded variation if 𝑔 𝑧 = 0 and 𝑔 is continuous for
all 𝑡 from the right, i.e. for all 𝑡 ∇ 𝑎, 𝑏 , 𝑔 𝑡 + 0 = 𝑔 𝑡 .
𝑓 𝑡 = 0, at 𝑡 = 𝑎,
and 𝑓 𝑡 = 𝑓 𝑏 − 𝑓, 𝑎𝑡 𝑡 = 𝑏
The Hermitian, real symmetric, unitary, real orthogonal, skew- Hermitian, and
real skew- symmetric matrices are normal.
Any diagonal matrix over the complex field is normal.
Every matrix unitarily similar to a normal matrix is normal.
If 𝑋 is an eigenvector of a normal matrix 𝐴 corresponding to an eigenvalue 𝜆,
then 𝑋 is also an eigenvector of 𝐴°; the corresponding eigenvalue being 𝜆.
Characteristic vectors corresponding to distinct characteristic values of a normal
matrix are orthogonal.
A triangular matrix is normal if and only if it is diagonal.
Note that
NORMAL STRAIN: It is defined as the ratio of the change is length to the original length
of a straight line element. It is also known as extension or compression.
NORMED SPACE (𝑳𝒑 (µ) / ∼, || · ||𝒑): We write 𝐿𝑝 (µ) for the normed space (𝐿𝑝 (µ) / ∼,
|| · ||𝑝 ). We will use notation and continue to write members of 𝐿𝑝 (µ) as functions.
Really they are equivalence classes, and so care must be taken when dealing with 𝐿𝑝 (µ).
For example, if 𝑓 ∇ 𝐿𝑝 (µ), it does not make sense to talk about the value of 𝑓 at a point.
Let (𝑓𝑛 ) be a Cauchy sequence in 𝐿𝑝 (µ). There exists 𝑓 ∇ 𝐿𝑝 µ with ||𝑓𝑛 − 𝑓||𝑝 → 0. In
fact, we can find a subsequence (𝑛𝑘 ) such that 𝑓𝑛 𝑘 → 𝑓 pointwise, almost everywhere.
𝐿𝑝 µ is a Banach space.
Let (𝑋, 𝐿, µ) be a measure space, and let 1 ≤ 𝑝 < ∞. We can define a map 𝛷: 𝐿𝑞 (µ)→
𝐿𝑝 (µ)* by setting 𝛷(𝑓) = 𝐹, for 𝑓 ∇ 𝐿𝑞 (µ), 1/𝑝 + 1/𝑞 = 1, where
𝐹: 𝐿𝑝 µ → 𝐾, 𝐹 𝑔 = ∫𝑋 𝑓𝑔𝑑𝜇 𝑔 ∇ 𝐿𝑝 µ
Let (𝑋, 𝐿, µ) be a finite measure space, let 1 ≤ 𝑝 < ∞, and let 𝐹 ∇ 𝐿𝑝 (µ)∗ . Then there
exists 𝑓 ∇ 𝐿𝑞 (µ), 1/𝑝 + 1/𝑞 = 1 such that
𝐹 𝑔 = ∫𝑋 𝑓𝑔𝑑𝜇 𝑔 ∇ 𝐿𝑝 µ
For 1 < 𝑝 < ∞, we have that 𝐿𝑝 (µ)∗ = 𝐿𝑞 (µ) isometrically, under the identification of
the above results. Note that 𝐿∞ ∗ is not isomorphic to 𝐿1 , except finite-dimensional
situation. Moreover if µ is not a point measure 𝐿1 is not a dual to any Banach space.
Let (𝑋, 𝐿, µ) be a finite measure space, and let 1 ≤ 𝑝 < ∞. Then the collection of simple
functions is dense in 𝐿𝑝 (µ).
NORM OF A PARTITION: The norm of a partition 𝑃 is the greatest of the lengths of the
segments of the partition 𝑃 and it is denoted by 𝑃 .
NORM OF LINEAR OPERATOR: A norm of linear operator is defined:
𝑇 = sup
{ 𝑇 𝑥 : 𝑥 ≤ 1}. 𝑇 is a bounded linear operator if
||𝑇|| = 𝑠𝑢𝑝{||𝑇𝑥||: ||𝑥||} < ∞.
Note that
Consider the following examples and determine kernel and images of the mentioned
operators.
II. On a normed space X define the identity operator by 𝐼𝑋 : 𝑥 → 𝑥 for all 𝑥 ∇ 𝑋. Its
norm is 1.
III. On a normed space 𝑋 any linear functional define a linear operator from 𝑋 to ℂ,
its norm as operator is the same as functional.
1. 𝑇 is continuous on 𝑋;
Let 𝐵(𝑋, 𝑌) be the space of bounded linear operators from 𝑋 and 𝑌 with the norm
defined above. If 𝑌 is complete, then 𝐵(𝑋, 𝑌) is a Banach space.
Let 𝑇 ∇ 𝐵(𝑋, 𝑌) and 𝑆 ∇ 𝐵(𝑌, 𝑍), where 𝑋, 𝑌, 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑍 are normed spaces. Then
𝑆𝑇 ∇ 𝐵(𝑋, 𝑍) and ||𝑆𝑇|| ≤ ||𝑆||||𝑇||.
Let 𝑇 ∇ 𝐵(𝑋, 𝑋) = 𝐵(𝑋), where 𝑋 is a normed space. Then for any 𝑛 ≥ 1, 𝑇𝑛 ∇
𝐵(𝑋) 𝑎𝑛𝑑 ||𝑇𝑛|| ≤ ||𝑇||𝑛.
Let 𝑇 ∇ 𝐵(𝑋, 𝑌). We say 𝑇 is an invertible operator if there exists 𝑆 ∇ 𝐵(𝑌, 𝑋) such that
𝑆𝑇 = 𝐼𝑋 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑇𝑆 = 𝐼𝑌 . Such an 𝑆 is called the inverse operator of 𝑇.
1. The zero operator is never invertible unless the pathological spaces 𝑋 = 𝑌 = {0}.
Φ𝑓 ≤ 𝑘 𝑓 , for all 𝑓 ∇ 𝑁.
The smallest number 𝑘, such that Φ(𝑓) ≤ 𝑘 𝑓 holds for all 𝑓, is called the norm of Φ,
and is denoted by Φ . Thus
Φ = inf. k: k ≤ 0, Φ (f) ≤ k f ,
For all 𝑓 𝜖 𝑁.
NORMS OF MAPPINGS: Let 𝑋 be a normed linear space (where the norm provides the
distance function). Then, if 𝑀 is a linear mapping from 𝑋 to 𝑈, its norm is defined to be
the number 𝑀 : = 𝑠𝑢𝑝 { 𝑀(𝑓) ∶ 𝑓 ∇ 𝑋, 𝑓 = 1}. It follows from linearity of the
norm that the inequality 𝑀(𝑓) ≤ 𝑀 𝑓 holds for every 𝑓 ∇ 𝑋.
NORTH –WEST CORNER RULE: This is the most widely used method for the solution of
transportation problem. The following steps must be followed to solve the problem:
(i) The first step is to check the total of both demand and supply
𝑚 𝑛
i.e. , 𝑖=1 𝑎𝑖 = 𝑗 =1 𝑏𝑗 … 1
if the above equation satisfies the problem is said to be a balanced problem, otherwise
it is called an unbalanced problem.
(ii) The next step is to allot the corner assignments. In this step we start from the top
most cell at the North West corner and allocate in that cell the maximum amount
possible.
If 𝑥11 be the allocation in that very cell, then:
𝑥11 = min 𝑎1 , 𝑏1
(iii) Now, we have certain conditions to proceed further:
(a) If 𝑏1 < 𝑎1 , 𝑡𝑒𝑛 𝑥11 = 𝑏1 .
It means a little quantity is still left in the first row. So, we have to move to the right side
for the 2nd cell in the same row, i.e. , for cell (1,2) and make the allocation there which
must be of the order:
(b) If 𝑏1 > 𝑎1 , 𝑡𝑒𝑛 𝑥11 = 𝑎1. it means a little quantity has been left in column 1.
Then, we move downwards to the cell (2, 1) and make next allocation of amount
𝑥21 = min. 𝑎1 , 𝑏1 − 𝑥11 in the particular cell.
(c) If however, 𝑏1 = 𝑎1 , then no quantity is left to be allocated in the same row or
column, i.e., 𝑥12 = 0 𝑜𝑟 𝑥21 = 0.
(iv) Repeat the steps from (i) to (iii) until the entire requirement is satisfied.
NOT: The word “NOT” is used in logic to indicate the negation of a statement . The
statement “NOT p” IS FALSE IF P IS TRUE, AND IT IS TRUE IF P IS FALSE. The operation
of NOT can be described by this truth table.
𝑝 𝑁𝑂𝑇 𝑃
𝑇 𝐹
𝐹 𝑇
𝒏 −PERSON GAME: When number of players is 𝑛 where 𝑛 ≥ 2 ,then for 𝑛 = 2 , the game
is known as 2 person game and for 𝑛 > 2 the game is known as 𝑛 person game.
NULL HYPOTHESIS: The null hypothesis is the hypothesis that is being tested in a
hypothesis – testing situation. Often the null hypothesis is of the form. “There is no
relation between two quantities”.
NULL MATRIX OR ZERO MATRIX: The m × n matrix whose elements are all 0 is called
the null matrix (or zero matrix) of the type m × n. It is usually denoted by 𝑂 or more
clearly by 𝑂𝑚 ,𝑛 . Often a null matrix is simple denoted by the symbol 0 read as ‘zero’.
For example
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 and 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 3×5 0 0 0 3×3
NULL SET: The null set is that contains no elements. The term “null set” mean the same
as the term “empty set”.
𝑝
3. The rational numbers ℚ = : 𝑝, 𝑞 𝜖 𝕫 , 𝑞 ≠ 0 . In ℚ, addition, subtraction,
𝑞
4. The Real numbers ℝ: These are the numbers which can be expressed as decimals. The
rational numbers are those with finite terminating or recurring decimals. In ℝ, addition,
subtraction, multiplication and division (except by zero) are still closed and all positive
numbers have square roots ,but −1 ∈ ℝ.
5. The complex numbers ℂ = 𝑥 + 𝑖𝑦: 𝑥, 𝑦 𝜖 ℝ , 𝑤𝑒𝑟𝑒 𝑖 2 = 1. In ℂ, addition, subtraction,
multiplication and division (except by zero) are still closed and all numbers have square
roots. In fact, all polynomial equations with coefficients in ℂ have solutions in ℂ.
NUMBER THEORY: Number theory is the study of properties of the natural numbers.
One aspect of number theory focuses on prime numbers. There are an infinite number
of prime numbers. Suppose for example that 𝑝 was the largest prime number. Then ,
form a new number equal to one plus the product of all the prime numbers from 2 up to
𝑝. This number will not be divisible by any of these prime numbers (and , therefore , not
by any composite number formed by multiplying these primes together) and will
therefore be prime. This contradicts the assumption that 𝑝 is the largest prime numbers.
There are still unsolved problems involving the frequency of occurrence of prime
numbers.
NUMERAL: A numeral is a symbol that stands for number For example “4” is the Arabic
numeral for the number four. “IV” is the Roman numeral for the same number.
NUMERATOR: The numerator is the number above the bar in a fraction . In the fraction
8
, 8 is the numerator.
9
In this procedure, we start with a trial solution and a set of rules for improving it. The
trial solution is improved by the given rules and is then replaced by this improved
solution. This process of improvement is repeated until no further improvement is
possible or when the cost of further calculation cannot be justified. Iterative procedures
as divided into three groups.
𝒏-VECTOR SPACE: The set of all 𝑛-vectors of a field 𝐹 is called the 𝑛-vector space over 𝐹.
It is usually denoted by 𝑉𝑛 (𝐹) or simply by 𝑉𝑛 if the field is understood. Similarly the set
of all 3 vectors is a vector space which is usually denoted by 𝑉3 . The elements of the field
𝐹 are known as scalars relatively to the vectors.
O
OBJECTIVE FUNCTION: An objective function is a function whose value you are trying to
maximize or minimize. The value of the objective function depends on the values of a set
of choice variables and the problem is to find the optimal values for those choice
variables.
ODD FUNCTION: The function 𝑓 𝑥 is an odd function if it is satisfies the property that
𝑓 −𝑥 = −𝑓 𝑥 . For example 𝑓 𝑥 = sin 𝑥 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑓 𝑥 = 𝑥 3 are both odd functions.
ODD NUMBER: An odd number is a whole number that is not divisible by 2, such as
1,3,5,7,9,11,13,15…
The flow is said to the two-dimensional when the velocity vector q is everywhere at
right angles to a certain direction and independent of displacement parallel to that
direction. The components of q (𝑢, 𝑣, 𝑤) in a two-dimensional flow are (𝑢, 𝑣, 𝑤), where 𝑢
and 𝑣 are independent of 𝑧. The flow conditions are identical in planes perpendicular to
the 𝑧- axis.
ONE –TAILED TEST: Ina a one- tailed test the critical region consists of only one tail of a
distribution. The null hypothesis is rejected only if the test statistic has an extreme
value in one direction.
OPEN BALL: Let (𝑋, 𝑑) be a metric space and 𝑥0 ∇ 𝑋. Let 𝑟 be a positive number. The set
𝐵(𝑥0 , 𝑟) = {𝑥 ∇ 𝑋 ∶ 𝑑(𝑥, 𝑥0 ) < 𝑟} is called the ball with center 𝑥0 and radius 𝑟. On
some spaces like 𝐶 or 𝑅 2 this is also known as an open disk and when the space is 𝑅, it is
known as open interval.
OPEN INTERVAL: An open interval is an interval that does not contain both its
endpoints. For example, the interval 0 < 𝑥 < 1 is an open interval because the
endpoints 0 and 1 are not included.
OPTIMAL STRATEGY AND VALUE OF THE GAME: If in a given payoff matrix 𝑖, 𝑗 is the
saddle point, then the player A and B are said to have the optimal strategy 𝑖 and 𝑗 . The
𝑡
value of the 𝑖, 𝑗 cell is known as the value of the game and is denoted by 𝑣.
OR: The word “OR” is a connective word used in logic. The sentence “𝑝 𝑜𝑟 𝑞" is false only
if both 𝑝 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑞 are false; it is true if either 𝑝 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑞 or both are true. The operation of OR
is illustrated by the truth table:
p q p or q
T T T
T F T
F T T
F F F
The symbol ∀ is often use to represent OR. An OR sentence is also called a disjunction.
ORIGIN: The origin is the point 0,0 in Cartesian coordinates. It is the point where the
𝑥 − 𝑎𝑥𝑖𝑠 and the 𝑦 − 𝑎𝑥𝑖𝑠 intersect.
ORTHOCENTER: The orthocenter of a triangle is the point where the three altitude of
the triangle meet.
On the integral 0 ≤ x ≤ 1
1
Since ∫0 𝑝 𝑥 . 𝐺𝑚 𝑥 𝐺𝑛 𝑥 𝑑𝑥 = 0.
∞ 0
𝑥2 𝑖𝑓 𝑚 ≠ 𝑛
𝑒 − 𝐻𝑛 𝑥 𝐻𝑚 𝑥 𝑑𝑥 =
−∞ 𝜋22 𝑛 !
𝑖𝑓 𝑚 = 𝑛
∞
𝑥2 0 𝑖𝑓 𝑚 ≠ 𝑛
𝑒 − 𝐿𝑛 𝑥 𝐿𝑚 𝑥 𝑑𝑥 = 𝛿𝑚𝑛 =
−∞
1 𝑖𝑓 𝑚 = 𝑛
+1
(i) ∫−1 Pm x Pn x dx = 0 if m ≠ n.
+1 2 2
(ii) ∫−1 Pn x dx = 2n+1 if m = n.
If there exists no such number 𝑘, then the integral function 𝑓(𝑧) is said to be of infinite
order.
ORIENTATION (MANIFOLD): Let V be a finite dimensional vector space. Two ordered
bases (𝑣1 , . . . , 𝑣𝑛 ) and (𝑣1 , . . . , 𝑣𝑛 ) are said to be equally oriented if the transition matrix
𝑆, whose columns are the coordinates of the vectors 𝑣1 , . . . , 𝑣𝑛 with respect to the basis
(𝑣1 , . . . , 𝑣𝑛 ), has positive determinant. Being equally oriented is an equivalence relation
among bases, for which there are precisely two equivalence classes. The space 𝑉 is said
to be oriented if a specific class has been chosen, this class is then called the orientation
of 𝑉, and its member bases are called positive. The Euclidean spaces 𝑅 𝑛 are usually
oriented by the class containing the standard basis (𝑒1 , . . . , 𝑒𝑛 ). For the null space
𝑉 = {0} we introduce the convention that an orientation is a choice between the signs
+ and −. An orientation of an abstract manifold 𝑀 is an orientation of each tangent
space 𝑇𝑝 𝑀, 𝑝 ∇ 𝑀, such that there exists an atlas of 𝑀 in which all charts induce the
given orientation on each tangent space. The manifold is called orientable if there exists
an orientation. If an orientation has been chosen we say that 𝑀 is an oriented manifold
and we call a chart positive if it induces the proper orientation on each tangent space.
A diffeomorphism map 𝑓: 𝑀 → 𝑁 between oriented manifolds of equal dimension is
said to be orientation preserving if for each 𝑝 ∇ 𝑀, the differential 𝑑𝑓𝑝 maps positive
bases for 𝑇𝑝 𝑀 to positive bases for 𝑇𝑓(𝑝) 𝑁. Every manifold 𝑀, of which there exists an
atlas with only one chart, is orientable. The orientation induced by that chart is of
course an orientation of 𝑀.
ORTHOGONAL COMPLEMENT: Let 𝑀 be a subspace of an inner product space V. The
orthogonal complement, written 𝑀⊥ , of 𝑀 is 𝑀⊥ = {𝑥 ∇ 𝑉: ⌌𝑥, 𝑚⌍ = 0 ∀𝑚 ∇ 𝑀.
0 𝑚≠𝑛
1 Tm x Tn x
(i) ∫−1 [ 1−x 2 𝑑𝑥 = 𝜋/2 𝑚=𝑛≠0
0 𝑚=𝑛=0
0 𝑚≠𝑛
1 U m x U n (x)
(ii) ∫−1 𝑑𝑥 = 𝜋/2 𝑚=𝑛≠0
[ 1−x 2
0 𝑚=𝑛=0
Lying on the same surface such that at every point of the surface the two curves, one
from each family are orthogonal, then the family of curves (2) is called the orthogonal
trajectories of the family of curves (1)
ORTHOGONAL VECTORS: Two vectors 𝑥 and 𝑦 in an inner product space are said to be
orthogonal if ⟨ 𝑥, 𝑦 ⟩ = 0, written 𝑥 ⊥ 𝑦.
An orthogonal sequence (or orthogonal system) 𝑒𝑛 (finite or infinite) is one in which
𝑒𝑛 ⊥ 𝑒𝑚 whenever 𝑛 ≠ 𝑚.
An orthonormal sequence (or orthonormal system) 𝑒𝑛 is an orthogonal sequence with
||𝑒𝑛 || = 1 for all 𝑛.
1. If all vectors of an orthogonal system are non-zero then they are linearly
independent.
We also say that the vectors of 𝑀 are orthonormal. If 𝑓, 𝑔 are two vectors of an
orthonormal set 𝑀, then 𝑓, 𝑔 = 0 for 𝑓 ≠ 𝑔 and 𝑓, 𝑔 = 1 𝑓𝑜𝑟 𝑓 = 𝑔
If 𝑀 consists of vectors 𝑒1 , where 𝑖 runs through a certain index set (which may be
finite, countably infinite, or even uncountable), then
We also write this as 𝑒𝑖 , 𝑒𝑗 = 𝛿𝑖𝑗 , where 𝛿𝑖𝑗 known as the Kronecker delta, is
defined by
𝛿𝑖𝑗 = 0, for 𝑖 ≠ 𝑗,
= 1, for 𝑖 = 𝑗.
(iii) Equivalent generating system: Two arbitrary subsets 𝐴 and 𝐵 of a linear space
are said to be equivalent generating systems if the linear manifolds spanned
by them are equal, i.e., 𝐿𝑀 𝐴 = 𝐿𝑀 𝐵 . This means that any finite linear
combination of vector of 𝐴 can also be expressed as finite linear combination
of vectors of 𝐵, and conversely.
µ∗ (𝐴) = 𝑘 𝜇 𝐴𝑘 ; 𝐴 ⊂ ⋃𝑘 𝐴𝑘 , 𝐴𝑘 ∇ 𝑆
1. µ∗ (∅) = 0;
Or 𝑤 = 𝑧 + 𝑖𝑓 𝑧0 𝑖𝑓 𝑧0 = ∞
𝑤 − 𝑧1 𝑘(𝑧 − 𝑧1 )
= 𝑖𝑓 𝑧1, 𝑧2 ≠ ∞
𝑤 − 𝑧2 (𝑧 − 𝑧2 )
A transformation with two different fixed points is called hyperbolic if 𝑘 > 0, and
elliptic if 𝑘 = 𝑎𝑒 𝑖𝛼 , where 𝑎 ≠ 1; 𝛼 and 𝑎 both are real number and 𝑎 > 0.
The Pareto chart provides a graphic depiction of the Pareto principle, a theory
maintaining that 80% of the output in a given situation or system is produced by 20% of
the input.
The Pareto chart is one of the seven basic tools of quality control. The independent
variables on the chart are shown on the horizontal axis and the dependent variables are
portrayed as the heights of bars. A point-to-point graph, which shows the cumulative
relative frequency, may be superimposed on the bar graph. Because the values of the
statistical variables are placed in order of relative frequency, the graph clearly reveals
which factors have the greatest impact and where attention is likely to yield the greatest
benefit.
PARITY: The word parity applies to situations where two items or their properties may
be juxtaposed as being opposites (in a certain context) of each other. Integers are of
either odd or even parity when they are, respectively, odd or even. The convenience is
in being able to say "two numbers of different parities" without having to explicitly
mention which is which.
PARITY CHECK MATRIX (CODING THEORY): A parity check matrix 𝐻 for 𝐶 is a generator
matrix for the dual code 𝐶 ⊥ . A parity check matrix is said to be in standard form if it is of
the form (𝑌 | 𝐼𝑛−𝑘 ).
PARSEVAL’S FORMULA: If the functions 𝑓, 𝑔 ∇ 𝐿2 [−𝜋, 𝜋] have Fourier series
∞ 𝑖𝑛𝑡 ∞ 𝑖𝑛𝑡 𝜋 ∞
𝑓= 𝑛=−∞ 𝑐𝑛 𝑒 , 𝑔= 𝑛=−∞ 𝑑𝑛 𝑒 then ⌌𝑓, 𝑔⌍ ∫−𝜋 𝑓(𝑡)g(t) 𝑑𝑡 = 2𝜋 −∞ 𝑐𝑛 𝑑𝑛 . An
integrable function 𝑓 belongs to 𝐿2 [−𝜋, 𝜋] if and only if its Fourier series is convergent
and then ||𝑥||2 = 2𝜋 ∞
−∞ 𝑐𝑘 2 .
PARSEVEL’S IDENTITY FOR FOURIER TRANSFORM: If the complex fourier transform of
𝑓 𝑡 and 𝑔 𝑡 be 𝐹 𝑠 and 𝐺 𝑠 respectively, then
∞ ∞
(i) ∫−∞ 𝑓 𝑡 𝑔 𝑡 𝑑𝑡 = ∫−∞ 𝐹 𝑠 𝐺 𝑠 𝑑𝑠
Where 𝑔 𝑡 is complex conjugate of 𝑔 𝑡 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝐺 𝑠 is complex conjugate of
𝐺 𝑠 .
∞ 𝟐 ∞ 𝟐
(ii) ∫−∞ 𝒇 𝑡 𝑑𝑡 = ∫−∞ 𝑭 𝑠 𝑑𝑠
Then
∞ 2 ∞
i. ∫𝟎 𝑓 𝑡 𝑔 𝑡 𝑑𝑡 = ∫𝟎 𝐹𝑠 𝑠 𝐺𝑠 𝒔 ds
𝜋
∞ 2 ∞
ii. ∫𝟎 𝑓 𝑡 𝑔 𝑡 𝑑𝑡 = ∫𝟎 𝐹𝐶 𝑠 𝐺𝐶 𝒔 ds
𝜋
∞ 2 2 ∞ 2
iii. ∫𝟎 𝑓 𝑡 𝑑𝑡 = ∫𝟎 𝐹𝑆 𝑠 ds
𝜋
∞ 2 2 ∞ 2
iv. ∫𝟎 𝑓 𝑡 𝑑𝑡 = ∫𝟎 𝐹𝐶 𝑠 ds
𝜋
PARSEVAL'S THEOREM: Suppose that 𝐴(𝑥) and 𝐵(𝑥) are two square integrable (with
respect to the Lebesgue measure), complex-valued functions on 𝑹 of period 2𝜋
with Fourier series
and
respectively. Then
where 𝑖 is the imaginary unit and horizontal bars indicate complex conjugation.
PARTIAL DIFFERENTIAL EQUATION: A Partial Differential Equation (PDE) is defined as
an equation relating a function of two or more independent variables and its partial
derivatives. The general Partial Differential equation is of the type
𝜕2𝑢 𝜕2𝑢 𝜕2𝑢 𝜕𝑢 𝜕𝑢
𝑎 𝜕𝑥 2 + 𝑏 𝜕𝑥𝜕𝑡 + 𝑐 𝜕𝑡 2 + 𝑑 𝜕𝑥 + 𝑒 𝜕𝑡 + 𝑓𝑢 = 𝑔 (1)
𝜕𝑢 𝜕𝑢
1. − 𝜕𝑡 = 0 ( linear PDE)
𝜕𝑥
𝜕𝑢 𝜕𝑢
2. 𝑢 𝜕𝑥 − 𝜕𝑡 = 0 ( non-linear PDE)
𝜕𝑢 𝜕𝑢
3. 𝑒 𝑡 𝜕𝑥 − 2 𝜕𝑡 = 0 ( linear, non-homogeneous PDE)
𝜕2𝑢 𝜕𝑢
1. 2 𝜕𝑥 2 − 3 𝜕𝑡 = 0 ( linear PDE)
1 𝜕 𝜕𝑢 𝜕2𝑢
2. 𝑥 𝜕𝑥 − 𝜕𝑡 2 = 𝑥 2 (linear, non-homogeneous PDE)
𝑡 𝜕𝑥
𝜕2𝑢 𝜕2𝑢
3. − 𝑒𝑥 = 𝑢2 (non-linear PDE)
𝜕𝑥 2 𝜕𝑡 2
It is to be noted that certain functions are solutions to first order PDEs. Consider the
first order wave equation
𝜕𝑢 𝜕𝑢
𝑐 − =0 (2)
𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑡
where 𝑐 is a constant known as wave speed. Also, note that the following are all
solutions to Equation (2).
1. 𝑢 = 𝑠𝑖𝑛(𝑥 − 𝑐𝑡)
𝜕𝑢
2. = cos
(𝑥 − 𝑐𝑡)
𝜕𝑥
𝜕𝑢
3. = −𝑐. cos
(𝑥 − 𝑐𝑡)
𝜕𝑡
𝜕𝑢 𝜕𝑢
Consider the linear equation 𝑐 𝜕𝑥 + 𝜕𝑡 = −𝑢.
𝜕𝑢 𝜕𝑢
Consider the linear equation without non-constant coefficients 𝑥 𝜕𝑥 + 𝜕𝑡 = 0, 𝑥 > 0.
The solution is given by 𝑢 = 𝐹(𝑥𝑒 −𝑡 ), where 𝐹 is again an arbitrary function but this
time 𝑧 = 𝑥𝑒 −𝑡 .
PARTIALLY ORDERED SET: A non-empty set on which some order relation is given.
Some examples of partially-ordered sets:
1) The set of natural numbers with the usual order relation.
2) The set of natural numbers, where 𝒂 ≤ 𝒃 means that 𝒂 divides 𝒃.
3) The set of all subsets of some set, where 𝒂 ≤ 𝒃 means that 𝒂 ⊆ 𝒃.
4) The set of all real-valued functions on the interval [𝟎, 𝟏], where 𝒇 ≤ 𝒈 means
that 𝒇(𝒕) ≤ 𝒈(𝒕) for all 𝒕 ∇ [𝟎, 𝟏].
5) The set of all finite increasing sequences of natural numbers, where
𝒂𝟏 , … , 𝒂𝒌 ≤ 𝒃𝟏 , … , 𝒃𝒍
PARTITION: (a) Let 𝐼 = [𝑎, 𝑏] be a closed and bounded interval. Then by a partition of 𝐼,
we mean a finite set of real numbers 𝑃 = 𝑥0 , 𝑥1 , 𝑥2 , 𝑥3 , … , 𝑥𝑛 with the property that
𝑎 = 𝑥0 ≤ 𝑥1 ≤ 𝑥2 ≤ 𝑥3 ≤ ⋯ ≤ 𝑥𝑛 = 𝑏.
(b) Let A be a set. A partition of A is collection of subsets of A with the property that
every element of A belongs to exactly one of the subsets in the collection.
PARTITION OF NUMBERS: A Partition of a positive integer 𝑛 is an expression of 𝑛 as the
sum of positive integers. The numbers of partitions of 𝑛, where the order of the
summands is ignored and repetitions is permitted, is denoted by 𝑝(𝑛) and is called the
number of partitions of 𝑛. For example 𝑝 5 = 7 since 5 = 4 + 1 = 3 + 2 = 3 + 1 + 1 =
2 + 2 + 1 = 2 + 1 + 1 + 1 = 1 + 1 + 1 + 1 + 1. Therefore, 𝑝(𝑛) equal the number of
conjugate classes of the symmetric group of order 𝑛 and is closely related to the
representation theory of this group.
∞ ∞
𝑓 𝑥 =1+ 𝑛=1 𝑝 𝑛 𝑥𝑛 = 𝑛=1 1 − 𝑥𝑛 −1
.
PATH LINE OF FLOW: The curve described in space by a moving fluid element is known
as its trajectory or path line. Such a lien is obtained by giving the position of an element
as a function of time. The path lines are given by 𝑞 = 𝑑𝑟/𝑑𝑡. In Cartesian coordinates.
𝑑𝑥 𝑑𝑦 𝑑𝑧
= 𝑢 𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧, 𝑡 , = 𝑣 𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧, 𝑡 , = 𝑤 𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧, 𝑡 .
𝑑𝑡 𝑑𝑡 𝑑𝑡
In general, the path line varies with each fluid particle. It indicates the direction of
velocity of a single particle of fluid at different times. In the case of steady flow, the fluid
particle will travel along the stream line i.e., the path of a material element of fluid
coincides with a stream line.
Player B
1 2 3 ⋯ 𝑛
𝑣11 𝑣12 𝑣13 … 𝑣1𝑛
𝑣31 ⋮ ⋮ ⋮
Player A ⋮ ⋮ ⋮ ⋮
1 2 3 ⋯ 𝑛
− 𝑣31 ⋮ ⋮ ⋮
⋮ ⋮ ⋮ ⋮
−𝑣𝑚 1 − 𝑣𝑚 2 − 𝑣𝑚 3 … − 𝑣𝑚𝑛
In 𝐴′ 𝑠 payoff matrix, the cell entry 𝑣𝑖𝑗 is the payment to player A when A choose the 𝑖 𝑡
activity and B choose the 𝑗 𝑡 .
Ina rectangular game or two person zero sum game, the player B’s payoff matrix will be
the negative of A’s payoff matrix. Thus the net gain will be zero.
PEANO EXISTENCE THEOREM: Peano existence theorem, Peano theorem or Cauchy-
Peano theorem is a fundamental theorem which guarantees the existence of solutions to
certain initial value problems.
𝐹 𝑧 = 𝐹 𝑧 + 𝑇 = 𝐹 𝑧 + 2𝑇 = 𝐹 𝑧 + 3𝑇 = − − −
For all values of 𝑧 this constant 𝑇 is called the period of the function 𝑓 𝑧 . Clearly if 𝑇 is a
period of 𝐹 𝑧 then 𝑛 𝑇 (where 𝑛 is a positive or negative integer) is also a period.
𝑓 𝑧 + 𝜔 = 𝑓(𝑧)
The function ez is of period 2πi. For example, ez+2πi = 𝑒 𝑧 .
PERMUTATIONS AND COMBINATIONS: Let there be given a set Ω and arrange them in a
row, we have a 𝑘-permutation of elements of Ω. The number of such arrays is
(𝑛)𝑘 = 𝑛 𝑛 − 1 … (𝑛 − 𝑘 + 1). The polynomial 𝑥 𝑘 = 𝑥 𝑥 − 1 … 𝑥 − 𝑘 + 1 in 𝑥 of
degree 𝑘 is called Jordan factorial of degree 𝑘. In particular, 𝑛 𝑘 = 𝑛!, n factorial, is the
number of permutations of Ω. A subset of Ω is called a 𝑘-subset if it contains exactly 𝑘
𝑛
elements. The number of 𝑘-subsets (or 𝑘-combinations) of Ω is 𝑘
= 𝑛 𝑘 /𝑘!. The
𝑥 𝑥
binomial coefficients 𝑛
are defined by the generating function 1 + 𝑧
∞ 𝑥
= 𝑛 =0 𝑛 𝑧 𝑛 . For any complex number 𝑥, the series is convergent for z < 1, and it is
𝑥
vertified that 𝑛
= 𝑥 𝑛 = 𝑛!in terms of the Jordan factorial 𝑥 𝑛 . The same result hold
in a comple field with valuation, in particular in a 𝑝-adic number field. in any case, we
have the recursive relation
𝑥 𝑥−1 𝑥−1
𝑛
= 𝑛
+ 𝑛−1
(𝑛 ≥ 1),
𝑥
0
= 1,
and in general
𝑛 𝑥 𝑦 𝑥+𝑦
𝑘=0 𝑘 = 𝑛−𝑘
= 𝑛
,
which leads to many identities involving binomial coefficients. The recursive relation
𝑛
allows us to compute the value of 𝑘
easily foe small integers 𝑛, 𝑘, as was noticed by
Pascal. The arrangement of these values in a triangular form:
1
1 1
1 2 1
1 3 3 1
1 4 6 4 1
is called Pascal’s triangle. For integral values 𝑥, (1 + 𝑧)𝑥 are polynomials, and we have
𝑛 𝑛
(𝑎 + 𝑏)𝑛 = 𝑘=0 𝑘 𝑎𝑛 −𝑘 𝑏 𝑘 (binomial thorem). As a generalization, we have
𝑛
𝑛! 𝑝 𝑝
𝑎1 + ⋯ + 𝑎𝑚 = 𝑎1 1 … 𝑎𝑚𝑚
𝑝1 ! … 𝑝𝑚 !
(multinomial theorem), where the sum is extended over all nonnegative 𝑝𝑖 with
𝑝𝑖 = 𝑛.
PERTURBATION: Let 𝑋 be a set and 𝑌 be a metric space. Let 𝐹, 𝐺 be two maps from 𝑋 to
𝑌 . We say that 𝐺 is a perturbation of 𝐹 if there exist a constant 𝑘 > 0 such that for each
𝑥0 , 𝑦0 ∇ 𝑋 one has:
𝑑(𝐺(𝑥0 ), 𝐺(𝑦0 )) ≤ 𝑘𝑑(𝐹(𝑥0 ), 𝐹(𝑦0 ))
y = a sin(mx − nt + ε)
where ε represents the phase of the wave at the instant from which t is measured. We
notice that wave motion have the same amplitude, wave length and period but they
differ in phase. The angle (𝑚𝑥 − 𝑛𝑡) is called the phase angle and n is called the phase
rate.
1
2 ∫0 𝑑𝑥/ 1 − 𝑥 2 .
The symbol 𝜋 has been used since W.Jones (1675-1749) and L.Eular. The fact that this
ratio is a constant is stated in Euclid’s Elements; however, Euclid gave no statement
about the numerical value of 𝜋. As an approximate value of 𝜋, 3 has been used from
antiquity. According to the Rhind Papyrus, (4/3)4 was used in ancient Egypt. Let 𝐿𝑛 (𝑙𝑛 )
be the perimeter of a regular 𝑛-gen circumscribed about (inscribed in) a circle of radius
1. Then the relations
2 1 1
𝐿𝑛 > 𝜋 > 𝑙𝑛 , =𝐿 +𝑙 ,
𝐿2𝑛 𝑛 𝑛
𝑙2𝑛 = 𝑙𝑛 𝐿2𝑛
10 1
hold. Archimedes obtained 3 71 < 𝜋 < 3 7 by calculating 𝐿96 and 𝑙96 . In 3rd-century China
Liu Hui used 𝜋 = 3.14. In 5th –centry China, Tsu Chung-Chih mentioned 22/7 as in
inaccurate approximate value and 355/113 as an accurate approximate value of 𝜋.
These values were obtained by methods similar to those of Archimedes. In 5th-countury
India, Aryabhatta obtained 𝜋 = 3.1416, and in 16th country Europe, Adriaen van
Roomen obtained 𝜋 = 355/113.
∞
𝜋 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
cos = + × + + …
2n 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
n=2
Using this formula, L. van Ceulen (15440-1610) calculated 𝜋 to 35 decimals. In the 17th
and 18th centuries, the Japenese mathematicians 𝑇. Seki, K. Takebe, and Y. Matunage
computed 𝜋 to 50 decimals. Since the 17th century, many formulas that represent 𝜋 as a
sum of infinite series or as a limit have been used to obtain more accurate approximate
values. The following are representations of 𝜋 known in those days:
𝜋 2∙2∙4∙4∙6∙6…
= 1∙3∙3∙5∙5∙7∙7… (J. Wallis)
2
PICARD’S ‘GREAT’ THEOREM: (a) Let 𝐴 = {𝑧 ∇ 𝐶 ∶ 𝑅 < |𝑧| < ∞}, and let 𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐 be
distinct elements of 𝐶 ∗ . Let 𝑓 ∶ 𝐴 → 𝐶 ∗ \{𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐} be meromorphic. Then lim𝑧→∞ 𝑓(𝑧)
exists.
(b) Suppose that 𝑓 is transcendental and meromorphic in 𝐶. Then 𝑓 takes every value in
𝐶 ∗ , with at most 2 exceptions, infinitely often in 𝐶.
Suppose 𝑓 is Lipschitz continuous in 𝑦 and continuous in 𝑡. Then, for some value 𝜀 >
0, there exists a unique solution 𝑦(𝑡)to the initial value problem on the interval 𝑡0 −
𝜖, 𝑡0 + 𝜖 .
PISANO: Leonardo Pisano, also known as Fibonacci was an Italian mathematician who
lived from 1170 - 1250. Fibonacci is sometimes called the greatest European
mathematician of the middle ages. As a boy, Fibonacci traveled, with his father, to North
Africa, where he learned the Arabic numeral system. Subsequently, Fibonacci studied
under leading Arabic mathematicians. Fibonacci is best known for introducing
mathematical concepts he learned in the Middle East to the Western world, including
the decimal system and the Fibonacci sequence , a series of numbers beginning with
zero or one and proceeding in such a manner that each number is the sum of the two
preceding numbers.
PLANE CURVE IN SPACE: A curve is known as plane curve if it lies on a plane. Otherwise
it is said to be a skew twisted or tortuous curve. The parametric equations of a plane
curve are 𝑥 = 𝑥(𝑡), 𝑦 = 𝑦(𝑡), 𝑧 = 𝑧(𝑡), where 𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧 are real valued functions of a single
real parameter 𝑡 ranging over a set value 𝑎 ≤ 𝑡 ≤ 𝑏.
Point-to-point graphs are commonly used for portraying functions in which time is the
independent variable. A point-to-point graph may be superimposed on a bar graph in a
specialized plot called a Pareto chart . Some point-to-point graphs allow plotting of
functions having multiple dependent variables, positive/negative variables and multi-
category variables.
POISSON ALGEBRA: An algebra, usually over the field of real or complex numbers,
equipped with a bilinear mapping satisfying the properties of the usual Poisson bracket
of functions. Let 𝐴 be an associative commutative algebra over a commutative ring, 𝑅. A
Poisson algebra structure on 𝐴 is defined by an Rbilinear, skew-symmetric mapping,
{ , } ∶ 𝐴 × 𝐴 → 𝐴 such that
(ii) (ii) the Leibniz rule is satisfied, namely, {𝑎, 𝑏𝑐} = {𝑎, 𝑏}𝑐 +
𝑏{𝑎, 𝑐}, for all a, b, c ∇ A.
The element {𝑎, 𝑏} is called the Poisson bracket of 𝑎 and 𝑏. The main example is that of
the algebra of smooth functions on a Poisson manifold
1 𝑅 2 − 𝑎𝑎 𝑓 𝑧 𝑑𝑧
𝑓 𝑎 = ∫
2𝜋𝑖 𝐶 𝑧 − 𝑎 (𝑅2 − 𝑧𝑎)
2𝜋
𝑖𝜃
1 𝑅 2 − 𝑟 2 𝑓 𝑅𝑒 𝑖ϕ 𝑑𝜙
𝑓 𝑟𝑒 =
2𝜋 0 𝑅² − 2𝑅𝑟 cos 𝜃 − 𝜙 + 𝑟²
POLAR PLANE OF A POINT WITH RESPECT TO A GIVEN SHAPE: The polar plane of a
given point with respect to a sphere is the locus of points the tangent planes at which
pass through the given point.
𝑎𝑖 𝑋 𝑖 + 𝑏𝑗 𝑋𝑗 = (𝑎𝑖 𝑏𝑖 )𝑋 𝑖 ,
( 𝑎𝑖 𝑋 𝑖 ) + ( 𝑏𝑗 𝑋𝑗 ) = 𝑘 𝑖+𝑙=𝑘 𝑎𝑖 𝑏𝑗 𝑋 𝑘 .
It hold that
If 𝑅 is an integral domain, then the letter inequality is an equality and therefore 𝑅[𝑋] is
an integral domain. For these inequalities and for convenience elsewhere, we define the
degree of 0 to be indefinite.
Assume that 𝑅 is a field. For given 𝑓, 𝑔𝜖𝑅 𝑋 deg 𝑔 ≥ 1 , we can find unique 𝑞, 𝑟𝜖𝑅[𝑋]
such that 𝑓 = 𝑔𝑞 + 𝑟 and deg 𝑟 < deg 𝑔 𝑜𝑟 𝑟 = 0 (division algorithum). This 𝑔 is called
the integral quotient of 𝑓 by 𝑔, and 𝑟 is called the remainder of 𝑓 divided by 𝑔. The same
fact remains true in the general 𝑅 𝑋 if 𝑔(𝑋) is monic.
𝑓 𝑥 = 𝑎0 + 𝑎1 𝑋 + ⋯ , 𝑎𝑛 𝑋 𝑛 (1)
POLYNOMIALS IN SEVERAL VARIABLE: Let 𝑅[𝑋, 𝑌] denote the ring 𝑅 𝑋 [𝑌], namely, the
ring obtained by adjoining 𝑌 to 𝑅[𝑋].
𝑣 𝑣 𝑣
𝑓 𝑋1 , 𝑋2 , ⋯ , 𝑋𝑚 = 𝑎𝑣1 𝑣2 ⋯𝑣𝑚 𝑋1 1 𝑋2 2 ⋯ , 𝑋𝑚𝑚 (1)
POSITON VECTOR: If the vector 𝑂𝑃 represents the position of the point P in space
relative to the point 𝑶 , then 𝑂𝑃 is called the position vector of P referred to 𝑶 as
origin.
If we say that 𝑨 is the point 𝑟 , then we mean that the position vector of 𝑨 is 𝒓 with
respect to some given origin O.
Let λ be a continuous linear functional on 𝐶(𝑋). Then there are positive functionals 𝜆+
and 𝜆− on 𝐶(𝑋), such that 𝜆 = 𝜆+ − 𝜆−
For 𝑓 ∇ 𝐶ℝ (𝐾), we define the support of 𝑓, written as supp(𝑓), to be the closure of the
set {𝑥 ∇ 𝐾 ∶ 𝑓(𝑥) ≠ 0}.
POSITIVE OPERATORS IN 𝑪(𝑲)): Let 𝐶(𝐾) be the set of real-valued continuous maps on
a compact 𝐾. For those, there is a natural (partial) order: 𝑓 ≥ 𝑔 means 𝑓(𝑥) ≥ 𝑔(𝑥)
for all 𝑥 ∇ 𝐾. An operator 𝑈 ∶ 𝐶(𝐾) → 𝐶(𝐾) is called positive if 𝑓 ≥ 0 implies
𝑈(𝑓) ≥ 0 and it is called monotone if 𝑓 ≥ 𝑔 implies 𝑈(𝑓) ≥ 𝑈(𝑔). If 𝑈 is linear then it
is positive iff it is monotone.
POSITIVE ORIENTATION: The positive orientation (counterclockwise) is the one that is
given by the standard parametrization 𝑧(𝑡) = 𝑧0 + 𝑟𝑒 𝑖𝑡 , where 𝑡 ∇ 0, 2𝜋 .
POSTULATIONS OF LINEAR PROGRAMMING:
Proportionality postulation: The contribution of each movement to the value
of the objective function is proportional to the level of that activity. In the
same way, the contribution of each movement to the left hand side of each
functional constraint is proportional to the level of the movement.
Divisibility postulation: Decision variables are allowed to have any values,
including non-integer values that satisfy the functional and non-negativity
constraints.
Certainty postulation: The value assigned to each parameter is assumed to be
a known constant.
Additivity postulation: Every function is the sum of the individual
contributions of the relevant activities.
PRANDTL’S FUNCTION: The Prandtl’s stress function 𝜓 is defined as
1 2
𝜓 = 𝜓 𝑥, 𝑦 − 𝑥 + 𝑦2
2
𝜕𝜓 𝜕𝜓 𝜕𝜓 𝜕𝜓
so that = 𝜕𝑥 − 𝑥 , 𝜕𝑦 = 𝜕𝑦 − 𝑦. From these equations, we get
𝜕𝑥
𝜕𝜙 𝜕𝜓 𝜕𝜙 𝜕𝜓
= 𝜕𝑦 − 𝜕𝑦 = − and 𝜏𝑥𝑥 = 𝜏𝑦𝑦 = 𝜏𝑧𝑧 = 𝜏𝑥𝑦 = 0,
𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑥
𝜕𝜙 𝜕𝜙
𝜏𝑧𝑥 = 𝜇 𝛼 − 𝑦 , 𝜏𝑦𝑧 = 𝜇 𝛼 +𝑥 ,
𝜕𝑥 𝜕𝑦
giving
𝜕𝜓
𝜏𝑧𝑥 = 𝜇 𝛼 ,
𝜕𝑦
𝜕𝜓
𝜏𝑧𝑦 = −𝜇 𝛼
𝜕𝑥
Since the stress components 𝜏𝑧𝑥 and 𝜏𝑧𝑦 are obtained from the function 𝜓 𝑥, 𝑦 by
differentiation , 𝜓 𝑥, 𝑦 is called the stress- function.
PREDICATE LOGIC: Predicate logic is the area of symbolic logic in which we take
quantifiers in account. Mainly propositional functions are discussed in predicate logic.
In the strict sense only single variable propositional functions are called predicates, but
the phrase predicate of n arguments (or wary predicate) denoting an 𝑛 variable
propositional function is also employed. Single-variable (or unary) predicates are also
called properties. We say that 𝑢 has the property 𝐹 if the proposition 𝐹(𝑎) formed by
the property 𝐹 is true. Predicates of two arguments are called binary relations. The
proposition 𝑅(𝑎, 𝑏) formed by the binary relation 𝑅 is occasionally expressed in the
form 𝑎𝑅𝑏. Generally, predicates of 𝑛 arguments are called n-ary relations. The domain of
definition of a unary predicate is called the object domain, elements of the object
domain are called objects, and any variable running over the object domain is called an
object variable. We assume here that the object domain is not empty. When we deal
with a number of predicates simultaneously (with different numbers of variables), it is
usual to arrange things so that all the independent variables have the same object
domain by suitably extending their object domains.
PRE-IMAGE THEOREM: Let 𝑓 ∶ 𝑀 → 𝑁 be a smooth map and let 𝑄 ∇ 𝑁 such that 𝑓 −1 (𝑄)
is not empty. Suppose that 𝑄 is regular. Then 𝑓 −1 (𝑄) is a submanifold of 𝑀 with dim
𝑓 −1 (𝑄)= dim𝑀 − dim𝑁.
PRESERVANCE OF CROSS RATIO: Cross ratio remains invariant under 𝑎 bilinear
transformation.
PRESSURE IN THE FLUID: The pressure P at a point in the fluid is the limit of the ratio of
normal force δA by the surrounding fluid particles as the area approaches zero. It is
defined as
Lt δF
p= .
δA → 0 δA
We know that the pressure at every point of an ideal fluid is equal in all directions
whether the fluid be at rest or in motion. It follows that an elements δA of a very small
area, free to rotate about its centre will have a force of constant magnitude acting on
either side of it.
PRIME IDEALS: Let 𝑅 be a unital ring. A proper ideal 𝐼 is said to be prime if, given any
ideals 𝐽 and 𝐾 satisfying 𝐽𝐾 ⊂ 𝐼, either 𝐽 ⊂ 𝐼 or 𝐾 ⊂ 𝐼.
PRIME NUMBER: A prime number is an integer 𝑝 greater than one with the property
that 1 and 𝑝 are the only positive integers that divide 𝑝.
Let 𝜋(𝑥) be the prime-counting function that gives the number of primes less than or
equal to 𝑥, for any real number 𝑥. For example, 𝜋(10) = 4 because there are four prime
numbers (2, 3, 5 and 7) less than or equal to 10. The prime number theorem then states
that 𝑥 / 𝑙𝑛(𝑥) is a good approximation to 𝜋(𝑥), in the sense that the limit of the
quotient of the two functions 𝜋(𝑥) and 𝑥 / 𝑙𝑛(𝑥) as x approaches infinity is 1:
This notation (and the theorem) does not say anything about the limit of
the difference of the two functions as x approaches infinity. Instead, the theorem states
that 𝑥/𝑙𝑛(𝑥) approximates 𝜋(𝑥) in the sense that the relative error of this
approximation approaches 0 as x approaches infinity.
The prime number theorem is equivalent to the statement that the 𝑛th prime
number 𝑝𝑛 satisfies
,
The prime number theorem is also equivalent to
,
and
.
PRIMITIVE ELEMENT THEOREM: Every finite separable field extension is simple.
in which 𝑓 𝑥 , become infinite at 𝑥 = 𝑐, where 𝑐 lies between the limits 𝑎 and 𝑏 . In this
case we define the integral
b
𝑓 𝑥 dx
a
as
c−μϵ b
lim 𝑓 𝑥 dx + 𝑓 𝑥 dx
∇→0 a c+υϵ
The above limit gives what is called the general value of the improper integral. If 𝜇 = 𝑣,
the value of the above limits is called the principal value of the integral.
PRINCIPAL AXIS THEOREM: The principal axis theorem concern quadratic forms in 𝑹𝒏 ,
which are homogeneous polynomials of degree 2. Any quadratic form may be
represented as
PRINCIPAL NORMAL: Let 𝑡 𝑖 be unit tangent vector at any point 𝑃(𝑥 𝑖 ) lying on a curve 𝐶
in a Vn. The derived vector of 𝑡 𝑖 in its own direction is called fist curvature vector of C
relative to Vn and is denoted by 𝑝𝑖 . Then
dx i dx i
𝑝𝑖 = 𝑡 𝑖 , where 𝑡 𝑖 =
dt ds
dx j 𝜕𝑡 𝑖 i dx i 𝜕𝑡 𝑖 dx i dx i i dt i dx a dx i i
pi = ti,𝑗 = + tα = 𝜕𝑥 𝑗 + tα aj
= + aj
ds 𝜕𝑥 𝑖 aj ds ds ds ds ds ds
d2xi dx i dx k i
= ds 2 + jk
ds ds
If the direction of vector Α is not changed by the strain, then δΑ and Α are parallel and
their components are proportional.
i.e. 𝛿𝐴𝑖 ∝ 𝐴𝑖
𝛿𝐴𝑖
Since ℯ = is the extension of each component of vector Α and is thus the extension of
𝐴𝑖
Α itself.
𝛿Α
Or ℯ = ,
Α
𝑒𝑖𝑗 𝑥𝑖 𝑥𝑗
ℯ= ,
Α2
Also since , 𝛿𝐴𝑖 = ℯ𝑖𝑗 𝐴𝑗 ,
Equation (2) is the set of three linear homogenous equations in the unknown 𝐴1 , 𝐴2 ,
𝐴3 . In expanded form, the equations (1) are
(3) possesses a non- vanishing solution if and only if the determinant of the coefficients
of 𝐴1 𝐴2 ,and 𝐴3 is equal to zero
Since this is cubic in ℯ and has three roots say ℯ1 , ℯ2 𝑎𝑛𝑑 ℯ3 . These three roots are
termed as the principal strains.
PRINCIPLE OF SUPERPOSITION: To get the general solution we just add together all the
∞
solutions we have (𝑥, 𝑡) = 𝑛=1 sinnx(𝑎𝑛 𝑐𝑜𝑠𝐾𝑛𝑡 + 𝑏𝑛 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝐾𝑛𝑡) . Applying the initial
∞
condition 𝑦(𝑥, 0) = 𝐹(𝑥), this gives 𝐹 𝑥 = 𝑛=1 𝑎𝑛 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝑛𝑥 .
𝐹 𝑥 , 𝑖𝑓 0 ≤ 𝑥 ≤ 𝜋;
𝐺 𝑥 =
−𝐹 −𝑥 , 𝑖𝑓 − 𝜋 ≤ 𝑥 < 0
∞
we have 𝐺 𝑥 = 𝑛=1 𝑎𝑛 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝑛𝑥 𝑓𝑜𝑟 − 𝜋 ≤ 𝑥 < 𝜋.
1 𝜋
𝑎𝑘 = 𝜋 ∫−𝜋 𝐺 𝑥 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝑘𝑥𝑑𝑥,
This implies that the 𝑎𝑛 are precisely the sine coefficients of 𝐺. If we now assume,
further, that the right-hand side is differentiable term by term, we differentiate with
respect to 𝑡, and we set 𝑡 = 0, to get
∞
0 = 𝑦𝑡 (x, 0) = 𝑛=1 𝑏𝑛 𝐾𝑛𝑠𝑖𝑛𝑛𝑥
This equation is solved by taking 𝑏𝑛 = 0 for all 𝑛, so we have the following result.
A solution of the differential equation (1) with the given boundary and initial conditions
∞
is 𝑦 𝑥, 𝑡 = 𝑛=1 𝑎𝑛 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝑛𝑥𝑐𝑜𝑠𝐾𝑛𝑡, where the coefficients an are the Fourier sine
1 𝜋
coefficients 𝑎𝑘 = 𝜋 ∫−𝜋 𝐺 𝑥 𝑠𝑖𝑛𝑘𝑥𝑑𝑥 of the 2π periodic function G, defined on (−𝜋, 𝜋]
𝑃 𝐸𝑛 = 𝑃 𝐸𝑛 ;
𝑛 𝑛
𝑃 𝐸 = 𝑃 𝐸𝑛
𝑛=1
This property is called the additivity of probability. If 𝑃 𝐸 = 1, the event 𝐸 is said to
occur almost certainly (almost surely (abbrev. a.s.), for almost all 𝜔 or with probability
1).
PRODUCT MEASURE: Let 𝑋 and 𝑌 be two spaces, and let 𝑆 and 𝑇 be semirings on 𝑋 and 𝑌
respectively. Then 𝑆 × 𝑇 is the semiring consisting of { 𝐴 × 𝐵 ∶ 𝐴 ∇ 𝑆, 𝐵 ∇ 𝑇 }. Let µ
and 𝜈 be measures on 𝑆 and 𝑇 respectively. Define the product measure µ × 𝜈 on 𝑆 × 𝑇
by the rule (µ × 𝜈)(𝐴 × 𝐵) = µ(𝐴) 𝜈(𝐵).
PROJECTION: Our shadow is our projection on the ground. x is the projection on the X
axis and y is the projection on the Y axis, of the point (𝑥, 𝑦).
X ∇ T, ∆θ x x − x ≥ 0 ⇒ θ x ≤ 𝜃(𝑥).
PURE SHEAR: If a volume initially cubical is deformed into a parallelepiped and the
volumes of the cube and the parallelepiped are equal, when the product of changes is
neglected in the linear elements, the deformation is called Pure-shear.
QED: The term “QED” is actually an abbreviation and stands for the Latin quod erat
demonstrandum, meaning “which was to be demonstrated.” QED typically is used to
signify the end of a mathematical proof.
QUADRATIC DUAL (MAXIMIZATION) PROBLEM (QDP): The quadric dual
(maximization) problem means to find an x ∇ Rn and a u ∇ Rm , if they exist, such that
1 1
− 𝑥 𝐶 𝑥 − 𝑐 𝑢 = max − 𝑥 𝐶 𝑥 − 𝑐𝑢
2 (𝑥,𝑢)∇𝑌 2
where x, u ∇ 𝑌 = x, u : x ∇ Rn , u ∇ Rm , Cx + A′ u = b and u ≥ 0
n n
aij xi xj ,
i−1 j−1
symmetrix matrix over the field 𝐹 and let 𝑋 = [x1 , x2 , … … , xn ]𝑇 be a column vector.
n n
Then 𝑋 𝑇 𝐴𝑋 determines a unique quadratic form i−1 j−1 a ij xi xj in n variables
x1 , x2 , … … , xn over the field F.
QUADRIC HYPERSURFACES: A subset 𝐹 of a n-dimensional Euclidean space 𝐸 𝑛 is called a
quadric hypersurface (or simply hyperquadric) if it is the set of points 𝑥1 , … , 𝑥𝑛
satisfying the following equation of the second degree:
𝑛 𝑛
𝑖,𝑘=1 𝑎𝑖𝑘 𝑥𝑖 𝑥𝑘 +2 𝑖=1 𝑏𝑖 𝑥𝑖 + 𝑐 = 0,
X ∇ T, θ x ≤ x , 0 ≤ λ ≤ 1 & 1 − 𝜆 x + λx ∇ T ⇒ θ(x) ≤ 𝜃 1 − 𝜆 x + λx
x ∇ T, θ x ≤ x , 0 ≤ λ ≤ 1 & 1 − 𝜆 x + λx ∇ T ⇒ 𝜃 1 − 𝜆 x + λx ≤ θ(x)
QUASI FUZZY NUMBER: A quasi fuzzy number 𝐴 is a fuzzy set of the real line with a
normal, fuzzy convex and continuous membership function satisfying the limit
conditions
lim 𝐴 𝑡 = 0, lim 𝐴 𝑡 = 0
𝑡→∞ 𝑡→−∞
𝑤 + 𝑥𝑖 + 𝑦𝑗 + 𝑧𝑘 + 𝑤 ′ + 𝑥 ′ 𝑖 + 𝑦 ′ 𝑗 + 𝑧 ′ 𝑘 = 𝑤 + 𝑤 ′ + 𝑥 + 𝑥 ′ 𝑖 +
𝑦 + 𝑦 ′ 𝑗 + 𝑧 + 𝑧 ′ 𝑘;
(𝑤 + 𝑥𝑖 + 𝑦𝑗 + 𝑧𝑘) − (𝑤 ′ + 𝑥 ′ 𝑖 + 𝑦 ′ 𝑗 + 𝑧 ′ 𝑘) = (𝑤 − 𝑤 ′ ) + (𝑥 − 𝑥 ′ )𝑖 +
(𝑦 − 𝑦 ′ )𝑗 + (𝑧 − 𝑧 ′ )𝑘.
QUEUE LENGTH: Number of persons in the system at any time. We may be interested in
studying the distribution of queue length.
QUEUING MODEL (MARKOV CHAINS H): In a telephone system, calls made when all the
lines of the system are busy are lost. The problem of computing the probability of loss
involved was fïrst solved in the pioneering article on queuing theory by A. K. Erlang in
1917. For systems in which calls can be put on hold when all lines are busy, one deals
with the waiting time distribution instead of the probability. In 1930, F. Pollaczeck and
A. Ya. Khinchin gave explicit formulas for the characteristic function of the waiting time
distribution. In many situations, such as in telephone systems, air and surface traffic,
production lines, and computer systems, various congestion phenomena are often
observed, and many kinds of queuing models are utilized to analyze the congestion.
Mathematically, almost all such models are formulated by using Markov processes. For
practical uses, approximation and computational methods are important as well as
theoretical results.
QUEUING PROCESS: A queuing process is centered on a service system (facility). The
queueing system has the following characteristics:
All queuing situation involve the arrival of customers (input) at a service facility, where
some time may be spent in waiting and then receiving the desired service. The
customers arriving for service may or may not enter the system. Thus, the input pattern
in the system depends on the nature of the system as well as the behavior of the
customer. The combination of these two determines the arrival pattern. After the
service is completed the customer leaves the service system (output). The departure
pattern mainly depends on the service discipline. There can be many types of queuing
systems depending on the nature of inputs, service mechanism and customer
characteristics.
Similarly some service facility waits for arrival of customers when the total capacity of
system is more than the number of customers, Thus , in the absence of a perfect balance
between the service facility and the customers, waiting is required either by the service
facility or by the customer. The imbalance between the customers and service facility ,
known as congestion , cannot be eliminated completely but efforts/ techniques can be
evolved to reduce the magnitude of congestion or waiting time of a new arrival in the
system.
The customers arriving for service may from one queue and be serviced through only
one station , that may form one queue and be serviced through several stations or they
may form several queues and be served through as many stations.
QUOTIENT LAW: A set of quantities, whose inner product with an arbitrary vector is a
tensor, it itself a tensor.
The radian is the Standard International (SI) unit of plane angular measure. There are 2 pi, or
approximately 6.28318, radians in a complete circle. Thus, one radian is about 57.296
angular degrees.
RADIAN: The term radian arises from the fact that the length of a circular arc,
corresponding to an angle of one radian, is equal to the radius of the arc. This is shown
in the illustration. Point 𝑃 represents the center of the circle. The angle 𝑞, representing
one radian, is such that the length of the subtended circular arc is equal to the radius, 𝑟,
of the circle.
RADICAL PLANE: The radical plane of any two given spheres is the locus of a point
which moves so that the squares of the lengths of the tangents drawn from it to the
given spheres are equal.
∞ 𝑛
RADIUS OF CONVERGENCE: Let 𝑎𝑛 ∇ 𝐶. Then, either 𝑛=0 𝑎𝑛 𝑧 converges for all 𝑧 ∇ 𝐶
(and we say that the power series has radius of covergence infinity) or there exists an 𝑅
with 𝑅 ≥ 0 such that
∞ 𝑛
(i) 𝑛=0 𝑎𝑛 𝑧 converges for all |𝑧| < 𝑅,
∞ 𝑛
(ii) 𝑛=0 𝑎𝑛 𝑧 diverges for all |𝑧| > 𝑅.
RADON'S THEOREM: Any set of 𝑑 + 2 points in 𝑹𝒅 can be partitioned into two disjoint
sets whose convex hulls intersect. A point in the intersection of these hulls is called
a Radon point of the set.
(1) the values are uniformly distributed over a defined interval or set, and
(2) it is impossible to predict future values based on past or present ones. Random
numbers are important in statistical analysis and probability theory.
The most common set from which random numbers are derived is the set of single-digit
decimal numbers {0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9}. The task of generating random digits from
this set is not trivial. A common scheme is the selection (by means of a mechanical
escape hatch that lets one ball out at a time) of numbered ping-pong balls from a set of
10, one bearing each digit, as the balls are blown about in a container by forced-air jets.
This method is popular in lotteries. After each number is selected, the ball with that
number is returned to the set, the balls are allowed to blow around for a minute or two,
and then another ball is allowed to escape.
Sometimes the digits in the decimal expansions of irrational numbers are used in an
attempt to obtain random numbers. Most whole numbers have irrational square roots,
so entering a string of six or eight digits into a calculator and then hitting the square
root button can provide a sequence of digits that seems random. Other algorithms have
been devised that supposedly generate random numbers. The problem with these
methods is that they violate condition (2) in the definition of randomness. The existence
of any number-generation algorithm produces future values based on past and/or
current ones. Digits or numbers generated in this manner are called pseudorandom.
Statisticians, mathematicians, and scientists have long searched for the ideal source of
random numbers. One of the best methods is the sampling of electromagnetic noise.
This noise, generated by the chaotic movements of electrons, holes, or other charge
carriers in materials and in space, is thought to be as close to "totally random" as any
observable phenomenon.
RATE OF A CODE: Let 𝐶 be an (𝑛, 𝑀)-code over an alphabet of size 𝑞. Then, the rate of
the code 𝐶 is defined by
log 𝑞 𝑀
𝑟𝑎𝑡𝑒(𝐶) =
𝑛
RATIONAL NUMBER: A rational number is a number determined by the ratio of
some integer p to some nonzero natural number q. The set of rational numbers is
denoted Q, and represents the set of all possible integer-to-natural-number ratios p/q.
In mathematical expressions, unknown or unspecified rational numbers are
represented by lowercase, italicized letters from the late middle or end of the alphabet,
especially r, s, and t, and occasionally u through z. Rational numbers are primarily of
interest to theoreticians. Theoretical mathematics has potentially far-reaching
applications in communications and computer science, especially in data encryption and
security.
If r and t are rational numbers such that r < t, then there exists a rational number s such
that r < s < t. This is true no matter how small the difference between r and t, as long as
the two are not equal. In this sense, the set Q is "dense."Nevertheless, Q is
a denumerable set. Denumerability refers to the fact that, even though a set might
contain an infinite number of elements, and even though those elements might be
"densely packed," the elements can be defined by a list that assigns them each a unique
number in a sequence corresponding to the set of natural numbers N = {1, 2, 3, ...}..
For the set of natural numbers N and the set of integers Z, neither of which are "dense"
denumeration lists are straightforward. For Q, it is less obvious how such a list might be
constructed. An example appears below. The matrix includes all possible numbers of the
form p/q, where p is an integer and q is a nonzero natural number. Every possible
rational number is represented in the array. Following the pink line, think of 0 as the
"first stop," 1/1 as the "second stop," -1/1 as the "third stop," 1/2 as the "fourth stop,"
and so on. This defines a sequential (although redundant) list of the rational numbers.
There is a one-to-one correspondence between the elements of the array and the set of
natural numbers N.
In contrast to the natural numbers, integers, and rational numbers, the sets of irrational
numbers, real numbers, imaginary numbers, and complex numbers are non-
denumerable. They have cardinality greater than that of the set N.
RANK OF A FREE MODULE: The rank of a free module is the number of elements in any
free basis for the free module.
(i) There is at least one square submatrix of 𝐴 of order 𝑟 whoes determinant is not
equal to zero.
(ii) If the matrix 𝐴 contains any square submatrix of order 𝑟 + 1, then the
determinant of every square submatrix of 𝐴 of order 𝑟 + 1 should be zero.
In short the rank of a matrix is the order of any highest order non-vanishing minor if 𝑡
matrix.
Since the rank of every non-zero matrix is ≥ 1, we agree to assign the rank, zero, to
every null matrix.
(i) The rank of a matrix is ≤ r, if all 𝑟 + 1-rowed minors of the matrix vanish.
(ii) The rank of a matrix is ≥ r, if there is at least one 𝑟-rowed minors of the matrix
which is not equal to zero.
RANK OF A QUADRATIC FORM: Let X ′ AX be a quadratic form over a field F . The rank of
the matrix A is called the rank of the quadratic form X ′ AX.
RANK OF A SUM: Rank of the sum of two matrices cannot exceed sum of their ranks.
∞
(iii) If 𝑙 < 1 then 𝑛=1 𝑎𝑛 converges.
∞
(iv) If 𝑙 > 1 then 𝑛=1 𝑎𝑛 diverges.
REAL NUMBER: A real number is any element of the set R, which is the union of the set
of rational numbers and the set of irrational numbers. In mathematical expressions,
unknown or unspecified real numbers are usually represented by lowercase italic
letters u through z. The set R gives rise to other sets such as the set of imaginary
numbers and the set of complex numbers. The idea of a real number (and what makes it
"real") is primarily of interest to theoreticians. Abstract mathematics has potentially
far-reaching applications in communications and computer science, especially in data
encryption and security.
If x and z are real numbers such that x < z, then there always exists a real
number y such that x < y < z. The set of reals is "dense" in the same sense as the set of
irrationals. Both sets are nonde numerable. There are more real numbers than is
possible to list, even by implication.
The set R is sometimes called the continuum because it is intuitive to think of the
elements of R as corresponding one-to-one with the points on a geometric line. This
notion, first proposed by Georg Cantor who also noted the difference between the
cardinalities (sizes) of the sets of rational and irrational numbers, is called
the Continuum Hypothesis. This hypothesis can be either affirmed or denied without
causing contradictions in theoretical mathematics.
REAL OR ACTUAL FLUIDS: The real fluid (Viscous and compressible) is one in which
both the tangential and normal forces exist. Viscosity, which is also known as an
internal friction, of a fluid is that characteristic of real fluid which is capable to offer
resistance to shearing stress. The resistance is comparatively small (not negligible) for
fluids such as water and gases but it quite large for other fluids such as oil, glycerin,
molasses, coal tar etc.
n n
aij xi xj ,
i−1 j−1
Where aij ’s are all real numbers, is called a real quadratic form in the n variables
x1 , x2 , … … , xn For example,
REAL VECTOR SPACES: A real vector space consists of a set 𝑉 on which there is defined
an operation of vector addition, yielding an element 𝑣 + 𝑤 of 𝑉 for each pair 𝑣, 𝑤 of
elements of 𝑉 , and an operation of multiplication-by-scalars that yields an element 𝜆𝑣
of 𝑉 for each 𝑣 ∇ 𝑉 and for each real number 𝜆. The operation of vector addition is
required to be commutative and associative. There must exist a zero element 0𝑣 of V
that satisfies 𝑣 + 0𝑣 = 𝑣 for all 𝑣 ∇ 𝑉 , and, for each 𝑣 ∇ 𝑉 there must exist an
element −𝑣 of 𝑉 for which 𝑣 + (−𝑣) = 0𝑣 . The following identities must also be
satisfied for all 𝑣, 𝑤 ∇ 𝑉 and for all real numbers 𝜆 and µ: (𝜆 + µ)𝑣 = 𝜆𝑣 + µ𝑣, 𝜆(𝑣 +
𝑤) = 𝜆𝑣 + 𝜆𝑤, 𝜆(µ𝑣) = (𝜆µ)𝑣, 1𝑣 = 𝑣.
2mx
(i) Pn m+1 x − Pn m x + n n + 1 − (m − 1) Pn m−1 x = 0.
1−x 2
(i) Hn ′ x = 2nHn−1 x n ≥ 1.
(ii) 2x. Hn x = 2nHn−1 x + Hn+1 (x)
(iii) H′n x = 2xHn x − Hn+1 (x).
(iv) Hn " x − 2x H′n x + 2nH x = 0.
RECTIFYING PLANE: The plane containing the tangent and binormal at 𝑃 is called
rectifying plane at 𝑃. i.e., it is plane passing through 𝑃 and perpendicular to principal
normal at 𝑃. Evidently equation of this plane is
𝑅−𝑟 ∙𝑛 =0
RECTILINEAR VORTICES: Consider a two dimensional vortex motion. The vorticity
vector is perpendicular to the plane of motion and the vortex lines are straight lines
parallel to 𝑍-axis. All vortex tubes are cylindrical, with generators perpendicular to the
plane of the motion. Such vortices are called rectilinear vortices.
REDUCTION TO NORMAL FORM: Every 𝑚 × 𝑛 matrix of the rank 𝑟can be reduced to the
Ir 0
form by a finite chain of 𝐸- operations, where Ir is the 𝑟- rowed unit matrix.
0 0
The following three properties of the relation ‘~’ in the set of all 𝑚 × 𝑛 matrices are
quite obvious:
(i) Reflexivity: If 𝐴 is any 𝑚 × 𝑛 matrix, then 𝐴~𝐴. Obviously 𝐴 can be obtained form
𝐴 by the elementary transformation R i → kR i , where k = 1.
(ii) Symmetry: If 𝐴~𝐵, then 𝐵~𝐴. If 𝐵 can be obtained from 𝐴 by a finite number of
elementary transformation of 𝐴, then 𝐴 can also be obtained from 𝐵 by a finite number
of elementary transformations of 𝐵.
(iii) Transitivity: If 𝐴~𝐵, then 𝐵~𝐶, and 𝐴~𝐶.
If 𝐵 can be obtained from 𝐴 by a series of elementary transformation of 𝐴 and 𝐶 can be
obtained from 𝐵 by a series of elementary transformations of 𝐵, then 𝐶 can also be
obtained from 𝐴 by a series of elementary transformations of 𝐴.
Therefore the relation ‘~’ in the set of all 𝑚 × 𝑛 matrices is equivalence relations.
REFINEMENT OF A PARTITION: Let 𝑃 and 𝑃 ∗ be two partitions of a closed interval [𝑎, 𝑏].
Then 𝑃∗ is said to be a refinement of 𝑃 if 𝑃 ⊆ 𝑃 ∗ . We also say that 𝑃 ∗ is finer than 𝑃.
REGULAR ELEMENTS: Let A be Banach algebra with identity. If 𝑓 is an element in A,
then it may happen that there is an element 𝑔 in A such that 𝑓𝑔 = 𝑔𝑓 = 𝑒 (identity). In
this case 𝑔 is denoted by 𝑓 −1 and called to inverse of 𝑓.
If an element 𝑓 in has an inverse, then 𝑓 is said to be regular element. Regular elements
are often called invertible elements or non-singular elements or unit element. The
element 𝑒 is always regular in a Banach algebra A. the set of regular elements in A is
denoted by G. Clearly G contains 𝑒 and is a group.
REGULAR POLYGONS: A ‘polygon in a Euclidean plane bounding a convex cell whose
sides and interior angles are all respectively congruent is called a regular polygon.
When the number of vertices (which equals the numbers of sides) is 𝑛, it is called a
regular 𝑛 −gon. There exist a circle (circumscribed circle) passing through all the
vertices of a regular 𝑛- gon and a concentric circle (inscribed circle) tangent to all the
sides. We call the center of those circles the center of the regular 𝑛-gon. The 𝑛 vertices
of a regular 𝑛- gon are obtained by divided a circle into 𝑛 equal parts.
(Γ(𝑙)Γ(𝑚 ))
𝐵 𝑙, 𝑚 = (Γ(𝑙+𝑚 ))
RELATIONS: In its wider sense the term relation means 𝑛- ary relation (𝑛 = 1,2,3, … )
but we restrict ourselves to its most ordinary meaning, i.e. ,to the case 𝑛 = 2. Let 𝑋, 𝑌 be
two sets and 𝑥, 𝑦 be two variables taking their values in 𝑋, 𝑌, respectively. A proposition
𝑅(𝑥, 𝑦) containing 𝑥, 𝑦 is called a relation or a binary relation if it can be determine
whether 𝑅(𝑎, 𝑏) is true or false for each pair (𝑎, 𝑏) in a Cartersian product 𝑋 × 𝑌. For
example, if both 𝑋 and 𝑌 are the set of rational integers, then the following propositions
relations: 𝑥 ≤ 𝑦, 𝑥 − 𝑦 is even, 𝑥 divides 𝑦. A relation 𝑅(𝑥, 𝑦) is sometimes written as
𝑥𝑅𝑦.
Suppose that we are given a relation 𝑥𝑅𝑦(𝑥 ∇ 𝑋, 𝑦 ∇ 𝑌). Then the set 𝐺 =
𝑥, 𝑦 𝑥𝑅𝑦 ,which consists of elements (𝑥, 𝑦) of the Cartesian product 𝑋 × 𝑌 satisfying
𝑥𝑅𝑦, is called the graph of the relation 𝑅.
(i) x 2 − 1 Qn Pn′ − Pn Qn ′ = c
Q n (x) ∞ dx
(ii) = ∫∝
P n (x) x 2 −1 Pn 2 x
1
(iii) Pn Qn−1 − Qn Pn−1 = n .
(2n−1)
(iv) Pn Qn−2 − Qn Pn−2 = n(n−1) x.
RELATIVE SCALAR: A relative tensor of order zero is called relative scalar. Thus
𝜔
′
𝜕𝑥
𝐼 =𝐼
𝜕𝑥 ′
Then 𝐼 is called relative scalar of weight 𝜔. A relative scalar of weight one is called scalar
density. A relative scalar of weight zero called absolute scalar.
RELATIVE TENSOR: If the quantities 𝐴𝑖𝑗 satisfy the following transformation law
𝜔
𝜕𝑥 𝑎 𝜕𝑥 𝛽 𝜕𝑥
𝐴′𝑖𝑗 = 𝐴𝑎𝛽
𝜕𝑥 ′𝑖 𝜕𝑥 ′𝑗 𝜕𝑥 ′
Then 𝐴𝑖𝑗 is called a relative tensor of weight 𝜔. A relative tensor of weight one is called
tensor density. If the weight of a relative tension is zero, then the relative tensor is
called an absolute tensor.
RELATIVE VECTOR: A relative tensor of rank one is called relative vector. Thus if
𝜔
𝜕𝑥 𝑎 𝜕𝑥
𝐴′𝑖𝑗 = 𝐴𝑎𝛽
𝜕𝑥 ′𝑖 𝜕𝑥 ′
Then 𝐴𝑖 is called a relative vector of weight 𝜔. A relative vector of weight of one is celled
vector density. A relative vector of weight zero is called absolute vector.
RELATIVE VELOCITY: The relative velocity of Q with respect to P is the rate of change of
the position of Q relative to P and therefore, if uniform, is determined by the relative
displacement in one second.
𝑓 𝑋 = 𝑋 − 𝛼 𝑞 𝑋 + 𝑟,
𝑞 𝑋 𝜖𝑘 𝑋 , 𝑟𝜖𝑘.
RENEGING: A customer may leave the queue due to impatience after joining it.
RESIDUE AT A POLE: Suppose a single valued function 𝑓(𝑧) has a pole of order 𝑚 at
𝑧 = 𝛼, then by definition of pole the principles part of Laurent’s expansion of 𝑓(𝑧)
contains only 𝑚 terms so that
∞ 𝑚
𝑛
𝑓 𝑧 = 𝑎𝑛 (𝑧 − 𝛼) + 𝑏𝑛 (𝑧 − 𝛼)𝑛
𝑛=0 𝑛 =1
C being a circle z − α = r
1
Evidently b1 = 2πi ∫ c f z dz
The coefficient b1 is called the residues of 𝑓 z at the pole z = α and is denoted by the
symbol Res (z = α) = b1 .
1
Res (𝑧 = ∞) = − 2𝜋𝑖 ∫ 𝑐 𝑓 𝑧 𝑑𝑧
Where 𝐶 is any closed contour which encloses all the finite singularities of 𝑓(𝑧). The
integral is taken in positive direction (anticlockwise direction).
Cauchy’s Residue Theorem: If 𝑓(𝑧) is analytic within and on a closed contour 𝐶, except
at a finite number of poles z1 , z2 , z3 … , zn within 𝐶, then
c f z dz = 2πi Res (z = zr )
r=1
Where R.H.S. denotes sum of residues of 𝑓(𝑧) at its poles lying within 𝐶.
Suppose 𝑈 is a simply connected open subset of the complex plane, and 𝑎1 , . . . , 𝑎𝑛 are
finitely many points of 𝑈 and 𝑓 is a function which is defined and holomorphic on 𝑈 \
{𝑎1 , . . . , 𝑎𝑛 }. If 𝛾 is a closed rectifiable curve in 𝑈 which does not meet any of the 𝑎𝑘 ,
Note that
RESOLVENT OPERATOR: Let A be a Banach algebra and 𝜌(𝑓) be the resolvent set of 𝑓.
The function
𝑓 ∶ 𝜌 𝑓 ⟶ 𝐴 𝑑𝑒𝑓𝑖𝑛𝑒𝑑 𝑏𝑦
𝑓 𝜆 = (𝑓 − 𝜆𝐼)−1
Is called resolvent operator of 𝑓.
The resolvent operator associated with 𝑓 is also called resolvent of 𝑓.
Note: 𝑓 𝜆 is a continuous function of 𝜆.
RESOLVENT SET: The resolvent set of 𝑓 is the complement of 𝜍 (𝑓) and it is denoted by
𝜌 𝑓 . 𝜌(𝑓) is an open subset of the complex plane which contains 𝑧: 𝑧 > 𝑓
RESOLVENT SET ρ T OF AN OPERATOR: The resolvent set 𝜌(𝑇) of an operator 𝑇 is the
set 𝜌 (𝑇) = {𝜆 ∇ ℂ: 𝑇 − 𝜆 𝐼 𝑖𝑠 𝑖𝑛𝑣𝑒𝑟𝑡𝑖𝑏𝑙𝑒}.
I = i gi x = 0
RICCI’S LEMMA: The metric tensors are covariant constants with respect to Christoffel
symbols.
RICCI’S THEOREM: The covariant derivatives of the tensors 𝑔𝑖𝑗 , 𝑔𝑖𝑗 , 𝑔𝑗𝑖 all vanish
identically.
Examples : (i) 𝑑𝑠 2 = 𝑑𝑥 2 + 𝑑𝑦 2 .
(ii) 𝑑𝑠 2 = 𝑑𝑟 2 + 𝑟 2 𝜃 2 .
(iii) 𝑑𝑠 2 = 𝑑𝑥 2 + 𝑑𝑦 2 + 𝑑𝑧 2 .
This expresses the distance between (𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧) and (𝑥 + 𝑑𝑥, 𝑦 + 𝑑𝑦, 𝑧 + 𝑑𝑧) in rectangular
Cartesian axes.
(iv) 𝑑𝑠 2 = 𝑎 𝑑𝑥 2 + 𝑏 𝑑𝑦 2 + 𝑐 𝑑𝑧 2 + 2𝑓 𝑑𝑥 𝑑𝑦 + 2 𝑑𝑧 𝑑𝑥.
This expresses the distance between curvilinear points (𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧) and (𝑥, 𝑑𝑥, 𝑦 + 𝑑𝑦, 𝑧 +
𝑑𝑧) when the axes are not rectangular. Here the coefficients 𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐, 𝑓, 𝑔, are functions
of co-ordinates 𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧. Riemann extended this idea to a space of 𝑛-dimension and
defined the distance 𝑑𝑠 between adjacent points whose co-ordinates in any system are
𝑥 𝑖 and 𝑥 𝑖 + 𝑑𝑥 𝑖 by the formula, 𝑑𝑠 2 = 𝑔𝑖𝑗 𝑑𝑥 𝑖 𝑑𝑦 𝑗
The quadratic differential form on the R.H.S. of (1) is called Riemannian metric for n-
dimention al space. This differential dorm is assumed to be potistive definite. A space
characterized by this metric is called Riemannian space of n- dimentsions and is denoted
by ‘𝑉𝑛 ’. Geometry based on this metric is called Riemannian Geometry of 𝑛- dimensions.
𝑓𝑑𝑥 = 𝑓𝑑𝑥
𝑎 𝑎
𝑓𝑑𝑥
𝑎
RIEMANN-LEBESGUE LEMMA: Consider the real Hilbert space of real valued square-
summarable function 𝐿20,2𝜋 . Then
= 𝒇𝟎 , 𝒇𝟏 , 𝒇𝟐, …
1 𝑛
where 𝑓𝑛 = cos 𝑡 , 𝑛 even
𝜋 2
1 𝑛+1
= sin 𝑡 , 𝑛 odd
𝜋 2
1 2𝜋
i.e. 𝑎0 = ∫0 𝑓 𝑡 𝑑𝑡,
(2𝜋)
1 2𝜋
𝑎1 = ∫0 𝑓 𝑡 𝑡 𝑑𝑡,
𝜋
⋯ ⋯ ⋯ ⋯ ⋯
1 2𝜋
𝑎0 = ∫0 𝑓 𝑡 𝑑𝑡,
𝜋
1 2𝜋 1
And for 𝑛 > 0, 𝑎𝑛 = ∫ 𝑓 𝑡 cos 𝑛𝑡 𝑑𝑡, 𝑛 even,
𝜋 0 2
1 2𝜋 1
and , 𝑏𝑛 = ∫ 𝑓 𝑡 sin 𝑛 + 1 𝑑𝑡, 𝑛 odd,
𝜋 0 2
𝛼0 = 𝑎0 𝜋/2, 𝛼1 = 𝑏1 𝜋, 𝛼2 𝜋, …
∞
2 2
𝛼𝑛 ≤ 𝑓 ,
𝑛=0
We see that
∞ 2𝜋
𝜋
𝛼02 + 𝜋 𝑎𝑛2 + 𝑏𝑛2 ≤ 𝑓2 𝑡 𝑑𝑡,
2 0
𝑛=0
Which implies
𝑓𝑑𝑔 = 𝑓𝑑𝑔
𝑎 𝑎
𝑛 −𝜍 1 1 1
RIEMANN ZETA FUNCTION: The series 𝑛=1 𝑛 = 1𝜍 + 2𝜍 + 3𝜍 + … …
is uniformly convergent for all real 𝜍 ≥ 𝜍0 where is 𝜍0 is a fixed number such that
𝜍0 > 1. The series (1) is a majorant of the series.
𝜃 −𝑧
𝜁 𝑧 = 𝑛=1 𝑛 (where z = x + iy)
where denotes the inner product of the Hilbert space, is an element of 𝐻 ∗ . The
Riesz representation theorem states that every element of 𝐻 ∗ can be written uniquely in
this form.
RIGHT CIRCULAR CONE OF SEMI-VERTICAL ANGLES 𝜶: Let the line OZ be taken as axis
of the cone and let 𝑃 = (𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧) be any point on the surface of the cone. Further let 𝑢 be
the distance of 𝑃 from z-axis and let 𝑣 be the inclination of the plane containing 𝑃 and
the 𝑧 − axis to zx-plane. Then as shown in the above figure, we have
𝑖 𝑗 𝑘
Here 𝑟1 × 𝑟2 = cos 𝑣 sin 𝑣 cot 𝛼
−𝑢 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝑣 𝑢 cos 𝑣 0
RIGHT HELOCOID: The surface generated by the helicoids motion of a straight line
meeting the axis in perpendicular direction is called right-helicoid.
𝑖 𝑖 𝑖 𝑖
𝜑 𝑎𝑖𝑗 , … , 𝑖𝑛 𝑋11 … 𝑋𝑛𝑛 = 𝑎𝑖𝑗 , … , 𝑖𝑛 𝑋11 … 𝑋𝑛𝑛
(𝑎𝑖𝑗 , … , 𝑖𝑛 ∇ 𝑅)
RINGS: A nonempty set 𝐴 is called a ring if the following conditions are satisfied.
(1) Two operations, called addition and multiplication (the ring operations), are
defined, which send an arbitrary pair of elements 𝑎, 𝑏 of 𝐴 to elements 𝑎 + 𝑏 and 𝑎𝑏
of 𝐴.
(2) For arbitrary elements 𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐 of 𝐴, these operations satisfy the following four laws;
(i) 𝑎 + 𝑏 = 𝑏 + 𝑎 (commutative law of additions); (ii) 𝑎+𝑏 +𝑐 =𝑎+
𝑏 + 𝑐 , 𝑎𝑏 𝑐 = 𝑎(𝑏𝑐)(associative laws); (iii) 𝑎 𝑏 + 𝑐 = 𝑎𝑏 + 𝑎𝑐, 𝑎 + 𝑏 𝑐 = 𝑎𝑐 +
𝑏𝑐 (distributive laws); and (iv) for every pair 𝑎, 𝑏 of elements of 𝐴, there exists a
unique element 𝑐 of 𝐴 such that 𝑎 + 𝑐 = 𝑏.
Thus a ring 𝐴 is an A belian group under addition. Each element 𝑎 of a ring 𝐴
determines operations 𝐿𝑎 and 𝑅𝑎 defined by 𝐿𝑎 𝑥 = 𝑎𝑥, 𝑅𝑎 𝑥 − 𝑥𝑎(𝑥 ∇ 𝐴). Thus a
ring 𝐴 has the structure of a left 𝐴- module and a right 𝐴- module. Since the operations
𝐿𝑎 and 𝑅𝑏 commute foe every pair 𝑎, 𝑏 of elements of 𝐴, the ring 𝐴 is also an 𝐴 − 𝐴-
bimodule.
The identity elements of 𝐴 under addition is called the zero element and is denoted by 0.
It satisfies the equation 𝑎0 = 0𝑎 = 0(𝑎 ∇ 𝐴). An element 𝑒 ∇ 𝐴 is called a unity element
(identity element or unit element) of 𝐴 if it satisfies 𝑎𝑒 = 𝑒𝑎 = 𝑎(𝑎 ∇ 𝐴). If 𝐴 has such a
unity element, it is unique and is often denoted by 1. A ring with unity element is called
a unitary ring. Most of the important examples of rings are unitary.
Hence we often call a unitary ring simply a ring. If a ring has only one member (namely,
0) then 0 is the unity element of the ring. Such a ring is called a zero ring. However, if a
ring has more than one element, the unity element is distinct from the zero elements. A
ring is called a commutative ring if it satisfies 𝑣 𝑎𝑏 = 𝑏𝑎 (𝑎, 𝑏 ∇ 𝐴)(commutative law
for multiplication.
𝑑𝑁 𝑑𝑟
∝ 𝑜𝑟 𝑑𝑁, 𝜅𝑑𝑟 = 0
𝑑𝑠 𝑑𝑠
𝑒 𝑥 𝑑𝑛
𝐿𝑛 𝑥 = 𝑥 𝑛 𝑒 −𝑥
𝑛 𝑑𝑥 𝑛
Rounding can produce a value that is easier to deal with than the actual value, especially
if the actual value contains a lot of digits. Rounding can also be done to indicate the
relative precision of a value. For example, the irrational number pi equals
approximately 3.14, rounded to two decimal places or three significant digits.
As an example of rounding error, consider the speed of light in a vacuum. The official
value is 299,792,458 meters per second. In scientific (power-of-10) notation, that
quantity is expressed as 2.99792458 x 108. Rounding it to three decimal places yields
2.998 x 108. The rounding error is the difference between the actual value and the
rounded value, in this case (2.998 - 2.99792458) x 108, which works out to 0.00007542
x 108. Expressed in the correct scientific notation format, that value is 7.542 x 103,
which equals 7542 in plain decimal notation.
ROW AND COLUMN EQUIVALENCE OF MATRICES: A matrix 𝐴 is said to be row
equivalent to 𝐵 if 𝐵 is obtainable from 𝐴 by a finite number of 𝐸- row transformations of
R
𝐴. Symbolically, we then write A~B . Similarly a matrix 𝐴 is said to be column equivalent
to 𝐵 if 𝐵 is obtainable from 𝐴 by a finite number of 𝐸 -column transformation of 𝐴.
C
Symbolically, we then write A~B .
ROW MATRICES: Column matrices: Any 1 × n matric which has only one row and n
columns is called a row matrix or a row vector. Similarly any 𝑚 × 1 matrix which has 𝑚
rows and one column is a column matrix or a column vector.
2
Y= −9 is a column matrix of the type 3 × 1.
11 3×1
ROW RANK OF A MATRIX: Let A = aij be any 𝑚 × 𝑛 matrix. Each of the 𝑚 × 𝑛 matrix.
Each of the 𝑚 rows of 𝐴 consists of 𝑛 elements. Therefore the row vectors of 𝐴 are 𝑛-
vectors. These row vectors of 𝐴 will span a subspace 𝑅 to 𝑉𝑛 . This subspace 𝑅 is called
the row space of the matrix 𝐴. The dimension 𝑟 of 𝑅 is called the rows rank of 𝐴. The
dimension 𝑟 of 𝑅 is called the row rank of 𝐴. In other words the row rank of a matrix 𝐴 is
equal to the maximum number of linearly independent rows of 𝐴.
selected in these rows and columns, calculate ∆𝑖𝑗 = 𝑐𝑖𝑗 – 𝑢𝑖 – 𝑣𝑗 . Select the variable
having the largest negative value of ∆𝑖𝑗 .
RUSSELL’S PARADOX: Suppose that for any coherent proposition 𝑃(𝑥), we can construct
a set {𝑥 ∶ 𝑃(𝑥)}. Let 𝑆 = {𝑥 ∶ 𝑥 ∈ 𝑥}. Suppose 𝑆 ∇ 𝑆; then, by definition, 𝑆 ∈ 𝑆.
Likewise, if 𝑆 ∈ 𝑆, then by definition 𝑆 ∇ 𝑆. Therefore, we have a contradiction.
Bertrand Russell gave this paradox as an example of how a purely intuitive set theory
can be inconsistent. The regularity axiom, one of the Zermelo-Fraenkel axioms, was
devised to avoid this paradox by prohibiting self-swallowing sets.
SADDLE POITNT: A point which is minimum in its row and maximum in its column is
known as the saddle point.
SAINT – VENANT’S PRINCIPLE: If some distribution of forces acing on the portion of the
surface of a body is replaced by a different distribution of forces acting on the same
portion of the body, then the effects of the two different distributions on the parts of the
body sufficiently far removed from the region of applications of the forces are
essentially the same, provided that the two distributions of forces are statically
equivalent. This principle is also called the principle of softening of boundary
conditions.
k 0 … 0
0 k … ⋮
If 𝑆 = 0 0 … ⋮
⋮ ⋮ … ⋮
0 0 … k
is an n-rowed scalar matrix each of whose diagonal elements equal to 𝑘 and 𝐴 is any n-
rowed square matrix, then
𝐴𝑆 = 𝑆𝐴 = 𝑘𝐴
i.e., the pre-multiplication or the post- multiplication of 𝐴 by 𝑆 has the same effect as the
multiplication of 𝐴 by the scalar 𝑘. This is perhaps the motivation behind the name
‘scalar matrix’.
by the rule
(𝛼𝑇) 𝑢 = 𝛼 𝑇 𝑢 ∀ 𝑢 𝜖 𝑈
Note that
𝒂∙𝒄 𝒃∙𝒄
𝒂 ×𝒃 . 𝒄×𝒅 =
𝒂∙𝒅 𝒃∙𝒅
SCALAR TRIPLE PRODUCT: The scalar product of two vectors one of which is itself the
vector product of two vectors is a scalar quantity called a “Scalar Triple Product”. This if
𝒂, 𝒃 and 𝒄 be three vectors, then 𝒂 × 𝒃 . 𝒄 is called the scalar triple product of these
three vectors. Since the scalar triple product involves both the signs of ‘cross’ and ‘dot’,
therefore it is sometimes also called the mixed product.
SCATTER PLOT: A scatter plot is a set of points plotted on a horizontal and vertical axes.
Scatter plots are important in statistics because they can show the extent of correlation,
if any, between the values of observed quantities or phenomena (called variables). If no
correlation exists between the variables, the points appear randomly scattered on the
coordinate plane. If a large correlation exists, the points concentrate near a straight line.
Scatter plots are useful data visualization tools for illustrating a trend.
Besides showing the extent of correlation, a scatter plot shows the sense of the
correlation:
If the vertical (or y-axis) variable increases as the horizontal (or x-axis) variable
increases, the correlation is positive.
If the y-axis variable decreases as the x-axis variable increases or vice-versa, the
correlation is negative.
If it is impossible to establish either of the above criteria, then the correlation is
zero.
The maximum possible positive correlation is +1 or +100%, when all the points in a
scatter plot lie exactly along a straight line with a positive slope. The maximum possible
negative correlation is -1 or -100%, in which case all the points lie exactly along a
straight line with a negative slope.
Correlation is often confused with causation, either accidentally (as a result of false or
unproved hypotheses) or deliberately (with intent to deceive). However, in the pure
sense, while a scatter plot can reveal the nature and extent of correlation, it says nothing
about causation.
𝑑𝑧 𝜃1 𝜃2 𝜃𝑛
= 𝐾(𝜁 − 𝑎1 ) 𝜋 −1 (𝜁 − 𝑎2 ) 𝜋 −1 … … … (𝜉 − 𝑎𝑛 ) 𝜋 −1
𝑑𝜉
Which transforms the real axis 𝜂 = 0 in the 𝜁(= 𝜉 + 𝑖𝜂) -plane into the boundary of a
closed polygon in the 𝑧(= 𝑥 + 𝑖𝑦)- plane in such a way that the vertices of the simple
closed polygon correspond to the points 𝑎1 , 𝑎2 , … , 𝑎𝑛 and the interior angles of the
polygon 𝜃1 , 𝜃2 , … , 𝜃𝑛 , 𝐾 is a constant which may be complex.
SCHWARZ REFLECTION PRINCIPLE: Suppose that 𝑓1 (𝑧) is analytic in the region 𝑅1 and
that 𝑓1 (𝑧) takes only real values on the part 𝐿𝑀𝑁 of the real axis. Then Schwarz’s
reflection principle states that the analytic continuation 𝑓2 (𝑧) of 𝑓1 (𝑧) into the domain
𝑅2 (considered as the mirror image of 𝑅1 with 𝐿𝑀𝑁 as mirror is given by 𝑓1 𝑧 .
SCREW- CURVATURE: The arc rate at which principal normal changes direction
dn
i. e. , ds is called the screw curvature vector and its magnitude is given by k 2 + τ2 .
SELF DUAL CODE: Let 𝐶 be a linear code. Then 𝐶 is self dual code if 𝐶 = 𝐶 ⊥
SELF ORTHOGONAL CODE: Let 𝐶 be a linear code. Then 𝐶 is self orthogonal code if
𝐶 ⊆ 𝐶⊥
SEMIGROUPS: A semigroup consists of a set on which is defined an associative binary
operation. We may denote by 𝐴,∗ a semigroup consisting of a set 𝐴 together with an
associative binary operation ∗ on 𝐴. A semigroup 𝐴,∗ is said to be commutative (or
Abelian) if the binary operation ∗ is commutative. The set of natural numbers, with the
operation of addition, is a commutative semigroup, as is the set of natural numbers with
the operation of multiplication. Let 𝐴,∗ be a semigroup. Given any element 𝑎 of 𝐴, we
define
𝑎1 = 𝑎,
𝑎2 = 𝑎 ∗ 𝑎,
𝑎3 = 𝑎 ∗ 𝑎2 = 𝑎 ∗ 𝑎 ∗ 𝑎 ,
𝑎4 = 𝑎 ∗ 𝑎3 = 𝑎 ∗ 𝑎 ∗ 𝑎 ∗ 𝑎 ,
𝑎 5 = 𝑎 ∗ 𝑎4 = 𝑎 ∗ (𝑎 ∗ (𝑎 ∗ (𝑎 ∗ 𝑎))), . ..
In general we define a n recursively for all natural numbers n so that a 1 = a and a n = a
∗ a n−1 whenever n > 1.
SEMIRING: A semiring S of sets is the collection such that
Let S be a semiring. Then the collection of all disjoint unions ⋃𝑛𝑘=1 𝐴𝑘 , where
𝐴𝑘 ∇ 𝑆, is a ring. We call it, the ring 𝑅(𝑆) generated by the semiring 𝑆.
Let S be a semiring. Then Any ring containing 𝑆 contains 𝑅(𝑆) is also a semiring.
Revision of model
Revision of final tableau
Conversion to proper form
Feasibility test
Optimality test
Re-optimize
Many network optimization models are actually special types of linear programming
problems.
Four important kinds of network problems are:
the shortest path problem
the minimum spanning tree problem
the maximum flow problem
the minimum cost flow problem
SEPARABLE FIELD EXTENSION: An algebraic field extension 𝐿: 𝐾 is said to be
separable over 𝐾 if the minimum polynomial of each element of 𝐿 is separable over 𝐾.
SEPARABLE POLYNOMIAL: Let 𝐾 be a field. An irreducible polynomial in 𝐾[𝑥] is said to
be separable over 𝐾 if it does not have repeated roots in a splitting field. A polynomial in
𝐾[𝑥] is said to separable over 𝐾 if all its irreducible factors are separable over 𝐾. A
polynomial is said to be inseparable if it is not separable.
Then we determine a sequence of jobs, i.e. a permutation of numbers 1, 2…,n for each
machine, which minimizes the time T.
All types of sequencing problems cannot be solved. The satisfactory solutions are
available only in few cases.
SEQUENTIAL SPACES: The space (𝑋, 𝑇) is sequential if for every open set 𝐴 ⊂ 𝑋 every
sequence convergent to a point in 𝐴 is eventually in 𝐴.
SERIES OF POSITIVE TERMS: Suppose that 𝑎𝑛 is a series of positive (or nonnegative)
terms. Since its partial sums 𝑠𝑛 form a ↑monotonically increasing sequence, the series is
∞ −𝑝
convergent if and only if 𝑠𝑛 is bounded. For example, the series 𝑛=1 𝑛 (𝑝 > 0)
converges if 𝑝 < 1 because 𝑠𝑛 < 2𝑝−1 (2𝑝−1 − 1), whereas it diverges if 𝑝 ≤ 1 because
∞ 𝑛−1
𝑠2𝑚 +1 > 1 + (𝑚 + 1) 2. The geometric series 𝑛=1 𝑎 (𝑎 > 0) converges for 𝑎 < 1
because 𝑠𝑛 = (1 − 𝑎𝑛 ) (1 − 𝑎), and diverges for 𝑎 ≥ 1 because 𝑠𝑛 ≥ 𝑛.
SERRET- FRENET FORMULAE: The following set of three relations involving space
derivations of fundamental unit vectors 𝑡, 𝑛, 𝑏 are known as Serret- Frenet Formulae.
dt
= kn
ds
dn
= τb = kt
ds
db
= τn
ds
SERVICING TIME: It is the time taken for servicing a particular arrival.
SET FUNCTIONS: A function whose domain is a family of sets is called a set function.
Usually we consider set functions that take real values or ±∞. For example, if 𝑓(𝑥) is a
real-valued function defined on a set 𝑋, and if we assign to each subset 𝐴 of 𝑋 values
such as 𝑠𝑢𝑝𝐴 𝑓, 𝑖𝑛𝑓𝐴 𝑓, or 𝑠𝑢𝑝𝐴 𝑓 − 𝑖𝑛𝑓𝐴 𝑓, then we obtain a corresponding set function. In
particular, a set function whose domain is the family of left open intervals in 𝑅 𝑚 is
called an interval function. To distinguish between set function and ordinary functions
defined at each point of a set, we call the latter point functions.
SET OF FIRST SPECIES: A set is said to be a set of first species if it has only a finite
number of derived sets.
SET OF SECOND SPECIES: A set is said to be a set of second species if it has infinite
number of derived sets.
SET OF FIRST SPECIES: A set is said to be a set of first species if it has only a finite
number of derived sets.
SETS: G.Cantor defined a set as a collection of objects of our intuition or thought, within
a certain realm, taken as a whole. Each object in the collection is called an element (or
member) of the set. The notation 𝑎 𝜖 𝐴 means that 𝑎 is an element of the set 𝐴. In this
case we say that 𝑎 is a member of 𝐴 or 𝑎 belongs to 𝐴. The negation of 𝑎 ∇ 𝐴 is written
𝑎 ∈ 𝐴. The set having no element, namely the set 𝐴 such that 𝑎 ∈ 𝐴 for every object 𝑎, is
called the empty set (or null set) and is usually denote by ∅. Two sets 𝐴 and 𝐵 are
identical, i.e., 𝐴 = 𝐵, if every element of 𝐴 belongs to 𝐵, and vice versa. The set
containing 𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐, … as its elements is said to consist of 𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐, … and is denoted by
𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐, … .
A set is called a finite set or an infinite set according as the number of its elements is
finite or infinite.
𝐴 set 𝐴 is a subset of a set 𝐵 if each element of 𝐴 is an element of 𝐵. in this case we also
we also say that 𝐴 is contained in 𝐵 or that 𝐵 contains 𝐴, and we write 𝐴 ⊂ 𝐵. The
negation of 𝐴 ⊂ 𝐵 is 𝐴 ⊄ 𝐵. For every set 𝐴, ∅ ⊂ 𝐴. 𝐴 ⊂ 𝐵 and 𝐵 ⊂ 𝐶 imply 𝐴 ⊂ 𝐶. If
𝐴 ⊂ 𝐵 and 𝐵 ⊂ 𝐴, then 𝐴 = 𝐵. 𝐴 is a proper subset of 𝐵 (in symbols: 𝐴 ⊂
≠
𝐵, if 𝐴 ⊂ 𝐵 and
𝐴 ≠ 𝐵.
where .
be two non- intersecting lines passing through the points 𝒂, 𝒂’ and parallel to the vector
𝒃, 𝒃’ respectively.
Let 𝑷𝑷′be the shortest distance between the two lines do that 𝑷𝑷′’ is perpendicular to
both b and b’. Then
′
𝒂 − 𝒂′ ∙ 𝒏 𝒂 − 𝒂′ ∙ 𝒃 × 𝒃′ 𝒂 − 𝒂′ , 𝒃, 𝒃′ 𝒂 − 𝒂′ , 𝒃, 𝒃′
𝑷𝑷 = = = = .
𝒏 𝒏 𝒏 𝒃 × 𝒃′
The shortest distance between two non-intersecting lines parallel respectively to 𝒃 and
𝒃’ will be the projection of the line joining any two points – one on each line- on the
vector 𝒃 × 𝒃′ which is perpendicular to both the lines.
If the straight lines intersect, then the shortest distance is zero, the condition for which
is 𝒂 − 𝒂′ , 𝒃, 𝒃′ =0
SHEARING STRAIN: It is defined in terms of the change in angle between two linear
elements from the unstrained shape to the strained state.
SIGNATURE AND INDEX OF A REAL QUADRATIC FORM: Let 𝑦12 + ⋯ + 𝑦𝑝2 − 𝑦𝑝+1
2
− ⋯−
𝑦𝑟2 be a normal form of a real quadratic form X ′ AX of rank r . The number p of positive
terms in a normal form of X ′ AX is called the index of the quadratic form. The excess of
the number of positive terms over the number of negative terms in a normal form of
X ′ AX i.e., p − r − p = 2p − r is called the signature of the quadratic form and is usually
denoted by s.
Thus s = 2p − r.
for some 𝑡𝑘 ⊆ ℝ and 𝐴𝑘 ∇ 𝐿. That is, simple functions are linear combinations of
indicator functions of measurable sets.
SIMPLE GROUPS: A non-trivial group 𝐺 is said to be simple if the only normal subgroups
of 𝐺 are the whole of 𝐺 and the trivial subgroup {𝑒} whose only element is the identity
element e of 𝐺.
SIMPLE PATH: A simple path in a graph is a path that contains no vertex more than once.
By definition, cycles are particular instances of simple paths.
SIMPLE-PERIODIC FUNCTION: A periodic function which has only one fundamental
period is said to be simply-periodic.
Step 1: First of all, it should be checked whether the given problem is to be maximized
or minimized. If the given problem is of minimization, convert it into minimization by
multiplying both sides of the objective function by (-1).
Step 2: Make all 𝑏𝑖 ’s i = 1 ,2,……….m non –negative , i.e., the RHS of each of the
constraints should be non- negative. This can done by multiplying with (-1) to that
inequation which contains negative 𝑏𝑖 .
Step 3: Convert inequalities of constraints of constraints into equations. For this step
introduce slack and surplus variables and the coefficients of these variables must be
equated to zero in the objective function.
𝑐𝑗 𝑐1 𝑐2 𝑐3 𝑐4 etc.
𝑋𝑗 𝑋1 𝑋2 𝑋3 𝑋4 etc .
Basic 𝐶𝐵 𝑋𝐵 𝐴1 𝐴2 𝐴3 𝐴4 etc . Minimum
variables ratio
I. At the top of the table, write the numerical values of the constants (𝑐𝑖 ) and x-
variables 𝑥1 to be obtained from the objective function.
II. 𝐴1 𝐴2 , … denotes the columns of the coefficients matrix A are to be obtained from
the matrix equations of the constraints. Write the columns of coefficients of
𝑥1 below 𝐴1 column of coefficient of 𝑥2 below 𝐴2 and so on.
III. The variable 𝑥𝑗 above the basic unit column are the basic variables. These basic
variables to be written in the column of basic variables (the left column of the
table)
IV. 𝐶𝑏 is the column of numerical of the cost the basic variables. Write the cost
entries below 𝐶𝐵 according to the x-variables in the left column.
V. 𝑋𝐵 is the column at numerical vales of the best variables. Variables Entries of this
column at initial stage are nothing but the value 𝑏1 , 𝑏2 …given in the constraints.
At this stage is called initial basic feasible solution.
To test whether the solution given in the tables (IBFS) is optimal we first calculate the
net evaluation ∆𝑗 = 𝑧𝑗 − 𝑐𝑗 = 𝐶𝑗 𝐴𝑗 − 𝑐𝑗 each j. Then we apply the following optimal test.
Here , 𝐶𝐵 is the column vector give in the table at second column 𝐴1 is the first column of
the coefficient matrix, which as also given in the table 𝐶1 is the cost of 𝑥1 given at the top
of the table.
Then we write 𝐶𝐵 and 𝐴1 as pairs of tuples. The product 𝑧1 = 𝐶𝐵 𝐴1 is given by the sum of
product of their corresponding coordinates. Subtracting the value 𝐶1 from it to get
∆1 = 𝑍1 − 𝑐𝑗 .
Step 8: Incoming Column Vector and Incoming Variable. Select the most negative
∆𝑗 = 𝑧𝑗 − 𝑐𝑗 say ∆, is most negative. Express it by putting it in a circle. The corresponding
column 𝐴𝑟 is the incoming column (it is to be converted to some basic unit column) and
the corresponding variable 𝑥𝑟 (at the top above the O) is incoming variable (i.e. it will
become a basic variable and will replace some basic variable presently appeared in the
left column of basic variables)
Step 9: Minimum Ratio. We calculate the ratios of elements of 𝑋𝐵 and incoming column
vector 𝐴𝑟 and written the last column of the table. The ratio which are negative or
undefined (infinity) are to be ignored. Out of the remaining ratios, the minimum ratio is
selected. Express it by putting a circle O on this minimum ratio.
Step 10: Pivoting Element. It is known as key element ratio also. The element of the
incoming column vector 𝐴𝑟 appears at the row of the minimum ratio is called pivot or
key element. Express it in the table by putting . Convert the key element to 1 and
other entries of this column shall be converted to zero, so that the declared incoming
column vector 𝐴𝑟 will become one of basic (unit) column vector.
Step 11: Outgoing Column Vector and Basic Variable. Select the basic column whose unit
element 1 appears in this row of key element. That basic column vector is to be declared
outgoing column vector. Express it by a downwards arrow below it. The variable
corresponding to the outgoing vector is the outgoing basic variable.
Step 12: Improved Simplex Table: Using the starting table, pick up the matrix
𝑋𝐵 , 𝐴 = 𝑋𝐵 , 𝐴1 , 𝐴2 , …
By applying row operations convert the key element to 1 and other elements of its
column 𝐴𝑟 to 0. Then A, becomes a basic column.
From this row reduced matrix, take the change values back to the table for the columns
𝑋𝐵 , 𝐴1 , 𝐴2 , …. and so on and construct an improved simplex table.
Repeat the steps (6) and (7) on this table. Here, if solution is not optimal, continue the
steps for improved solution.
SIMPLEX METHOD: Simplex Method is one of the most efficient and convenient method
of solution of problems involving more than two variables. The simplex algorithm
proceeds in a step- by step systematic manner and it involves feasible solutions which
are provided by the corner points only. This method is also used to indicate whether a
given solution is optimal or not.
Initialize Set up slack variables, which are the initial basic variables. Set
decision variables to be the initial non-basic variables.
Optimality Test Basic feasible solution is optimal iff every coefficient in row 0 is
non-negative. If so, we are done, otherwise we will continue.
Iteration Settle on entering basic variable – having the most negative
coefficient in row 0. This is the pivot column. Settle on leaving basic
variable by applying the minimum ratio test.
SIMPLY AND MULTIPLY CONNECTED DOMAINS: A domain in which every closed curve
can be shrunk to a point without passing out of the region, is called a simply connected
domain. If a domain is not simply connected, then it is called multiply connected
domain.
3) In certain card games, a singleton is a card that is the only one of a suit in a hand. In
the game of bridge, each player is dealt 13 cards and any hand with only one card in a
given suit is said to hold a singleton of that suit (which, depending on the play of the
cards may turn out to be a strength or a weakness, or make no difference.)
SINGULAR ELEMENTS: Elements which are not regular in a Banach algebra A are called
singular elements. The element 0 (null vector) is always singular in A. The set of
singular elements in A is denoted by S.
SINGULAR POINT (COMPLEX ANALYSIS): A point 𝑧 = 𝑧0 is said to be a singular point of
a function 𝑓 𝑧 if 𝑓′(𝑧0 ) does not exist.
SINK: A source of negative strength −𝑚 or inward radial flow is called a sink. This is a
point at which the fluid continuously annihilates. Whirlpool is an example of a sink.
SKEW- HERMITIAN MATRIX: A square matrix A = aij is said to be skew-Hermitian if
th th
the i, j element of A is equal to the negative of the conjugate complex of the j, i
element of A i.e., if aij = aji for all i and j.
If A is a skew-Hermitian matrix, then aii = aii by definition . ∴ aii = aji =0 i.e., aii must
be either a pure imaginary number or must be zero.Thus the diagonal elements of a
skew-Hermitian matrix must be pure imaginary number or zero.
0 −2 − i −i 3 + 4i
Illustration: , are skew-Hermitian matrices. A skew-
2−i 0 −3 + 4i 0
Hermitian matrix over the field of real numbers is nothing but a real skew-symmetric
matrix. Obviously, a necessary and sufficient condition for a matrix A to be skew-
Hermitian is that A° = −A.
In a perfect normal distribution (green solid curve in the illustration below), the
tails on either side of the curve are exact mirror images of each other.
When a distribution is skewed to the left (red dashed curve), the tail on the curve's
left-hand side is longer than the tail on the right-hand side, and the mean is less than
the mode. This situation is also called negative skewness.
When a distribution is skewed to the right (blue dotted curve), the tail on the
curve's right-hand side is longer than the tail on the left-hand side, and the mean is
greater than the mode. This situation is also called positive skewness.
SKEW- SYMMETRIC MATRIX: A square matrix A = aij is said to be skew-symmetric if
th
the i, j element A i.e., if aij = aij for all i, j.
If A is a skew-symmetric matrix, then aij = −aji be definition ∴ aii = −aii , for all
values of i ∴ 2aii = 0 or aii = 0
SLACK VARIABLES: If the given constrains in LPP has a sign ≤ , then to turn the
inequations as equality a positive quantity is to be added on LHS. The positive quantities
(or variables) which are added on the LHS are called slack variables.
g I x > 0 where
𝐼 = i: g i x = 0
Such problems occur in the field of postal deliveries, school bus routing, television
relays assembly lines, production of several items by one machine.
SOLVABLE GROUPS: The concept of a solvable group was introduced into mathematics
by Evariste Galois, in order to state and prove his fundamental general theorems
concerning the solvability of polynomial equations. A group 𝐺 is said to be solvable (or
soluble) if there exists a finite sequence 𝐺0 , 𝐺1 , . . . , 𝐺𝑛 of subgroups of 𝐺, where 𝐺0 = {1}
and 𝐺𝑛 = 𝐺, such that 𝐺𝑖−1 is normal in 𝐺𝑖 and 𝐺𝑖 /𝐺𝑖−1 is Abelian for 𝑖 = 1, 2, . . . , 𝑛.
SOURCE: Any point in a two dimensional field is assumed to flow uniformly in all
directions along radial paths or consists of outward radial flow from a point, is called a
simple source. The lines of flow will be straight radial lines i.e., q θ = 0 and q r (r). A
source is a point at which the fluid is continuously created. In fact, this is a purely
abstract conception which foes not occur in nature. If the total flux outwards across a
small closed surface surrounding the point be +𝑚 then +𝑚 is called the strength of
the source.
SPANNING TREE: A spanning tree is a connected network of the 𝑛 nodes that contains
no undirected cycles. A network with 𝑛 nodes requires only ( 𝑛 – 1 ) links to provide a
path between each pair of nodes. Every connected graph contains a spanning tree.
SPACE: Space is a term that can refer to various phenomena in science, mathematics,
and communications. In astronomy and cosmology, space is the vast 3-dimensional
region that begins where the earth's atmosphere ends. Space is usually thought to begin
at the lowest altitude at which satellites can maintain orbits for a reasonable time
without falling into the atmosphere. This is approximately 160 kilometers (100 miles)
above the surface. Astronomers may speak of interplanetary space (the space between
planets in our solar system), interstellar space (the space between stars in our galaxy),
or intergalactic space (the space between galaxies in the universe). Some scientists
believe that space extends infinitely far in all directions, while others believe that space
is finite but unbounded, just as the 2-space surface of the earth has finite area yet no
beginning nor end.
The curve is known as plane curve if it lies on a plane, otherwise it is said to be a skew
twisted or tortuous curve.
The parametric equations of a curve are
𝑥 = 𝑥 𝑡 , 𝑦 = 𝑦 𝑡 , 𝑧 = 𝑧( 𝑡)
Where x, y, z are real valued functions of a single real parameter 𝑡 ranging over a set of
vaues 𝑎 ≤ 𝑡 ≤ 𝑏.
SPANNING VECTORS: The vectors 𝑣1 , 𝑣2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝑣𝑛 in 𝑉 span 𝑉 if every vector v 𝜖 𝑉 is a
linear combination 𝛼1 𝑣1 + 𝛼2 𝑣2 + ⋯ ⋯ + 𝛼𝑛 𝑣𝑛 of 𝑣1 , 𝑣2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝑣𝑛 .
𝑑𝑖2
𝑟𝑠 = 1 − 6
𝑛3 − 𝑛
Note that
1
1. For a bounded operator T, we have 𝑟(𝑇) = lim𝑛 →∞ 𝑇 𝑛 𝑛.
SPECTRAL THEOREM: For every self-adjoint operator 𝐻in a Hilbert space 𝑋, there
exists a unique real spectral measure 𝐸 such that
∞
𝐻 = ∫−∞ 𝜆𝐸(𝑑𝜆).
∞
𝐷 𝐻 = 𝑥 ∫−∞ 𝜆2 𝐸 𝑑𝜆 𝑥, 𝑥 < +∞ ,
∞
𝐻𝑥, 𝑦 = ∫−∞ 𝜆(𝐸 𝑑𝜆 𝑥, 𝑦),
𝑥 ∇ 𝐷, 𝑦 ∇ 𝑋.
This is the spectral theorem for self-adjoint operators. The support of 𝐸 is equal to the
spectrum 𝜍(𝐻), so that we can write
∞
𝐻 = ∫𝜍(𝐻) 𝜆𝐸(𝑑𝜆) = ∫−∞ 𝜆𝜒𝜍 𝐻 (𝜆)𝐸(𝑑𝜆),
2. All the eigenspaces, i.e. 𝑘𝑒𝑟(𝑇 − 𝜆 𝐼), are finite-dimensional for all 𝜆 ≠ 0.
Note that
1. Let T be a compact normal operator. Then all non-zero points 𝜆 ∇ 𝜍(𝑇) are
eigenvalues and there exists an eigenvalue of modulus ||𝑇||.
2. Let T be a compact normal operator on a separable Hilbert space 𝐻, then there
exists a orthonormal basis 𝑔𝑘 such that 𝑇 𝑥 = 𝑛 𝜆𝑛 x, 𝑔𝑛 𝑔𝑛 and 𝜆𝑛 are
eigenvalues of T including zeros.
SPHERE: Sphere can be regarded as a surface of revolution formed by rotating the circle
𝑥² + 𝑧² = 𝑎², 𝑦 = 0 [in zx-plane] about z-axis.
Co-ordinates of any point, say Q on any point of the circle can be taken as 𝑥 =
𝑎 sin 𝑢, 𝑦 = 0, 𝑧 = 𝑎 cos 𝑢 whence the equation of the sphere can be written as
Where 𝜙 is replaced by v,
SPHERICAL HARMONICS: In dealing with the theory of potential, we commonly use the
Laplace’s equation
∂2 V ∂2 V ∂2 V
+ + =0
∂x 2 ∂y 2 ∂z 2
Let Vn ; when expressed in polar coordinates take the form Vn = r n . Un (θ, ∅), where
Un (𝜃, ∅) is a function of θ and ∅ only.
Obviously when r = l, Vn = Un .
Hence surface spherical harmonics is the value of the corresponding solids spherical
harmonics on the surface of a unit sphere whose centre is the origin.
V
Kelvin’s Theorem:- If Vn is a solid harmonics of degree n, then r 2nn+1 is a solid spherical
𝑆𝑟 𝑓 = 𝑔 𝜖 𝑋 ∶ 𝜌 𝑓, 𝑔 < 𝑟 .
𝑆𝑟 𝑓 = 𝑔 𝜖 𝑅 𝑛 ∶ 𝑔 − 𝑓 < 𝑟
SPLITTING FIELD: Let 𝐿: 𝐾 be a field extension, and let 𝑓 ∇ 𝐾[𝑥] be a polynomial with
coefficients in 𝐾. The polynomial 𝑓 is said to split over 𝐿 if 𝑓 is a constant polynomial or
if there exist elements 𝛼1 , 𝛼2 , . . . , 𝛼𝑛 of 𝐿 such that 𝑓(𝑥) = 𝑐(𝑥 − 𝛼1 )(𝑥 − 𝛼2 ) · · · (𝑥 −
𝛼𝑛 ), where 𝑐 ∇ 𝐾 is the leading coefficient of 𝑓.
SPORADIC GROUPS: The sporadic groups are the 26 finite simple groups that do not fit
into any of the four infinite families of finite simple groups (i.e., the cyclic groups of
prime order, alternating groups of degree at least five, Lie-type Chevalley groups,
and Lie-type groups). The smallest sporadic group is the Mathieu group , which has
order 7920, and the largest is the monster group, which has
order .
SQUARE FREE INTEGER: An integer 𝑑 is said to be square-free if there is no integer 𝑘
other than ±1 for which 𝑘 2 divides 𝑑.
SQUARE MATRIX: An m × n matrix for which m = n(i.e., the number of rows is equal to
the number of columns) is called a square matrix of order n. It is also called an n-rowed
square matrix. Thus is a square matrix, we have the same number of rows and columns.
The elements 𝑎𝑖𝑗 of a square matrix 𝐴 = 𝑎𝑖𝑗 , for which 𝑖 = 𝑗 i.e., the elements
𝑚 ×𝑛
𝑎11 , 𝑎22 , 𝑎33 , … . , 𝑎𝑚𝑛 are called the diagonal elements and the line along which they lie
is celled the principal diagonal of the matrix.
0 1 2 3
2 3 1 0
A=
5 0 1 1
0 0 1 2 4×4
is a square matrix of order 4. The elements 0,3,1,2 constitute the principle diagonal of
this matrix.
Let y x, t represents the free surface profile then by superimposing these two waves,
we get
y x, t = y1 + y2 A sin mx − nt + sin
(mx + nt)
𝜌𝜋
sin 𝑚𝑥 = 0 𝑜𝑟 𝑥 = ; 𝜌 = 0, ±1, ±2
𝑚
Surface waves arise where the vertical acceleration of fluid is no longer neglected and
the wave length is small in comparison with the depth of the water. It moves along the
surface of liquid. The disturbance does not extend far below the surface. Surface waves
occur in deep and bounded ( in horizontal directions) liquids like ocean and lakes.
Tidal waves describe the alternative limit where the wave length of oscillations is much
larger compared to the water. The vertical accelerations can be assumed negligible
compared with the horizontal accelerations. The disturbance affects the motion of the
whole of fluid. Tidal waves are also known as long wave in shallow water.
characteristic of the fluid, e.g., velocity, density, temperature and pressure etc. Thus, in
steady motion time drops out of the independent variables and the various field
quantities becomes function of the space coordinates. Water being pumped through a
fixed system at a constant rate is an example of steady flow.
The flow is said to be unsteady when conditions at any point change with regard to the
time, what being pumped through a fixed system at an increasing rate is an example of
unsteady flow.
Stochastic processes are commonly involved in business analytics (BA), sales, service,
manufacturing, finance and communications. Stochastic processes always
involveprobability, such as trying to predict the water level in a reservoir at a certain time
based on random distribution of rainfall and water usage, or estimating the number of
dropped connections in a communications network based on randomly variable traffic but
constant available bandwidth. In contrast, deterministic processes never involve probability;
outcomes occur (or fail to occur) based on predictable and exact input values.
STOKE’S THEOREM: Stoke’s theorem states that the circulation round any closed curve
T drawn in a fluid is equal to the surface integral 𝑆 of the normal component of spin
taken over any surface, provided the surface lies wholly in the fluid.
q. dr = curl q ds
T S
STRATEGY: For a given player the strategy is given by the set of rules which specify that
which of the available course of action he should make at each play. The strategy may be
of two types:
(a) PURE STRATEGY : A pure strategy is that in which one player knows what the
other player is going to do. In this case , the player always choose a particular course of
action.
(b) MIXED STRATEGY: When a player does not know exactly what the other player is
going to do, a probabilistic situation is obtained and such type of strategy is known as
mixed strategy . Mathematically , let 𝑥𝑖 be the probability to choose the 𝑖 𝑡 activity, then
we define the set
𝑋 = 𝑥1 , 𝑥2 , 𝑥3 , … , 𝑥𝑛
𝑠. 𝑡. 𝑥1 +𝑥2 + 𝑥3 , … , +𝑥𝑛 = 1
𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑥1 , 𝑥2 , 𝑥3 , … , 𝑥𝑛 ≥ 0.
STREAK LINES: A streak line is a lien on which lie all those fluid elements that at some
earlier instant passed through a particular point in space. It is a lien making the position
of a set of fluid particles that had passed through a fixed point in the flow field. A streak
line connects the locations at one instead of particles moving with the fluid which
passed through a particular point. The coloured dye injected in a fluid stream or the
smoke particles rising from the cigarette end exhibits streak lines. When the flow is
steady, streak line coincides with path lines and stream lines.
𝛻. 𝑢 = 𝜕𝑢/ 𝜕𝑥 + 𝜕𝑣 /𝜕𝑦 = 0
STREAMLINE FLOW: A streamline is a continuous line of flow drawn in the fluid so that
the tangent at every point is the direction of the fluid velocity at the point at given
instant. The component of velocity at right angles to the streamline is always zero. This
shows that there is no flow across the streamline. Thus a solid boundary is also a
streamline.
STREAM SURFACE: A steam surface is a surface made by the stream lines passing
through an arbitrary line in the fluid region at any instant of time.
STREAM TUBE: A stream tube is obtained by drawing the stream lines through every
point of a closed curve in the fluid. Stream surface and stream tubes remain unchanged
in steady motion.
STRENGTH OF THE VORTEX: Let k be the circulation around any closed curve C. Then
k= q dr
c
Consider the closed curve C encloses the vortex tube and lies on its wall, then by Stoke’s
theorem, we have
k= q dr = n curl q ds = ω ∙ n dS = 𝑐𝑜𝑛𝑠𝑡.
c c c
It follows that the circulation round any closed curve enclosing a vortex tube is constant
all along the tube. This constant is also known the strength of the vortex tube. Let 𝜔
denotes the angular velocity and 𝐴 be the cross- section of the vortex tube (assumed
small) then the circulation round this section is 2ωA, which is constant for all section.
This product is called the strength of the vortex.
STRESS TENSOR:- The state of stress at any point of medium is completely characterized
by the specification of nine quantities, called the components of stress tensor.
Let 𝑃 𝑥 be any point in the medium and let → be the stress vector acting on an element
𝑇
of surface at P, with the normal v. Draw through three planar elements parallel to the
coordinate planes and pass the fourth plane ABC normal to v and at a small distance h
from P.
Let the three planar elements which are normal to 𝑥1 , 𝑥2 , 𝑥3 - axes be PBC, PAC,PAB
respectively .
Let →,→ 𝑎𝑛𝑑 → be the stresses acting on the faces 𝒫ℬ𝒞, 𝒫𝒜𝒞 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝒫𝒜ℬ on the
𝑇 𝑇 𝑇
tetrahedron PABC respectively. Thus → is the stress vector acing on a planar surface
𝑇
Resolving the stress vector → into components along the coordinate axes, we have
𝑇
→ = 𝑒𝑗
𝑇 𝑇𝑗
𝐼𝑓 𝑖 = 1,2, 3, 𝑤𝑒 𝑎𝑣𝑒
The nine scalar quantities 𝒯𝑖𝑗 are the components of a stress –tensor . Hence the state of
a stress at a point is completely determined if the nine components of stress tensor at
that point are known.
STRESS VECTOR: Consider an element ∆ 𝜍 of a surface which lies either in the interior or
on the boundary of the medium. Let the force acting on the element ∆ 𝜍 𝑏𝑒 → ∆ 𝜍 .
𝑇
∆𝜍
Lim 𝑇 = → 𝑥1 , 𝑥2 , 𝑥3 ,
∆𝜍 𝑇
Where → represents the surface per unit area of the surface acting at the point
𝑇
𝑠𝑢𝑟𝑓𝑎𝑐𝑒 𝑓𝑜𝑟𝑐𝑒
Therefore, stress vector → =
𝑇 𝑎𝑟𝑒𝑎
STRICT CONVERSE DUALITY THEOREM: Let X 0 be an open set in Rn and let 𝜃 and 𝑔 be
differentiable and convex on X 0 , let the (primal) minimization problem have a solution
x, and let g satisfy any one of the six constraint qualifications of Kuhn- Tucker stationary
point necessary optimality theorem. If x, u is a solution of the dual (maximization)
problem and if Ψ x, u is strictly convex at x, then x = x that is, x solve MP i.e., (the
primal) minimization problem and θ x = Ψ(x, u).
STRONG CONVERGENCE: The convergence with respect to the norm is called strong
convergence. Thus the sequence 𝑓𝑛 converges strongly to 𝑓 if
𝑓𝑛 − 𝑓 ⟶ 0, 𝑎𝑠 𝑛 ⟶ ∞
a a1 y + a2 y ′ = 0 at x = a
………. 2
and b b1 y + b2 y ′ = 0 at x = b
here λ is a real parameter and a1 , a2 , b1 , b2 , are given real constants at least one in each
conditions (2) being different from zero.
1 2 3 9
1 2 3
Example. The matrix is submatrix of the matrix 𝐴 = 7 11 6 5 as it can
0 2 1
0 2 1 8
be obtained from 𝐴 by omitting the second row and the fourth column.
The space 𝐶[𝑎, 𝑏] is incomplete for any 𝑎 < 𝑏 if equipped by the inner product and the
1
𝑏 2 𝑏 2 2
corresponding norm: ⌌𝑓, 𝑔⌍ = ∫𝑎 𝑓 𝑡 ḡ t dt, 𝑓 = ∫𝑎 𝑓(𝑡) 𝑑𝑡
It is important to note that every sub-space of 𝑉𝑛 contains the zero vector, being the
scalar product of any vector with the scalar zero.
SUBSPACES: Let V be a vector space over the field K. Certain subsets of V have the nice
property of being closed under addition and scalar multiplication; i.e., adding or taking
scalar multiples of vector in the subset gives vectors which are again in the subset. We
call such a subset a subspace:
𝒖, 𝒗 ϵ W , 𝛼, 𝛽 𝜖𝐾 ⟹ 𝛼𝐮 + 𝛽 𝒗 𝜖 𝑊
A subspace W is itself a vector space over K under the operations of vector addition and
scalar multiplication in V. Notice that all vector space axioms of W hold automatically.
For any Vector space V, V is always a subspace of itself. Subspaces other than V are
sometimes called proper subspaces. We also always have a subspace 0 consisting of
the zero vector alone.This is called the trivial subspace, and its dimension is 0, because
it has no linearly independent set of vectors at all.
Intersection of two subspaces gives third subspace i.e. If 𝑊1 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑊2 are subspaces of V
then so is 𝑊1 ∩ 𝑊2 .
Note that any subspace of V that contains 𝑊1 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑊2 has to contain all vectors of the
form u+v for u 𝜖 𝑊1 , 𝑣 𝜖 𝑊2
Or 𝑊1 + 𝑊2 = 𝑤1 + 𝑤2 : 𝑤1 𝜖 𝑊1 , 𝑤2 𝜖 𝑊2
Let 𝑣1 , 𝑣2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝑣𝑛 be vectors in the vector space V.Then the set of all linear
combinations 𝛼1 𝑣1 + 𝛼2 𝑣2 + ⋯ ⋯ + 𝛼𝑛 𝑣𝑛 of 𝑣1 , 𝑣2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝑣𝑛 forms a subspace of V.
SUCCESSOR OF A SET: Given a set 𝑆, the successor of 𝑆 is the set 𝑆 ′ = 𝑆 ∪ {𝑆}. One often
denotes the successor of 𝑆 by 𝑆 1 .
SUFFICIENT OPTIMALITY THEOREM (KUHN- TUCKER): Let x ∇ X 0 , let X 0 be open and let
θ and g be differentiable and convex at x. If x, u is a solution of Kuhn- Tucker problem:
∆θ x) + u ∆g(x = 0, g(x) ≤ 0,
u g x = 0, u ≥ 0,
2
𝑑𝑦
𝑑𝑆 = 1+ 𝑑𝑥 .
𝑑𝑥
Then the total surface area is given by this integral:
𝑏
2
𝑑𝑦
2𝜋𝑦 1 + 𝑑𝑥.
𝑑𝑥
𝑎
SURFACE FORCES: The forces which act on the surface of the volume elements are called
surface forces.
𝑬. 𝒅𝑺
SURJECTIVE FUNCTION: We say that the function f is surjective if, given any element 𝑏 of
𝐵, there exists some element 𝑎 of 𝐴 such that 𝑓(𝑎) = 𝑏. Thus a function is surjective if
every element of the codomain is the image of some element of the domain. We say that
the function f is bijective if it both injective and surjective.
SURPLUS VARIABLES: If the given constraints in LPP have a sign ≥ , then to turn the
inequations as equality, a positive quantity is to be subtracted from LHS. The positive
quantities (or variables), that are to be subtracted from LHS to form the equations are
called surplus variables.
SUSLIN’S HYPOTHESIS (SH): Every dense, linear, order complete set without end points,
having at most 𝑤 disjoint intervals, is order isomorphic to the continuum of real
numbers.
SYLOW p-SUBGROUPS: Let 𝐺 be a finite group and 𝑝 be a prime that divides |𝐺|. We can
then write |𝐺| = 𝑝𝑘 𝑚 for some positive integer 𝑘 so that 𝑝 does not divide 𝑚. Any
subgroup of 𝐻 whose order is 𝑝𝑘 is called a Sylow 𝑝-subgroup or simply 𝑝 subgroup.
First Sylow theorem states that any group with order 𝑝𝑘 𝑚 has a Sylow 𝑝-subgroup.
SYMMETRIC: (1) Two points A and B are symmetric with respect to a third point (called
the center of symmetry) if the third point is the midpoint of the segment connecting the
first two points.
(2) Two points A and B are symmetric with respect to a line (called the axis of
symmetry) if the line is the perpendicular bisector of the segment AB.
SYMMETRIC CHANNEL: A symmetric channel is a memoryless communication channel
1
for which there exists a 𝑝 < 2 such that for every 𝑖, 𝑗 ∇ {0, 1}𝑛 with 𝑖 ≠ 𝑗 it holds that
𝑞
a h g p
h b f g 1 i −2i
2 4
For example, . i −2 4 , are symmetric matrices
g f c r 4 3
−2i 4 3
p q r s
A necessary and sufficient condition for a matrix A to be symmetric is that A and A’ are
equal.
SYMMETRIC TENSOR: A tenser 𝐴𝑖𝑗 is said to be symmetric if 𝐴𝑖𝑗 = 𝐴𝑗𝑖 . Similarly a tensor
𝐴𝑖𝑗𝑘 is symmetric in the suffixes 𝑗 and 𝑘 if 𝐴𝑖𝑗𝑘 = 𝐴𝑗𝑘𝑖 .
𝑓 𝑛 (𝑎)
Where 𝑎𝑛 = 𝑛!
𝜕𝑥 ′𝑖 𝜕𝑥 ′𝑗
𝐴′𝑖𝑗 = 𝐴𝑎𝛽 .
𝜕𝑥 𝑎 𝜕𝑥 𝛽
Then 𝐴𝑖𝑗 are called components of a contravariant tensor of rank two. Similarly if
𝐴𝑖𝑗 𝑖, 𝑗, = 1,2, … 𝑛 be 𝑛2 funcations of ordinates 𝑥1 , 𝑥 2 , … 𝑥 𝑛 and if 𝐴𝑖𝑗 are transformed
to 𝐴′𝑖𝑗 in another co-ordinate system 𝑥′1 , 𝑥′2 , … 𝑥′𝑛 by the rule
𝜕𝑥 𝑎 𝜕𝑥 𝛽
𝐴′𝑖𝑗 = 𝐴𝑎𝛽
𝜕𝑥 ′𝑖 𝜕𝑥 ′𝑗
𝜕𝑥 ′𝑖 𝜕𝑥 𝛽
𝐴𝑗′𝑖 = 𝐴𝛽𝑎
𝜕𝑥 𝑎 𝜕𝑥 ′𝑗
TEST STATISTIC: A test statistic is a quantity calculated from observed sample values
that is used to test a null hypothesis. The test statistic is constructed so that it will come
from a known distribution if the null hypothesis is true. Therefore, the null hypothesis is
rejected if it seems implausible that the observed value of the test statistic could have
come from that distribution.
TETRAHEDRON: A tetrahedron is a polyhedron with four faces. Each face is a triangle. In
other words, a tetrahedron is a pyramid with a triangular base. A regular tetrahedron
has all four faces congruent.
1
TETRAHEDRAL NUMBER: An integer of the form 6 𝑛 𝑛 + 1 𝑛 + 2 , where 𝑛 is a positive
integer. This number equals the sum of the first 𝑛 triangular numbers. The first few
tetrahedral numbers are 1, 4, 10 and20.
TFAE: The abbreviation “TFAE” is shorthand for “the following are equivalent”. It is used
before a set of equivalent conditions.
THE IDENTITY THEOREM: Suppose that 𝑓 is meromorphic on a domain 𝐷 in 𝐶. Suppose
that 𝑏 ∇ 𝐶. Then either 𝑓(𝑧) ≡ 𝑏 on 𝐷, or the set 𝐸 = {𝑧 ∇ 𝐷 ∶ 𝑓(𝑧) = 𝑏} has no
limit point in 𝐷.
THEN: The word “THEN” is used as a connective word in logic sentences of the form “p S
q” “IF p, THEN q.” Here is an example: “If a triangle has three equal sides, then it has
three equal angles.”
THE SPACE 𝑩 [𝒂, 𝒃 ]: The space of all those complex valued functions defined on 𝑎, 𝑏
which are such that, for some real number 𝑀, 𝑓(𝑥) ≤ 𝑀, is denoted by 𝐵 𝑎, 𝑏 .
Let 4πm is the volume flux per unit time from the source point O then m is called the
strength of the source.
TIME SERIES: A sequence of observations taken over a period of time, usually at equal
intervals. Time series analysis is concerned with identifying the factors that influence
the variation in a time series, perhaps with a view to predicting what will happen in the
future.
TISSOT’S THEOREM DIFFERENTIAL GEOMETRY): Let S, S* be two surface and 𝑓 be a
non conformal mapping of the surface S onto the surface 𝑆 ∗ , given by a differential
homeomorphism regular at each point, there exists at every point P of S a uniquely
determined pair of real orthogonal directions such that the corresponding directions of
S* are also orthogonal.
T-NORM IN FUZZY SETS: Any function 𝑡 ∶ [0, 1] × [0, 1] → [0, 1] that satisfies
following Axioms tl-t4 is called a 𝑡 −norm.
Axiom t1: 𝑡(0,0) = 0; 𝑡(𝑎, 1) = 𝑡(1, 𝑎) = 𝑎 (boundary condition).
Axiom t2: 𝑡(𝑎, 𝑏) = 𝑡(𝑏, 𝑎) (commutativity).
Axiom t3: If 𝑎 ≤ 𝑎′ and 𝑏 ≤ 𝑏′, then 𝑡(𝑎, 𝑏) ≤ 𝑡(𝑎′ , 𝑏′) (non-decreasing condition).
Axiom t4: 𝑡[𝑡(𝑎, 𝑏), 𝑐] = 𝑡[𝑎, 𝑡(𝑏, 𝑐)] (associativity).
TOPOLOGICAL DIVISORS OF ZERO: An element 𝑓 of Banach algebra A is called
topological divisor of zero if there exists a sequence 𝑓𝑛 in A sich that 𝑓𝑛 = 1 and
either 𝑓𝑓𝑛 ⟶ 0 or 𝑓𝑛 𝑓 ⟶ 0. We denote the set of all topological divisors of zero by Z.
TOPOLOGICAL GROUP: We say that (𝐺,×, 𝜏 ) is a topological group if (𝐺,×) is a group
and (𝐺, 𝜏 ) a topological space such that, writing 𝑀(𝑥, 𝑦) = 𝑥 × 𝑦 and 𝐽𝑥 = 𝑥 −1 the
multiplication map 𝑀 ∶ 𝐺 2 → 𝐺 and the inversion map 𝐽 ∶ 𝐺 → 𝐺 are continuous.
TOPOLOGICAL ISOMORPHISM: If (𝐺,×𝐺 , 𝜏𝐺 ) and (𝐻,×𝐻 , 𝜏𝐻 ) are topological groups we
say that 𝜃 ∶ 𝐺 → 𝐻 is an isomorphism if it is a group isomorphism and a topological
homeomorphism.
TOPOLOGICAL MANIFOLD: A Hausdorff space 𝑀 is called a (topological) 𝑛-manifold if
each point of 𝑀 has a neighborhood homeomorphic to an open set in 𝑅 𝑛 . Roughly
speaking, an 𝑛-manifold is locally 𝑅 𝑛 . Sometimes 𝑀 is denoted as 𝑀𝑛 for mentioning the
dimension of 𝑀.
TOPOLOGY: Topology is the mathematical study of how points are connected together. If
an object is stretched or bent, then its geometric shape changes but its topology remains
unchanged. Let 𝑋 be a non-empty set. A set ℑ of subsets of 𝑋 is said to be a topology on
𝑋 if
(i) 𝑋 and the empty set, 𝜑, belong to ℑ ,
(ii) The union of any (finite or infinite) number of sets in ℑ belongs to ℑ ,
(iii) The intersection of any two sets in ℑ belongs to ℑ .
The pair (𝑋; ℑ) is called a topological space.
In other words, a topological space is a set X and a collection of subsets of X called open
sets such that:
(1) The empty set is open,
(2) The whole set is open,
(3) A finite intersection of open sets is open,
(4) An arbitrary union of open sets is open.
A metric space (𝑋, 𝑑) is a topological space: the open sets are any union of balls
𝐵𝑟(𝑥) = {𝑦 ∇ 𝑋 ∶ 𝑑(𝑥, 𝑦) < 𝑟} (for centres 𝑥 ∇ 𝑋, radii 𝑟 > 0).
TOPOLOGY OF R: With the collection of all its open intervals (𝑎, 𝑏) as an open base, 𝑅 is
a topological space (order topology) that satisfies the separation axioms 𝑇2 , 𝑇3 , 𝑇4 . In 𝑅
every (finite or infinite) interval (including 𝑅 itself) is connected, and the set 𝑄 of
rational numbers is dense. A necessary and sufficient condition for a subset 𝐹 of 𝑅 to be
compact is that 𝐹 be bounded and closed Weierstrass’s theorem . In particular, any
finite closed interval is compact. 𝑅 is a locally compact space satisfying the second
countablity axiom. Further, any (finite or infinite) open interval is homeomorphic to 𝑅.
TOROID: A toroid can be formed by rotating a closed curve for a full turn about a line
that is in the same plane as the curve, but does not cross it. The set of all points that the
curve crosses in the course of the rotation forms a toroid.
TORSION: Torsion at point 𝑃of a given curve is the arc rate of the change in the direction
of the binormal at 𝑃. Its magnitude is denoted by 𝜏(𝑇𝑎𝑢).
TORSION-FREE MODULES: A module 𝑀 over an integral domain 𝑅 is said to be
torsionfree if 𝑟𝑚 is non-zero for all non-zero elements 𝑟 of 𝑅 and for all non-zero
elements 𝑚 of 𝑀.
TORSION MODULES: A module 𝑀 over an integral domain 𝑅 is said to be a torsion
module if, given any element 𝑚 of 𝑀, there exists some non-zero element 𝑟 of 𝑅 such
that 𝑟𝑚 = 0𝑀 , where 0𝑀 is the zero element of 𝑀.
TORSION SUBMODULE: Let 𝑀 be a module over an integral domain 𝑅. The torsion
submodule of 𝑀 is the submodule 𝑇 of M defined such that 𝑇 = {𝑚 ∇ 𝑀 ∶ 𝑟𝑚 = 0𝑀
for some non-zero element 𝑟 of 𝑅}, where 0𝑀 denotes the zero element of 𝑀. Thus an
element 𝑚 of 𝑀 belongs to the torsion submodule 𝑇 of 𝑀 if and only if there exists some
non-zero element 𝑟 of 𝑅 for which 𝑟𝑚 = 0𝑀 .
TORUS: A torus is a solid figure formed by rotating a circle about a line in the same
plane as the circle, but not on the circle. A tube of a cycle is an example of a torus.
TOTAL ORDER: A total order is a special case of a partial order. If ≤ is a partial order on
𝐴, then it
satisfies the following three properties:
1. reflexivity: 𝑎 ≤ 𝑎 for all 𝑎 ∇ 𝐴
2. antisymmetry: If 𝑎 ≤ 𝑏 and 𝑏 ≤ 𝑎 for any 𝑎, 𝑏 ∇ 𝐴, then 𝑎 = 𝑏
3. transitivity: If 𝑎 ≤ 𝑏 and 𝑏 ≤ 𝑐 for any 𝑎, 𝑏, 𝑐 ∇ 𝐴, then 𝑎 ≤ 𝑐
The relation ≤ is a total order if it satisfies the above three properties and the following
additional property:
Comparability: For any 𝑎, 𝑏 ∇ 𝐴, either 𝑎 ≤ 𝑏 or 𝑏 ≤ 𝑎.
TOWER OF HANOI: Imagine three poles with a number of discs of different sizes initially
all on one of the poles in decreasing order. The problem is to transfer all the discs to one
of the other poles, moving the discs individually from pole to pole, so that one disc is
never placed above another of smaller
diameter. A version with 8 discs, known as the Tower of Hanoi, was invented by
Edouard Lucas. If 𝑘𝑛 is the number of moves it takes to transfer 𝑛 discs from one pole to
another, then 𝑘1 = 1 and 𝑘𝑛+1 = 2𝑘𝑛 + 1. It can be shown that the solution of this
difference equation is 𝑘𝑛 = 2𝑛 – 1, so the original Tower of Hanoi puzzle takes 255
moves.
TOY THEOREM: A toy theorem is a simplified version of a more general theorem. For
instance, by introducing some simplifying assumptions in a theorem, one obtains a toy
theorem.
TOWER LAW: If K is a subfield of 𝐿 and 𝐿 is a subfield of 𝑀 then [𝑀 ∶ 𝐾] = [𝑀 ∶ 𝐿][𝐿 ∶
𝐾].
TRACE OF A MATRIX: Let 𝐴 be a square matrix of order 𝑛. The sum of the elements of 𝐴
lying along the principal is called the trace of 𝐴. We shall write the trace of 𝐴 as tr 𝐴.
Thus if A = aij , then tr
n×n
n
A= i=1 a ij = a11 + a22 + ⋯ + ann .
(1) tr 𝜆𝐴 = 𝜆 tr 𝐴;
(2) tr 𝐴 + 𝐵 = tr 𝐴 + 𝑡𝑟 𝐵;
(3) tr 𝐴𝐵 = tr B𝐴 .
The main objective is to minimize the cost of associated with such transportation from
the place of supply to their destination. These special types of linear programming
problems are called ‘Transportation problem’.
TRANSPOSE: The transpose of a matrix is formed by changing all the columns in the
original matrix into corresponding rows in the transposed matrix.
TRANSPOSED CONJUGATE OF A MATRIX: The transpose of the conjugate of a matrix A is
called transposed conjugate of A and 𝐵 is denoted by 𝐴° or A∗ .
Obviously the conjugate of the transpose of A is the same as the transpose of the
conjugate of A i.e., A′ = A ′ = 𝐴°.
If A = aij then A° = bji where bji = aij i.e., the (j, t)th element of A°= the
m×n, n×m
For example, If
1 + 2i 2 − 3i 3 + 4i 1 + 2i 4 − 5i 8
′
A = 4 − 5i 5 + 6i 6 − 7i , then A = 2 − 3i 5 + 6i 7 + 8i
8 7 + 8i 7 3 + 4i 6 − 7i 7
1 − 2i 4 + 5i 8
and 𝐴′ = 𝐴° 2 + 3i 5 − 6i 7 − 8i .
3 − 4i 6 + 7i 7
(i) A° = A;
(ii) A + B ° = A° + B°, A and B being of the same size.
(iii) kA ° = k A°, 𝑘 being any complex number;
(iv) AB = B°A°, A and B being conformable to multiplication.
changing its rows into columns and its columns into rows is called the transpose of 𝐴
and is denoted by the symbol 𝐴′ or 𝐴𝑇 .
The operation of interchanging rows with columns is called transposition. Symbolically
if A = aij ,then A′ = bji , where bji = aij , i.e. the (𝑗, 𝑖)𝑡 element of A′ is the
m×n n×m
1 2 3 4
For example, the transpose of the 3 × 4 matrix A = 2 3 4 1 is the 4 × 3 matrix
3 4 2 1 3×4
1 2 3
2 3 4
A′ = .
3 4 2
4 1 1 4×3
The first row of A is the first column of A′. The second row of A is the second column of
A′ . the third row of A is the third column of A.
(i) A′ = A
(ii) A + B ′ = A′ + B′ , A and B being of the same size.
(iii) kA ′ = kA′ , k being any complex number.
(iv) AB ′ = B′ A′ , A and B being conformable to multiplication.
TRAPEZOIDAL FUZZY NUMBER: A fuzzy set 𝐴 is called trapezoidal fuzzy number with
tolerance interval [𝑎, 𝑏], left width 𝛼 and right width 𝛽 if its membership function has
the following form
𝑎−𝑡
1−;𝑎 − 𝛼 ≤ 𝑡 ≤ 𝑎
𝛼
1; 𝑎 ≤ 𝑡 ≤ 𝑏
𝐴 𝑡 = 𝑡−𝑏
1− ;𝑏 ≤ 𝑡 ≤ 𝑎 + 𝛽
𝛽
0; 𝑜𝑡𝑒𝑟𝑤𝑖𝑠𝑒
⋮ ⋮ ⋮ ⋮
⋮ ⋮ ⋮ ⋮
Like assignment problem, if we represent “going” and “not going” of the salesman from
𝐴𝑖 𝑡𝑜 𝐴𝑗 station by saying 𝑥𝑖𝑗 = 1 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑥𝑖𝑗 = 0 respectively, then we wish to determine
𝑥𝑖𝑗 , 𝑖, 𝑗 = 1 … , 𝑛, which minimizes
𝑛 𝑛 𝑛
𝑧= 𝑖=1 𝑗 =1 𝑐𝑖𝑗 𝑥𝑖𝑗 s. t. 𝑗 =1 𝑥𝑖𝑗 = 1, 𝑖 = 1,2, … , 𝑛
𝑛
𝑗 =1 𝑥𝑖𝑗 = 1, 𝑗 = 1,2, … , 𝑛
𝑥𝑖𝑗 = 0 𝑜𝑟 1,
and one extra restriction that the 𝑥𝑖𝑗 must be so chosen hat no city is visited twice until
the tour of all the cities is completed. Note that as we have written ∞ in the leading
diagonal 𝑥𝑖𝑗 cannot be 1 when 𝑖 = 𝑗, because then 𝑧 will not be minimum. Thus the
second restriction of no going to 𝐴𝑖 again just after 𝐴𝑖 is automatically satisfied.
TREE: A connected graph with no cycles. It can be shown that a connected simple graph
with 𝑛 vertices is a tree if and only if it has 𝑛 – 1 edges. Note that a non-trivial tree
contains at least one pendant vertex.
TREE DIAGRAM: A tree diagram illustrates all of the possible results for a process with
several stages. Following figure illustrates a tree diagram that shows all of the possible
results for tossing three coins.
TREE TRAVERSALS: A tree traversal is an algorithm for visiting all the nodes in a rooted
tree exactly once. The constraint is on rooted trees, because the root is taken to be the
starting point of the traversal. A traversal is also defined on a forest in the sense that
each tree in the forest can be iteratively traversed (provided one knows the roots of
every tree beforehand). This entry presents a few common and simple tree traversals.
TRIANGLE: A triangle is a three-sided polygon. The three points where the sides
intersect are called vertices. Triangles are sometimes identified by listing their vertices,
as in triangle ABC.
TRIANGULAR INEQUALITY: It states that for any triangle, the sum of the lengths of any
two sides must be greater than or equal to the length of the remaining side. If 𝑥, 𝑦
and 𝑧 are the lengths of the sides of the triangle, then the triangle inequality states that
with equality only in the degenerate case of a triangle with zero area. In Euclidean
geometry, the triangle inequality is a theorem about distances, and it is written using
vectors and vector lengths:
𝑥+𝑦 ≤ 𝑥 + 𝑦 .
TRIANGULARIZATION THEOREM OR JACOBI’S THEOREM: Every square matrix is
unitarily similar to a triangular matrix.
TRIANGULATION: The method of fixing a point by using directions from two known
points to construct a triangle.
TRIANGULAR MATRIX: A square matrix that is either lower triangular or upper
triangular. It is lower triangular if all the entries above the main diagonal are zero, and
upper triangular if all the entries below the main diagonal are zero.
𝑛(𝑛+1)
TRIANGULAR NUMBER: An integer of the form , where 𝑛 is a positive integer. The
2
𝑟 𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧 𝑑𝑥𝑑𝑦𝑑𝑧
𝑧=0 𝑦 =0 𝑥=0
As an example of truncation error, consider the speed of light in a vacuum. The official
value is 299,792,458 meters per second. In scientific (power-of-10) notation, that
quantity is expressed as 2.99792458 x 108. Truncating it to two decimal places yields
2.99 x 108. The truncation error is the difference between the actual value and the
truncated value, or 0.00792458 x 108. Expressed properly in scientific notation, it is
7.92458 x 105.
TRUTH TABLE: A truth table is a table showing whether a compound logic sentence will
be true or false, based on whether the simple sentences contained in the compound
sentence are true. Each row of the table corresponds to one set of possible truth values
for the simple sentences.
TRUTH VALUE: In logic, a sentence is assigned one of two truth values. One of the truth
values is labeled T, or 1; it corresponds to “true.” The other truth value is labeled F, or 0;
it corresponds to “false.”
t-TEST: A test to determine whether or not a sample of size 𝑛 with mean comes from a
normal distribution with mean 𝜇. The statistic 𝑡 given by
𝑛 𝑥−𝜇
𝑡=
𝑠
has a 𝑡-distribution with 𝑛 – 1 degrees of freedom, where 𝑠 2 is the (unbiased) sample
variance. The 𝑡-test can also be used to test whether a sample mean differs significantly
from a population mean, and to test whether two samples have been drawn from the
same population.
TURNING POINT: A point on the graph 𝑦 = 𝑓(𝑥) at which 𝑓′(𝑥) = 0 and 𝑓′(𝑥) changes
sign. A turning point is either a local maximum or a local minimum.
TWIN PRIMES: A pair of prime numbers that differ by 2. For example, 11 and 13, 29 and
31, 71 and 73 are twin primes. A conjecture that there are infinitely
many such pairs has been neither proved nor disproved.
TWO-PERSON ZERO-SUM GAME: A game with two players in which the total payoff is
zero, i.e. anything which one player gains is directly at the expense of the other player.
TWO-PHASE SIMPLEX METHOD:
Initialization Modify constraints of innovative problem to achieve an obvious Basic
feasible solution for the artificial problem.
Phase I Discover a Basic feasible solution for the actual problem by minimizing
the sum of the artificial variables.
Phase II Leave the artificial variables, replace with phase 2 objective function.
Re-establish appropriate structure. Locate an optimal solution for the
real problem.
TWO-SAMPLE TESTS (STATISTICS): Any test which is to be applied to two independent
samples, in contrast to paired-sample tests when the two samples are combined before
applying a one-sample test to the resulting sample.
TWO-TAILED TEST: In a two-tailed test the critical region consists of both tails of a
distribution. The null hypothesis is rejected if the test-statistic value is either too large
or too small.
TYPE m FUZZY SET: A type m fuzzy set is a fuzzy set whose membership values are type
𝑚 − 1, 𝑚 > 1, fuzzy sets on [0, 1].
TYPES OF MODELS:
ICONIC MODELS: Iconic models represent the system as it is but in different size. Thus,
ionic models are obtained by enlarging or reducing the size of the system. In other
words, they are images.
Some common examples are photographs, drawing, model aeroplanes, ships, engines,
globes, maps etc. A toy aeroplane is an ionic model of a real one.
The symbolic model is usually the easiest to manipulate experimentally and it is most
general and abstract. Its function is more often explanatory rather than descriptive.
PREDICTIVE MODEL: Such models can answer ‘what if’ type of question, i.e, they can
make predictions regarding certain event. For example, based on the survey results,
television networks such models attempt to explain and predict the election result
before all the votes are actually counted.
DYNAMIC MODELS: In these models, time is considered as one of the important variable
and admits the impact of changes generated by time. Also, in dynamic models not only
one, but a series of interdependent is required during the planning horizon.
STATIC MODELS: These models do not consider the impact of changes that take place
during the planning horizon, i.e. they are independent of time. Also, in static model only
one decision is needed for the duration of a given time period.
TYPE 1 ERROR: A type 1 error occurs when the null hypothesis is rejected when it is
actually true.
TYPE 2 ERROR: A type 2 error occurs when the null hypothesis is accepted when it is
actually false.
ULTRAFILTER: A filter 𝐹 on 𝑀 is called ultrafilter if for every 𝐴 ⊆ 𝑀 either
𝐴 ∇ 𝐹 𝑜𝑟 𝑀 − 𝐴 ∇ 𝐹. Ultrafilters are precisely the maximal filters with respect to
inclusion. Using AC, it can be shown that every system of sets, which has finite
intersection property, is contained in an ultrafilter.
ULTRAFILTER LEMMA: Ultrafilter lemma states that every filter on a set 𝑋 is a subset of
some ultrafilter on 𝑋. This lemma is most often used in the study of topology. An
ultrafilter that does not contain finite sets is called non-principal. The ultrafilter lemma,
and in particular the existence of non-principal ultrafilters follows easily from Zorn's
lemma.
UNARY OPERATION: A unary operation on a set 𝑆 is a rule that associates with any
element of 𝑆 a resulting element. If this resulting element is always also in 𝑆, then it is
said that 𝑆 is closed under the operation. The following are examples of unary
operations: the rule that associates with each integer 𝑎 its negative – 𝑎; the rule that
associates with each non-zero real number 𝑎 its inverse 1/𝑎; and the rule that
associates with any subset 𝐴 of a universal set 𝐸 its complement 𝐴′.
UNBALANCED ASSIGNMENT PROBLEM: Sometimes, during a problem, the number of
jobs is not equal to number of persons, that means our assignment matrix is not square.
Such kinds of problems are known as unbalanced assignment problem.
There types of problems are solved by the introduction of a supposed or dummy rows
or columns in which each element has zero cost to form a square matrix. The new
square matrix can be solved by the usual method of balanced assignment problem.
g x1 ) + ∆g(x1 z ≤ 0
has no solution on z ∇ Rn , then the dual problem has an unbounded objective function
on the set by dual feasible points Y.
UNBOUNDED FUNCTION: A function 𝑓(𝑥) not possessing both an upper and a lower
bound. So for all positive real values 𝑀 there is a value of the independent variable x for
which |𝑓(𝑥)| > 𝑀. For example, 𝑓(𝑥) = 𝑥 4 is unbounded because 𝑓(𝑥) ≥ 0 but
𝑓(𝑥) → ∞ as 𝑥 → ±∞, i.e. it is bounded below but not above, while 𝑓(𝑥) = 𝑥 3 has
neither upper nor lower bound.
UNBOUNDED SOLUTION: The solution of a LPP is said to be unbounded solution or LPP
is said to possess an unbounded solution if the value of the objective function can be
increased or decreased indefinitely.
UNCONDITIONAL INEQUALITY: An inequality that is always true, irrespective of the
values taken by the variables so 𝑥 2 + 4𝑥 + 13 > 0 is unconditional since it can be
expressed as (𝑥 + 2)2 + 9 > 0 which is always > 0, but 𝑥 2 + 4𝑥 + 3 > 0 is a
conditional inequality because it can be expressed as (𝑥 + 2)2 > 1 which is only true
for 𝑥 > −1 or 𝑥 < – 3.
UNCOUNTABLE SET: A set which is not countable, so the elements cannot be put into
one to-one correspondence with the natural numbers, or a subset of them.
UNDEFINED TERM: An undefined term is a basic concept that is described, rather than
given a rigorous definition. It would be impossible to rigorously define every term,
because sooner or later the definitions would become circular. “Plane” is an example of
an undefined term from spherical geometry.
UNDIRECTED GRAPH: An undirected graph (𝑉, 𝐸) consists of a finite set 𝑉 together with
a subset 𝐸 of 𝑉2 (where 𝑉2 is the set consisting of all subsets of 𝑉 with exactly two
elements). The elements of 𝑉 are the vertices of the graph; the elements of 𝐸 are the
edges of the graph.
UNIFORM AND NON-UNIFORM FLOWS: If at every point the velocity vector is identical
in magnitude and direction at any given instant, or, the conditions and properties are
independent of the coordinate of the direction in which the fluid is moving then the
motion is said to be uniform. If the flow characteristics at any given time change with
distance, it is said to be non-uniform. For example, a liquid pumped through a long
straight pipe has uniform flow whereas a liquid flowing through a curved pipe has non-
uniform flow.
then
A unitary matrix over the field of real numbers in orthogonal i.e., a real unitary matrix is
an orthogonal matrix.
1. 𝑈 is unitary;
3. 𝑈 is onto and preserves the inner product, i.e. ⟨ 𝑈𝑥, 𝑈𝑦 ⟩ = ⟨ 𝑥, 𝑦 ⟩ for all 𝑥, 𝑦 ∇ 𝐻.
UNIT CIRCLE: In the plane, the unit circle is the circle of radius 1 with its centre at the
origin. In Cartesian coordinates, it has equation 𝑥 2 + 𝑦 2 = 1. In the complex plane, it
represents those complex numbers 𝑧 such that |𝑧| = 1.
UNIT ELEMENT: An element 𝑢 of an integral domain 𝑅 is said to be a unit if there exists
some element 𝑢−1 of 𝑅 such that 𝑢𝑢−1 = 1.
UNITS MATRIX OR IDENTITY MATRIX: A square matrix each of whose diagonal elements
is 1 and each of whose non-diagonal elements is equal to zero is called a unit matrix or
an identity matrix and is denoted by I. In will denote a unit matrix of order n. Thus a
square matrix 𝐴 = 𝑎𝑖𝑗 is a unit matrix if𝑎𝑖𝑗 = 1 when 𝑖 = 𝑗 and 𝑎𝑖𝑗 = 0 when 𝑖 ≠ 𝑗.
For example,
1 0 0 0
0 1 0 0
I4 =
0 0 1 0
0 0 0 1
1 0 0
1 0
I3 0 1 0 , I2
0 1
0 0 1
UNIT VECTOR: A vector, whose modulus is unity, is called a unit vector. The unit vector
in the direction of vector 𝜶 is represented by 𝜶. It is read as ‘𝜶 Cap’.
UNIVALENT FUNCTION: The map ω = f(z) is called one-one (or one to one) function if
f z1 ⇒ z1 = z2
or z1 ≠ z2 ⇒ f z1 ≠ f z2
If the function ω = f(z) one-one, then it is also called univalent function, a fancy term for
one-one map.
UNIT CIRCLE: A unit circle is a circle with radius 1. If the unit circle is centered at the
origin, and (𝑥, 𝑦) is a point on the circle such that the line from the origin to that point
makes an angle 𝑢 with the 𝑥 −axis, then 𝑠𝑖𝑛 𝑢 = 𝑦 and 𝑐𝑜𝑠 𝑢 = 𝑥.
UNIT VECTOR: A unit vector is a vector of length 1. It is common to use 𝒊 to represent
the unit vector along the 𝑥-axis—that is, the vector whose components are (1,0,0).
Likewise, 𝒋 is used to represent (0,1,0), and 𝒌 represents (0,0,1). A three-dimensional
vector whose components are (𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧) can be written as the vector sum of each
component times the corresponding unit vector: 𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧 = 𝑥𝒊 + 𝑦𝒋 + 𝑧𝒌.
UNKNOWN CONSTANT: A constant whose value is not currently known. For example, in
the general equation of a straight line 𝑦 = 𝑚𝑥 + 𝑐, 𝑥 and 𝑦 are variables and 𝑚 and 𝑐
are unknown constants which are determined by the gradient and intercept of the
particular line.
UPPER AND LOWER BOUNDS: Characteristics of sets on the real line. The least upper
bound of a given set of real numbers is the smallest number bounding this set from
above; its greatest lower bound is the largest number bounding it from below. This will
now be restated in more detail. Let there be given a subset 𝑿 of the real numbers. A
number 𝜷 is said to be its least upper bound, denoted by sup𝑿 (from the Latin
"supremum" — largest), if every number 𝒙 ∇ 𝑿 satisfies the inequality 𝒙 ≤ 𝜷, and if for
any 𝜷′ < 𝜷 there exists an 𝒙′ ∇ 𝑿 such that 𝒙′ > 𝜷′. A number 𝜶 is said to be the greatest
lower bound of 𝑿, denoted by 𝒊𝒏𝒇𝑿 (from the Latin "infimum"-smallest), if every 𝒙 ∇
𝑿 satisfies the inequality 𝒙 ≥ 𝜶, and if for any 𝜶′ > 𝜶 there exists an 𝒙′ ∇ 𝑿 such
that 𝒙′ < 𝜶′.
Examples.
𝑖𝑛𝑓[𝑎, 𝑏] = 𝑎, 𝑠𝑢𝑝[𝑎, 𝑏] = 𝑏;
𝑖𝑛𝑓(𝑎, 𝑏) = 𝑎, 𝑠𝑢𝑝(𝑎, 𝑏) = 𝑏;
UPPER RIEMANN INTEGRAL: Let 𝑓 be a bounded function on a bounded interval [𝑎, 𝑏].
Then upper Riemann integral of 𝑓 over [𝑎, 𝑏] is the infimum of 𝑈 𝑃, 𝑓 over all
𝑏
partitions 𝑃 of [𝑎, 𝑏] and is denoted as ∫𝑎 𝑓𝑑𝑥.
UPPER RIEMANN-STIELTJES SUM: Let 𝑓 be a bounded real valued function on a
bounded interval [𝑎, 𝑏] and let 𝑔 be a monotonically non-decreasing function on [𝑎, 𝑏].
Let 𝑃 = 𝑥0 , 𝑥1 , 𝑥2 , 𝑥3 , … , 𝑥𝑛 be a partition of [𝑎, 𝑏]. We write
∆𝑔𝑖 = 𝑔𝑖 − 𝑔𝑖−1
Then upper Riemann-Stieltjes sum denoted by 𝑈(𝑃, 𝑓, 𝑔) is defined as
𝑛
𝑈 𝑃, 𝑓, 𝑔 = 𝑀𝑖 ∆𝑔𝑖
𝑖=1
Where
𝑀𝑖 = sup 𝑓(𝑥)
𝑥∇[𝑥 𝑖−1 ,𝑥 𝑖 ]
UPPER RIEMANN SUM: Let 𝑓 be a bounded function on a bounded interval [𝑎, 𝑏]. Let
𝑃 = 𝑥0 , 𝑥1 , 𝑥2 , 𝑥3 , … , 𝑥𝑛 be a partition of [𝑎, 𝑏]. Then upper Riemann sum denoted by
𝑈(𝑃, 𝑓) is defined as
𝑛
𝑈 𝑃, 𝑓 = 𝑀𝑖 𝑥𝑖 − 𝑥𝑖−1
𝑖=1
Where
𝑀𝑖 = sup 𝑓(𝑥)
𝑥∇[𝑥 𝑖−1 ,𝑥 𝑖 ]
Thus in an upper triangular matrix all the elements below the principle diagonal are
zero.
a11 a12 a13 … a1n
0 a22 a23 … a2n
For example A = 0 0 a33 … a3n
… … … … …
0 0 0 … amn
1 2 4 2
2 −9 0
0 3 −1 0
A= ,B = 0 1 2
0 0 2 1
0 0 1 3×3
0 0 0 8 4×4
URYSOHN’S LEMMA: Let 𝐾 be a compact space, and let 𝐸, 𝐹 be the closed subsets of 𝐾
with 𝐸 ∩ 𝐹 = ∅. There exists 𝑓: 𝐾 → [0,1] continuous with 𝑓(𝑥) = 1 for 𝑥 ∇ 𝐸 and
𝑓(𝑥) = 0 for 𝑥 ∇ 𝐹 (written 𝑓(𝐸) = {1} and 𝑓(𝐹) = {0}).
(i) If a set of vector is linearly dependent, then at least one member of the set can be
expressed as a linear combination of the remaining members.
(ii) If a set of vectors is linearly independent then no member of the set can be
expressed as a linear combination of the remaining member.
VECTOR SPACES: A vector space over a field K is a set V which has two basic operations,
addition and scalar multiplications, satisfying certain requirements. Thus for every pair
𝑢, 𝑣 𝜖 𝑉, 𝑢 + 𝑣 𝜖 𝑉 is defined, and for every 𝛼 𝜖 𝐾 , 𝛼𝑣 𝜖 𝑉 is defined.For V to be called
vector space, the following axioms must be satisfied for all α, β ϵ K and all 𝑢, 𝑣 𝜖 𝑉.
𝛼1 , 𝛼2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝛼𝑛 + 𝛽1 , 𝛽2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝛽𝑛 = 𝛼1 + 𝛽1 , 𝛼2 + 𝛽2 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝛼𝑛 + 𝛽𝑛 ;
ℝ2 = 𝑥, 𝑦 : 𝑥, 𝑦 𝜖ℝ
and
ℝ3 = 𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧 : 𝑥, 𝑦, 𝑧 𝜖ℝ
Which we can think of geometrically as the points in ordinary 2-and 3-dimensional
space, equipped with a coordinate system.
Note that the polynomials of degree exactly n do not form a vector space.
4: Let K=ℝ and let V be the set of n-times differentiable functions 𝑓: ℝ → ℝ which are
solutions of the differential equation
𝑑𝑛 𝑓 𝑑𝑛 −1 𝑓 𝑑𝑓
𝜇0 + 𝜇1 + ⋯ ⋯ + 𝜇 𝑛−1 + 𝜇𝑛 𝑓 = 0
𝑑𝑥 𝑛 𝑑𝑥 𝑛 −1 𝑑𝑥
For fixed 𝜇0 , 𝜇1 , ⋯ ⋯ , 𝜇𝑛 𝜖 ℝ .Then 𝑉 is a vector space over ℝ, for if 𝑓(𝑥) and 𝑔(𝑥) are
both solutions of this equation ,then so are 𝑓(𝑥) + 𝑔(𝑥) and 𝛼𝑓 𝑥 𝑓𝑜𝑟 𝑎𝑙𝑙 𝛼 𝜖 ℝ.
5: There are many such examples that are important in Analysis. For example, the set
𝑐 𝑘 0,1 , ℝ , consisting of all functions 𝑓: 0,1 → ℝ such that the kth derivative 𝑓 𝑘
exists and is continuous, is a vector space over ℝ with the usual pointwise definitions of
addition and scalar multiplication of functions.
If 𝑎1 , 𝑎2 , … , 𝑎𝑟 be a set of 𝑟 fixed vectors of 𝑉𝑛 , then the set 𝑆 of all 𝑛- vectors of the form
𝑝1 𝑎1 + 𝑝2 𝑎2 + ⋯ + 𝑝𝑟 𝑎𝑟 where 𝑝1 , 𝑝2 , … , 𝑝𝑟 are any scalers is a vector subspace of 𝑉𝑛 .
This vector space is said to be spanned by the vectors 𝑎1 , 𝑎2 , … , 𝑎𝑟 . Thus a vector space
which arises a set of all linear combinations of any given set of vectors is said to be
spanned by the given set of vectors.
VECTOR TRIPLE PRODUCT: The vector product of two vectors one of which is itself the
vector product of two vectors is a vector quantity called a “Vector Triple product”. Thus
if 𝒂, 𝒃, and 𝒄 be three vectors, the product of the form 𝒂 × 𝒃 × 𝒄 and 𝒂 × 𝒃 × 𝒄 etc.
are called “Vector Triple Products”.
VELOCITY POTENTIAL: If 𝑞 is the fluid velocity at any instant 𝑡 then the equation of the
streamline, at that instant are defined as
𝑑𝑥 𝑑𝑦 𝑑𝑧
= =
𝑢 𝑣 𝑤
𝑢 𝑑𝑥 + 𝑣 𝑑𝑦 + 𝑤 𝑑𝑧 = 0
−𝑑∅ = 𝑢 𝑑𝑥 + 𝑣 𝑑𝑦 + 𝑤 𝑑𝑧.
∂∅ ∂∅ ∂∅
Or − ∂x dx − ∂y dy − ∂z dz = 𝑢 𝑑𝑥 + 𝑣 𝑑𝑦 + 𝑤 𝑑𝑧.
∂∅ ∂∅ ∂∅
𝑢= , v = − ∂y , w = − ∂z
∂x
Or q = −∆∅ ,
where ∅ is termed the velocity potential for the filed 𝑞, the negative sign is taken as a
matter of convention.
VENN DIAGRAM:A Venn diagram is a picture that illustrates the relationships between
sets. The universal set you are considering is represented by a rectangle, and sets are
represented by circles or ellipses. The possible relationships between two sets A and B
are as follows:
Set B is a subset of set A.
Set A is a subset of set B.
Set A and set B are disjoint (they have no elements in common).
Set A and set B have some elements in common.
Venn diagram for the universal set of complex numbers is
VERTEX METHOD: For a linear programming problem where the decision variables are
not required to take integer values, the optimal solutions will occur at one or more of
the extreme points, i.e. vertices of the feasible region. The method of solution is to
calculate the value of the objective function at each vertex, and the maximum or
minimum (as required) of these values identifies any optimal solutions. Where more
than one such vertex is found, all points on the boundary of the feasible region between
them will also be an optimal solution.
VERTICAL LINE: The vertical line, also called the vertical slash or upright slash (|), is
used in mathematical notation in place of the expression "such that" or "it is true that."
This symbol is commonly encountered in statements involving logic and sets.
VERTICAL LINE TEST: The vertical line test can be used to determine if a relation is a
function. If a vertical line can be drawn that crosses two points on the graph of the
relation, then the relation is not a function.
VISCOSITY: Each element of fluid experiences stress exerted on it by other elements of
the fluid which surround it. The stress at each part of the surface of element is resolved
into two components: normal and tangential to the surface, which are called pressure
and shear stress respectively. Pressure is exerted whether the fluid is moving or at rest,
but shear stress occurs only in moving fluids. The feature is the one which enables fluids
to be distinguished from solids. Matter in solid form can exert shear stresses when at
rest, liquids and gases can not. The property which gives rise to shear stresses is called
viscosity. It is a measure of its resistance to flow. It is possessed by all real fluids and its
magnitude is expressed by a coefficient which relates the size of the shear stress at a
point in a fluid to the rate of shear strain which causes it.
The ratio of coefficient of viscosity μ to the mass density ρ of the fluid is known as the
coefficient of kinematic viscosity which is represented as 𝑣 = μ/ρ. The viscosity of a
fluid is practically independent of pressure and depends upon temperature only. The
kinematic viscosity of liquid at a given pressure is a function of temperature. The
dimensions of viscosity can be determined as
τ Shearingstress
μ= =
du/dy Velocityqradient
The kinematic viscosity, which is the ratio of absolute viscosity to the density, has
dimensions of length and time.
viscosity μ M/LT 2 −1
v= = = LT
density ρ M/L3
Viscosity of the fluid is practically independent of pressure and the depends upon the
temperature only.
VOGEL’S APPROXIMATION MEHTOD OR VAM METHOD OR PENALTY METHOD OR LEAST
ERROR METHOD: For each row and column remaining under consideration, calculate
its difference, the arithmetic difference between the smallest and next-to-the-smallest
unit cost 𝑐𝑖𝑗 still remaining in that row or column. In that row or column having the
largest difference, select the variable having the smallest remaining unit cost. VAM is the
most appropriate and lest error method, widely used for the solution of transportation
problems. The difference steps used for this method can be made well clear by the
following example:
2 7 4
2 3 3 1
5 4 7
1 6 2
5 2 7 4
3 3 8 1
5 7 4 8 7
2 1 2 6 10 2
7 9 18
2 7 4
3 3 8 1
5 4 7
1 6 2
Penalties 1 1 1
5 2 7 4
5 4 7
1 6 2
Penalties 1 2 2
5 4 7
2
1 6 10 2
Penalties 4 2 5
5 7 4
2 1 2 6
So, solution set is
5 0 0
0 0 8
0 7 0
2 2 10
Min cost 5 × 2 + 2 × 1 + 7 × 4 + 6 × 2 + 8 × 1 + 10 × 2
= 10 + 2 + 28 + 12 + 8 + 20
= 80
VOLUME: The volume of a solid is a measure of how much space it occupies. The volume
of a cube with edge a units long is 𝑎3 . Volumes of other solids are measured in cubic
units. The volume of a prism or cylinder is (base area) (altitude), and the volume of a
pyramid or cone is (1/3) (base area) (altitude).
VOLUME OF TETRAHEDRON: The volume of a tetrahedron, whose three coterminous
𝟏
edges in the right-handed orientation are 𝒂, 𝒃, 𝒄 is 𝟔 𝒂, 𝒃, 𝒄 .
The four points 𝒂, 𝒃, 𝒄, 𝒅 will be coplanar if the volume of the tetrahedron formed by
them is zero,
𝑎1 𝑎2 𝑎3 1
𝑏1 𝑏2 𝑏3 1
1 𝑐1 𝑐2 𝑐3 1
6 𝑑1 𝑑2 𝑑3 1
2𝑝 3
and 𝒓 ∙ 𝒍𝒊 + 𝒎𝒋 + 𝒎𝒌 = 𝒑 𝑖𝑠 .
3𝑙𝑚𝑛
VORTEX LINE: A vortex lien is a line whose direction coincides with the direction of the
instantaneous axis of molecular rotation. In other words, a line to which vorticity vector
are tangent at all its points is called a vortex line. The differential equation to the vortex
line is
dx dy dz
ω × dr = 0 ⇒ = =
ξ η ζ
VORTEX TUBE: A vortex tube is obtained if through every point of a small closed curve
(tube), the corresponding vortex cannot originate or terminate at internal points in
fluid. They can only form closed or terminate on boundaries. In the case of smoke rings
the vortex lines form closed curves where as in a whirlpool it terminate on the
boundary of the fluid.
The fluid contained within the vortex tube constitutes the vortex filaments or
simply vortices. The boundary of a vortex filament is called a vortex tube.
Every vortex is always composed of the same element of fluid.
The product of the angular velocity of any vortex into its cross-section is
constant with respect to the time, and is the same throughout its length.
Every vortex must either form a closed curve or have its extrenities in the
boundaries of fluid.
VORTICITY VECTOR: Let 𝑞 represents the velocity of a fluid motion, then the vorticity of
an element of fluid is defined as the curl of its velocity vector. That is, vorticity ω is
defined by ω = curl q.
Physically, vorticity may be generated in an inviscid fluid by the rotational body forces.
WAITING TIME: It is the time up to which a unit has to wait before it is taken into
service after arriving at the servicing station. This a studied with the help of waiting
time distribution.
A simple harmonic progressive wave represented by a sine curve moving with definite
velocity in the direction of its length is of the form
which shows that the profile y = a sin mx at t = 0 move, with velocity c(= n/m) along
the positive direction of the X- axis, c is called the velocity of propagation of the wave.
The maximum value of the disturbance y, viz. , a is called the amplitude of the wave. The
points P and P′ of maximum elevation are called the troughs of the wave. The distance
between successive crests is called the wave length and is denoted by λ i. e. , λ = 2π/m.
The aspect of the free surface is same at time t and t + 2π/n. Thus the period, T of a
wave is 2π/n. The reciprocal of a period is called the frequency. It denotes the number
of oscillations per second.
WEAK ARROW- HURWICZ- UZAWA CONSTRAINT: Let X 0 be an open set in Rn and let 𝑔
be an 𝑚- dimensional vector function defined on X 0 , and let
𝑋 = x: x ∇ X 0 , g(x) ≤ 0 .
𝑔 is said to satisfy the Weak Arrow- Hurwicz- Uzawa constraint qualification at x ∇ X if
𝑔 is differentiable at x, and ∆g Q x z > 0, ∆g Q x z ≥ 0 has a solution z ∇ Rn , where
𝑃 = i: g i x = 0, and g i is pseudoconcave at x and
𝑄 = i ∶ g i x = 0, and g i is pseudoconcave at x
Φ 𝑓𝑛 ⟶ Φ 𝑓 , 𝑎𝑠 𝑛 ⟶ ∞
WEAK DUALITY THEOREM: Let X 0 be open, and let θ and g be differentiable on X 0 . Then
x1 ∇ X, x 2 , u2 ∇ Y ⇒ θ x1 ≥ Ψ x 2 , u2
where θ and g are convex at x 2 and X and Y are defined in the (primal) minimization
problem and the dual (maximization) problem.
𝑋 = x: x ∇ X 0 , g(x) ≤ 0 .
WEAK TOPOLOGY AND STRONG TOPOLOGY: Let 𝑋 be a normed linear space and 𝑋’ its
dual space. Take a finite number of elements 𝑥1′ , 𝑥2′ , − − −, 𝑥𝑛′ from 𝑋’, and consider the
subset of X: {𝑥 ∇ 𝑋; 𝑠𝑢𝑝 ⌌𝒙, 𝒙′ ⌍ ≤∇}, ∇> 𝑂. If we take the totality of such subsets of 𝑋 as a
fundamental system of neighborhoods of 0 of 𝑋, then 𝑋 is a locally convex topological
linear space, denoted sometimes by 𝑋𝑤 . This topology is called the weak topology of 𝑋. If
a sequence {𝑥𝑛 } ⊆ 𝑋 converges to 𝑥 ∇ 𝑋 with respect to the weak topology of 𝑋, then
it is said to converge weakly. This is equivalent to the convergence (𝑥𝑛 , 𝒇 ) → (𝒙, 𝒇) for
any 𝒇 ∇ 𝑋’. The original topology of 𝑋 determined by the norm is then called the strong
topology of 𝑋, and to stress the strong topology we sometimes write 𝑋𝑠 in place of the
original 𝑋.
WEIERSTRASS APPROXIMATION THEOREM: For any function 𝑓 ∇ 𝐶[𝑎, 𝑏] and any є > 0
there exists a polynomial 𝑝 such that ||𝑓 − 𝑝||∞ < є.
where summation is extended over all positive and negative integral and zero values of
𝑚 and 𝑛, save 𝑚 = 𝑛 = 0.
p(z) is an analytic function whose only singularities are double poles of residue zero at
each of the point Ω𝑚 ,𝑛 .
∞
𝑧 𝑧 𝑧
ς 2/ω1 , ω2 = z 1− 𝑒𝑥𝑝. +
Ωm,n Ωm,n 2Ωm,n
𝑚 ,𝑛=∞
where multiplication is extended over all positive and negative integral and zero values
of 𝑚 = 𝑛 = 0.
ς 2/ω1 , ω2 is an integral function of order 2, with simple zeroes at the points Ωm,n .
This function is also denoted by ς(z).
WEIERSTRASS THEOREM: For any finite 𝐼 = [𝑎, 𝑏], 𝑃 is dense in 𝐶(𝐼), i.e., for each
𝑓 ∇ 𝐶(𝐼) and for each 𝜀 > 0 there exists some 𝑝 ∇ 𝑃 such that |𝑓(𝑥) − 𝑝(𝑥)| <
𝜀, 𝑎 ≤ 𝑥 ≤ 𝑏 .
WELL-FORMED FORMULA: A well-formed formula (or wff ) is a sequence of symbols
that is an acceptable formula in logic. For example, the sequence p AND q is a wff, but
the sequence AND pq is not a wff. Certain rules govern the formation of wff ’s in a
particular type of logic. Here is an example of such a rule: If p and q are wff’s, then (p
AND q) is also a wff.
WELL-ORDERING THEOREM: Every nonempty set 𝑆 of nonnegative integers contains a
least element; that is, there is some integer 𝑎 in 𝑆 such that 𝑎 ∇ 𝑏 for all 𝑏 belonging to
𝑆. In 1904, E. Zermelo first stated the axiom of choice and used it for his proof of the well
ordering theorem, which says that every set can be well-ordered by an appropriate
ordering. Conversely, the well-ordering theorem implies the axiom of choice. Many
important results in set theory can be obtained by using the axiom of choice, for
example, that Cardinal numbers are comparable, or that various definitions of the
finiteness or infiniteness of sets are equivalent. Various important theorems outside of
set theory, e.g., the existence of bases in a linear space, compactness of the direct
product of compact topological spaces Tikonov’s theorem , the existence of a subset
which is not Lebesgue measurable in Euclidean space, etc., are proved using the axiom
of choice.
for some 𝑡 greater than or equal to 1, then for any positive real number ∇ one has
WHITNEY SUM: A Whitney sum is an analog of the direct product for vector bundles.
Given two vector bundles 𝛼 and 𝛽 over the same base 𝐵 their Cartesian product is a
vector bundle over 𝐵 × 𝐵. The diagonal map induces a vector bundle
over 𝐵 called the Whitney sum of these vector bundles and denoted by 𝛼 ⊕ 𝛽.
We have:
(i) 𝑛(𝛤, 𝑎) is an integer.
(ii) If 𝜍 ∶ [𝑐, 𝑑] → 𝐶 is a path not intersecting 𝛤, then 𝑛(𝛤, 𝜍(𝑡)) is
constant, and hence if 𝐷 is a domain in 𝐶 not intersecting 𝛤, then
𝑛(𝛤, 𝑎) is constant on 𝐷.
(iii) If |𝑤| is large enough, 𝑛(𝛤, 𝑤) = 0.
(iv) If 𝛤 is the circle |𝑧 − 𝑎| = 𝑠 > 0, described once counter-
clockwise, then 𝑛(𝛤, 𝑎) = 1.
WLOG: “WLOG” or “WOLOG” is an acronym which stands for “without loss of
generality.” WLOG is invoked in situations where some property of a model or system is
invariant under the particular choice of instance attributes, but for the sake of
demonstration, these attributes must be fixed.
WOLFE’S DUALITY THEOREM: Let X 0 be an open set in Rn and let 𝜃 and 𝑔 be
differentiable and convex on X 0 , let x solves maximization problem. Let g satisfy any one
of the six constraint qualifications. Then there exists u ∇ Rm such that (x, u) solves the
dual problem (maximization) DP and θ x = Ψ x, u .
WORK: Force acting on a particle does work when the particle is displaced in a direction
which is not perpendicular to the force. The work done is a scalar quantity and its
measure is equal to the product of the magnitude of the force and the resolved part of
the displacement in the direction of the force. Thus if F, d are vectors representing the
force and displacement respectively inclined at an angle 𝜃, the measure of the work
done is = F. d i. e. w = Fd cos θ = F d cosθ, where F = F and d = d .
From the above, it is clear that the work done is zero only where 𝜃 = 𝜋/2 i.e. when d is
perpendicular to F.
WORK–ENERGY PRINCIPLE: The principle that the change in kinetic energy of a particle
during some time interval is equal to the work done by the total force acting on the
particle during the time interval.
x, y COORDINATES: 𝑥, 𝑦 coordinates are respectively the horizontal and vertical
addresses of any pixel or addressable point on a computer display screen.
The x coordinate is a given number of pixels along the horizontal axis of a display
starting from the pixel (pixel 0) on the extreme left of the screen. The y coordinate is a
given number of pixels along the vertical axis of a display starting from the pixel (pixel
0) at the top of the screen. Together, the x and y coordinates locate any specific pixel
location on the screen. x and y coordinates can also be specified as values relative to any
starting point on the screen or any subset of the screen such as an image. On the Web,
each clickable area of an image map is specified as a pair of x and y coordinates relative
to the upper left-hand corner of the image.
X-INTERCEPT: The 𝑥-intercept of a curve is the value of 𝑥 at the point where the curve
crosses the 𝑥 -axis.
Y-INTERCEPT: The 𝑦-intercept of a curve is the value of 𝑦 at the point where the curve
crosses the 𝑦-axis.
YOUNG’S INEQUALITY: Let two real numbers 1 < 𝑝, 𝑞 < ∞ are related through
𝑎 𝑝 𝑏 𝑞
1/𝑝 + 1/𝑞 = 1 then 𝑎𝑏 ≤ + for any complex 𝑎 and 𝑏.
𝑝 𝑞
1. AXIOM OF EXTENSIONALITY:
∀𝑥 𝑥 𝜖 𝑎 ≡ 𝑥 𝜖 𝑏 → 𝑎 = 𝑏.
This asserts that sets formed by the same elements are equal. The formula 𝑥 𝜖 𝑎 (𝑥 𝜖 𝑏)
is denoted by 𝑎 ⊂ 𝑏. This means “𝑎 is a subset of 𝑏.” Then Axiom 1 can be expressed by
𝑎 ⊂ 𝑏 ∧ 𝑏 ⊂ 𝑎 → 𝑎 = 𝑏.
∃𝑥∀𝑦 𝑦 𝜖 𝑥 ≡ 𝑦 𝜖 𝑎 ∨ 𝑦 = 𝑏 .
This asserts the existence, for any sets a and b, of a set 𝑥 having a and b as its only
elements. This 𝑥 is called the unordered pair of a and b and is denoted by 𝑎, 𝑏 . The
notion of ordered pair is characterized by
𝑎, 𝑏 = 𝑐. 𝑑 ≡ 𝑎 = 𝑐 ∨ 𝑏 = 𝑑.
An example of such is 𝑎, 𝑏 = 𝑎, 𝑎 , 𝑎, 𝑏 .
∃𝑥∀𝑦 𝑦 𝜖 𝑥 ≡ ∃𝑧 𝜖 𝑎(𝑦𝜖𝑧) .
This asserts the existence, for any sets a of the sum (or union) 𝑥 of all the sets that are
elements of a. This 𝑥 is denoted by the 𝑈𝑎 or 𝑆(𝑎). We write a 𝑈𝑏 for 𝑈 𝑎, 𝑏 and
𝑎′ for 𝑎𝑈{𝑎. 𝑎}.
4. AXIOM OF THE POWER SET:
∀𝑥∃𝑦 𝑦 𝜖 𝑥 ≡ ∀𝑧 𝜖 𝑦(𝑧𝜖𝑎) .
This asserts the existence, for any sets a of the power set 𝑥 consisting of all the subsets
of a. This 𝑥 is denoted by 𝑃𝑎. We have 𝑆(𝑃 𝑎 = 𝑎, 𝑠𝑜 𝑆 is a left inverse of 𝑃 and the
products 𝑆𝑃 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝑃𝑆 are idempotent.
∃𝑥∀𝑦 ℸ𝑦 𝜖 𝑥 .
This asserts the existence of the empty set. The empty set is denoted by ⊘ or 0.
6. AXIOM OF INFINITY:
∃𝑥 0 𝜖 𝑥 ∨ ∀ 𝑦 𝜖 𝑥(𝑦 ′ 𝜖𝑥) .
This asserts the existence of the set consisting all the natural numbers, whereas
0,1 = 0′ = 0 , 2 = 1′ = 0,1 , 3 = 2′ = 0,1,2 . This definition of natural number is due
to von Neumann.
7. AXIOM OF SEPARATION:
∃𝑥∀𝑦 𝑦 𝜖 𝑥 ≡ 𝑦 𝜖 𝑎 ⋀ 𝐴 (𝑦) .
This asserts that the existence for any set a and a formula 𝐴(𝑦) of a set 𝑥 consisting of all
element of a satisfying 𝐴(𝑦). This 𝑥 is denoted by {𝑦𝜖𝑎 𝐴 𝑦 }. This is rather a schema for
an infinite number of axioms, for there are an infinite number of 𝐴(𝑦). This axiom, also
called the axiom of comprehension or axiom of subsets, was introduced by Zermelo.
8. AXIOM OF REPLACEMENT:
9. AXIOM OF REGULARITY:
ℸ(𝑥𝜖𝑦 𝐴 𝑦𝜖 𝑥), etc. If we assume the axiom of choice stated below, then this is equivalent
to the nonexistence of an infinite descending sequence
𝑥𝑛 ∇ ⋯ ∇ 𝑥2 ∇ 𝑥1 .
If a model e1 of a set theory satisfies the axiom of regularity and has an infinite
descending sequence that is not in the model, then such a model is called a nonstandard
model.
This asserts that if for any element 𝑥 of a there is a set 𝑦 such that 𝐴(𝑥, 𝑦), then there is a
choice function 𝑦 for the formula, i.e., 𝐴 𝑥, 𝑦 𝑥 for all 𝑥 in a. Usually a function is
represented by its graph. A set 𝑓 is called a function defined on a if
∀𝑥 ∇ 𝑎∀𝑦𝐴𝑧 𝑥, 𝑦 ∇ 𝑓⋀ 𝑥, 𝑧 ∇ 𝑓 → 𝑦 = 𝑧).
The theory ZF minus the axiom of infinity is called general set theory.
ZERO: Intuitively, zero means nothing—for example, the score that each team has at the
beginning of a game is zero. Formally, zero is the identity element for addition, which
means that, if you add zero to any number, the number remains unchanged. In our
number system the symbol “0” also serves as a placeholder in the decimal
representation of a number. Without zero we would have trouble telling the difference
between 1000 and 10.
ZERO DIVISORS: Non-zero elements in a ring whose product is zero. There are no zero
divisors within the real or complex numbers, but there are in other systems. For
1 0 0 0 0 0
example, if 𝑨 = and 𝑩 = then AB=BA= , so 𝑨 and 𝑩 are zero
0 0 0 1 0 0
divisors within the ring of 2 × 2 matrices, defined with the usual matrix addition and
multiplication.
ZERO ELEMENT: An element 𝑧 is a zero element for a binary operation ° on a set 𝑆 if, for
all 𝑎 in 𝑆, 𝑎 ° 𝑧 = 𝑧 ° 𝑎 = 𝑧. Thus the real number 0 is a zero element for multiplication
since, for all 𝑎, 𝑎° = °𝑎 = 0. The term ‘zero element’, also denoted by 0, may be used
for an element such that 𝑎 + 0 = 0 + 𝑎 = 𝑎 for all 𝑎 in 𝑆, when S is a set with a
binary operation + called addition. Strictly speaking, this is a neutral element for the
operation +.
ZERO FUNCTION: In real analysis, the zero function is the real function 𝑓 such that
𝑓(𝑥) = 0 for all 𝑥 in 𝑹.
ZERO MATRIX: The 𝑚 × 𝑛 zero matrix 𝑶 is the 𝑚 × 𝑛 matrix with all its entries zero. A
zero column matrix or row matrix may be denoted by 𝟎.
ZERO OF AN ANALYTIC FUNCTION: A zero of an analytic function 𝑓(𝑧) is a value of 𝑧
such that 𝑓 𝑧 = 0.
𝑓 𝑧 = (𝑧 − 𝑎)𝑚 ∅ 𝑧 ,
Where ∅(𝑧) is analytic and ∅ 𝛼 ≠ 0. 𝑓(𝑧) is said to have a simple zero at 𝑧 = 𝛼 if 𝑧 = 𝛼
is a zero of order one.
𝑛
If there exists no finite value of 𝑛 𝑠. 𝑡. lim𝑧→𝛼 𝑧 − 𝛼 𝑓 𝑧 = 𝑐 = finite non-zero
constant, then 𝑧 = 𝛼 is called essential singlularity.
ZERO OR NULL VECTOR: The zero or the null vector is a vector whose modulus is zero,
and whose direction is indeterminate. The null vector is represented by the symbol 0. In
the case of the null vector, the initial and terminal points coincide. Thus 𝐴𝐴, 𝑂𝑂 etc. are
null vectors.
ZERO-ONE LAWS: In probability theory there are many theorems claiming that an event
with certain properties has probability 0 or 1. Such theorems are called zero-one laws,
we mention two famous examples, Kolmogorov’z zero-one law and the Hewitt- Savage
zero-one law. Let 𝛼 = 𝛼(𝑋1 , 𝑋2 , … ) be an event concerning a sequence of random
variables 𝑋𝑛 if for every 𝑛, occurrence or nonoccurrence of 𝛼 depends only on
𝑋𝑛 , 𝑋𝑛+1 , … . For example, lim𝑛→∞ 𝑋𝑛 = 0 is a tail event, 𝛼 is called a symmetric event
concerning 𝑋𝑛 if occurrence or nonoccurrence of 𝛼 is invariant under every finite
𝑛
permutation of 𝑋1 , 𝑋2 , ⋯ For example, the event that 𝑘=1 𝑋𝑘 > 0 for infinitely many 𝑛’s
is a symmetric event. Kolmogorov’s zero-one law. Every tail event concerning a
sequence of independent random variables has probability 0 or 1.
ZERO SUM AND NON-ZERO SUM GAME: A game is known as zero sum game in which the
net gain or not profit after the game is zero means nothing comes from outside,
payment is always between the players , the loss of one player is the gain of others , and
a game which is not zero sum game is known as non- zero sum game.
ZORN’S LEMMA: An ordered set 𝑋 is called an inductively ordered set if every totally
ordered subset of 𝑋 has an upper bound. A condition 𝐶 for sets is called a condition of
finite character if a set 𝑋 satisfies C if and only if every finite subset of 𝑋 satisfies 𝐶. A
condition 𝐶 for functions is called a condition of finite character if 𝐶 is a condition of
finite character for the graph of the function. Zorn’s lemma can be stated in any one of
the following ways, which are all equivalent to the axiom of choice. It is often more
convenient to use than the axiom of choice or the well-ordering theorem.
(1) Every inductively ordered set has at least one maximal element.
(2) If every well-ordered subset of an ordered set 𝑀 has an Upper bound, then there is
at least one maximal element in 𝑀.
(3) Every ordered set 𝐴 has a well-ordered subset W such that every Upper bound of 𝑀
belongs to 𝑊 .
(4) For a condition 𝐶 of finite character for sets, every set 𝑋 has a maximal (for the
relation of the inclusion) subset of 𝑋 that satisfies 𝐶.
(5) Let 𝐶 be a condition of finite character for functions from 𝑋 to 𝑌. Then, in the set of
functions that satisfy 𝐶, there is a function whose domain is maximal (for the relation of
the inclusion)